utils: Use Guile-zlib for gzip compression and decompression.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020, 2021 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 Nikita Gillmann@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2020, 2021 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2021 Christopher Lemmer Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020, 2021 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2021 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019, 2020 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
78 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Naga Malleswari@*
79 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Brice Waegeneire@*
80 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 R Veera Kumar@*
81 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Pierre Langlois@*
82 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 pinoaffe@*
83 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 André Batista@*
84 Copyright @copyright{} 2020, 2021 Alexandru-Sergiu Marton@*
85 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 raingloom@*
86 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Daniel Brooks@*
87 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 John Soo@*
88 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jonathan Brielmaier@*
89 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Edgar Vincent@*
90
91 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
92 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
93 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
94 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
95 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
96 Documentation License''.
97 @end copying
98
99 @dircategory System administration
100 @direntry
101 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
102 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
103 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
104 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
105 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
106 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
107 @end direntry
108
109 @dircategory Software development
110 @direntry
111 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
112 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
113 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
114 @end direntry
115
116 @titlepage
117 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
118 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
119 @author The GNU Guix Developers
120
121 @page
122 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
123 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
124 @value{UPDATED} @*
125
126 @insertcopying
127 @end titlepage
128
129 @contents
130
131 @c *********************************************************************
132 @node Top
133 @top GNU Guix
134
135 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
136 package management tool written for the GNU system.
137
138 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
139 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
140 @c translation.
141 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
142 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
143 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
144 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
145 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
146 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining
147 @uref{https://translate.fedoraproject.org/projects/guix/documentation-manual,
148 Weblate}.
149
150 @menu
151 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
152 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
153 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
154 * Getting Started:: Your first steps.
155 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
156 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
157 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
158 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
159 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
160 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
161 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
162 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
163 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
164 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
165 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
166 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
167
168 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
169 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
170 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
171 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
172
173 @detailmenu
174 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
175
176 Introduction
177
178 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
179 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
180
181 Installation
182
183 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
184 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
185 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
186 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
187 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
188 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
189 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
190
191 Setting Up the Daemon
192
193 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
194 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
195 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
196
197 System Installation
198
199 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
200 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
201 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
202 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
203 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
204 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
205 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
206 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
207 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
208
209 Manual Installation
210
211 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
212 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
213
214 Package Management
215
216 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
217 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
218 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
219 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
220 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
221 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
222 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
223 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
224 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
225 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
226
227 Substitutes
228
229 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
230 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
231 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
232 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
233 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
234 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
235 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
236
237 Channels
238
239 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
240 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
241 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
242 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
243 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
244 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
245 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
246 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
247 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
248 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
249 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
250
251 Development
252
253 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
254 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
255 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
256 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
257
258 Programming Interface
259
260 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
261 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
262 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
263 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
264 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
265 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
266 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
267 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
268 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
269 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
270 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile.
271
272 Defining Packages
273
274 * package Reference:: The package data type.
275 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
276
277 Utilities
278
279 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
280 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
281 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
282 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
283 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
284 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
285 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
286 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
287 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
288 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
289 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
290 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
291 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
292 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
293 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
294
295 Invoking @command{guix build}
296
297 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
298 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
299 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
300 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
301
302 System Configuration
303
304 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
305 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
306 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
307 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
308 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
309 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
310 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
311 * Services:: Specifying system services.
312 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
313 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
314 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
315 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
316 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
317 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
318 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
319 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
320 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
321
322 Services
323
324 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
325 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
326 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
327 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
328 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
329 * X Window:: Graphical display.
330 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
331 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
332 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
333 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
334 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
335 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
336 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
337 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
338 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
339 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
340 * Web Services:: Web servers.
341 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
342 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
343 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
344 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
345 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
346 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
347 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
348 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
349 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
350 * Game Services:: Game servers.
351 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
352 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
353 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
354 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
355 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
356
357 Defining Services
358
359 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
360 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
361 * Service Reference:: API reference.
362 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
363
364 Installing Debugging Files
365
366 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
367 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
368
369 Bootstrapping
370
371 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
372 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
373
374 @end detailmenu
375 @end menu
376
377 @c *********************************************************************
378 @node Introduction
379 @chapter Introduction
380
381 @cindex purpose
382 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
383 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
384 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
385 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
386 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
387 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
388 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
389
390 @cindex Guix System
391 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
392 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
393 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
394 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
395 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
396 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
397 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
398 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
399 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
400 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
401
402 @menu
403 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
404 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
405 @end menu
406
407 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
408 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
409
410 @cindex user interfaces
411 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
412 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
413 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage
414 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
415 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
416 @cindex build daemon
417 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
418 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
419 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
420
421 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
422 @cindex customization, of packages
423 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
424 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
425 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
426 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
427 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
428 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
429 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
430 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
431
432 @cindex functional package management
433 @cindex isolation
434 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
435 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
436 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
437 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
438 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
439 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
440 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
441 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
442 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
443 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
444 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
445 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
446 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
447 explicit inputs are visible.
448
449 @cindex store
450 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
451 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
452 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
453 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
454 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
455 input yields a different directory name.
456
457 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
458 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
459 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
460
461
462 @node GNU Distribution
463 @section GNU Distribution
464
465 @cindex Guix System
466 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
467 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
468 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
469 users of that software}.}. The
470 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
471 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
472 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
473 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
474 Guix@tie{}System.
475
476 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
477 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
478 list of available packages can be browsed
479 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
480 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
481
482 @example
483 guix package --list-available
484 @end example
485
486 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
487 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
488 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
489 tools that help users exert that freedom.
490
491 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
492
493 @table @code
494
495 @item x86_64-linux
496 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel.
497
498 @item i686-linux
499 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel.
500
501 @item armhf-linux
502 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
503 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
504 and Linux-Libre kernel.
505
506 @item aarch64-linux
507 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
508
509 @item i586-gnu
510 @uref{https://hurd.gnu.org, GNU/Hurd} on the Intel 32-bit architecture
511 (IA32).
512
513 This configuration is experimental and under development. The easiest
514 way for you to give it a try is by setting up an instance of
515 @code{hurd-vm-service-type} on your GNU/Linux machine
516 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, @code{hurd-vm-service-type}}).
517 @xref{Contributing}, on how to help!
518
519 @item mips64el-linux (deprecated)
520 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
521 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
522 supported; in particular, there is no ongoing work to ensure that this
523 architecture still works. Should someone decide they wish to revive this
524 architecture then the code is still available.
525
526 @end table
527
528 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
529 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
530 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
531 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
532 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
533 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
534 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
535
536 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
537 @code{mips64el-linux}.
538
539 @noindent
540 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
541 @pxref{Porting}.
542
543 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
544 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
545
546
547 @c *********************************************************************
548 @node Installation
549 @chapter Installation
550
551 @cindex installing Guix
552
553 @quotation Note
554 We recommend the use of this
555 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
556 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
557 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
558 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
559 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
560 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
561 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
562 as the root user.
563 @end quotation
564
565 @cindex foreign distro
566 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
567 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
568 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
569 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
570 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
571
572 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
573 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
574
575 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
576 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
577 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
578 ready to use it.
579
580 @menu
581 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
582 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
583 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
584 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
585 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
586 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
587 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
588 @end menu
589
590 @node Binary Installation
591 @section Binary Installation
592
593 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
594 @cindex installer script
595 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
596 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
597 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
598 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
599 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
600
601 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
602 @quotation Note
603 We recommend the use of this
604 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
605 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
606 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
607 user. As root, you can thus run this:
608
609 @example
610 cd /tmp
611 wget https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh
612 chmod +x guix-install.sh
613 ./guix-install.sh
614 @end example
615
616 When you're done, @pxref{Application Setup} for extra configuration you
617 might need, and @ref{Getting Started} for your first steps!
618 @end quotation
619
620 Installing goes along these lines:
621
622 @enumerate
623 @item
624 @cindex downloading Guix binary
625 Download the binary tarball from
626 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz},
627 where @code{x86_64-linux} can be replaced with @code{i686-linux} for an
628 @code{i686} (32-bits) machine already running the kernel Linux, and so on
629 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
630
631 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
632 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
633 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
634
635 @example
636 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
637 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz.sig
638 @end example
639
640 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
641 then run this command to import it:
642
643 @example
644 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
645 -qO - | gpg --import -
646 @end example
647
648 @noindent
649 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
650
651 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
652 signature!'' is normal.
653
654 @c end authentication part
655
656 @item
657 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
658 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
659
660 @example
661 # cd /tmp
662 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
663 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.tar.xz
664 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
665 @end example
666
667 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
668 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
669 step).
670
671 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
672 would overwrite its own essential files.
673
674 The @option{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
675 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
676 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
677 versions are fine).
678 They stem from the fact that all the
679 files in the archive have their modification time set to 1 (which
680 means January 1st, 1970). This is done on purpose to make sure the
681 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
682 reproducible.
683
684 @item
685 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
686 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
687
688 @example
689 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
690 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
691 ~root/.config/guix/current
692 @end example
693
694 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @env{PATH} and other relevant
695 environment variables:
696
697 @example
698 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
699 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
700 @end example
701
702 @item
703 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
704 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
705
706 @item
707 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
708
709 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
710 with these commands:
711
712 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
713 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
714 @c files into place.
715 @c
716 @c See this thread for more information:
717 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
718
719 @example
720 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/gnu-store.mount \
721 ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
722 /etc/systemd/system/
723 # systemctl enable --now gnu-store.mount guix-daemon
724 @end example
725
726 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
727
728 @example
729 # initctl reload-configuration
730 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
731 /etc/init/
732 # start guix-daemon
733 @end example
734
735 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
736
737 @example
738 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
739 --build-users-group=guixbuild
740 @end example
741
742 @item
743 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
744 for instance with:
745
746 @example
747 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
748 # cd /usr/local/bin
749 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
750 @end example
751
752 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
753 there:
754
755 @example
756 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
757 # cd /usr/local/share/info
758 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
759 do ln -s $i ; done
760 @end example
761
762 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
763 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
764 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
765 Info search path).
766
767 @item
768 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
769 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
770 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
771
772 @example
773 # guix archive --authorize < \
774 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
775 @end example
776
777 @item
778 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
779 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
780 @end enumerate
781
782 Voilà, the installation is complete!
783
784 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
785 the root profile:
786
787 @example
788 # guix install hello
789 @end example
790
791 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
792 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
793
794 @example
795 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
796 @end example
797
798 @noindent
799 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
800
801 @example
802 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
803 --profile-name=current-guix guix
804 @end example
805
806 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
807
808 @node Requirements
809 @section Requirements
810
811 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
812 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
813 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
814 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
815
816 @cindex official website
817 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
818 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
819
820 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
821
822 @itemize
823 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
824 2.2.x;
825 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
826 0.1.0 or later;
827 @item
828 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
829 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
830 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
831 @item
832 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
833 or later;
834 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zlib/guile-zlib, Guile-zlib},
835 version 0.1.0 or later;
836 @item @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-lzlib/guile-lzlib, Guile-lzlib};
837 @item @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-avahi/, Guile-Avahi};
838 @item
839 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
840 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, version 0.3.0
841 or later;
842 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON}
843 4.3.0 or later;
844 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
845 @end itemize
846
847 The following dependencies are optional:
848
849 @itemize
850 @item
851 @c Note: We need at least 0.13.0 for #:nodelay.
852 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
853 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
854 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
855 version 0.13.0 or later.
856
857 @item
858 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-zstd/guile-zstd, Guile-zstd}, for zstd
859 compression and decompression in @command{guix publish} and for
860 substitutes (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
861
862 @item
863 @uref{https://ngyro.com/software/guile-semver.html, Guile-Semver} for
864 the @code{crate} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
865
866 @item
867 @uref{https://www.nongnu.org/guile-lib/doc/ref/htmlprag/, Guile-Lib} for
868 the @code{go} importer (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
869
870 @item
871 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
872 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
873 @end itemize
874
875 Unless @option{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
876 following packages are also needed:
877
878 @itemize
879 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
880 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
881 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
882 C++11 standard.
883 @end itemize
884
885 @cindex state directory
886 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
887 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
888 using the @option{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
889 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
890 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
891 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
892 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
893 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
894
895 @node Running the Test Suite
896 @section Running the Test Suite
897
898 @cindex test suite
899 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
900 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
901 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
902 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
903 suite, type:
904
905 @example
906 make check
907 @end example
908
909 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
910 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
911 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
912 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
913 cache.
914
915 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
916 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
917
918 @example
919 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
920 @end example
921
922 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
923 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
924 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
925
926 @example
927 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
928 @end example
929
930 The underlying SRFI 64 custom Automake test driver used for the 'check'
931 test suite (located at @file{build-aux/test-driver.scm}) also allows
932 selecting which test cases to run at a finer level, via its
933 @option{--select} and @option{--exclude} options. Here's an example, to
934 run all the test cases from the @file{tests/packages.scm} test file
935 whose names start with ``transaction-upgrade-entry'':
936
937 @example
938 export SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--select=^transaction-upgrade-entry"
939 make check TESTS="tests/packages.scm"
940 @end example
941
942 Those wishing to inspect the results of failed tests directly from the
943 command line can add the @option{--errors-only=yes} option to the
944 @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable and set the @code{VERBOSE}
945 Automake makefile variable, as in:
946
947 @example
948 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --errors-only=yes" VERBOSE=1
949 @end example
950
951 The @option{--show-duration=yes} option can be used to print the
952 duration of the individual test cases, when used in combination with
953 @option{--brief=no}:
954
955 @example
956 make check SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no --show-duration=yes"
957 @end example
958
959 @xref{Parallel Test Harness,,,automake,GNU Automake} for more
960 information about the Automake Parallel Test Harness.
961
962 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
963 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
964 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
965 your message.
966
967 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
968 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
969 Guix is already installed, using:
970
971 @example
972 make check-system
973 @end example
974
975 @noindent
976 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
977
978 @example
979 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
980 @end example
981
982 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
983 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
984 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
985 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
986 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
987 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
988
989 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
990 all the details.
991
992 @node Setting Up the Daemon
993 @section Setting Up the Daemon
994
995 @cindex daemon
996 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
997 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
998 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
999 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
1000 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
1001 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
1002 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
1003
1004 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
1005 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
1006 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
1007
1008 @menu
1009 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
1010 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
1011 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
1012 @end menu
1013
1014 @node Build Environment Setup
1015 @subsection Build Environment Setup
1016
1017 @cindex build environment
1018 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
1019 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
1020 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
1021 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
1022 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
1023 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
1024 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
1025
1026 @cindex build users
1027 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
1028 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
1029 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
1030 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
1031 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
1032 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
1033 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
1034 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
1035 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
1036 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
1037
1038 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
1039 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
1040
1041 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
1042 @c for why `-G' is needed.
1043 @example
1044 # groupadd --system guixbuild
1045 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
1046 do
1047 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
1048 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
1049 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
1050 guixbuilder$i;
1051 done
1052 @end example
1053
1054 @noindent
1055 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
1056 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
1057 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
1058 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
1059 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
1060 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
1061 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
1062
1063 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
1064 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
1065 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
1066 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
1067 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
1068 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
1069 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
1070 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
1071
1072 @example
1073 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1074 @end example
1075
1076 @cindex chroot
1077 @noindent
1078 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
1079 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
1080 environment contains nothing but:
1081
1082 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
1083 @itemize
1084 @item
1085 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
1086 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
1087 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
1088 can only be created if the host has them.};
1089
1090 @item
1091 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
1092 since a separate PID name space is used;
1093
1094 @item
1095 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
1096 user @file{nobody};
1097
1098 @item
1099 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
1100
1101 @item
1102 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
1103 @code{127.0.0.1};
1104
1105 @item
1106 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
1107 @end itemize
1108
1109 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
1110 @i{via} the @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
1111 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
1112 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
1113 This way, the value of @env{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1114 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1115 capture the name of their build tree.
1116
1117 @vindex http_proxy
1118 @vindex https_proxy
1119 The daemon also honors the @env{http_proxy} and @env{https_proxy}
1120 environment variables for HTTP and HTTPS downloads it performs, be it
1121 for fixed-output derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes
1122 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1123
1124 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1125 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @option{--disable-chroot}.
1126 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1127 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1128 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1129 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1130 @emph{pure} functions.
1131
1132
1133 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1134 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1135
1136 @cindex offloading
1137 @cindex build hook
1138 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1139 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1140 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1141 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1142 present.}. When that feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build
1143 machines is read from @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build
1144 is requested, for instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to
1145 offload it to one of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the
1146 derivation, in particular its system types---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
1147 A single machine can have multiple system types, either because its
1148 architecture natively supports it, via emulation
1149 (@pxref{transparent-emulation-qemu, Transparent Emulation with QEMU}),
1150 or both. Missing prerequisites for the build are
1151 copied over SSH to the target machine, which then proceeds with the
1152 build; upon success the output(s) of the build are copied back to the
1153 initial machine. The offload facility comes with a basic scheduler that
1154 attempts to select the best machine. The best machine is chosen among
1155 the available machines based on criteria such as:
1156
1157 @enumerate
1158 @item
1159 The availability of a build slot. A build machine can have as many
1160 build slots (connections) as the value of the @code{parallel-builds}
1161 field of its @code{build-machine} object.
1162
1163 @item
1164 Its relative speed, as defined via the @code{speed} field of its
1165 @code{build-machine} object.
1166
1167 @item
1168 Its load. The normalized machine load must be lower than a threshold
1169 value, configurable via the @code{overload-threshold} field of its
1170 @code{build-machine} object.
1171
1172 @item
1173 Disk space availability. More than a 100 MiB must be available.
1174 @end enumerate
1175
1176 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1177
1178 @lisp
1179 (list (build-machine
1180 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1181 (systems (list "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux"))
1182 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1183 (user "bob")
1184 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1185
1186 (build-machine
1187 (name "armeight.example.org")
1188 (systems (list "aarch64-linux"))
1189 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1190 (user "alice")
1191 (private-key
1192 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1193 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1194 @end lisp
1195
1196 @noindent
1197 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1198 the @code{x86_64} and @code{i686} architectures and one for the
1199 @code{aarch64} architecture.
1200
1201 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1202 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1203 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1204 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1205 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1206 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1207 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1208 detailed below.
1209
1210 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1211 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1212 builds. The important fields are:
1213
1214 @table @code
1215
1216 @item name
1217 The host name of the remote machine.
1218
1219 @item systems
1220 The system types the remote machine supports---e.g., @code{(list
1221 "x86_64-linux" "i686-linux")}.
1222
1223 @item user
1224 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1225 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1226 allow non-interactive logins.
1227
1228 @item host-key
1229 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1230 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1231 long string that looks like this:
1232
1233 @example
1234 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1235 @end example
1236
1237 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1238 key can be found in a file such as
1239 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1240
1241 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1242 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1243 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1244 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1245
1246 @example
1247 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1248 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1249 @end example
1250
1251 @end table
1252
1253 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1254
1255 @table @asis
1256
1257 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1258 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1259
1260 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1261 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1262 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1263
1264 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1265 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1266
1267 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1268 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1269 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1270
1271 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1272 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1273
1274 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1275 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1276 to on that machine.
1277
1278 @item @code{overload-threshold} (default: @code{0.6})
1279 The load threshold above which a potential offload machine is
1280 disregarded by the offload scheduler. The value roughly translates to
1281 the total processor usage of the build machine, ranging from 0.0 (0%) to
1282 1.0 (100%). It can also be disabled by setting
1283 @code{overload-threshold} to @code{#f}.
1284
1285 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1286 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1287
1288 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1289 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1290 machines with a higher speed factor.
1291
1292 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1293 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1294 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1295 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1296 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1297
1298 @end table
1299 @end deftp
1300
1301 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1302 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1303
1304 @example
1305 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1306 @end example
1307
1308 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1309 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1310 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1311 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1312 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1313
1314 @example
1315 # guix archive --generate-key
1316 @end example
1317
1318 @noindent
1319 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1320 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1321
1322 @example
1323 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1324 @end example
1325
1326 @noindent
1327 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1328
1329 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1330 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1331 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1332 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1333 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1334
1335 @cindex offload test
1336 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1337 master node:
1338
1339 @example
1340 # guix offload test
1341 @end example
1342
1343 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1344 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guix is
1345 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1346 from it, and report any error in the process.
1347
1348 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1349 command line:
1350
1351 @example
1352 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1353 @end example
1354
1355 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1356 regular expression like this:
1357
1358 @example
1359 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1360 @end example
1361
1362 @cindex offload status
1363 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1364 main node:
1365
1366 @example
1367 # guix offload status
1368 @end example
1369
1370
1371 @node SELinux Support
1372 @subsection SELinux Support
1373
1374 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1375 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1376 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1377 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1378 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1379 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1380 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1381 be used on Guix System.
1382
1383 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1384 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1385 To install the policy run this command as root:
1386
1387 @example
1388 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1389 @end example
1390
1391 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1392 mechanism provided by your system.
1393
1394 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1395 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1396 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1397 command:
1398
1399 @example
1400 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1401 @end example
1402
1403 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1404 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1405 operations.
1406
1407 @subsubsection Limitations
1408 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1409
1410 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1411 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1412 the Guix daemon.
1413
1414 @enumerate
1415 @item
1416 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1417 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1418 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1419 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1420
1421 @item
1422 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1423 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1424 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1425 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1426 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1427 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1428 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1429 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1430 reading and following these links.
1431
1432 @item
1433 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1434 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1435 differently from files.
1436
1437 @item
1438 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1439 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1440 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1441 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1442 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1443 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1444 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1445 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1446 allowed for processes in that domain.
1447
1448 You will need to relabel the store directory after all upgrades to
1449 @file{guix-daemon}, such as after running @code{guix pull}. Assuming the
1450 store is in @file{/gnu}, you can do this with @code{restorecon -vR /gnu},
1451 or by other means provided by your operating system.
1452
1453 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1454 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1455 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1456 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1457 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1458 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1459 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1460 @end enumerate
1461
1462 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1463 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1464
1465 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1466 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1467 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1468 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1469
1470 @example
1471 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1472 @end example
1473
1474 @noindent
1475 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1476
1477 @cindex chroot
1478 @cindex container, build environment
1479 @cindex build environment
1480 @cindex reproducible builds
1481 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1482 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1483 @option{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1484 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1485 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1486 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1487 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1488 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1489 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1490 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1491 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1492
1493 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1494 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1495 its @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1496 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1497 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1498
1499 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1500 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1501 (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1502
1503 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1504 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands). The
1505 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1506 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1507 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1508
1509 The following command-line options are supported:
1510
1511 @table @code
1512 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1513 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1514 the Daemon, build users}).
1515
1516 @item --no-substitutes
1517 @cindex substitutes
1518 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1519 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1520 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1521
1522 When the daemon runs with @option{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1523 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1524 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1525
1526 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1527 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1528 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1529 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1530 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1531
1532 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1533 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1534
1535 @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}, for more information on
1536 how to configure the daemon to get substitutes from other servers.
1537
1538 @cindex offloading
1539 @item --no-offload
1540 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1541 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1542 builds to remote machines.
1543
1544 @item --cache-failures
1545 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1546
1547 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1548 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1549 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1550 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1551
1552 @item --cores=@var{n}
1553 @itemx -c @var{n}
1554 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1555 as available.
1556
1557 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1558 as the @option{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1559 guix build}).
1560
1561 The effect is to define the @env{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1562 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1563 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1564
1565 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1566 @itemx -M @var{n}
1567 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1568 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1569 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1570 Setup}), or simply fail.
1571
1572 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1573 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1574 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1575
1576 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1577
1578 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1579 Build Options, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
1580
1581 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1582 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1583 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1584
1585 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1586
1587 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1588 Build Options, @option{--timeout}}).
1589
1590 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1591 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1592 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1593 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1594 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1595
1596 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1597 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1598 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1599
1600 @item --debug
1601 Produce debugging output.
1602
1603 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1604 overridden by clients, for example the @option{--verbosity} option of
1605 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1606
1607 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1608 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1609
1610 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1611 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1612 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1613 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1614 needs.
1615
1616 @item --disable-chroot
1617 Disable chroot builds.
1618
1619 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1620 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1621 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1622 account.
1623
1624 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1625 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1626 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1627
1628 Unless @option{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1629 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1630 them with Bzip2 by default.
1631
1632 @item --discover[=yes|no]
1633 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
1634 and DNS-SD.
1635
1636 This feature is still experimental. However, here are a few
1637 considerations.
1638
1639 @enumerate
1640 @item
1641 It might be faster/less expensive than fetching from remote servers;
1642 @item
1643 There are no security risks, only genuine substitutes will be used
1644 (@pxref{Substitute Authentication});
1645 @item
1646 An attacker advertising @command{guix publish} on your LAN cannot serve
1647 you malicious binaries, but they can learn what software you’re
1648 installing;
1649 @item
1650 Servers may serve substitute over HTTP, unencrypted, so anyone on the
1651 LAN can see what software you’re installing.
1652 @end enumerate
1653
1654 It is also possible to enable or disable substitute server discovery at
1655 run-time by running:
1656
1657 @example
1658 herd discover guix-daemon on
1659 herd discover guix-daemon off
1660 @end example
1661
1662 @item --disable-deduplication
1663 @cindex deduplication
1664 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1665
1666 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1667 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1668 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1669 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1670 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1671 this optimization.
1672
1673 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1674 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1675 derivations.
1676
1677 @cindex GC roots
1678 @cindex garbage collector roots
1679 When set to @code{yes}, the GC will keep the outputs of any live
1680 derivation available in the store---the @file{.drv} files. The default
1681 is @code{no}, meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are
1682 reachable from a GC root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC
1683 roots.
1684
1685 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1686 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1687 corresponding to live outputs.
1688
1689 When set to @code{yes}, as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1690 derivations---i.e., @file{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1691 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1692 items in their store. Setting it to @code{no} saves a bit of disk
1693 space.
1694
1695 In this way, setting @option{--gc-keep-derivations} to @code{yes} causes
1696 liveness to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting
1697 @option{--gc-keep-outputs} to @code{yes} causes liveness to flow from
1698 derivations to outputs. When both are set to @code{yes}, the effect is
1699 to keep all the build prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries,
1700 and other build-time tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of
1701 whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC root. This is
1702 convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1703
1704 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1705 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1706 kernel's @command{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1707
1708 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1709 on the kernel version number.
1710
1711 @item --lose-logs
1712 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1713 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1714
1715 @item --system=@var{system}
1716 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1717 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1718 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1719
1720 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1721 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1722 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1723 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1724 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1725
1726 @table @code
1727 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1728 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1729 creating it if needed.
1730
1731 @item --listen=localhost
1732 @cindex daemon, remote access
1733 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1734 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1735 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1736 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1737 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1738
1739 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1740 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1741 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1742 @end table
1743
1744 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1745 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1746 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1747 by setting the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1748 (@pxref{The Store, @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1749
1750 @quotation Note
1751 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1752 @option{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1753 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1754 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1755 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1756 @end quotation
1757
1758 When @option{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1759 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1760 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1761 @end table
1762
1763
1764 @node Application Setup
1765 @section Application Setup
1766
1767 @cindex foreign distro
1768 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1769 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1770 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1771
1772 @subsection Locales
1773
1774 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1775 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1776 @vindex LOCPATH
1777 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1778 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1779 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1780 available with Guix and then define the @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1781 variable:
1782
1783 @example
1784 $ guix install glibc-locales
1785 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1786 @end example
1787
1788 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1789 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1790 917@tie{}MiB@. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1791 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1792
1793 The @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @env{LOCPATH}
1794 (@pxref{Locale Names, @env{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1795 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1796
1797 @enumerate
1798 @item
1799 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1800 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1801 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1802 incompatible locale data.
1803
1804 @item
1805 libc suffixes each entry of @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1806 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1807 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1808 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1809 data in the right format.
1810 @end enumerate
1811
1812 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1813 versions may be incompatible.
1814
1815 @subsection Name Service Switch
1816
1817 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1818 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1819 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1820 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1821 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1822 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1823 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1824 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1825 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1826 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1827
1828 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1829 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1830 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1831 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1832 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1833
1834 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1835 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1836 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1837 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1838 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1839 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1840 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1841 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1842 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1843 Reference Manual}).
1844
1845 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1846 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1847 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1848 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1849 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1850 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1851 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1852 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1853 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1854
1855 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1856 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1857 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1858 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1859
1860 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1861 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1862 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1863 themselves.
1864
1865 @subsection X11 Fonts
1866
1867 @cindex fonts
1868 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1869 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1870 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1871 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1872 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1873 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1874 @code{font-gnu-freefont}.
1875
1876 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1877 @cindex font cache
1878 Once you have installed or removed fonts, or when you notice an
1879 application that does not find fonts, you may need to install Fontconfig
1880 and to force an update of its font cache by running:
1881
1882 @example
1883 guix install fontconfig
1884 fc-cache -rv
1885 @end example
1886
1887 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1888 graphical applications, consider installing
1889 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1890 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1891 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1892 for Chinese languages:
1893
1894 @example
1895 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1896 @end example
1897
1898 @cindex @code{xterm}
1899 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1900 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1901 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1902
1903 @example
1904 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1905 @end example
1906
1907 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1908 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1909
1910 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1911 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1912 @example
1913 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1914 @end example
1915
1916 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1917 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1918 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1919
1920
1921 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1922
1923 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1924 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1925 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1926
1927 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1928 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1929 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1930 information.
1931
1932 @subsection Emacs Packages
1933
1934 @cindex @code{emacs}
1935 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the Elisp files are placed
1936 under the @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/} directory of the profile in
1937 which they are installed. The Elisp libraries are made available to
1938 Emacs through the @env{EMACSLOADPATH} environment variable, which is
1939 set when installing Emacs itself.
1940
1941 Additionally, autoload definitions are automatically evaluated at the
1942 initialization of Emacs, by the Guix-specific
1943 @code{guix-emacs-autoload-packages} procedure. If, for some reason, you
1944 want to avoid auto-loading the Emacs packages installed with Guix, you
1945 can do so by running Emacs with the @option{--no-site-file} option
1946 (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1947
1948
1949 @node Upgrading Guix
1950 @section Upgrading Guix
1951
1952 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1953
1954 To upgrade Guix, run:
1955
1956 @example
1957 guix pull
1958 @end example
1959
1960 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1961
1962 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1963 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1964 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1965
1966 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1967
1968 @example
1969 sudo -i guix pull
1970 @end example
1971
1972 @noindent
1973 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1974 tool):
1975
1976 @example
1977 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1978 @end example
1979
1980 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1981 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1982
1983 @c TODO What else?
1984
1985 @c *********************************************************************
1986 @node System Installation
1987 @chapter System Installation
1988
1989 @cindex installing Guix System
1990 @cindex Guix System, installation
1991 This section explains how to install Guix System
1992 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1993 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1994 @pxref{Installation}.
1995
1996 @ifinfo
1997 @quotation Note
1998 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1999 @c installation image.
2000 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
2001 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
2002 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
2003 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
2004
2005 Alternatively, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
2006 available.
2007 @end quotation
2008 @end ifinfo
2009
2010 @menu
2011 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
2012 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
2013 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
2014 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
2015 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
2016 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
2017 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
2018 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
2019 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
2020 @end menu
2021
2022 @node Limitations
2023 @section Limitations
2024
2025 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
2026 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
2027 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
2028
2029 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
2030 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
2031
2032 @itemize
2033 @item
2034 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
2035 may be missing.
2036
2037 @item
2038 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
2039 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
2040 missing.
2041 @end itemize
2042
2043 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
2044 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
2045 info.
2046
2047
2048 @node Hardware Considerations
2049 @section Hardware Considerations
2050
2051 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
2052 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
2053 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
2054 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
2055 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
2056 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
2057 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
2058 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
2059 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
2060
2061 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
2062 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
2063 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
2064 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
2065 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
2066 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
2067 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
2068 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
2069 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
2070
2071 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
2072 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
2073 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
2074 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
2075 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
2076 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
2077
2078 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
2079 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
2080 about their support in GNU/Linux.
2081
2082
2083 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
2084 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
2085
2086 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
2087 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
2088 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz},
2089 where you can replace @code{x86_64-linux} with one of:
2090
2091 @table @code
2092 @item x86_64-linux
2093 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
2094
2095 @item i686-linux
2096 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
2097 @end table
2098
2099 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
2100 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
2101 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
2102
2103 @example
2104 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2105 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz.sig
2106 @end example
2107
2108 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
2109 then run this command to import it:
2110
2111 @example
2112 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
2113 -qO - | gpg --import -
2114 @end example
2115
2116 @noindent
2117 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
2118
2119 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
2120 signature!'' is normal.
2121
2122 @c end duplication
2123
2124 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
2125 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
2126
2127 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
2128
2129 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
2130
2131 @enumerate
2132 @item
2133 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2134
2135 @example
2136 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2137 @end example
2138
2139 @item
2140 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
2141 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
2142 copy the image with:
2143
2144 @example
2145 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso of=/dev/sdX status=progress
2146 sync
2147 @end example
2148
2149 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
2150 @end enumerate
2151
2152 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
2153
2154 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
2155
2156 @enumerate
2157 @item
2158 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
2159
2160 @example
2161 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso.xz
2162 @end example
2163
2164 @item
2165 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
2166 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
2167 copy the image with:
2168
2169 @example
2170 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.iso
2171 @end example
2172
2173 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2174 @end enumerate
2175
2176 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2177
2178 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2179 the USB stick or DVD@. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2180 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2181 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2182 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2183
2184 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2185 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2186
2187
2188 @node Preparing for Installation
2189 @section Preparing for Installation
2190
2191 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2192 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternatively,
2193 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2194 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2195 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2196
2197 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2198 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2199 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2200 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2201 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2202 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2203 with the middle button.
2204
2205 @quotation Note
2206 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2207 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2208 ``Networking'' section below.
2209 @end quotation
2210
2211 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2212 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2213
2214 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2215 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2216
2217 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2218 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2219 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2220 the networking dialog.
2221
2222 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2223
2224 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2225 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2226 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2227 things.
2228
2229 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2230
2231 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2232 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2233
2234 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2235
2236 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2237 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2238 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2239 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2240
2241
2242 @node Manual Installation
2243 @section Manual Installation
2244
2245 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2246 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2247 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2248 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2249 Installation}).
2250
2251 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2252 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2253 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2254 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2255 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2256
2257 @menu
2258 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2259 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2260 @end menu
2261
2262 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2263 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2264
2265 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2266 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2267 guide you through this.
2268
2269 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2270
2271 @cindex keyboard layout
2272 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2273 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2274 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2275
2276 @example
2277 loadkeys dvorak
2278 @end example
2279
2280 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2281 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2282 more information.
2283
2284 @subsubsection Networking
2285
2286 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2287
2288 @example
2289 ifconfig -a
2290 @end example
2291
2292 @noindent
2293 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2294
2295 @example
2296 ip address
2297 @end example
2298
2299 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2300 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2301 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2302 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2303 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2304
2305 @table @asis
2306 @item Wired connection
2307 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2308 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2309
2310 @example
2311 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2312 @end example
2313
2314 @noindent
2315 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2316
2317 @example
2318 ip link set @var{interface} up
2319 @end example
2320
2321 @item Wireless connection
2322 @cindex wireless
2323 @cindex WiFi
2324 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2325 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2326 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2327 @command{nano}:
2328
2329 @example
2330 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2331 @end example
2332
2333 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2334 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2335 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2336
2337 @example
2338 network=@{
2339 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2340 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2341 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2342 @}
2343 @end example
2344
2345 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2346 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2347 network interface you want to use):
2348
2349 @example
2350 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2351 @end example
2352
2353 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2354 @end table
2355
2356 @cindex DHCP
2357 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2358 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2359
2360 @example
2361 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2362 @end example
2363
2364 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2365
2366 @example
2367 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2368 @end example
2369
2370 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2371 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2372
2373 @cindex proxy, during system installation
2374 If you need HTTP and HTTPS access to go through a proxy, run the
2375 following command:
2376
2377 @example
2378 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon @var{URL}
2379 @end example
2380
2381 @noindent
2382 where @var{URL} is the proxy URL, for example
2383 @code{http://example.org:8118}.
2384
2385 @cindex installing over SSH
2386 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2387 an SSH server:
2388
2389 @example
2390 herd start ssh-daemon
2391 @end example
2392
2393 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2394 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2395
2396 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2397
2398 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2399 then format the target partition(s).
2400
2401 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2402 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2403 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2404 the partition layout you want:
2405
2406 @example
2407 cfdisk
2408 @end example
2409
2410 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2411 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2412 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2413 manual}).
2414
2415 @cindex EFI, installation
2416 @cindex UEFI, installation
2417 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2418 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2419 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2420 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2421
2422 @example
2423 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2424 @end example
2425
2426 @quotation Note
2427 @vindex grub-bootloader
2428 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2429 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2430 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2431 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2432 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2433 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2434 bootloaders.
2435 @end quotation
2436
2437 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2438 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2439 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, JFS, and F2FS file systems. In
2440 particular, code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these
2441 file system types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2442 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2443
2444 @example
2445 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2446 @end example
2447
2448 For the root file system, ext4 is the most widely used format. Other
2449 file systems, such as Btrfs, support compression, which is reported to
2450 nicely complement file deduplication that the daemon performs
2451 independently of the file system (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2452 deduplication}).
2453
2454 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2455 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2456 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2457 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2458 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2459 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2460
2461 @example
2462 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2463 @end example
2464
2465 @cindex encrypted disk
2466 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2467 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2468 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2469 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information). Assuming you want to
2470 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2471 be along these lines:
2472
2473 @example
2474 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2475 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2476 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2477 @end example
2478
2479 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2480 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2481 root file system):
2482
2483 @example
2484 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2485 @end example
2486
2487 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2488 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2489 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2490 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2491
2492 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2493 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2494 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2495 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2496
2497 @example
2498 mkswap /dev/sda3
2499 swapon /dev/sda3
2500 @end example
2501
2502 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2503 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2504 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2505 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2506 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2507 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2508
2509 @example
2510 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2511 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2512 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2513 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2514 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2515 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2516 @end example
2517
2518 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2519 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2520 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2521
2522 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2523 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2524
2525 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2526 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2527
2528 @example
2529 herd start cow-store /mnt
2530 @end example
2531
2532 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2533 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2534 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2535 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2536 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2537
2538 Next, you have to edit a file and
2539 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2540 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2541 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2542 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2543 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2544 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2545 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2546 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2547 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2548
2549 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2550 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2551 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2552 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2553 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2554 something along these lines:
2555
2556 @example
2557 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2558 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2559 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2560 @end example
2561
2562 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2563 in particular:
2564
2565 @itemize
2566 @item
2567 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2568 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2569 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2570 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2571 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2572 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2573 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2574 configuration.
2575
2576 @item
2577 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2578 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2579 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2580 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2581
2582 @item
2583 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2584 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2585 @end itemize
2586
2587 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2588 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2589 under @file{/mnt}):
2590
2591 @example
2592 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2593 @end example
2594
2595 @noindent
2596 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2597 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2598 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2599 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2600
2601 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2602 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2603 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2604 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2605 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2606 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2607 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2608
2609
2610 @node After System Installation
2611 @section After System Installation
2612
2613 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2614 system whenever you want by running, say:
2615
2616 @example
2617 guix pull
2618 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2619 @end example
2620
2621 @noindent
2622 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2623 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2624 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2625
2626 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2627 @quotation Note
2628 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2629 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2630 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @env{PATH} unchanged. To
2631 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2632
2633 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2634 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is run
2635 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2636 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2637 @end quotation
2638
2639 Now, @pxref{Getting Started}, and
2640 join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2641 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2642
2643
2644 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2645 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2646
2647 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2648 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2649 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2650 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2651 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2652 section is for you.
2653
2654 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2655 disk image, follow these steps:
2656
2657 @enumerate
2658 @item
2659 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2660 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2661
2662 @item
2663 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2664 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2665
2666 @example
2667 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2668 @end example
2669
2670 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2671 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2672
2673 @item
2674 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2675
2676 @example
2677 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2678 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2679 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2680 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2681 @end example
2682
2683 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2684 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2685
2686 @item
2687 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2688 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2689 @end enumerate
2690
2691 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2692 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2693 that.
2694
2695 @node Building the Installation Image
2696 @section Building the Installation Image
2697
2698 @cindex installation image
2699 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2700 system} command, specifically:
2701
2702 @example
2703 guix system image -t iso9660 gnu/system/install.scm
2704 @end example
2705
2706 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2707 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2708 about the installation image.
2709
2710 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2711
2712 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2713 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2714
2715 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2716 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2717 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2718
2719 @example
2720 guix system image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2721 @end example
2722
2723 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2724 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2725
2726 @c *********************************************************************
2727 @node Getting Started
2728 @chapter Getting Started
2729
2730 Presumably, you've reached this section because either you have
2731 installed Guix on top of another distribution (@pxref{Installation}), or
2732 you've installed the standalone Guix System (@pxref{System
2733 Installation}). It's time for you to get started using Guix and this
2734 section aims to help you do that and give you a feel of what it's like.
2735
2736 Guix is about installing software, so probably the first thing you'll
2737 want to do is to actually look for software. Let's say you're looking
2738 for a text editor, you can run:
2739
2740 @example
2741 guix search text editor
2742 @end example
2743
2744 This command shows you a number of matching @dfn{packages}, each time
2745 showing the package's name, version, a description, and additional info.
2746 Once you've found out the one you want to use, let's say Emacs (ah ha!),
2747 you can go ahead and install it (run this command as a regular user,
2748 @emph{no need for root privileges}!):
2749
2750 @example
2751 guix install emacs
2752 @end example
2753
2754 You've installed your first package, congrats! In the process, you've
2755 probably noticed that Guix downloaded pre-built binaries; or, if you
2756 explicitly chose to @emph{not} use pre-built binaries, then probably
2757 Guix is still building software (@pxref{Substitutes}, for more info).
2758
2759 Unless you're using Guix System, the @command{guix install} command must
2760 have printed this hint:
2761
2762 @example
2763 hint: Consider setting the necessary environment variables by running:
2764
2765 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile"
2766 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2767
2768 Alternately, see `guix package --search-paths -p "$HOME/.guix-profile"'.
2769 @end example
2770
2771 Indeed, you must now tell your shell where @command{emacs} and other
2772 programs installed with Guix are to be found. Pasting the two lines
2773 above will do just that: it will add
2774 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin}---which is where the installed package
2775 is---to the @code{PATH} environment variable. You can paste these two
2776 lines in your shell so they take effect right away, but more importantly
2777 you should add them to @file{~/.bash_profile} (or equivalent file if you
2778 do not use Bash) so that environment variables are set next time you
2779 spawn a shell. You only need to do this once and other search paths
2780 environment variables will be taken care of similarly---e.g., if you
2781 eventually install @code{python} and Python libraries, @code{PYTHONPATH}
2782 will be defined.
2783
2784 You can go on installing packages at your will. To list installed
2785 packages, run:
2786
2787 @example
2788 guix package --list-installed
2789 @end example
2790
2791 To remove a package, you would unsurprisingly run @command{guix remove}.
2792 A distinguishing feature is the ability to @dfn{roll back} any operation
2793 you made---installation, removal, upgrade---by simply typing:
2794
2795 @example
2796 guix package --roll-back
2797 @end example
2798
2799 This is because each operation is in fact a @dfn{transaction} that
2800 creates a new @dfn{generation}. These generations and the difference
2801 between them can be displayed by running:
2802
2803 @example
2804 guix package --list-generations
2805 @end example
2806
2807 Now you know the basics of package management!
2808
2809 @quotation Going further
2810 @xref{Package Management}, for more about package management. You may
2811 like @dfn{declarative} package management with @command{guix package
2812 --manifest}, managing separate @dfn{profiles} with @option{--profile},
2813 deleting old generations, collecting garbage, and other nifty features
2814 that will come in handy as you become more familiar with Guix. If you
2815 are a developer, @pxref{Development} for additional tools. And if
2816 you're curious, @pxref{Features}, to peek under the hood.
2817 @end quotation
2818
2819 Once you've installed a set of packages, you will want to periodically
2820 @emph{upgrade} them to the latest and greatest version. To do that, you
2821 will first pull the latest revision of Guix and its package collection:
2822
2823 @example
2824 guix pull
2825 @end example
2826
2827 The end result is a new @command{guix} command, under
2828 @file{~/.config/guix/current/bin}. Unless you're on Guix System, the
2829 first time you run @command{guix pull}, be sure to follow the hint that
2830 the command prints and, similar to what we saw above, paste these two
2831 lines in your terminal and @file{.bash_profile}:
2832
2833 @example
2834 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.config/guix/current"
2835 . "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
2836 @end example
2837
2838 @noindent
2839 You must also instruct your shell to point to this new @command{guix}:
2840
2841 @example
2842 hash guix
2843 @end example
2844
2845 At this point, you're running a brand new Guix. You can thus go ahead
2846 and actually upgrade all the packages you previously installed:
2847
2848 @example
2849 guix upgrade
2850 @end example
2851
2852 As you run this command, you will see that binaries are downloaded (or
2853 perhaps some packages are built), and eventually you end up with the
2854 upgraded packages. Should one of these upgraded packages not be to your
2855 liking, remember you can always roll back!
2856
2857 You can display the exact revision of Guix you're currently using by
2858 running:
2859
2860 @example
2861 guix describe
2862 @end example
2863
2864 The information it displays is @emph{all it takes to reproduce the exact
2865 same Guix}, be it at a different point in time or on a different
2866 machine.
2867
2868 @quotation Going further
2869 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information. @xref{Channels}, on
2870 how to specify additional @dfn{channels} to pull packages from, how to
2871 replicate Guix, and more. You may also find @command{time-machine}
2872 handy (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
2873 @end quotation
2874
2875 If you installed Guix System, one of the first things you'll want to do
2876 is to upgrade your system. Once you've run @command{guix pull} to get
2877 the latest Guix, you can upgrade the system like this:
2878
2879 @example
2880 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2881 @end example
2882
2883 Upon completion, the system runs the latest versions of its software
2884 packages. When you eventually reboot, you'll notice a sub-menu in the
2885 bootloader that reads ``Old system generations'': it's what allows you
2886 to boot @emph{an older generation of your system}, should the latest
2887 generation be ``broken'' or otherwise unsatisfying. Just like for
2888 packages, you can always @emph{roll back} to a previous generation
2889 @emph{of the whole system}:
2890
2891 @example
2892 sudo guix system roll-back
2893 @end example
2894
2895 There are many things you'll probably want to tweak on your system:
2896 adding new user accounts, adding new system services, fiddling with the
2897 configuration of those services, etc. The system configuration is
2898 @emph{entirely} described in the @file{/etc/config.scm} file.
2899 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, to learn how to change it.
2900
2901 Now you know enough to get started!
2902
2903 @quotation Resources
2904 The rest of this manual provides a reference for all things Guix. Here
2905 are some additional resources you may find useful:
2906
2907 @itemize
2908 @item
2909 @xref{Top,,, guix-cookbook, The GNU Guix Cookbook}, for a list of
2910 ``how-to'' style of recipes for a variety of applications.
2911
2912 @item
2913 The @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/guix-refcard.pdf, GNU Guix Reference
2914 Card} lists in two pages most of the commands and options you'll ever
2915 need.
2916
2917 @item
2918 The web site contains @uref{https://guix.gnu.org/en/videos/,
2919 instructional videos} covering topics such as everyday use of Guix, how
2920 to get help, and how to become a contributor.
2921
2922 @item
2923 @xref{Documentation}, to learn how to access documentation on your
2924 computer.
2925 @end itemize
2926
2927 We hope you will enjoy Guix as much as the community enjoys building it!
2928 @end quotation
2929
2930 @c *********************************************************************
2931 @node Package Management
2932 @chapter Package Management
2933
2934 @cindex packages
2935 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2936 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2937 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2938 features.
2939
2940 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2941 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2942 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2943 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2944 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2945 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2946 with it):
2947
2948 @example
2949 guix install emacs-guix
2950 @end example
2951
2952 @menu
2953 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2954 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2955 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2956 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2957 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2958 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2959 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2960 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2961 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2962 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2963 @end menu
2964
2965 @node Features
2966 @section Features
2967
2968 Here we assume you've already made your first steps with Guix
2969 (@pxref{Getting Started}) and would like to get an overview about what's
2970 going on under the hood.
2971
2972 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2973 own directory---something that resembles
2974 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2975
2976 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2977 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2978 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2979 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2980
2981 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2982 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2983 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2984 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2985 simply continues to point to
2986 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2987 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2988
2989 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2990 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2991 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2992
2993 @cindex transactions
2994 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2995 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2996 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2997 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2998 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2999 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
3000
3001 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
3002 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
3003 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
3004 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
3005 system configuration on Guix is subject to
3006 transactional upgrades and roll-back
3007 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
3008
3009 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
3010 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
3011 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
3012 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
3013 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
3014 collected.
3015
3016 @cindex reproducibility
3017 @cindex reproducible builds
3018 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
3019 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
3020 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
3021 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
3022 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
3023 given package installation matches the current state of their
3024 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
3025 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
3026 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
3027 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
3028
3029 @cindex substitutes
3030 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
3031 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
3032 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
3033 downloads it and unpacks it;
3034 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
3035 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
3036 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
3037 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
3038 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
3039
3040 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
3041 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
3042 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
3043 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
3044 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3045
3046 @cindex replication, of software environments
3047 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
3048 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
3049 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
3050 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
3051 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
3052 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
3053 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
3054
3055 @node Invoking guix package
3056 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
3057
3058 @cindex installing packages
3059 @cindex removing packages
3060 @cindex package installation
3061 @cindex package removal
3062 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
3063 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
3064 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
3065 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
3066 is:
3067
3068 @example
3069 guix package @var{options}
3070 @end example
3071
3072 @cindex transactions
3073 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
3074 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
3075 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
3076 want to roll back.
3077
3078 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
3079 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
3080
3081 @example
3082 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
3083 @end example
3084
3085 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
3086 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
3087
3088 @itemize
3089 @item
3090 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
3091 @item
3092 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
3093 @item
3094 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
3095 @item
3096 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
3097 @item
3098 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
3099 @end itemize
3100
3101 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
3102 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
3103 package} directly.
3104
3105 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
3106 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
3107 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
3108 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
3109
3110 @cindex profile
3111 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
3112 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
3113 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
3114 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @env{PATH} environment
3115 variable, and so on.
3116 @cindex search paths
3117 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
3118 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
3119 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
3120 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
3121
3122 @example
3123 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
3124 source "$GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile"
3125 @end example
3126
3127 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
3128 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
3129 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
3130 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
3131 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
3132 @option{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
3133 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
3134 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
3135 package}.
3136
3137 The @var{options} can be among the following:
3138
3139 @table @code
3140
3141 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
3142 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
3143 Install the specified @var{package}s.
3144
3145 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
3146 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
3147 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
3148 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected).
3149
3150 If no version number is specified, the
3151 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
3152 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
3153 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
3154 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
3155 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
3156 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3157
3158 @cindex propagated inputs
3159 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
3160 that automatically get installed along with the required package
3161 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
3162 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
3163 package definitions).
3164
3165 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
3166 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
3167 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
3168 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
3169 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
3170 also been explicitly installed by the user.
3171
3172 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
3173 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
3174 @option{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
3175 environment variable definitions are reported here.
3176
3177 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
3178 @itemx -e @var{exp}
3179 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
3180
3181 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
3182 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
3183 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
3184 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
3185
3186 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
3187 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
3188 multiple-output package.
3189
3190 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
3191 @itemx -f @var{file}
3192 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
3193
3194 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
3195 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
3196
3197 @lisp
3198 @include package-hello.scm
3199 @end lisp
3200
3201 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
3202 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
3203 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
3204 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
3205
3206 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
3207 package definitions. Running @code{guix package -f} on
3208 @file{hello.json} with the following contents would result in installing
3209 the package @code{greeter} after building @code{myhello}:
3210
3211 @example
3212 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
3213 @end example
3214
3215 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
3216 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
3217 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
3218
3219 As for @option{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
3220 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
3221 @samp{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
3222 @code{glibc}.
3223
3224 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3225 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3226 @cindex upgrading packages
3227 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
3228 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
3229 @var{regexp}. Also see the @option{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
3230
3231 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
3232 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
3233 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
3234 pull}).
3235
3236 @cindex package transformations, upgrades
3237 When upgrading, package transformations that were originally applied
3238 when creating the profile are automatically re-applied (@pxref{Package
3239 Transformation Options}). For example, assume you first installed Emacs
3240 from the tip of its development branch with:
3241
3242 @example
3243 guix install emacs-next --with-branch=emacs-next=master
3244 @end example
3245
3246 Next time you run @command{guix upgrade}, Guix will again pull the tip
3247 of the Emacs development branch and build @code{emacs-next} from that
3248 checkout.
3249
3250 Note that transformation options such as @option{--with-branch} and
3251 @option{--with-source} depend on external state; it is up to you to
3252 ensure that they work as expected. You can also discard a
3253 transformations that apply to a package by running:
3254
3255 @example
3256 guix install @var{package}
3257 @end example
3258
3259 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
3260 When used together with the @option{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
3261 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
3262 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
3263 substring ``emacs'':
3264
3265 @example
3266 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
3267 @end example
3268
3269 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
3270 @itemx -m @var{file}
3271 @cindex profile declaration
3272 @cindex profile manifest
3273 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
3274 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
3275 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
3276
3277 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
3278 constructing it through a sequence of @option{--install} and similar
3279 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
3280 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
3281 so on.
3282
3283 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
3284 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
3285 of packages:
3286
3287 @findex packages->manifest
3288 @lisp
3289 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
3290
3291 (packages->manifest
3292 (list emacs
3293 guile-2.0
3294 ;; Use a specific package output.
3295 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
3296 @end lisp
3297
3298 @findex specifications->manifest
3299 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
3300 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
3301 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
3302 instead provide regular package specifications and let
3303 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
3304 objects, like this:
3305
3306 @lisp
3307 (specifications->manifest
3308 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
3309 @end lisp
3310
3311 @xref{export-manifest, @option{--export-manifest}}, to learn how to
3312 obtain a manifest file from an existing profile.
3313
3314 @item --roll-back
3315 @cindex rolling back
3316 @cindex undoing transactions
3317 @cindex transactions, undoing
3318 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
3319 the last transaction.
3320
3321 When combined with options such as @option{--install}, roll back occurs
3322 before any other actions.
3323
3324 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
3325 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
3326 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
3327
3328 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
3329 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
3330 generations in a profile is always linear.
3331
3332 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3333 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3334 @cindex generations
3335 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3336
3337 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3338 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3339 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3340 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
3341 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
3342
3343 The difference between @option{--roll-back} and
3344 @option{--switch-generation=-1} is that @option{--switch-generation} will
3345 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
3346 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
3347
3348 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
3349 @cindex search paths
3350 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
3351 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
3352 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
3353 of the installed packages.
3354
3355 For example, GCC needs the @env{CPATH} and @env{LIBRARY_PATH}
3356 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
3357 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
3358 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
3359 library are installed in the profile, then @option{--search-paths} will
3360 suggest setting these variables to @file{@var{profile}/include} and
3361 @file{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
3362
3363 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
3364 shell:
3365
3366 @example
3367 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
3368 @end example
3369
3370 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
3371 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
3372 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
3373 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
3374
3375 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
3376 of several profiles. Consider this example:
3377
3378 @example
3379 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
3380 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
3381 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
3382 @end example
3383
3384 The last command above reports about the @env{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
3385 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
3386 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
3387
3388
3389 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3390 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3391 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
3392
3393 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
3394 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
3395 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
3396 installed:
3397
3398 @example
3399 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
3400 @dots{}
3401 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
3402 Hello, world!
3403 @end example
3404
3405 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
3406 siblings that point to specific generations:
3407
3408 @example
3409 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
3410 @end example
3411
3412 @item --list-profiles
3413 List all the user's profiles:
3414
3415 @example
3416 $ guix package --list-profiles
3417 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
3418 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
3419 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
3420 /home/charlie/tmp/test
3421 @end example
3422
3423 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
3424
3425 @cindex collisions, in a profile
3426 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
3427 @cindex profile collisions
3428 @item --allow-collisions
3429 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3430
3431 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3432 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3433 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3434
3435 @item --bootstrap
3436 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3437 useful to distribution developers.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3442 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3443 availability of packages:
3444
3445 @table @option
3446
3447 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3448 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3449 @anchor{guix-search}
3450 @cindex searching for packages
3451 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3452 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3453 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3454 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3455 GNU recutils manual}).
3456
3457 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3458 command, for instance:
3459
3460 @example
3461 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3462 name: jemalloc
3463 version: 4.5.0
3464 relevance: 6
3465
3466 name: glibc
3467 version: 2.25
3468 relevance: 1
3469
3470 name: libgc
3471 version: 7.6.0
3472 relevance: 1
3473 @end example
3474
3475 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3476 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3477
3478 @example
3479 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3480 name: elfutils
3481
3482 name: gmp
3483 @dots{}
3484 @end example
3485
3486 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3487 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3488 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3489 the @command{guix search} alias):
3490
3491 @example
3492 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3493 name: gnubg
3494 @dots{}
3495 @end example
3496
3497 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3498 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3499 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3500 keyboards.
3501
3502 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3503 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3504 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3505
3506 @example
3507 $ guix search crypto library | \
3508 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3509 @end example
3510
3511 @noindent
3512 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3513 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3514
3515 @item --show=@var{package}
3516 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3517 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3518 recutils manual}).
3519
3520 @example
3521 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3522 name: python
3523 version: 2.7.6
3524
3525 name: python
3526 version: 3.3.5
3527 @end example
3528
3529 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3530 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3531 @example
3532 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3533 name: python
3534 version: 3.4.3
3535 @end example
3536
3537
3538
3539 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3540 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3541 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3542 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3543 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3544
3545 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3546 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3547 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3548 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3549 the store.
3550
3551 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3552 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3553 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3554 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3555 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3556
3557 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3558 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3559 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3560
3561 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3562 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3563 @cindex generations
3564 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3565 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3566 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3567 shown.
3568
3569 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3570 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3571 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3572 location of this package in the store.
3573
3574 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3575 generations. Valid patterns include:
3576
3577 @itemize
3578 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3579 generation numbers. For instance, @option{--list-generations=1} returns
3580 the first one.
3581
3582 And @option{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3583 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3584
3585 @item @emph{Ranges}. @option{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3586 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3587 a range must be smaller than its end.
3588
3589 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3590 @option{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3591 second one.
3592
3593 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3594 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3595 duration. For example, @option{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3596 that are up to 20 days old.
3597 @end itemize
3598
3599 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3600 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3601 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3602 one.
3603
3604 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3605 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3606 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3607 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
3608 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3609
3610 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3611 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3612
3613 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3614 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3615
3616 @cindex manifest, exporting
3617 @anchor{export-manifest}
3618 @item --export-manifest
3619 Write to standard output a manifest suitable for @option{--manifest}
3620 corresponding to the chosen profile(s).
3621
3622 This option is meant to help you migrate from the ``imperative''
3623 operating mode---running @command{guix install}, @command{guix upgrade},
3624 etc.---to the declarative mode that @option{--manifest} offers.
3625
3626 Be aware that the resulting manifest @emph{approximates} what your
3627 profile actually contains; for instance, depending on how your profile
3628 was created, it can refer to packages or package versions that are not
3629 exactly what you specified.
3630
3631 Keep in mind that a manifest is purely symbolic: it only contains
3632 package names and possibly versions, and their meaning varies over time.
3633 If you wish to ``pin'' channels to the revisions that were used to build
3634 the profile(s), see @option{--export-channels} below.
3635
3636 @cindex pinning, channel revisions of a profile
3637 @item --export-channels
3638 Write to standard output the list of channels used by the chosen
3639 profile(s), in a format suitable for @command{guix pull --channels} or
3640 @command{guix time-machine --channels} (@pxref{Channels}).
3641
3642 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this option provides
3643 information allowing you to replicate the current profile
3644 (@pxref{Replicating Guix}).
3645
3646 However, note that the output of this command @emph{approximates} what
3647 was actually used to build this profile. In particular, a single
3648 profile might have been built from several different revisions of the
3649 same channel. In that case, @option{--export-manifest} chooses the last
3650 one and writes the list of other revisions in a comment. If you really
3651 need to pick packages from different channel revisions, you can use
3652 inferiors in your manifest to do so (@pxref{Inferiors}).
3653
3654 Together with @option{--export-manifest}, this is a good starting point
3655 if you are willing to migrate from the ``imperative'' model to the fully
3656 declarative model consisting of a manifest file along with a channels
3657 file pinning the exact channel revision(s) you want.
3658 @end table
3659
3660 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3661 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3662 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3663 @option{--with-source}, and preserves them across upgrades
3664 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3665
3666 @node Substitutes
3667 @section Substitutes
3668
3669 @cindex substitutes
3670 @cindex pre-built binaries
3671 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3672 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3673 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3674 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3675 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3676
3677 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3678 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3679 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3680 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3681
3682 @menu
3683 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3684 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3685 * Getting Substitutes from Other Servers:: Substitute diversity.
3686 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3687 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3688 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3689 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3690 @end menu
3691
3692 @node Official Substitute Server
3693 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3694
3695 @cindex build farm
3696 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3697 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3698 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3699 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3700 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3701 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3702 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3703 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3704 option}).
3705
3706 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3707 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3708 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3709 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3710 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3711
3712 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3713 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3714 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3715 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3716 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3717 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3718 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3719 other substitute server.
3720
3721 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3722 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3723
3724 @cindex security
3725 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3726 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3727 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3728 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3729 mirror thereof, you
3730 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3731 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3732 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3733 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3734
3735 @quotation Note
3736 If you are using Guix System, you can skip this section: Guix System
3737 authorizes substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} by default.
3738 @end quotation
3739
3740 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3741 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3742 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3743 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3744 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3745 Then, you can run something like this:
3746
3747 @example
3748 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3749 @end example
3750
3751 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3752 should change from something like:
3753
3754 @example
3755 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3756 The following derivations would be built:
3757 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3758 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3759 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3760 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3761 @dots{}
3762 @end example
3763
3764 @noindent
3765 to something like:
3766
3767 @example
3768 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3769 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3770 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3771 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3772 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3773 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3774 @dots{}
3775 @end example
3776
3777 @noindent
3778 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3779 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3780 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and will be downloaded, when
3781 possible, for future builds.
3782
3783 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3784 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3785 @code{guix-daemon} with @option{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3786 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3787 @option{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package},
3788 @command{guix build}, and other command-line tools.
3789
3790 @node Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3791 @subsection Getting Substitutes from Other Servers
3792
3793 @cindex substitute servers, adding more
3794 Guix can look up and fetch substitutes from several servers. This is
3795 useful when you are using packages from additional channels for which
3796 the official server does not have substitutes but another server
3797 provides them. Another situation where this is useful is when you would
3798 prefer to download from your organization's substitute server, resorting
3799 to the official server only as a fallback or dismissing it altogether.
3800
3801 You can give Guix a list of substitute server URLs and it will check
3802 them in the specified order. You also need to explicitly authorize the
3803 public keys of substitute servers to instruct Guix to accept the
3804 substitutes they sign.
3805
3806 On Guix System, this is achieved by modifying the configuration of the
3807 @code{guix} service. Since the @code{guix} service is part of the
3808 default lists of services, @code{%base-services} and
3809 @code{%desktop-services}, you can use @code{modify-services} to change
3810 its configuration and add the URLs and substitute keys that you want
3811 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}).
3812
3813 As an example, suppose you want to fetch substitutes from
3814 @code{guix.example.org} and to authorize the signing key of that server,
3815 in addition to the default @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. The
3816 resulting operating system configuration will look something like:
3817
3818 @lisp
3819 (operating-system
3820 ;; @dots{}
3821 (services
3822 ;; Assume we're starting from '%desktop-services'. Replace it
3823 ;; with the list of services you're actually using.
3824 (modify-services %desktop-services
3825 (guix-service-type config =>
3826 (guix-configuration
3827 (inherit config)
3828 (substitute-urls
3829 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
3830 %default-substitute-urls))
3831 (authorized-keys
3832 (append (list (local-file "./key.pub"))
3833 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))))))
3834 @end lisp
3835
3836 This assumes that the file @file{key.pub} contains the signing key of
3837 @code{guix.example.org}. With this change in place in your operating
3838 system configuration file (say @file{/etc/config.scm}), you can
3839 reconfigure and restart the @code{guix-daemon} service or reboot so the
3840 changes take effect:
3841
3842 @example
3843 $ sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
3844 $ sudo herd restart guix-daemon
3845 @end example
3846
3847 If you're running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', you would instead take
3848 the following steps to get substitutes from additional servers:
3849
3850 @enumerate
3851 @item
3852 Edit the service configuration file for @code{guix-daemon}; when using
3853 systemd, this is normally
3854 @file{/etc/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}. Add the
3855 @option{--substitute-urls} option on the @command{guix-daemon} command
3856 line and list the URLs of interest (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,
3857 @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}}):
3858
3859 @example
3860 @dots{} --substitute-urls='https://guix.example.org https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'
3861 @end example
3862
3863 @item
3864 Restart the daemon. For systemd, it goes like this:
3865
3866 @example
3867 systemctl daemon-reload
3868 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
3869 @end example
3870
3871 @item
3872 Authorize the key of the new server (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
3873
3874 @example
3875 guix archive --authorize < key.pub
3876 @end example
3877
3878 Again this assumes @file{key.pub} contains the public key that
3879 @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign substitutes.
3880 @end enumerate
3881
3882 Now you're all set! Substitutes will be preferably taken from
3883 @code{https://guix.example.org}, using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
3884 as a fallback. Of course you can list as many substitute servers as you
3885 like, with the caveat that substitute lookup can be slowed down if too
3886 many servers need to be contacted.
3887
3888 Note that there are also situations where one may want to add the URL of
3889 a substitute server @emph{without} authorizing its key.
3890 @xref{Substitute Authentication}, to understand this fine point.
3891
3892 @node Substitute Authentication
3893 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3894
3895 @cindex digital signatures
3896 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3897 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3898 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3899
3900 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3901 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3902 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3903 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3904 with this option:
3905
3906 @example
3907 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3908 @end example
3909
3910 @noindent
3911 @cindex reproducible builds
3912 If the ACL contains only the key for @samp{b.example.org}, and if
3913 @samp{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3914 then Guix will download substitutes from @samp{a.example.org} because it
3915 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3916 @samp{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3917 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3918 below).
3919
3920 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3921 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3922 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3923 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3924 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3925 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys).
3926
3927 @node Proxy Settings
3928 @subsection Proxy Settings
3929
3930 @vindex http_proxy
3931 @vindex https_proxy
3932 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS@. The @env{http_proxy} and
3933 @env{https_proxy} environment variables can be set in the environment of
3934 @command{guix-daemon} and are honored for downloads of substitutes.
3935 Note that the value of those environment variables in the environment
3936 where @command{guix build}, @command{guix package}, and other client
3937 commands are run has @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3938
3939 @node Substitution Failure
3940 @subsection Substitution Failure
3941
3942 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3943 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3944 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3945 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3946 etc.
3947
3948 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3949 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3950 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3951 @option{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3952 option @option{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @option{--fallback} was
3953 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3954 considered to have failed. However, if @option{--fallback} was given,
3955 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3956 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3957 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3958 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3959 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3960 @option{--fallback} was given.
3961
3962 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3963 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3964 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3965 by a server.
3966
3967 @node On Trusting Binaries
3968 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3969
3970 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3971 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3972 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3973 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3974 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3975 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3976 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3977 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3978 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3979 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3980
3981 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3982 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3983 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3984 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3985 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3986 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3987 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3988 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3989 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3990 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3991 @command{guix build --check}}).
3992
3993 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3994 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3995 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3996
3997 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3998 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3999
4000 @cindex multiple-output packages
4001 @cindex package outputs
4002 @cindex outputs
4003
4004 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
4005 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
4006 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
4007 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
4008 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
4009 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
4010 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
4011 files.
4012
4013 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
4014 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
4015 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
4016 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
4017 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
4018 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
4019 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
4020
4021 @example
4022 guix install glib
4023 @end example
4024
4025 @cindex documentation
4026 The command to install its documentation is:
4027
4028 @example
4029 guix install glib:doc
4030 @end example
4031
4032 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
4033 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
4034 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
4035 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
4036 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
4037 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
4038 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
4039 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
4040 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
4041
4042 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
4043 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
4044 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
4045 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
4046 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
4047 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
4048 guix package}).
4049
4050
4051 @node Invoking guix gc
4052 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
4053
4054 @cindex garbage collector
4055 @cindex disk space
4056 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
4057 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
4058 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
4059 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
4060 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
4061
4062 @cindex GC roots
4063 @cindex garbage collector roots
4064 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
4065 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
4066 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
4067 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
4068 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
4069 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
4070 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
4071 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
4072
4073 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
4074 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
4075 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
4076 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
4077 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4078
4079 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
4080 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
4081 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
4082
4083 @example
4084 guix gc -F 5G
4085 @end example
4086
4087 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
4088 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
4089 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
4090 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
4091 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
4092 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
4093 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
4094
4095 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
4096 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
4097 files (the @option{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
4098 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
4099 options are as follows:
4100
4101 @table @code
4102 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
4103 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
4104 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
4105 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
4106 specified.
4107
4108 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
4109 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4110 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
4111 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
4112
4113 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
4114
4115 @item --free-space=@var{free}
4116 @itemx -F @var{free}
4117 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
4118 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
4119 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
4120
4121 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
4122 nothing and exit immediately.
4123
4124 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
4125 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
4126 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
4127 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
4128 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
4129
4130 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
4131 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
4132 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
4133
4134 @example
4135 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
4136 @end example
4137
4138 @item --delete
4139 @itemx -D
4140 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
4141 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
4142 they are still live.
4143
4144 @item --list-failures
4145 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
4146
4147 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
4148 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
4149 @option{--cache-failures}}).
4150
4151 @item --list-roots
4152 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
4153 roots.
4154
4155 @item --list-busy
4156 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
4157 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
4158
4159 @item --clear-failures
4160 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
4161
4162 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
4163 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
4164
4165 @item --list-dead
4166 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
4167 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
4168
4169 @item --list-live
4170 Show the list of live store files and directories.
4171
4172 @end table
4173
4174 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
4175
4176 @table @code
4177
4178 @item --references
4179 @itemx --referrers
4180 @cindex package dependencies
4181 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
4182 as arguments.
4183
4184 @item --requisites
4185 @itemx -R
4186 @cindex closure
4187 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
4188 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
4189 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
4190 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
4191
4192 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
4193 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
4194 the graph of references.
4195
4196 @item --derivers
4197 @cindex derivation
4198 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
4199 (@pxref{Derivations}).
4200
4201 For example, this command:
4202
4203 @example
4204 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
4205 @end example
4206
4207 @noindent
4208 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
4209 installed in your profile.
4210
4211 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
4212 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
4213 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
4214 @end table
4215
4216 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
4217 store and to control disk usage.
4218
4219 @table @option
4220
4221 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
4222 @cindex integrity, of the store
4223 @cindex integrity checking
4224 Verify the integrity of the store.
4225
4226 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
4227 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
4228
4229 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
4230 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
4231
4232 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
4233 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
4234 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
4235 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
4236 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
4237
4238 @cindex repairing the store
4239 @cindex corruption, recovering from
4240 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
4241 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
4242 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
4243 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
4244 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
4245 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
4246 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
4247
4248 @item --optimize
4249 @cindex deduplication
4250 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
4251 @dfn{deduplication}.
4252
4253 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
4254 import, unless it was started with @option{--disable-deduplication}
4255 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
4256 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
4257 @option{--disable-deduplication}.
4258
4259 @end table
4260
4261 @node Invoking guix pull
4262 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
4263
4264 @cindex upgrading Guix
4265 @cindex updating Guix
4266 @cindex @command{guix pull}
4267 @cindex pull
4268 @cindex security, @command{guix pull}
4269 @cindex authenticity, of code obtained with @command{guix pull}
4270 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
4271 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
4272 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
4273 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
4274 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
4275 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
4276 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized. @command{guix
4277 pull} ensures that the code it downloads is @emph{authentic} by
4278 verifying that commits are signed by Guix developers.
4279
4280 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
4281 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
4282
4283 @enumerate
4284 @item
4285 the @option{--channels} option;
4286 @item
4287 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
4288 @item
4289 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
4290 @item
4291 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
4292 variable.
4293 @end enumerate
4294
4295 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
4296 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
4297 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
4298 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
4299 become available.
4300
4301 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
4302 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
4303 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
4304 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
4305 versa.
4306
4307 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
4308 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
4309 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
4310 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
4311 (@pxref{Documentation}):
4312
4313 @example
4314 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
4315 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
4316 @end example
4317
4318 The @option{--list-generations} or @option{-l} option lists past generations
4319 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
4320
4321 @example
4322 $ guix pull -l
4323 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
4324 guix 65956ad
4325 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4326 branch: origin/master
4327 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
4328
4329 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
4330 guix e0cc7f6
4331 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4332 branch: origin/master
4333 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
4334 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
4335 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
4336 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
4337 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
4338
4339 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
4340 guix 844cc1c
4341 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4342 branch: origin/master
4343 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
4344 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
4345 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
4346 @end example
4347
4348 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
4349 describe the current status of Guix.
4350
4351 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
4352 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
4353 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
4354 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
4355
4356 @example
4357 $ guix pull --roll-back
4358 switched from generation 3 to 2
4359 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
4360 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4361 @end example
4362
4363 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
4364 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
4365 @example
4366 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
4367 switched from generation 3 to 2
4368 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
4369 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
4370 @end example
4371
4372 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
4373 but it supports the following options:
4374
4375 @table @code
4376 @item --url=@var{url}
4377 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4378 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4379 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4380 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4381 string), or @var{branch}.
4382
4383 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4384 @cindex configuration file for channels
4385 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
4386 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
4387 @option{--channels} option (see below).
4388
4389 @item --channels=@var{file}
4390 @itemx -C @var{file}
4391 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
4392 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
4393 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
4394 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
4395 information.
4396
4397 @cindex channel news
4398 @item --news
4399 @itemx -N
4400 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
4401 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
4402 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
4403
4404 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
4405 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
4406 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
4407
4408 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4409 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
4410 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
4411 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
4412 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
4413 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
4414
4415 @item --roll-back
4416 @cindex rolling back
4417 @cindex undoing transactions
4418 @cindex transactions, undoing
4419 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
4420 undo the last transaction.
4421
4422 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
4423 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
4424 @cindex generations
4425 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
4426
4427 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
4428 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
4429 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
4430 the latest generation after @option{--roll-back}, use
4431 @option{--switch-generation=+1}.
4432
4433 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
4434 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
4435 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
4436 one.
4437
4438 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
4439 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
4440 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
4441 specified duration match. For instance, @option{--delete-generations=1m}
4442 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
4443
4444 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
4445
4446 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
4447 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
4448
4449 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
4450 current generation only.
4451
4452 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4453 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4454 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
4455
4456 @item --dry-run
4457 @itemx -n
4458 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
4459 substituted but do not actually do it.
4460
4461 @item --allow-downgrades
4462 Allow pulling older or unrelated revisions of channels than those
4463 currently in use.
4464
4465 @cindex downgrade attacks, protection against
4466 By default, @command{guix pull} protects against so-called ``downgrade
4467 attacks'' whereby the Git repository of a channel would be reset to an
4468 earlier or unrelated revision of itself, potentially leading you to
4469 install older, known-vulnerable versions of software packages.
4470
4471 @quotation Note
4472 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4473 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
4474 @end quotation
4475
4476 @item --disable-authentication
4477 Allow pulling channel code without authenticating it.
4478
4479 @cindex authentication, of channel code
4480 By default, @command{guix pull} authenticates code downloaded from
4481 channels by verifying that its commits are signed by authorized
4482 developers, and raises an error if this is not the case. This option
4483 instructs it to not perform any such verification.
4484
4485 @quotation Note
4486 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
4487 @option{--disable-authentication}.
4488 @end quotation
4489
4490 @item --system=@var{system}
4491 @itemx -s @var{system}
4492 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4493 the system type of the build host.
4494
4495 @item --bootstrap
4496 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
4497 useful to Guix developers.
4498 @end table
4499
4500 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
4501 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
4502 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
4503 information.
4504
4505 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
4506 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4507
4508 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4509 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4510
4511 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4512 @cindex pinning, channels
4513 @cindex replicating Guix
4514 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4515
4516 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4517 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4518 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4519 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4520 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4521 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4522
4523 The general syntax is:
4524
4525 @example
4526 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4527 @end example
4528
4529 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4530 @command{guix} command of the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4531 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4532
4533 @table @code
4534 @item --url=@var{url}
4535 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4536 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4537 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4538 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4539 string), or @var{branch}.
4540
4541 @item --channels=@var{file}
4542 @itemx -C @var{file}
4543 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4544 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4545 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4546 @end table
4547
4548 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4549 latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4550
4551 @example
4552 guix time-machine -- build hello
4553 @end example
4554
4555 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4556 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4557 Time travel works in both directions!
4558
4559 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4560 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4561 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4562
4563 @node Inferiors
4564 @section Inferiors
4565
4566 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4567 @quotation Note
4568 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4569 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4570 @end quotation
4571
4572 @cindex inferiors
4573 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4574 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4575 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4576 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4577 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4578
4579 @cindex inferior packages
4580 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4581 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4582 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4583 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4584 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4585
4586 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4587 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4588 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4589 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4590 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4591 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4592 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4593 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4594 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4595
4596 @lisp
4597 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4598 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4599
4600 (define channels
4601 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4602 ;; extract guile-json.
4603 (list (channel
4604 (name 'guix)
4605 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4606 (commit
4607 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4608
4609 (define inferior
4610 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4611 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4612
4613 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4614 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4615 (packages->manifest
4616 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4617 (specification->package "guile")))
4618 @end lisp
4619
4620 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4621 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4622 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4623
4624 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4625 inferior:
4626
4627 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4628 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4629 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4630 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4631 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4632
4633 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4634 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4635 @end deffn
4636
4637 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4638 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4639 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4640 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4641 the inferior could not be launched.
4642 @end deffn
4643
4644 @cindex inferior packages
4645 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4646 packages.
4647
4648 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4649 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4650 @end deffn
4651
4652 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4653 [@var{version}]
4654 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4655 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4656 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4660 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4661 @end deffn
4662
4663 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4664 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4665 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4666 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4667 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4668 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4669 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4670 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4671 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4672 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4673 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4674 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4675 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4676 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4677 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4678 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4679 these procedures.
4680 @end deffn
4681
4682 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4683 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4684 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4685 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4686 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4687 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4688 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4689 declaration, and so on.
4690
4691 @node Invoking guix describe
4692 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4693
4694 @cindex reproducibility
4695 @cindex replicating Guix
4696 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4697 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4698 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4699 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4700 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4701 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4702 command answers these questions.
4703
4704 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4705 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4706 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4707
4708 @example
4709 $ guix describe
4710 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4711 guix e0fa68c
4712 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4713 branch: master
4714 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4715 @end example
4716
4717 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4718 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4719 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4720 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4721 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4722 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4723 also to replicate it.
4724
4725 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4726 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4727
4728 @example
4729 $ guix describe -f channels
4730 (list (channel
4731 (name 'guix)
4732 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4733 (commit
4734 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")
4735 (introduction
4736 (make-channel-introduction
4737 "9edb3f66fd807b096b48283debdcddccfea34bad"
4738 (openpgp-fingerprint
4739 "BBB0 2DDF 2CEA F6A8 0D1D E643 A2A0 6DF2 A33A 54FA")))))
4740 @end example
4741
4742 @noindent
4743 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4744 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4745 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4746 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4747 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4748 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4749
4750 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4751 follows:
4752
4753 @table @code
4754 @item --format=@var{format}
4755 @itemx -f @var{format}
4756 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4757
4758 @table @code
4759 @item human
4760 produce human-readable output;
4761 @item channels
4762 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4763 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4764 guix pull});
4765 @item channels-sans-intro
4766 like @code{channels}, but omit the @code{introduction} field; use it to
4767 produce a channel specification suitable for Guix version 1.1.0 or
4768 earlier---the @code{introduction} field has to do with channel
4769 authentication (@pxref{Channels, Channel Authentication}) and is not
4770 supported by these older versions;
4771 @item json
4772 @cindex JSON
4773 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4774 @item recutils
4775 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4776 @end table
4777
4778 @item --list-formats
4779 Display available formats for @option{--format} option.
4780
4781 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4782 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4783 Display information about @var{profile}.
4784 @end table
4785
4786 @node Invoking guix archive
4787 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4788
4789 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4790 @cindex archive
4791 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4792 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4793 a machine that runs Guix.
4794 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4795 to the store on another machine.
4796
4797 @quotation Note
4798 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4799 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4800 @end quotation
4801
4802 @cindex exporting store items
4803 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4804
4805 @example
4806 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4807 @end example
4808
4809 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4810 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4811 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4812 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4813 output of @code{emacs}:
4814
4815 @example
4816 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4817 @end example
4818
4819 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4820 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4821 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4822
4823 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4824 one would run:
4825
4826 @example
4827 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4828 @end example
4829
4830 @noindent
4831 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4832 to another like this:
4833
4834 @example
4835 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4836 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4837 @end example
4838
4839 @noindent
4840 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4841 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4842 @option{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on
4843 the target machine. The @option{--missing} option can help figure out
4844 which items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4845 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4846 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4847
4848 @cindex nar, archive format
4849 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4850 @cindex nar bundle, archive format
4851 Each store item is written in the @dfn{normalized archive} or @dfn{nar}
4852 format (described below), and the output of @command{guix archive
4853 --export} (and input of @command{guix archive --import}) is a @dfn{nar
4854 bundle}.
4855
4856 The nar format is
4857 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4858 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4859 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4860 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4861 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4862 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4863 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4864 deterministic.
4865
4866 That nar bundle format is essentially the concatenation of zero or more
4867 nars along with metadata for each store item it contains: its file name,
4868 references, corresponding derivation, and a digital signature.
4869
4870 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4871 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4872 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4873 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4874 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4875
4876 The main options are:
4877
4878 @table @code
4879 @item --export
4880 Export the specified store files or packages (see below). Write the
4881 resulting archive to the standard output.
4882
4883 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4884 @option{--recursive} is passed.
4885
4886 @item -r
4887 @itemx --recursive
4888 When combined with @option{--export}, this instructs @command{guix archive}
4889 to include dependencies of the given items in the archive. Thus, the
4890 resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure of the
4891 exported store items.
4892
4893 @item --import
4894 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4895 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4896 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4897 keys (see @option{--authorize} below).
4898
4899 @item --missing
4900 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4901 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4902 the store.
4903
4904 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4905 @cindex signing, archives
4906 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4907 archives can be exported with @option{--export}. This
4908 operation is usually instantaneous but it can take time if the system's
4909 entropy pool needs to be refilled. On Guix System,
4910 @code{guix-service-type} takes care of generating this key pair the
4911 first boot.
4912
4913 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4914 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4915 key, which must be kept secret). When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4916 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4917 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4918 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4919 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4920 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4921 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4922
4923 @item --authorize
4924 @cindex authorizing, archives
4925 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4926 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4927 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4928
4929 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4930 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4931 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4932 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4933 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4934 (SPKI)}.
4935
4936 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4937 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4938 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4939 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4940 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4941
4942 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4943 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4944
4945 @example
4946 $ wget -O - \
4947 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/gzip/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4948 | gunzip | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4949 @end example
4950
4951 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4952 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4953 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4954 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4955 unsafe.
4956
4957 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4958 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers
4959 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
4960
4961 @item --list
4962 @itemx -t
4963 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4964 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4965 this example:
4966
4967 @example
4968 $ wget -O - \
4969 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4970 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4971 @end example
4972
4973 @end table
4974
4975 @c *********************************************************************
4976 @node Channels
4977 @chapter Channels
4978
4979 @cindex channels
4980 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
4981 @cindex configuration file for channels
4982 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
4983 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
4984 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
4985 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
4986 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
4987 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
4988 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
4989 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
4990 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used
4991 to @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
4992 Guix is able to take into account security concerns and deal with authenticated
4993 updates.
4994
4995 @menu
4996 * Specifying Additional Channels:: Extending the package collection.
4997 * Using a Custom Guix Channel:: Using a customized Guix.
4998 * Replicating Guix:: Running the @emph{exact same} Guix.
4999 * Channel Authentication:: How Guix verifies what it fetches.
5000 * Creating a Channel:: How to write your custom channel.
5001 * Package Modules in a Sub-directory:: Specifying the channel's package modules location.
5002 * Declaring Channel Dependencies:: How to depend on other channels.
5003 * Specifying Channel Authorizations:: Defining channel authors authorizations.
5004 * Primary URL:: Distinguishing mirror to original.
5005 * Writing Channel News:: Communicating information to channel's users.
5006 * Channels with Substitutes:: Using channels with available substitutes.
5007 @end menu
5008
5009 @node Specifying Additional Channels
5010 @section Specifying Additional Channels
5011
5012 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
5013 @cindex variant packages (channels)
5014 You can specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. To use a channel, write
5015 @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct @command{guix pull} to pull from it
5016 @emph{in addition} to the default Guix channel(s):
5017
5018 @vindex %default-channels
5019 @lisp
5020 ;; Add variant packages to those Guix provides.
5021 (cons (channel
5022 (name 'variant-packages)
5023 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git"))
5024 %default-channels)
5025 @end lisp
5026
5027 @noindent
5028 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
5029 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
5030 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5031 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
5032 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
5033 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
5034 modules:
5035
5036 @example
5037 $ guix pull --list-generations
5038 @dots{}
5039 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
5040 guix d894ab8
5041 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
5042 branch: master
5043 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
5044 variant-packages dd3df5e
5045 repository URL: https://example.org/variant-packages.git
5046 branch: master
5047 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
5048 11 new packages: variant-gimp, variant-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
5049 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
5050 @end example
5051
5052 @noindent
5053 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
5054 both Guix and packages from the @code{variant-personal-packages} channel. Among
5055 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{variant-gimp} and
5056 @code{variant-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
5057 @code{variant-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
5058
5059 @node Using a Custom Guix Channel
5060 @section Using a Custom Guix Channel
5061
5062 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
5063 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
5064 suppose you want to update from another copy of the Guix repository at
5065 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
5066 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
5067
5068 @lisp
5069 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use another repo.
5070 (list (channel
5071 (name 'guix)
5072 (url "https://example.org/another-guix.git")
5073 (branch "super-hacks")))
5074 @end lisp
5075
5076 @noindent
5077 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
5078 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}. The authentication concern is
5079 addressed below ((@pxref{Channel Authentication}).
5080
5081 @node Replicating Guix
5082 @section Replicating Guix
5083
5084 @cindex pinning, channels
5085 @cindex replicating Guix
5086 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
5087 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
5088 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
5089 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
5090 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
5091
5092 @lisp
5093 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
5094 (list (channel
5095 (name 'guix)
5096 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
5097 (commit "6298c3ffd9654d3231a6f25390b056483e8f407c"))
5098 (channel
5099 (name 'variant-packages)
5100 (url "https://example.org/variant-packages.git")
5101 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
5102 @end lisp
5103
5104 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
5105 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
5106 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
5107 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
5108 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
5109
5110 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
5111 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
5112 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
5113 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
5114 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
5115 package it defines.
5116
5117 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
5118 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
5119 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
5120 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
5121
5122 @node Channel Authentication
5123 @section Channel Authentication
5124
5125 @anchor{channel-authentication}
5126 @cindex authentication, of channel code
5127 The @command{guix pull} and @command{guix time-machine} commands
5128 @dfn{authenticate} the code retrieved from channels: they make sure each
5129 commit that is fetched is signed by an authorized developer. The goal
5130 is to protect from unauthorized modifications to the channel that would
5131 lead users to run malicious code.
5132
5133 As a user, you must provide a @dfn{channel introduction} in your
5134 channels file so that Guix knows how to authenticate its first commit.
5135 A channel specification, including its introduction, looks something
5136 along these lines:
5137
5138 @lisp
5139 (channel
5140 (name 'some-channel)
5141 (url "https://example.org/some-channel.git")
5142 (introduction
5143 (make-channel-introduction
5144 "6f0d8cc0d88abb59c324b2990bfee2876016bb86"
5145 (openpgp-fingerprint
5146 "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5147 @end lisp
5148
5149 The specification above shows the name and URL of the channel. The call
5150 to @code{make-channel-introduction} above specifies that authentication
5151 of this channel starts at commit @code{6f0d8cc@dots{}}, which is signed
5152 by the OpenPGP key with fingerprint @code{CABB A931@dots{}}.
5153
5154 For the main channel, called @code{guix}, you automatically get that
5155 information from your Guix installation. For other channels, include
5156 the channel introduction provided by the channel authors in your
5157 @file{channels.scm} file. Make sure you retrieve the channel
5158 introduction from a trusted source since that is the root of your trust.
5159
5160 If you're curious about the authentication mechanics, read on!
5161
5162 @node Creating a Channel
5163 @section Creating a Channel
5164
5165 @cindex personal packages (channels)
5166 @cindex channels, for personal packages
5167 Let's say you have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages
5168 that you think would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but
5169 would like to have these packages transparently available to you at the
5170 command line. You would first write modules containing those package
5171 definitions (@pxref{Package Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and
5172 then you and anyone else can use it as an additional channel to get packages
5173 from. Neat, no?
5174
5175 @c What follows stems from discussions at
5176 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
5177 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
5178 @quotation Warning
5179 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
5180 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
5181 of caution:
5182
5183 @itemize
5184 @item
5185 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
5186 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
5187 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
5188 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
5189 process.
5190
5191 @item
5192 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
5193 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
5194 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
5195 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
5196 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
5197 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
5198 either.
5199
5200 @item
5201 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
5202 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
5203 @end itemize
5204
5205 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
5206 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
5207 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
5208 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
5209 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
5210 @end quotation
5211
5212 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
5213 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
5214 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
5215 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
5216 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
5217 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
5218 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
5219 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
5220 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
5221 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5222
5223 As a channel author, consider bundling authentication material with your
5224 channel so that users can authenticate it. @xref{Channel
5225 Authentication}, and @ref{Specifying Channel Authorizations}, for info
5226 on how to do it.
5227
5228
5229 @node Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5230 @section Package Modules in a Sub-directory
5231
5232 @cindex subdirectory, channels
5233 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
5234 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
5235 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
5236
5237 @lisp
5238 (channel
5239 (version 0)
5240 (directory "guix"))
5241 @end lisp
5242
5243 @node Declaring Channel Dependencies
5244 @section Declaring Channel Dependencies
5245
5246 @cindex dependencies, channels
5247 @cindex meta-data, channels
5248 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
5249 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
5250 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
5251 the channel repository.
5252
5253 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
5254
5255 @lisp
5256 (channel
5257 (version 0)
5258 (dependencies
5259 (channel
5260 (name 'some-collection)
5261 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git")
5262
5263 ;; The 'introduction' bit below is optional: you would
5264 ;; provide it for dependencies that can be authenticated.
5265 (introduction
5266 (channel-introduction
5267 (version 0)
5268 (commit "a8883b58dc82e167c96506cf05095f37c2c2c6cd")
5269 (signer "CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"))))
5270 (channel
5271 (name 'some-other-collection)
5272 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
5273 (branch "testing"))))
5274 @end lisp
5275
5276 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
5277 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
5278 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
5279 channels are available.
5280
5281 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
5282 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
5283 dependencies to a minimum.
5284
5285 @node Specifying Channel Authorizations
5286 @section Specifying Channel Authorizations
5287
5288 @cindex channel authorizations
5289 @anchor{channel-authorizations}
5290 As we saw above, Guix ensures the source code it pulls from channels
5291 comes from authorized developers. As a channel author, you need to
5292 specify the list of authorized developers in the
5293 @file{.guix-authorizations} file in the channel's Git repository. The
5294 authentication rule is simple: each commit must be signed by a key
5295 listed in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its parent
5296 commit(s)@footnote{Git commits form a @dfn{directed acyclic graph}
5297 (DAG). Each commit can have zero or more parents; ``regular'' commits
5298 have one parent and merge commits have two parent commits. Read
5299 @uref{https://eagain.net/articles/git-for-computer-scientists/, @i{Git
5300 for Computer Scientists}} for a great overview.} The
5301 @file{.guix-authorizations} file looks like this:
5302
5303 @lisp
5304 ;; Example '.guix-authorizations' file.
5305
5306 (authorizations
5307 (version 0) ;current file format version
5308
5309 (("AD17 A21E F8AE D8F1 CC02 DBD9 F8AE D8F1 765C 61E3"
5310 (name "alice"))
5311 ("2A39 3FFF 68F4 EF7A 3D29 12AF 68F4 EF7A 22FB B2D5"
5312 (name "bob"))
5313 ("CABB A931 C0FF EEC6 900D 0CFB 090B 1199 3D9A EBB5"
5314 (name "charlie"))))
5315 @end lisp
5316
5317 Each fingerprint is followed by optional key/value pairs, as in the
5318 example above. Currently these key/value pairs are ignored.
5319
5320 This authentication rule creates a chicken-and-egg issue: how do we
5321 authenticate the first commit? Related to that: how do we deal with
5322 channels whose repository history contains unsigned commits and lack
5323 @file{.guix-authorizations}? And how do we fork existing channels?
5324
5325 @cindex channel introduction
5326 Channel introductions answer these questions by describing the first
5327 commit of a channel that should be authenticated. The first time a
5328 channel is fetched with @command{guix pull} or @command{guix
5329 time-machine}, the command looks up the introductory commit and verifies
5330 that it is signed by the specified OpenPGP key. From then on, it
5331 authenticates commits according to the rule above.
5332
5333 Additionally, your channel must provide all the OpenPGP keys that were
5334 ever mentioned in @file{.guix-authorizations}, stored as @file{.key}
5335 files, which can be either binary or ``ASCII-armored''. By default,
5336 those @file{.key} files are searched for in the branch named
5337 @code{keyring} but you can specify a different branch name in
5338 @code{.guix-channel} like so:
5339
5340 @lisp
5341 (channel
5342 (version 0)
5343 (keyring-reference "my-keyring-branch"))
5344 @end lisp
5345
5346 To summarize, as the author of a channel, there are three things you have
5347 to do to allow users to authenticate your code:
5348
5349 @enumerate
5350 @item
5351 Export the OpenPGP keys of past and present committers with @command{gpg
5352 --export} and store them in @file{.key} files, by default in a branch
5353 named @code{keyring} (we recommend making it an @dfn{orphan branch}).
5354
5355 @item
5356 Introduce an initial @file{.guix-authorizations} in the channel's
5357 repository. Do that in a signed commit (@pxref{Commit Access}, for
5358 information on how to sign Git commits.)
5359
5360 @item
5361 Advertise the channel introduction, for instance on your channel's web
5362 page. The channel introduction, as we saw above, is the commit/key
5363 pair---i.e., the commit that introduced @file{.guix-authorizations}, and
5364 the fingerprint of the OpenPGP used to sign it.
5365 @end enumerate
5366
5367 Before pushing to your public Git repository, you can run @command{guix
5368 git-authenticate} to verify that you did sign all the commits you are
5369 about to push with an authorized key:
5370
5371 @example
5372 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer}
5373 @end example
5374
5375 @noindent
5376 where @var{commit} and @var{signer} are your channel introduction.
5377 @xref{Invoking guix git authenticate}, for details.
5378
5379 Publishing a signed channel requires discipline: any mistake, such as an
5380 unsigned commit or a commit signed by an unauthorized key, will prevent
5381 users from pulling from your channel---well, that's the whole point of
5382 authentication! Pay attention to merges in particular: merge commits
5383 are considered authentic if and only if they are signed by a key present
5384 in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of @emph{both} branches.
5385
5386 @node Primary URL
5387 @section Primary URL
5388
5389 @cindex primary URL, channels
5390 Channel authors can indicate the primary URL of their channel's Git
5391 repository in the @file{.guix-channel} file, like so:
5392
5393 @lisp
5394 (channel
5395 (version 0)
5396 (url "https://example.org/guix.git"))
5397 @end lisp
5398
5399 This allows @command{guix pull} to determine whether it is pulling code
5400 from a mirror of the channel; when that is the case, it warns the user
5401 that the mirror might be stale and displays the primary URL@. That way,
5402 users cannot be tricked into fetching code from a stale mirror that does
5403 not receive security updates.
5404
5405 This feature only makes sense for authenticated repositories, such as
5406 the official @code{guix} channel, for which @command{guix pull} ensures
5407 the code it fetches is authentic.
5408
5409 @node Writing Channel News
5410 @section Writing Channel News
5411
5412 @cindex news, for channels
5413 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
5414 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
5415 an email, but that's not convenient.
5416
5417 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
5418 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
5419 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
5420 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
5421
5422 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
5423 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
5424
5425 @lisp
5426 (channel
5427 (version 0)
5428 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
5429 @end lisp
5430
5431 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
5432 something like this:
5433
5434 @lisp
5435 (channel-news
5436 (version 0)
5437 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
5438 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
5439 (fr "Oh la la"))
5440 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
5441 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
5442 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
5443 (title (en "Added a great package")
5444 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
5445 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
5446 @end lisp
5447
5448 While the news file is using the Scheme syntax, avoid naming it with a
5449 @file{.scm} extension or else it will get picked up when building the
5450 channel and yield an error since it is not a valid module.
5451 Alternatively, you can move the channel module to a subdirectory and
5452 store the news file in another directory.
5453
5454 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
5455 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
5456 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
5457 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
5458
5459 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
5460 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
5461 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
5462 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
5463 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
5464
5465 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
5466 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
5467 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
5468 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
5469 file containing the strings to translate:
5470
5471 @example
5472 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.txt
5473 @end example
5474
5475 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
5476 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
5477
5478 @node Channels with Substitutes
5479 @section Channels with Substitutes
5480
5481 When running @command{guix pull}, Guix will first compile the
5482 definitions of every available package. This is an expensive operation
5483 for which substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}) may be available. The
5484 following snippet in @file{channels.scm} will ensure that @command{guix
5485 pull} uses the latest commit with available substitutes for the package
5486 definitions: this is done by querying the continuous integration
5487 server at @url{https://ci.guix.gnu.org}.
5488
5489 @lisp
5490 (use-modules (guix ci))
5491
5492 (list (channel-with-substitutes-available
5493 %default-guix-channel
5494 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))
5495 @end lisp
5496
5497 Note that this does not mean that all the packages that you will
5498 install after running @command{guix pull} will have available
5499 substitutes. It only ensures that @command{guix pull} will not try to
5500 compile package definitions. This is particularly useful when using
5501 machines with limited resources.
5502
5503 @c *********************************************************************
5504 @node Development
5505 @chapter Development
5506
5507 @cindex software development
5508 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
5509 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
5510 this chapter is about.
5511
5512 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
5513 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
5514 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
5515 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
5516 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
5517
5518 @menu
5519 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
5520 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
5521 * The GCC toolchain:: Working with languages supported by GCC.
5522 * Invoking guix git authenticate:: Authenticating Git repositories.
5523 @end menu
5524
5525 @node Invoking guix environment
5526 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5527
5528 @cindex reproducible build environments
5529 @cindex development environments
5530 @cindex @command{guix environment}
5531 @cindex environment, package build environment
5532 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5533 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5534 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5535 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5536 environment to use them.
5537
5538 The general syntax is:
5539
5540 @example
5541 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5542 @end example
5543
5544 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5545 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5546
5547 @example
5548 guix environment guile
5549 @end example
5550
5551 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5552 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an
5553 augmented version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was
5554 run in. It contains the necessary search paths for building the given
5555 package added to the existing environment variables. To create
5556 a ``pure'' environment, in which the original environment variables have
5557 been unset, use the @option{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes
5558 wrongfully augment environment variables such as @env{PATH} in their
5559 @file{~/.bashrc} file. As a consequence, when @command{guix
5560 environment} launches it, Bash may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby
5561 introducing ``impurities'' in these environment variables. It is an
5562 error to define such environment variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead,
5563 they should be defined in @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by
5564 log-in shells. @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference
5565 Manual}, for details on Bash start-up files.}.
5566
5567 Exiting from a Guix environment is the same as exiting from the shell,
5568 and will place the user back in the old environment before @command{guix
5569 environment} was invoked. The next garbage collection (@pxref{Invoking
5570 guix gc}) will clean up packages that were installed from within the
5571 environment and are no longer used outside of it.
5572
5573 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5574 @command{guix environment} defines the @env{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5575 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5576 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5577 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5578 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5579
5580 @example
5581 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5582 then
5583 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5584 fi
5585 @end example
5586
5587 @noindent
5588 ...@: or to browse the profile:
5589
5590 @example
5591 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5592 @end example
5593
5594 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5595 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5596 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5597 and Emacs are available:
5598
5599 @example
5600 guix environment guile emacs
5601 @end example
5602
5603 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5604 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5605 command from the rest of the arguments:
5606
5607 @example
5608 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5609 @end example
5610
5611 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5612 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5613 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5614 NumPy:
5615
5616 @example
5617 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5618 @end example
5619
5620 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5621 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5622 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5623 @option{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5624 @option{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5625 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5626 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5627 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5628 additionally includes Git and strace:
5629
5630 @example
5631 guix environment --pure guix --ad-hoc git strace
5632 @end example
5633
5634 @cindex container
5635 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5636 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5637 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
5638 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5639 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5640 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5641 working directory are mounted:
5642
5643 @example
5644 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5645 @end example
5646
5647 @quotation Note
5648 The @option{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5649 @end quotation
5650
5651 @cindex certificates
5652 Another typical use case for containers is to run security-sensitive
5653 applications such as a web browser. To run Eolie, we must expose and
5654 share some files and directories; we include @code{nss-certs} and expose
5655 @file{/etc/ssl/certs/} for HTTPS authentication; finally we preserve the
5656 @env{DISPLAY} environment variable since containerized graphical
5657 applications won't display without it.
5658
5659 @example
5660 guix environment --preserve='^DISPLAY$' --container --network \
5661 --expose=/etc/machine-id \
5662 --expose=/etc/ssl/certs/ \
5663 --share=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/=$HOME/.local/share/eolie/ \
5664 --ad-hoc eolie nss-certs dbus -- eolie
5665 @end example
5666
5667 The available options are summarized below.
5668
5669 @table @code
5670 @item --root=@var{file}
5671 @itemx -r @var{file}
5672 @cindex persistent environment
5673 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
5674 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
5675 register it as a garbage collector root.
5676
5677 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
5678 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
5679
5680 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
5681 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
5682 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
5683 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
5684 gc}, for more on GC roots.
5685
5686 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5687 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5688 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5689 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5690
5691 For example, running:
5692
5693 @example
5694 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5695 @end example
5696
5697 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5698 PETSc package.
5699
5700 Running:
5701
5702 @example
5703 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5704 @end example
5705
5706 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
5707
5708 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
5709 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5710
5711 @example
5712 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5713 @end example
5714
5715 @item --load=@var{file}
5716 @itemx -l @var{file}
5717 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5718 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5719
5720 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5721 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5722
5723 @lisp
5724 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5725 @end lisp
5726
5727 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5728 @itemx -m @var{file}
5729 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
5730 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
5731 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
5732
5733 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
5734 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
5735 manifest files.
5736
5737 @item --ad-hoc
5738 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5739 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5740 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5741 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5742
5743 For instance, the command:
5744
5745 @example
5746 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5747 @end example
5748
5749 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5750 available.
5751
5752 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5753 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5754 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5755 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5756
5757 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5758 environment}. Packages appearing before @option{--ad-hoc} are
5759 interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be added to the
5760 environment, the default behavior. Packages appearing after are
5761 interpreted as packages that will be added to the environment directly.
5762
5763 @item --pure
5764 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
5765 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below). This has the effect of
5766 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
5767
5768 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
5769 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
5770 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
5771 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
5772 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
5773 several times.
5774
5775 @example
5776 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
5777 -- mpirun @dots{}
5778 @end example
5779
5780 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
5781 variables defined are @env{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
5782 with @samp{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@env{HOME},
5783 @env{USER}, etc.).
5784
5785 @item --search-paths
5786 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5787 environment.
5788
5789 @item --system=@var{system}
5790 @itemx -s @var{system}
5791 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5792
5793 @item --container
5794 @itemx -C
5795 @cindex container
5796 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5797 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5798 Additionally, unless overridden with @option{--user}, a dummy home
5799 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
5800 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5801
5802 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
5803 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
5804 @option{--user} is passed (see below).
5805
5806 @item --network
5807 @itemx -N
5808 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5809 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5810 device.
5811
5812 @item --link-profile
5813 @itemx -P
5814 For containers, link the environment profile to @file{~/.guix-profile}
5815 within the container and set @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT} to that.
5816 This is equivalent to making @file{~/.guix-profile} a symlink to the
5817 actual profile within the container.
5818 Linking will fail and abort the environment if the directory already
5819 exists, which will certainly be the case if @command{guix environment}
5820 was invoked in the user's home directory.
5821
5822 Certain packages are configured to look in @file{~/.guix-profile} for
5823 configuration files and data;@footnote{For example, the
5824 @code{fontconfig} package inspects @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts}
5825 for additional fonts.} @option{--link-profile} allows these programs to
5826 behave as expected within the environment.
5827
5828 @item --user=@var{user}
5829 @itemx -u @var{user}
5830 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
5831 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
5832 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
5833 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
5834 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
5835 need not exist on the system.
5836
5837 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @option{--share} and
5838 @option{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
5839 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
5840 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
5841
5842 @example
5843 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
5844 cd $HOME/wd
5845 guix environment --container --user=foo \
5846 --expose=$HOME/test \
5847 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
5848 @end example
5849
5850 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
5851 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
5852 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
5853
5854 @item --no-cwd
5855 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
5856 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
5857 directory within the container. If this is undesirable,
5858 @option{--no-cwd} will cause the current working directory to @emph{not}
5859 be automatically shared and will change to the user's home directory
5860 within the container instead. See also @option{--user}.
5861
5862 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5863 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5864 For containers, @option{--expose} (resp. @option{--share}) exposes the
5865 file system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
5866 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
5867 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5868 point in the container.
5869
5870 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5871 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5872 directory:
5873
5874 @example
5875 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
5876 @end example
5877
5878 @end table
5879
5880 @command{guix environment}
5881 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5882 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
5883 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5884
5885 @node Invoking guix pack
5886 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
5887
5888 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
5889 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
5890 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
5891 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
5892
5893 @quotation Note
5894 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5895 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5896 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5897 @end quotation
5898
5899 @cindex pack
5900 @cindex bundle
5901 @cindex application bundle
5902 @cindex software bundle
5903 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5904 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5905 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5906 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5907 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5908 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5909 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5910 that you pretend to be shipping.
5911
5912 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5913 their dependencies, you can run:
5914
5915 @example
5916 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5917 @dots{}
5918 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5919 @end example
5920
5921 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5922 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5923 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5924 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5925 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5926 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5927
5928 Users of this pack would have to run
5929 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5930 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5931 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5932
5933 @example
5934 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5935 @end example
5936
5937 @noindent
5938 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5939
5940 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5941 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5942 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5943 that case, you will want to use the @option{--relocatable} option (see
5944 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5945 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5946 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5947 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5948
5949 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5950 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5951 the following command:
5952
5953 @example
5954 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5955 @end example
5956
5957 @noindent
5958 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5959 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5960
5961 @example
5962 docker load < @var{file}
5963 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5964 @end example
5965
5966 @noindent
5967 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
5968 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
5969 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5970 documentation} for more information.
5971
5972 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5973 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5974 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5975 command:
5976
5977 @example
5978 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5979 @end example
5980
5981 @noindent
5982 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5983 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5984 @uref{https://www.sylabs.io/docs/, Singularity container execution
5985 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5986 @command{singularity exec}.
5987
5988 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5989
5990 @table @code
5991 @item --format=@var{format}
5992 @itemx -f @var{format}
5993 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5994
5995 The available formats are:
5996
5997 @table @code
5998 @item tarball
5999 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
6000 specified binaries and symlinks.
6001
6002 @item docker
6003 This produces a tarball that follows the
6004 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
6005 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
6006 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
6007 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
6008
6009 @item squashfs
6010 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
6011 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
6012 procfs.
6013
6014 @quotation Note
6015 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
6016 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
6017 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
6018 with something like:
6019
6020 @example
6021 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
6022 @end example
6023
6024 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
6025 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
6026 such file or directory'' message.
6027 @end quotation
6028 @end table
6029
6030 @cindex relocatable binaries
6031 @item --relocatable
6032 @itemx -R
6033 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
6034 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
6035
6036 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
6037 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
6038 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
6039 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
6040 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to
6041 other techniques if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially
6042 work anywhere---see below for the implications.
6043
6044 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
6045
6046 @example
6047 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
6048 @end example
6049
6050 @noindent
6051 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
6052 home directory as a normal user, run:
6053
6054 @example
6055 tar xf pack.tar.gz
6056 ./mybin/sh
6057 @end example
6058
6059 @noindent
6060 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
6061 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
6062 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
6063 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
6064 software on a non-Guix machine.
6065
6066 @quotation Note
6067 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
6068 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
6069 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
6070 turn it off.
6071
6072 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
6073 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
6074 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to another
6075 @dfn{execution engine} if user namespaces are not supported. The
6076 following execution engines are supported:
6077
6078 @table @code
6079 @item default
6080 Try user namespaces and fall back to PRoot if user namespaces are not
6081 supported (see below).
6082
6083 @item performance
6084 Try user namespaces and fall back to Fakechroot if user namespaces are
6085 not supported (see below).
6086
6087 @item userns
6088 Run the program through user namespaces and abort if they are not
6089 supported.
6090
6091 @item proot
6092 Run through PRoot. The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program
6093 provides the necessary
6094 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
6095 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
6096 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
6097 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
6098
6099 @item fakechroot
6100 Run through Fakechroot. @uref{https://github.com/dex4er/fakechroot/,
6101 Fakechroot} virtualizes file system accesses by intercepting calls to C
6102 library functions such as @code{open}, @code{stat}, @code{exec}, and so
6103 on. Unlike PRoot, it incurs very little overhead. However, it does not
6104 always work: for example, some file system accesses made from within the
6105 C library are not intercepted, and file system accesses made @i{via}
6106 direct syscalls are not intercepted either, leading to erratic behavior.
6107 @end table
6108
6109 @vindex GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE
6110 When running a wrapped program, you can explicitly request one of the
6111 execution engines listed above by setting the
6112 @env{GUIX_EXECUTION_ENGINE} environment variable accordingly.
6113 @end quotation
6114
6115 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
6116 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
6117 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
6118 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
6119 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
6120 pack.
6121
6122 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
6123 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
6124 do:
6125
6126 @example
6127 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
6128 @end example
6129
6130 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
6131 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
6132
6133 @example
6134 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
6135 docker run @var{image-id}
6136 @end example
6137
6138 @item --expression=@var{expr}
6139 @itemx -e @var{expr}
6140 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
6141
6142 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6143 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @option{--expression} in
6144 @command{guix build}}).
6145
6146 @item --manifest=@var{file}
6147 @itemx -m @var{file}
6148 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
6149 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
6150 case the manifests are concatenated.
6151
6152 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
6153 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
6154 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
6155 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
6156 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
6157 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
6158 but not both.
6159
6160 @item --system=@var{system}
6161 @itemx -s @var{system}
6162 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
6163 the system type of the build host.
6164
6165 @item --target=@var{triplet}
6166 @cindex cross-compilation
6167 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
6168 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
6169 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6170
6171 @item --compression=@var{tool}
6172 @itemx -C @var{tool}
6173 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
6174 @code{zstd}, @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no
6175 compression.
6176
6177 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
6178 @itemx -S @var{spec}
6179 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
6180 appear several times.
6181
6182 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
6183 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
6184 symlink target.
6185
6186 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
6187 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
6188
6189 @item --save-provenance
6190 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
6191 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
6192 (@pxref{Channels}).
6193
6194 Provenance information is saved in the
6195 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
6196 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
6197 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
6198 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
6199
6200 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
6201 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
6202 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
6203 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
6204 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
6205
6206 @item --root=@var{file}
6207 @itemx -r @var{file}
6208 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
6209 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
6210 collector root.
6211
6212 @item --localstatedir
6213 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
6214 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
6215 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
6216 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
6217 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
6218
6219 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
6220 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
6221 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
6222 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
6223 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
6224
6225 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
6226 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
6227
6228 @item --derivation
6229 @itemx -d
6230 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
6231
6232 @item --bootstrap
6233 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
6234 useful to Guix developers.
6235 @end table
6236
6237 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
6238 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
6239 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
6240
6241
6242 @node The GCC toolchain
6243 @section The GCC toolchain
6244
6245 @cindex GCC
6246 @cindex ld-wrapper
6247 @cindex linker wrapper
6248 @cindex toolchain, for C development
6249 @cindex toolchain, for Fortran development
6250
6251 If you need a complete toolchain for compiling and linking C or C++
6252 source code, use the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This package
6253 provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development, including GCC
6254 itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus debugging symbols
6255 in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker wrapper.
6256
6257 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
6258 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
6259 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
6260 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
6261 @env{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
6262
6263 The package @code{gfortran-toolchain} provides a complete GCC toolchain
6264 for Fortran development. For other languages, please use
6265 @samp{guix search gcc toolchain} (@pxref{guix-search,, Invoking guix package}).
6266
6267
6268 @node Invoking guix git authenticate
6269 @section Invoking @command{guix git authenticate}
6270
6271 The @command{guix git authenticate} command authenticates a Git checkout
6272 following the same rule as for channels (@pxref{channel-authentication,
6273 channel authentication}). That is, starting from a given commit, it
6274 ensures that all subsequent commits are signed by an OpenPGP key whose
6275 fingerprint appears in the @file{.guix-authorizations} file of its
6276 parent commit(s).
6277
6278 You will find this command useful if you maintain a channel. But in
6279 fact, this authentication mechanism is useful in a broader context, so
6280 you might want to use it for Git repositories that have nothing to do
6281 with Guix.
6282
6283 The general syntax is:
6284
6285 @example
6286 guix git authenticate @var{commit} @var{signer} [@var{options}@dots{}]
6287 @end example
6288
6289 By default, this command authenticates the Git checkout in the current
6290 directory; it outputs nothing and exits with exit code zero on success
6291 and non-zero on failure. @var{commit} above denotes the first commit
6292 where authentication takes place, and @var{signer} is the OpenPGP
6293 fingerprint of public key used to sign @var{commit}. Together, they
6294 form a ``channel introduction'' (@pxref{channel-authentication, channel
6295 introduction}). The options below allow you to fine-tune the process.
6296
6297 @table @code
6298 @item --repository=@var{directory}
6299 @itemx -r @var{directory}
6300 Open the Git repository in @var{directory} instead of the current
6301 directory.
6302
6303 @item --keyring=@var{reference}
6304 @itemx -k @var{reference}
6305 Load OpenPGP keyring from @var{reference}, the reference of a branch
6306 such as @code{origin/keyring} or @code{my-keyring}. The branch must
6307 contain OpenPGP public keys in @file{.key} files, either in binary form
6308 or ``ASCII-armored''. By default the keyring is loaded from the branch
6309 named @code{keyring}.
6310
6311 @item --stats
6312 Display commit signing statistics upon completion.
6313
6314 @item --cache-key=@var{key}
6315 Previously-authenticated commits are cached in a file under
6316 @file{~/.cache/guix/authentication}. This option forces the cache to be
6317 stored in file @var{key} in that directory.
6318
6319 @item --historical-authorizations=@var{file}
6320 By default, any commit whose parent commit(s) lack the
6321 @file{.guix-authorizations} file is considered inauthentic. In
6322 contrast, this option considers the authorizations in @var{file} for any
6323 commit that lacks @file{.guix-authorizations}. The format of @var{file}
6324 is the same as that of @file{.guix-authorizations}
6325 (@pxref{channel-authorizations, @file{.guix-authorizations} format}).
6326 @end table
6327
6328
6329 @c *********************************************************************
6330 @node Programming Interface
6331 @chapter Programming Interface
6332
6333 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
6334 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
6335 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
6336 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
6337 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
6338 turned into concrete build actions.
6339
6340 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
6341 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
6342 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
6343 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under specific
6344 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
6345
6346 @cindex derivation
6347 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
6348 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
6349 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
6350 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
6351 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
6352 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
6353 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
6354
6355 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
6356 package definitions.
6357
6358 @menu
6359 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6360 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
6361 * Defining Package Variants:: Customizing packages.
6362 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
6363 * Build Phases:: Phases of the build process of a package.
6364 * Build Utilities:: Helpers for your package definitions and more.
6365 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
6366 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
6367 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
6368 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
6369 * Invoking guix repl:: Programming Guix in Guile
6370 @end menu
6371
6372 @node Package Modules
6373 @section Package Modules
6374
6375 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
6376 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
6377 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
6378 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
6379 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
6380 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
6381 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
6382 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
6383 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
6384 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
6385 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6386
6387 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
6388 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
6389 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
6390 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
6391 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
6392 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
6393
6394 @cindex customization, of packages
6395 @cindex package module search path
6396 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
6397 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
6398 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
6399 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
6400 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
6401 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
6402 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
6403 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
6404
6405 @enumerate
6406 @item
6407 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
6408 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
6409 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
6410 environment variable described below.
6411
6412 @item
6413 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
6414 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
6415 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
6416 channels.
6417 @end enumerate
6418
6419 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
6420
6421 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6422 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
6423 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
6424 over the own modules of the distribution.
6425 @end defvr
6426
6427 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
6428 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
6429 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
6430 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
6431 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
6432 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
6433
6434 @node Defining Packages
6435 @section Defining Packages
6436
6437 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
6438 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
6439 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
6440 package looks like this:
6441
6442 @lisp
6443 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
6444 #:use-module (guix packages)
6445 #:use-module (guix download)
6446 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
6447 #:use-module (guix licenses)
6448 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
6449
6450 (define-public hello
6451 (package
6452 (name "hello")
6453 (version "2.10")
6454 (source (origin
6455 (method url-fetch)
6456 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
6457 ".tar.gz"))
6458 (sha256
6459 (base32
6460 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
6461 (build-system gnu-build-system)
6462 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
6463 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
6464 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
6465 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
6466 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
6467 (license gpl3+)))
6468 @end lisp
6469
6470 @noindent
6471 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
6472 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
6473 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
6474 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6475 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
6476 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
6477 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
6478
6479 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
6480 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
6481 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
6482
6483 In the example above, @code{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
6484 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
6485 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
6486 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
6487 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6488
6489 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
6490
6491 @itemize
6492 @item
6493 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
6494 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
6495 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
6496 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
6497
6498 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
6499 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
6500
6501 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
6502 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
6503 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6504 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
6505 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
6506 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
6507
6508 @cindex patches
6509 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
6510 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
6511 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
6512
6513 @item
6514 @cindex GNU Build System
6515 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
6516 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @code{gnu-build-system}
6517 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
6518 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
6519 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
6520
6521 When you start packaging non-trivial software, you may need tools to
6522 manipulate those build phases, manipulate files, and so on. @xref{Build
6523 Utilities}, for more on this.
6524
6525 @item
6526 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
6527 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
6528 @code{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
6529 @option{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
6530
6531 @cindex quote
6532 @cindex quoting
6533 @findex '
6534 @findex quote
6535 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
6536 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
6537 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
6538 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
6539 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
6540 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
6541 Manual}).
6542
6543 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
6544 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
6545 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
6546 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
6547 Reference Manual}).
6548
6549 @item
6550 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
6551 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
6552 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @code{gawk}
6553 variable; @code{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
6554
6555 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
6556 @findex `
6557 @findex quasiquote
6558 @cindex comma (unquote)
6559 @findex ,
6560 @findex unquote
6561 @findex ,@@
6562 @findex unquote-splicing
6563 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
6564 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
6565 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
6566 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
6567 Reference Manual}).
6568
6569 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
6570 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @code{gnu-build-system} takes care
6571 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
6572
6573 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
6574 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
6575 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
6576 @end itemize
6577
6578 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
6579
6580 Once a package definition is in place, the
6581 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
6582 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
6583 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
6584 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
6585 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
6586 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
6587 more information on how to test package definitions, and
6588 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
6589 for style conformance.
6590 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
6591 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
6592 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
6593 in a ``channel''.
6594
6595 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
6596 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
6597 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
6598
6599 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
6600 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
6601 That derivation is stored in a @file{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
6602 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
6603 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
6604
6605 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
6606 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
6607 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6608
6609 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
6610 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
6611 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
6612 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
6613 (@pxref{The Store}).
6614 @end deffn
6615
6616 @noindent
6617 @cindex cross-compilation
6618 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
6619 package for some other system:
6620
6621 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
6622 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
6623 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
6624 @var{system} to @var{target}.
6625
6626 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
6627 and operating system, such as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"}
6628 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 Once you have package definitions, you can easily define @emph{variants}
6632 of those packages. @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for more on that.
6633
6634 @menu
6635 * package Reference:: The package data type.
6636 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
6637 @end menu
6638
6639
6640 @node package Reference
6641 @subsection @code{package} Reference
6642
6643 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
6644 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6645
6646 @deftp {Data Type} package
6647 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
6648
6649 @table @asis
6650 @item @code{name}
6651 The name of the package, as a string.
6652
6653 @item @code{version}
6654 The version of the package, as a string.
6655
6656 @item @code{source}
6657 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
6658 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
6659 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
6660 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
6661 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6662 @code{local-file}}).
6663
6664 @item @code{build-system}
6665 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
6666 Systems}).
6667
6668 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6669 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
6670 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
6671
6672 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6673 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6674 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
6675 @cindex inputs, of packages
6676 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
6677 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
6678 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
6679 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
6680 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
6681 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
6682 inputs:
6683
6684 @lisp
6685 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
6686 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
6687 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
6688 @end lisp
6689
6690 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
6691 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
6692 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
6693 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
6694 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
6695 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
6696
6697 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
6698 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
6699 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
6700 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
6701
6702 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
6703 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
6704 specified packages will be automatically installed to profiles
6705 (@pxref{Features, the role of profiles in Guix}) alongside the package
6706 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
6707 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
6708 propagated inputs).
6709
6710 For example this is necessary when packaging a C/C++ library that needs
6711 headers of another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers
6712 to another one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
6713
6714 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
6715 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
6716 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
6717 more. When packaging libraries written in those languages, ensure they
6718 can find library code they depend on at run time by listing run-time
6719 dependencies in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
6720
6721 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
6722 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
6723 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
6724
6725 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6726 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
6727 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
6728 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
6729
6730 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
6731 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
6732 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
6733 for details.
6734
6735 @item @code{synopsis}
6736 A one-line description of the package.
6737
6738 @item @code{description}
6739 A more elaborate description of the package.
6740
6741 @item @code{license}
6742 @cindex license, of packages
6743 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
6744 or a list of such values.
6745
6746 @item @code{home-page}
6747 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
6748
6749 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @code{%supported-systems})
6750 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
6751 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
6752
6753 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
6754 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
6755 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
6756 automatically corrected.
6757 @end table
6758 @end deftp
6759
6760 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
6761 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
6762 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
6763
6764 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
6765 cross-compiling:
6766
6767 @lisp
6768 (package
6769 (name "guile")
6770 ;; ...
6771
6772 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
6773 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
6774 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
6775 `(("self" ,this-package))
6776 '())))
6777 @end lisp
6778
6779 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
6780 @end deffn
6781
6782 Because packages are regular Scheme objects that capture a complete
6783 dependency graph and associated build procedures, it is often useful to
6784 write procedures that take a package and return a modified version
6785 thereof according to some parameters. Below are a few examples.
6786
6787 @cindex tool chain, choosing a package's tool chain
6788 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-with-c-toolchain @var{package} @var{toolchain}
6789 Return a variant of @var{package} that uses @var{toolchain} instead of
6790 the default GNU C/C++ toolchain. @var{toolchain} must be a list of
6791 inputs (label/package tuples) providing equivalent functionality, such
6792 as the @code{gcc-toolchain} package.
6793
6794 The example below returns a variant of the @code{hello} package built
6795 with GCC@tie{}10.x and the rest of the GNU tool chain (Binutils and the
6796 GNU C Library) instead of the default tool chain:
6797
6798 @lisp
6799 (let ((toolchain (specification->package "gcc-toolchain@@10")))
6800 (package-with-c-toolchain hello `(("toolchain" ,toolchain))))
6801 @end lisp
6802
6803 The build tool chain is part of the @dfn{implicit inputs} of
6804 packages---it's usually not listed as part of the various ``inputs''
6805 fields and is instead pulled in by the build system. Consequently, this
6806 procedure works by changing the build system of @var{package} so that it
6807 pulls in @var{toolchain} instead of the defaults. @ref{Build Systems},
6808 for more on build systems.
6809 @end deffn
6810
6811 @node origin Reference
6812 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
6813
6814 This section documents @dfn{origins}. An @code{origin} declaration
6815 specifies data that must be ``produced''---downloaded, usually---and
6816 whose content hash is known in advance. Origins are primarily used to
6817 represent the source code of packages (@pxref{Defining Packages}). For
6818 that reason, the @code{origin} form allows you to declare patches to
6819 apply to the original source code as well as code snippets to modify it.
6820
6821 @deftp {Data Type} origin
6822 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
6823
6824 @table @asis
6825 @item @code{uri}
6826 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
6827 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
6828 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
6829 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
6830
6831 @cindex fixed-output derivations, for download
6832 @item @code{method}
6833 A monadic procedure that handles the given URI@. The procedure must
6834 accept at least three arguments: the value of the @code{uri} field and
6835 the hash algorithm and hash value specified by the @code{hash} field.
6836 It must return a store item or a derivation in the store monad
6837 (@pxref{The Store Monad}); most methods return a fixed-output derivation
6838 (@pxref{Derivations}).
6839
6840 Commonly used methods include @code{url-fetch}, which fetches data from
6841 a URL, and @code{git-fetch}, which fetches data from a Git repository
6842 (see below).
6843
6844 @item @code{sha256}
6845 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. This is
6846 equivalent to providing a @code{content-hash} SHA256 object in the
6847 @code{hash} field described below.
6848
6849 @item @code{hash}
6850 The @code{content-hash} object of the source---see below for how to use
6851 @code{content-hash}.
6852
6853 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
6854 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
6855 guix hash}).
6856
6857 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
6858 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
6859 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
6860 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
6861 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
6862 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
6863
6864 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
6865 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6866 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
6867
6868 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
6869 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
6870 @code{%current-target-system}.
6871
6872 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
6873 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
6874 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
6875 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
6876
6877 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
6878 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
6879 command.
6880
6881 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
6882 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
6883 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
6884 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
6885
6886 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
6887 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
6888 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
6889
6890 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
6891 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
6892 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
6893 @end table
6894 @end deftp
6895
6896 @deftp {Data Type} content-hash @var{value} [@var{algorithm}]
6897 Construct a content hash object for the given @var{algorithm}, and with
6898 @var{value} as its hash value. When @var{algorithm} is omitted, assume
6899 it is @code{sha256}.
6900
6901 @var{value} can be a literal string, in which case it is base32-decoded,
6902 or it can be a bytevector.
6903
6904 The following forms are all equivalent:
6905
6906 @lisp
6907 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj")
6908 (content-hash "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"
6909 sha256)
6910 (content-hash (base32
6911 "05zxkyz9bv3j9h0xyid1rhvh3klhsmrpkf3bcs6frvlgyr2gwilj"))
6912 (content-hash (base64 "kkb+RPaP7uyMZmu4eXPVkM4BN8yhRd8BTHLslb6f/Rc=")
6913 sha256)
6914 @end lisp
6915
6916 Technically, @code{content-hash} is currently implemented as a macro.
6917 It performs sanity checks at macro-expansion time, when possible, such
6918 as ensuring that @var{value} has the right size for @var{algorithm}.
6919 @end deftp
6920
6921 As we have seen above, how exactly the data an origin refers to is
6922 retrieved is determined by its @code{method} field. The @code{(guix
6923 download)} module provides the most common method, @code{url-fetch},
6924 described below.
6925
6926 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} url-fetch @var{url} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6927 [name] [#:executable? #f]
6928 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches data from @var{url} (a
6929 string, or a list of strings denoting alternate URLs), which is expected
6930 to have hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). By default,
6931 the file name is the base name of URL; optionally, @var{name} can
6932 specify a different file name. When @var{executable?} is true, make the
6933 downloaded file executable.
6934
6935 When one of the URL starts with @code{mirror://}, then its host part is
6936 interpreted as the name of a mirror scheme, taken from @file{%mirror-file}.
6937
6938 Alternatively, when URL starts with @code{file://}, return the
6939 corresponding file name in the store.
6940 @end deffn
6941
6942 Likewise, the @code{(guix git-download)} module defines the
6943 @code{git-fetch} origin method, which fetches data from a Git version
6944 control repository, and the @code{git-reference} data type to describe
6945 the repository and revision to fetch.
6946
6947 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash}
6948 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6949 @code{<git-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6950 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6951 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#f}.
6952 @end deffn
6953
6954 @deftp {Data Type} git-reference
6955 This data type represents a Git reference for @code{git-fetch} to
6956 retrieve.
6957
6958 @table @asis
6959 @item @code{url}
6960 The URL of the Git repository to clone.
6961
6962 @item @code{commit}
6963 This string denotes either the commit to fetch (a hexadecimal string,
6964 either the full SHA1 commit or a ``short'' commit string; the latter is
6965 not recommended) or the tag to fetch.
6966
6967 @item @code{recursive?} (default: @code{#f})
6968 This Boolean indicates whether to recursively fetch Git sub-modules.
6969 @end table
6970
6971 The example below denotes the @code{v2.10} tag of the GNU@tie{}Hello
6972 repository:
6973
6974 @lisp
6975 (git-reference
6976 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6977 (commit "v2.10"))
6978 @end lisp
6979
6980 This is equivalent to the reference below, which explicitly names the
6981 commit:
6982
6983 @lisp
6984 (git-reference
6985 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
6986 (commit "dc7dc56a00e48fe6f231a58f6537139fe2908fb9"))
6987 @end lisp
6988 @end deftp
6989
6990 For Mercurial repositories, the module @code{(guix hg-download)} defines
6991 the @code{hg-fetch} origin method and @code{hg-reference} data type for
6992 support of the Mercurial version control system.
6993
6994 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} hg-fetch @var{ref} @var{hash-algo} @var{hash} @
6995 [name]
6996 Return a fixed-output derivation that fetches @var{ref}, a
6997 @code{<hg-reference>} object. The output is expected to have recursive
6998 hash @var{hash} of type @var{hash-algo} (a symbol). Use @var{name} as
6999 the file name, or a generic name if @code{#false}.
7000 @end deffn
7001
7002 @node Defining Package Variants
7003 @section Defining Package Variants
7004
7005 @cindex customizing packages
7006 @cindex variants, of packages
7007 One of the nice things with Guix is that, given a package definition,
7008 you can easily @emph{derive} variants of that package---for a different
7009 upstream version, with different dependencies, different compilation
7010 options, and so on. Some of these custom packages can be defined
7011 straight from the command line (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
7012 This section describes how to define package variants in code. This can
7013 be useful in ``manifests'' (@pxref{profile-manifest,
7014 @option{--manifest}}) and in your own package collection
7015 (@pxref{Creating a Channel}), among others!
7016
7017 @cindex inherit, for package definitions
7018 As discussed earlier, packages are first-class objects in the Scheme
7019 language. The @code{(guix packages)} module provides the @code{package}
7020 construct to define new package objects (@pxref{package Reference}).
7021 The easiest way to define a package variant is using the @code{inherit}
7022 keyword together with @code{package}. This allows you to inherit from a
7023 package definition while overriding the fields you want.
7024
7025 For example, given the @code{hello} variable, which contains a
7026 definition for the current version of GNU@tie{}Hello, here's how you
7027 would define a variant for version 2.2 (released in 2006, it's
7028 vintage!):
7029
7030 @lisp
7031 (use-modules (gnu packages base)) ;for 'hello'
7032
7033 (define hello-2.2
7034 (package
7035 (inherit hello)
7036 (version "2.2")
7037 (source (origin
7038 (method url-fetch)
7039 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
7040 ".tar.gz"))
7041 (sha256
7042 (base32
7043 "0lappv4slgb5spyqbh6yl5r013zv72yqg2pcl30mginf3wdqd8k9"))))))
7044 @end lisp
7045
7046 The example above corresponds to what the @option{--with-source} package
7047 transformation option does. Essentially @code{hello-2.2} preserves all
7048 the fields of @code{hello}, except @code{version} and @code{source},
7049 which it overrides. Note that the original @code{hello} variable is
7050 still there, in the @code{(gnu packages base)} module, unchanged. When
7051 you define a custom package like this, you are really @emph{adding} a
7052 new package definition; the original one remains available.
7053
7054 You can just as well define variants with a different set of
7055 dependencies than the original package. For example, the default
7056 @code{gdb} package depends on @code{guile}, but since that is an
7057 optional dependency, you can define a variant that removes that
7058 dependency like so:
7059
7060 @lisp
7061 (use-modules (gnu packages gdb) ;for 'gdb'
7062 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'alist-delete'
7063
7064 (define gdb-sans-guile
7065 (package
7066 (inherit gdb)
7067 (inputs (alist-delete "guile"
7068 (package-inputs gdb)))))
7069 @end lisp
7070
7071 The @code{alist-delete} call above removes the tuple from the
7072 @code{inputs} field that has @code{"guile"} as its first element
7073 (@pxref{SRFI-1 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7074 Manual}).
7075
7076 In some cases, you may find it useful to write functions
7077 (``procedures'', in Scheme parlance) that return a package based on some
7078 parameters. For example, consider the @code{luasocket} library for the
7079 Lua programming language. We want to create @code{luasocket} packages
7080 for major versions of Lua. One way to do that is to define a procedure
7081 that takes a Lua package and returns a @code{luasocket} package that
7082 depends on it:
7083
7084 @lisp
7085 (define (make-lua-socket name lua)
7086 ;; Return a luasocket package built with LUA.
7087 (package
7088 (name name)
7089 (version "3.0")
7090 ;; several fields omitted
7091 (inputs
7092 `(("lua" ,lua)))
7093 (synopsis "Socket library for Lua")))
7094
7095 (define-public lua5.1-socket
7096 (make-lua-socket "lua5.1-socket" lua-5.1))
7097
7098 (define-public lua5.2-socket
7099 (make-lua-socket "lua5.2-socket" lua-5.2))
7100 @end lisp
7101
7102 Here we have defined packages @code{lua5.1-socket} and
7103 @code{lua5.2-socket} by calling @code{make-lua-socket} with different
7104 arguments. @xref{Procedures,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
7105 more info on procedures. Having top-level public definitions for these
7106 two packages means that they can be referred to from the command line
7107 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7108
7109 @cindex package transformations
7110 These are pretty simple package variants. As a convenience, the
7111 @code{(guix transformations)} module provides a high-level interface
7112 that directly maps to the more sophisticated package transformation
7113 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}):
7114
7115 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} options->transformation @var{opts}
7116 Return a procedure that, when passed an object to build (package,
7117 derivation, etc.), applies the transformations specified by @var{opts} and returns
7118 the resulting objects. @var{opts} must be a list of symbol/string pairs such as:
7119
7120 @lisp
7121 ((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7122 (without-tests . "libgcrypt"))
7123 @end lisp
7124
7125 Each symbol names a transformation and the corresponding string is an argument
7126 to that transformation.
7127 @end deffn
7128
7129 For instance, a manifest equivalent to this command:
7130
7131 @example
7132 guix build guix \
7133 --with-branch=guile-gcrypt=master \
7134 --with-debug-info=zlib
7135 @end example
7136
7137 @noindent
7138 ... would look like this:
7139
7140 @lisp
7141 (use-modules (guix transformations))
7142
7143 (define transform
7144 ;; The package transformation procedure.
7145 (options->transformation
7146 '((with-branch . "guile-gcrypt=master")
7147 (with-debug-info . "zlib"))))
7148
7149 (packages->manifest
7150 (list (transform (specification->package "guix"))))
7151 @end lisp
7152
7153 @cindex input rewriting
7154 @cindex dependency graph rewriting
7155 The @code{options->transformation} procedure is convenient, but it's
7156 perhaps also not as flexible as you may like. How is it implemented?
7157 The astute reader probably noticed that most package transformation
7158 options go beyond the superficial changes shown in the first examples of
7159 this section: they involve @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency
7160 graph of a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others.
7161
7162 Dependency graph rewriting, for the purposes of swapping packages in the
7163 graph, is what the @code{package-input-rewriting} procedure in
7164 @code{(guix packages)} implements.
7165
7166 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
7167 [@var{rewrite-name}] [#:deep? #t]
7168 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
7169 indirect dependencies, including implicit inputs when @var{deep?} is
7170 true, according to @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of
7171 package pairs; the first element of each pair is the package to replace,
7172 and the second one is the replacement.
7173
7174 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
7175 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
7176 @end deffn
7177
7178 @noindent
7179 Consider this example:
7180
7181 @lisp
7182 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7183 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
7184 ;; recursively.
7185 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
7186
7187 (define git-with-libressl
7188 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
7189 @end lisp
7190
7191 @noindent
7192 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
7193 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
7194 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
7195 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
7196 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
7197
7198 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
7199 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
7200
7201 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements} [#:deep? #t]
7202 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given
7203 @var{replacements} to all the package graph, including implicit inputs
7204 unless @var{deep?} is false. @var{replacements} is a list of
7205 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as
7206 @code{"gcc"} or @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching
7207 package and returns a replacement for that package.
7208 @end deffn
7209
7210 The example above could be rewritten this way:
7211
7212 @lisp
7213 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
7214 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
7215 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
7216 @end lisp
7217
7218 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
7219 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
7220 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
7221
7222 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
7223 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
7224 graph.
7225
7226 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}] [#:deep? #f]
7227 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
7228 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
7229 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package. When @var{deep?} is true, @var{proc} is
7230 applied to implicit inputs as well.
7231 @end deffn
7232
7233
7234 @node Build Systems
7235 @section Build Systems
7236
7237 @cindex build system
7238 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
7239 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
7240 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
7241 dependencies of that build procedure.
7242
7243 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
7244 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
7245 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
7246
7247 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
7248 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
7249 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
7250 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
7251 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
7252 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
7253 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
7254 The @code{package-with-c-toolchain} is an example of a way to change the
7255 implicit inputs that a package's build system pulls in (@pxref{package
7256 Reference, @code{package-with-c-toolchain}}).
7257
7258 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
7259 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
7260 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
7261 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
7262 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
7263 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
7264 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
7265
7266 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
7267 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
7268 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
7269
7270 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
7271 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
7272 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
7273 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
7274
7275 @cindex build phases
7276 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
7277 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
7278 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
7279 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
7280 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
7281 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
7282
7283 @table @code
7284 @item unpack
7285 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
7286 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
7287 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
7288
7289 @item patch-source-shebangs
7290 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
7291 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
7292 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
7293
7294 @item configure
7295 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
7296 as @option{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
7297 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
7298
7299 @item build
7300 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
7301 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7302 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
7303
7304 @item check
7305 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
7306 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
7307 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
7308 check -j}.
7309
7310 @item install
7311 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
7312
7313 @item patch-shebangs
7314 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
7315
7316 @item strip
7317 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
7318 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
7319 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
7320 @end table
7321
7322 @vindex %standard-phases
7323 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
7324 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
7325 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
7326 procedure implements the actual phase.
7327
7328 @xref{Build Phases}, for more info on build phases and ways to customize
7329 them.
7330
7331 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
7332 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
7333 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
7334 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
7335 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
7336 have to mention them.
7337 @end defvr
7338
7339 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
7340 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
7341 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
7342 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
7343 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
7344
7345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
7346 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
7347 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
7348 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
7349
7350 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
7351 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
7352 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
7353 parameters, respectively.
7354
7355 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
7356 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
7357 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
7358 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
7359 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
7360
7361 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
7362 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
7363 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
7364 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
7365 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
7366 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
7367 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
7368
7369 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
7370 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
7371 ``jar'' task will be run.
7372
7373 @end defvr
7374
7375 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
7376 @cindex Android distribution
7377 @cindex Android NDK build system
7378 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
7379 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
7380 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
7381
7382 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
7383 (header) files to the subdirectory @file{include} of the @code{out} output and
7384 their libraries to the subdirectory @file{lib} the @code{out} output.
7385
7386 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
7387 has no conflicting files.
7388
7389 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
7390 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
7391
7392 @end defvr
7393
7394 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
7395 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
7396 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
7397
7398 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
7399 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
7400 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
7401 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
7402
7403 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
7404 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
7405 ASDF@. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
7406 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
7407 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
7408 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
7409
7410 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
7411 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
7412 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
7413
7414 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
7415 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
7416 the @code{cl-} prefix.
7417
7418 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
7419 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
7420 They should be called in a build phase after the
7421 @code{create-asdf-configuration} phase, so that the system which was
7422 just built can be used within the resulting image. @code{build-program}
7423 requires a list of Common Lisp expressions to be passed as the
7424 @code{#:entry-program} argument.
7425
7426 By default, all the @file{.asd} files present in the sources are read to
7427 find system definitions. The @code{#:asd-files} parameter can be used
7428 to specify the list of @file{.asd} files to read. Furthermore, if the
7429 package defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be
7430 loaded before the tests are run if it is specified by the
7431 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
7432 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
7433 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
7434
7435 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
7436 naming conventions suggest, or if several systems must be compiled, the
7437 @code{#:asd-systems} parameter can be used to specify the list of system
7438 names.
7439
7440 @end defvr
7441
7442 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
7443 @cindex Rust programming language
7444 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
7445 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
7446 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
7447 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
7448
7449 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
7450 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
7451
7452 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
7453 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
7454 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
7455 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
7456 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
7457 should be added to the package definition via the
7458 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
7459
7460 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
7461 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
7462 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
7463 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
7464 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs the binaries
7465 defined by the crate.
7466 @end defvr
7467
7468 @defvr {Scheme Variable} chicken-build-system
7469 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system chicken)}. It
7470 builds @uref{https://call-cc.org/, CHICKEN Scheme} modules, also called
7471 ``eggs'' or ``extensions''. CHICKEN generates C source code, which then
7472 gets compiled by a C compiler, in this case GCC.
7473
7474 This build system adds @code{chicken} to the package inputs, as well as
7475 the packages of @code{gnu-build-system}.
7476
7477 The build system can't (yet) deduce the egg's name automatically, so just like
7478 with @code{go-build-system} and its @code{#:import-path}, you should define
7479 @code{#:egg-name} in the package's @code{arguments} field.
7480
7481 For example, if you are packaging the @code{srfi-1} egg:
7482
7483 @lisp
7484 (arguments '(#:egg-name "srfi-1"))
7485 @end lisp
7486
7487 Egg dependencies must be defined in @code{propagated-inputs}, not @code{inputs}
7488 because CHICKEN doesn't embed absolute references in compiled eggs.
7489 Test dependencies should go to @code{native-inputs}, as usual.
7490 @end defvr
7491
7492 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
7493 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
7494 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
7495 mostly just moving files around.
7496
7497 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
7498 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
7499 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
7500 @code{trivial-build-system}.
7501
7502 To further simplify the file installation process, an
7503 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
7504 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
7505 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
7506
7507 @itemize
7508 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
7509 @itemize
7510 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
7511 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
7512 @end itemize
7513
7514 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
7515 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
7516 as above.
7517 @itemize
7518 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
7519 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
7520 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
7521 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
7522 @itemize
7523 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
7524 at least one of the elements in the given list.
7525 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
7526 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
7527 list.
7528 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
7529 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
7530 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
7531 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
7532 on top of the inclusions.
7533 @end itemize
7534 @end itemize
7535 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
7536 @var{target}.
7537 @end itemize
7538
7539 Examples:
7540
7541 @itemize
7542 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
7543 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
7544 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
7545 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7546 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
7547 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
7548 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
7549 @file{share/my-app/file}.
7550 @end itemize
7551 @end defvr
7552
7553
7554 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
7555 @cindex simple Clojure build system
7556 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
7557 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
7558 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
7559 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
7560 yet.
7561
7562 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
7563 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
7564 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
7565
7566 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
7567 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
7568 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
7569 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
7570 Other parameters are documented below.
7571
7572 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
7573 following phases changed:
7574
7575 @table @code
7576
7577 @item build
7578 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
7579 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
7580 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
7581 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
7582 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
7583 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
7584 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
7585 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
7586
7587 @item check
7588 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
7589 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
7590 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
7591 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
7592 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
7593 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
7594
7595 @item install
7596 This phase installs all jars built previously.
7597 @end table
7598
7599 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
7600
7601 @table @code
7602
7603 @item install-doc
7604 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
7605 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
7606 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
7607 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
7608 @end table
7609 @end defvr
7610
7611 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
7612 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
7613 implements the build procedure for packages using the
7614 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
7615
7616 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
7617 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
7618 parameter.
7619
7620 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
7621 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
7622 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
7623 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
7624 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
7625 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7626 @end defvr
7627
7628 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
7629 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
7630 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
7631 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
7632 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
7633 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
7634 system.
7635
7636 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
7637 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
7638 parameter.
7639
7640 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
7641 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
7642 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
7643
7644 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
7645 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
7646 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
7647
7648 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
7649 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
7650 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
7651 @code{dune}.
7652 @end defvr
7653
7654 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
7655 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
7656 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
7657 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
7658 Go build mechanisms}.
7659
7660 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
7661 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
7662 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
7663 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
7664 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
7665 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
7666 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
7667 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
7668 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
7669 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
7670
7671 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
7672 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
7673 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
7674 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
7675 @end defvr
7676
7677 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
7678 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
7679 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
7680
7681 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7682 @code{gnu-build-system}:
7683
7684 @table @code
7685 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
7686 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
7687 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
7688 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
7689 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
7690 that appropriately set the @env{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @env{GTK_PATH}
7691 environment variables.
7692
7693 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
7694 process by listing their names in the
7695 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
7696 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
7697 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
7698 GLib and GTK+.
7699
7700 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
7701 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
7702 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
7703 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
7704 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
7705 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
7706 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
7707 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
7708 @end table
7709
7710 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
7711 @end defvr
7712
7713 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
7714 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
7715 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
7716 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
7717 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
7718 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
7719 installs documentation.
7720
7721 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the
7722 @option{--target} option of @samp{guild compile}.
7723
7724 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
7725 their @code{native-inputs} field.
7726 @end defvr
7727
7728 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
7729 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It
7730 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/,
7731 julia} packages, which essentially is similar to running @samp{julia -e
7732 'using Pkg; Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where
7733 @env{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the paths to all Julia package inputs.
7734 Tests are run by calling @code{/test/runtests.jl}.
7735
7736 The Julia package name is read from the file @file{Project.toml}. This
7737 value can be overridden by passing the argument @code{#:julia-file-name}
7738 (which must be correctly capitalized).
7739
7740 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
7741 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
7742 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
7743 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
7744
7745 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
7746 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
7747 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
7748 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
7749 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
7750 and their uuid.
7751 @end defvr
7752
7753 @defvr {Scheme Variable} maven-build-system
7754 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system maven)}. It implements
7755 a build procedure for @uref{https://maven.apache.org, Maven} packages. Maven
7756 is a dependency and lifecycle management tool for Java. A user of Maven
7757 specifies dependencies and plugins in a @file{pom.xml} file that Maven reads.
7758 When Maven does not have one of the dependencies or plugins in its repository,
7759 it will download them and use them to build the package.
7760
7761 The maven build system ensures that maven will not try to download any
7762 dependency by running in offline mode. Maven will fail if a dependency is
7763 missing. Before running Maven, the @file{pom.xml} (and subprojects) are
7764 modified to specify the version of dependencies and plugins that match the
7765 versions available in the guix build environment. Dependencies and plugins
7766 must be installed in the fake maven repository at @file{lib/m2}, and are
7767 symlinked into a proper repository before maven is run. Maven is instructed
7768 to use that repository for the build and installs built artifacts there.
7769 Changed files are copied to the @file{lib/m2} directory of the package output.
7770
7771 You can specify a @file{pom.xml} file with the @code{#:pom-file} argument,
7772 or let the build system use the default @file{pom.xml} file in the sources.
7773
7774 In case you need to specify a dependency's version manually, you can use the
7775 @code{#:local-packages} argument. It takes an association list where the key
7776 is the groupId of the package and its value is an association list where the
7777 key is the artifactId of the package and its value is the version you want to
7778 override in the @file{pom.xml}.
7779
7780 Some packages use dependencies or plugins that are not useful at runtime nor
7781 at build time in Guix. You can alter the @file{pom.xml} file to remove them
7782 using the @code{#:exclude} argument. Its value is an association list where
7783 the key is the groupId of the plugin or dependency you want to remove, and
7784 the value is a list of artifactId you want to remove.
7785
7786 You can override the default @code{jdk} and @code{maven} packages with the
7787 corresponding argument, @code{#:jdk} and @code{#:maven}.
7788
7789 The @code{#:maven-plugins} argument is a list of maven plugins used during
7790 the build, with the same format as the @code{inputs} fields of the package
7791 declaration. Its default value is @code{(default-maven-plugins)} which is
7792 also exported.
7793 @end defvr
7794
7795 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
7796 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
7797 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
7798
7799 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
7800 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
7801 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
7802 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
7803 output.
7804
7805 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
7806 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
7807 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
7808 @end defvr
7809
7810 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
7811 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
7812 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
7813 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
7814 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
7815 try some of them.
7816
7817 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
7818 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
7819 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
7820 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
7821 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
7822 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
7823 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
7824 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
7825 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
7826
7827 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
7828 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
7829 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
7830 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
7831
7832 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
7833 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
7834 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
7835
7836 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
7837 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
7838 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
7839 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
7840 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
7841 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
7842 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
7843
7844 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
7845 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
7846 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
7847 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
7848 libraries cannot be found and we use @env{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
7849 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
7850 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
7851 @end defvr
7852
7853 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
7854 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
7855 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
7856 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
7857 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
7858
7859 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
7860 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @env{PYTHONPATH}
7861 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
7862
7863 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
7864 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
7865 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
7866 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
7867 interpreter version.
7868
7869 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
7870 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
7871 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
7872 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
7873 @end defvr
7874
7875 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
7876 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
7877 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
7878 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
7879 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
7880 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
7881 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
7882 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
7883 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
7884 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
7885 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
7886 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
7887
7888 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
7889 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
7890 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7891
7892 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
7893 @end defvr
7894
7895 @defvr {Scheme Variable} renpy-build-system
7896 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system renpy)}. It implements
7897 the more or less standard build procedure used by Ren'py games, which consists
7898 of loading @code{#:game} once, thereby creating bytecode for it.
7899
7900 It further creates a wrapper script in @code{bin/} and a desktop entry in
7901 @code{share/applications}, both of which can be used to launch the game.
7902
7903 Which Ren'py package is used can be specified with @code{#:renpy}.
7904 Games can also be installed in outputs other than ``out'' by using
7905 @code{#:output}.
7906 @end defvr
7907
7908 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
7909 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
7910 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
7911
7912 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
7913 @code{cmake-build-system}:
7914
7915 @table @code
7916 @item check-setup
7917 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
7918 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
7919 For now this only sets some environment variables:
7920 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
7921 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
7922 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
7923
7924 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
7925 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
7926
7927 @item qt-wrap
7928 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
7929 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
7930 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
7931 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
7932 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
7933
7934 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
7935 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
7936 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
7937 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
7938 or such.
7939
7940 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
7941 @end table
7942 @end defvr
7943
7944 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
7945 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
7946 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
7947 packages, which essentially is little more than running @samp{R CMD
7948 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
7949 @env{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests are
7950 run after installation using the R function
7951 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
7952 @end defvr
7953
7954 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
7955 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
7956 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
7957 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
7958 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
7959 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
7960 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
7961 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
7962
7963 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
7964 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
7965 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7966 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
7967 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
7968 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
7969 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
7970 @end defvr
7971
7972 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
7973 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
7974 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
7975 build system sets the @env{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
7976 files in the inputs.
7977
7978 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
7979 different engine and format can be specified with the
7980 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
7981 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
7982 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
7983 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
7984 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
7985 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
7986
7987 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
7988 install the built files under the texmf tree.
7989 @end defvr
7990
7991 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
7992 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
7993 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
7994 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
7995
7996 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
7997 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
7998 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
7999 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
8000 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
8001 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
8002 a traditional source release tarball.
8003
8004 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
8005 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
8006 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
8007 @end defvr
8008
8009 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
8010 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
8011 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
8012 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
8013 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
8014 script.
8015
8016 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
8017 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
8018 @code{#:python} parameter.
8019 @end defvr
8020
8021 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
8022 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
8023 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
8024 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
8025 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
8026 the package.
8027
8028 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
8029 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
8030 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
8031 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
8032 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
8033 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
8034 @end defvr
8035
8036 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
8037 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
8038 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
8039 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
8040 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
8041 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
8042 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
8043 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
8044 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
8045 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
8046 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
8047 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
8048 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
8049 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
8050
8051 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
8052 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
8053 @end defvr
8054
8055 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
8056 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
8057 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
8058 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
8059 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
8060
8061 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
8062 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
8063 @end defvr
8064
8065 @anchor{emacs-build-system}
8066 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
8067 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
8068 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
8069 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8070
8071 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
8072 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
8073 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
8074 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. The Elisp
8075 package files are installed directly under @file{share/emacs/site-lisp}.
8076 @end defvr
8077
8078 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
8079 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
8080 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
8081 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
8082 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
8083 locations in the output directory.
8084 @end defvr
8085
8086 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
8087 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
8088 implements the build procedure for packages that use
8089 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
8090
8091 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
8092 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
8093 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
8094 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
8095 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
8096
8097 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8098 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
8099
8100 @table @code
8101
8102 @item configure
8103 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
8104 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @option{--buildtype} is always set to
8105 @code{debugoptimized} unless something else is specified in
8106 @code{#:build-type}.
8107
8108 @item build
8109 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
8110 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
8111
8112 @item check
8113 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
8114 which is @code{"test"} by default.
8115
8116 @item install
8117 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
8118 @end table
8119
8120 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
8121
8122 @table @code
8123
8124 @item fix-runpath
8125 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
8126 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
8127 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
8128 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
8129 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
8130 required for the program to run.
8131
8132 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
8133 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8134 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8135
8136 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
8137 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
8138 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
8139 @end table
8140 @end defvr
8141
8142 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
8143 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
8144
8145 @cindex build phases
8146 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
8147 following phases changed:
8148
8149 @table @code
8150
8151 @item configure
8152 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
8153 can be used to build the external kernel module.
8154
8155 @item build
8156 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
8157 kernel module.
8158
8159 @item install
8160 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
8161 kernel module.
8162 @end table
8163
8164 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
8165 the module (in the @code{arguments} form of a package using the
8166 @code{linux-module-build-system}, use the key @code{#:linux} to specify it).
8167 @end defvr
8168
8169 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
8170 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
8171 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
8172 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
8173 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
8174
8175 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
8176 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
8177 @code{node}.
8178 @end defvr
8179
8180 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
8181 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
8182 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
8183 and does not have a notion of build phases.
8184
8185 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
8186 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
8187
8188 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
8189 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
8190 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
8191 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
8192 @end defvr
8193
8194 @node Build Phases
8195 @section Build Phases
8196
8197 @cindex build phases, for packages
8198 Almost all package build systems implement a notion @dfn{build phases}:
8199 a sequence of actions that the build system executes, when you build the
8200 package, leading to the installed byproducts in the store. A notable
8201 exception is the ``bare-bones'' @code{trivial-build-system}
8202 (@pxref{Build Systems}).
8203
8204 As discussed in the previous section, those build systems provide a
8205 standard list of phases. For @code{gnu-build-system}, the standard
8206 phases include an @code{unpack} phase to unpack the source code tarball,
8207 a @command{configure} phase to run @code{./configure}, a @code{build}
8208 phase to run @command{make}, and (among others) an @code{install} phase
8209 to run @command{make install}; @pxref{Build Systems}, for a more
8210 detailed view of these phases. Likewise, @code{cmake-build-system}
8211 inherits these phases, but its @code{configure} phase runs
8212 @command{cmake} instead of @command{./configure}. Other build systems,
8213 such as @code{python-build-system}, have a wholly different list of
8214 standard phases. All this code runs on the @dfn{build side}: it is
8215 evaluated when you actually build the package, in a dedicated build
8216 process spawned by the build daemon (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
8217
8218 Build phases are represented as association lists or ``alists''
8219 (@pxref{Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where
8220 each key is a symbol for the name of the phase and the associated value
8221 is a procedure that accepts an arbitrary number of arguments. By
8222 convention, those procedures receive information about the build in the
8223 form of @dfn{keyword parameters}, which they can use or ignore.
8224
8225 For example, here is how @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
8226 @code{%standard-phases}, the variable holding its alist of build
8227 phases@footnote{We present a simplified view of those build phases, but
8228 do take a look at @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} to see all the
8229 details!}:
8230
8231 @lisp
8232 ;; The build phases of 'gnu-build-system'.
8233
8234 (define* (unpack #:key source #:allow-other-keys)
8235 ;; Extract the source tarball.
8236 (invoke "tar" "xvf" source))
8237
8238 (define* (configure #:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8239 ;; Run the 'configure' script. Install to output "out".
8240 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8241 (invoke "./configure"
8242 (string-append "--prefix=" out))))
8243
8244 (define* (build #:allow-other-keys)
8245 ;; Compile.
8246 (invoke "make"))
8247
8248 (define* (check #:key (test-target "check") (tests? #true)
8249 #:allow-other-keys)
8250 ;; Run the test suite.
8251 (if tests?
8252 (invoke "make" test-target)
8253 (display "test suite not run\n")))
8254
8255 (define* (install #:allow-other-keys)
8256 ;; Install files to the prefix 'configure' specified.
8257 (invoke "make" "install"))
8258
8259 (define %standard-phases
8260 ;; The list of standard phases (quite a few are omitted
8261 ;; for brevity). Each element is a symbol/procedure pair.
8262 (list (cons 'unpack unpack)
8263 (cons 'configure configure)
8264 (cons 'build build)
8265 (cons 'check check)
8266 (cons 'install install)))
8267 @end lisp
8268
8269 This shows how @code{%standard-phases} is defined as a list of
8270 symbol/procedure pairs (@pxref{Pairs,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
8271 Manual}). The first pair associates the @code{unpack} procedure with
8272 the @code{unpack} symbol---a name; the second pair defines the
8273 @code{configure} phase similarly, and so on. When building a package
8274 that uses @code{gnu-build-system} with its default list of phases, those
8275 phases are executed sequentially. You can see the name of each phase
8276 started and completed in the build log of packages that you build.
8277
8278 Let's now look at the procedures themselves. Each one is defined with
8279 @code{define*}: @code{#:key} lists keyword parameters the procedure
8280 accepts, possibly with a default value, and @code{#:allow-other-keys}
8281 specifies that other keyword parameters are ignored (@pxref{Optional
8282 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8283
8284 The @code{unpack} procedure honors the @code{source} parameter, which
8285 the build system uses to pass the file name of the source tarball (or
8286 version control checkout), and it ignores other parameters. The
8287 @code{configure} phase only cares about the @code{outputs} parameter, an
8288 alist mapping package output names to their store file name
8289 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). It extracts the file name of
8290 for @code{out}, the default output, and passes it to
8291 @command{./configure} as the installation prefix, meaning that
8292 @command{make install} will eventually copy all the files in that
8293 directory (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile
8294 conventions,, standards, GNU Coding Standards}). @code{build} and
8295 @code{install} ignore all their arguments. @code{check} honors the
8296 @code{test-target} argument, which specifies the name of the Makefile
8297 target to run tests; it prints a message and skips tests when
8298 @code{tests?} is false.
8299
8300 @cindex build phases, customizing
8301 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
8302 @code{#:phases} parameter of the build system. Changing the set of
8303 build phases boils down to building a new alist of phases based on the
8304 @code{%standard-phases} alist described above. This can be done with
8305 standard alist procedures such as @code{alist-delete} (@pxref{SRFI-1
8306 Association Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); however, it is
8307 more convenient to do so with @code{modify-phases} (@pxref{Build
8308 Utilities, @code{modify-phases}}).
8309
8310 Here is an example of a package definition that removes the
8311 @code{configure} phase of @code{%standard-phases} and inserts a new
8312 phase before the @code{build} phase, called
8313 @code{set-prefix-in-makefile}:
8314
8315 @lisp
8316 (define-public example
8317 (package
8318 (name "example")
8319 ;; other fields omitted
8320 (build-system gnu-build-system)
8321 (arguments
8322 '(#:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases
8323 (delete 'configure)
8324 (add-before 'build 'set-prefix-in-makefile
8325 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8326 ;; Modify the makefile so that its
8327 ;; 'PREFIX' variable points to "out".
8328 (let ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out")))
8329 (substitute* "Makefile"
8330 (("PREFIX =.*")
8331 (string-append "PREFIX = "
8332 out "\n")))
8333 #true))))))))
8334 @end lisp
8335
8336 The new phase that is inserted is written as an anonymous procedure,
8337 introduced with @code{lambda*}; it honors the @code{outputs} parameter
8338 we have seen before. @xref{Build Utilities}, for more about the helpers
8339 used by this phase, and for more examples of @code{modify-phases}.
8340
8341 @cindex code staging
8342 @cindex staging, of code
8343 Keep in mind that build phases are code evaluated at the time the
8344 package is actually built. This explains why the whole
8345 @code{modify-phases} expression above is quoted (it comes after the
8346 @code{'} or apostrophe): it is @dfn{staged} for later execution.
8347 @xref{G-Expressions}, for an explanation of code staging and the
8348 @dfn{code strata} involved.
8349
8350 @node Build Utilities
8351 @section Build Utilities
8352
8353 As soon as you start writing non-trivial package definitions
8354 (@pxref{Defining Packages}) or other build actions
8355 (@pxref{G-Expressions}), you will likely start looking for helpers for
8356 ``shell-like'' actions---creating directories, copying and deleting
8357 files recursively, manipulating build phases, and so on. The
8358 @code{(guix build utils)} module provides such utility procedures.
8359
8360 Most build systems load @code{(guix build utils)} (@pxref{Build
8361 Systems}). Thus, when writing custom build phases for your package
8362 definitions, you can usually assume those procedures are in scope.
8363
8364 When writing G-expressions, you can import @code{(guix build utils)} on
8365 the ``build side'' using @code{with-imported-modules} and then put it in
8366 scope with the @code{use-modules} form (@pxref{Using Guile Modules,,,
8367 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}):
8368
8369 @lisp
8370 (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils)) ;import it
8371 (computed-file "empty-tree"
8372 #~(begin
8373 ;; Put it in scope.
8374 (use-modules (guix build utils))
8375
8376 ;; Happily use its 'mkdir-p' procedure.
8377 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/a/b/c")))))
8378 @end lisp
8379
8380 The remainder of this section is the reference for most of the utility
8381 procedures provided by @code{(guix build utils)}.
8382
8383 @c TODO Document what's missing.
8384
8385 @subsection Dealing with Store File Names
8386
8387 This section documents procedures that deal with store file names.
8388
8389 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} %store-directory
8390 Return the directory name of the store.
8391 @end deffn
8392
8393 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} store-file-name? @var{file}
8394 Return true if @var{file} is in the store.
8395 @end deffn
8396
8397 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} strip-store-file-name @var{file}
8398 Strip the @file{/gnu/store} and hash from @var{file}, a store file name.
8399 The result is typically a @code{"@var{package}-@var{version}"} string.
8400 @end deffn
8401
8402 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-name->name+version @var{name}
8403 Given @var{name}, a package name like @code{"foo-0.9.1b"}, return two
8404 values: @code{"foo"} and @code{"0.9.1b"}. When the version part is
8405 unavailable, @var{name} and @code{#f} are returned. The first hyphen
8406 followed by a digit is considered to introduce the version part.
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409 @subsection File Types
8410
8411 The procedures below deal with files and file types.
8412
8413 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-exists? @var{dir}
8414 Return @code{#t} if @var{dir} exists and is a directory.
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} executable-file? @var{file}
8418 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} exists and is executable.
8419 @end deffn
8420
8421 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} symbolic-link? @var{file}
8422 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is a symbolic link (aka. a ``symlink'').
8423 @end deffn
8424
8425 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elf-file? @var{file}
8426 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} ar-file? @var{file}
8427 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} gzip-file? @var{file}
8428 Return @code{#t} if @var{file} is, respectively, an ELF file, an
8429 @code{ar} archive (such as a @file{.a} static library), or a gzip file.
8430 @end deffn
8431
8432 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} reset-gzip-timestamp @var{file} [#:keep-mtime? #t]
8433 If @var{file} is a gzip file, reset its embedded timestamp (as with
8434 @command{gzip --no-name}) and return true. Otherwise return @code{#f}.
8435 When @var{keep-mtime?} is true, preserve @var{file}'s modification time.
8436 @end deffn
8437
8438 @subsection File Manipulation
8439
8440 The following procedures and macros help create, modify, and delete
8441 files. They provide functionality comparable to common shell utilities
8442 such as @command{mkdir -p}, @command{cp -r}, @command{rm -r}, and
8443 @command{sed}. They complement Guile's extensive, but low-level, file
8444 system interface (@pxref{POSIX,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
8445
8446 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-directory-excursion @var{directory} @var{body}@dots{}
8447 Run @var{body} with @var{directory} as the process's current directory.
8448
8449 Essentially, this macro changes the current directory to @var{directory}
8450 before evaluating @var{body}, using @code{chdir} (@pxref{Processes,,,
8451 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). It changes back to the initial
8452 directory when the dynamic extent of @var{body} is left, be it @i{via}
8453 normal procedure return or @i{via} a non-local exit such as an
8454 exception.
8455 @end deffn
8456
8457 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mkdir-p @var{dir}
8458 Create directory @var{dir} and all its ancestors.
8459 @end deffn
8460
8461 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} install-file @var{file} @var{directory}
8462 Create @var{directory} if it does not exist and copy @var{file} in there
8463 under the same name.
8464 @end deffn
8465
8466 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} make-file-writable @var{file}
8467 Make @var{file} writable for its owner.
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} copy-recursively @var{source} @var{destination} @
8471 [#:log (current-output-port)] [#:follow-symlinks? #f] [#:keep-mtime? #f]
8472 Copy @var{source} directory to @var{destination}. Follow symlinks if
8473 @var{follow-symlinks?} is true; otherwise, just preserve them. When
8474 @var{keep-mtime?} is true, keep the modification time of the files in
8475 @var{source} on those of @var{destination}. Write verbose output to the
8476 @var{log} port.
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} delete-file-recursively @var{dir} @
8480 [#:follow-mounts? #f]
8481 Delete @var{dir} recursively, like @command{rm -rf}, without following
8482 symlinks. Don't follow mount points either, unless @var{follow-mounts?}
8483 is true. Report but ignore errors.
8484 @end deffn
8485
8486 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} substitute* @var{file} @
8487 ((@var{regexp} @var{match-var}@dots{}) @var{body}@dots{}) @dots{}
8488 Substitute @var{regexp} in @var{file} by the string returned by
8489 @var{body}. @var{body} is evaluated with each @var{match-var} bound to
8490 the corresponding positional regexp sub-expression. For example:
8491
8492 @lisp
8493 (substitute* file
8494 (("hello")
8495 "good morning\n")
8496 (("foo([a-z]+)bar(.*)$" all letters end)
8497 (string-append "baz" letter end)))
8498 @end lisp
8499
8500 Here, anytime a line of @var{file} contains @code{hello}, it is replaced
8501 by @code{good morning}. Anytime a line of @var{file} matches the second
8502 regexp, @code{all} is bound to the complete match, @code{letters} is bound
8503 to the first sub-expression, and @code{end} is bound to the last one.
8504
8505 When one of the @var{match-var} is @code{_}, no variable is bound to the
8506 corresponding match substring.
8507
8508 Alternatively, @var{file} may be a list of file names, in which case
8509 they are all subject to the substitutions.
8510
8511 Be careful about using @code{$} to match the end of a line; by itself it
8512 won't match the terminating newline of a line.
8513 @end deffn
8514
8515 @subsection File Search
8516
8517 @cindex file, searching
8518 This section documents procedures to search and filter files.
8519
8520 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-name-predicate @var{regexp}
8521 Return a predicate that returns true when passed a file name whose base
8522 name matches @var{regexp}.
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} find-files @var{dir} [@var{pred}] @
8526 [#:stat lstat] [#:directories? #f] [#:fail-on-error? #f]
8527 Return the lexicographically sorted list of files under @var{dir} for
8528 which @var{pred} returns true. @var{pred} is passed two arguments: the
8529 absolute file name, and its stat buffer; the default predicate always
8530 returns true. @var{pred} can also be a regular expression, in which
8531 case it is equivalent to @code{(file-name-predicate @var{pred})}.
8532 @var{stat} is used to obtain file information; using @code{lstat} means
8533 that symlinks are not followed. If @var{directories?} is true, then
8534 directories will also be included. If @var{fail-on-error?} is true,
8535 raise an exception upon error.
8536 @end deffn
8537
8538 Here are a few examples where we assume that the current directory is
8539 the root of the Guix source tree:
8540
8541 @lisp
8542 ;; List all the regular files in the current directory.
8543 (find-files ".")
8544 @result{} ("./.dir-locals.el" "./.gitignore" @dots{})
8545
8546 ;; List all the .scm files under gnu/services.
8547 (find-files "gnu/services" "\\.scm$")
8548 @result{} ("gnu/services/admin.scm" "gnu/services/audio.scm" @dots{})
8549
8550 ;; List ar files in the current directory.
8551 (find-files "." (lambda (file stat) (ar-file? file)))
8552 @result{} ("./libformat.a" "./libstore.a" @dots{})
8553 @end lisp
8554
8555 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} which @var{program}
8556 Return the complete file name for @var{program} as found in
8557 @code{$PATH}, or @code{#f} if @var{program} could not be found.
8558 @end deffn
8559
8560 @subsection Build Phases
8561
8562 @cindex build phases
8563 The @code{(guix build utils)} also contains tools to manipulate build
8564 phases as used by build systems (@pxref{Build Systems}). Build phases
8565 are represented as association lists or ``alists'' (@pxref{Association
8566 Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) where each key is a symbol
8567 naming the phase and the associated value is a procedure (@pxref{Build
8568 Phases}).
8569
8570 Guile core and the @code{(srfi srfi-1)} module both provide tools to
8571 manipulate alists. The @code{(guix build utils)} module complements
8572 those with tools written with build phases in mind.
8573
8574 @cindex build phases, modifying
8575 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-phases @var{phases} @var{clause}@dots{}
8576 Modify @var{phases} sequentially as per each @var{clause}, which may
8577 have one of the following forms:
8578
8579 @lisp
8580 (delete @var{old-phase-name})
8581 (replace @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8582 (add-before @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8583 (add-after @var{old-phase-name} @var{new-phase-name} @var{new-phase})
8584 @end lisp
8585
8586 Where every @var{phase-name} above is an expression evaluating to a
8587 symbol, and @var{new-phase} an expression evaluating to a procedure.
8588 @end deffn
8589
8590 The example below is taken from the definition of the @code{grep}
8591 package. It adds a phase to run after the @code{install} phase, called
8592 @code{fix-egrep-and-fgrep}. That phase is a procedure (@code{lambda*}
8593 is for anonymous procedures) that takes a @code{#:outputs} keyword
8594 argument and ignores extra keyword arguments (@pxref{Optional
8595 Arguments,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for more on
8596 @code{lambda*} and optional and keyword arguments.) The phase uses
8597 @code{substitute*} to modify the installed @file{egrep} and @file{fgrep}
8598 scripts so that they refer to @code{grep} by its absolute file name:
8599
8600 @lisp
8601 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8602 (add-after 'install 'fix-egrep-and-fgrep
8603 ;; Patch 'egrep' and 'fgrep' to execute 'grep' via its
8604 ;; absolute file name instead of searching for it in $PATH.
8605 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8606 (let* ((out (assoc-ref outputs "out"))
8607 (bin (string-append out "/bin")))
8608 (substitute* (list (string-append bin "/egrep")
8609 (string-append bin "/fgrep"))
8610 (("^exec grep")
8611 (string-append "exec " bin "/grep")))
8612 #t))))
8613 @end lisp
8614
8615 In the example below, phases are modified in two ways: the standard
8616 @code{configure} phase is deleted, presumably because the package does
8617 not have a @file{configure} script or anything similar, and the default
8618 @code{install} phase is replaced by one that manually copies the
8619 executable files to be installed:
8620
8621 @lisp
8622 (modify-phases %standard-phases
8623 (delete 'configure) ;no 'configure' script
8624 (replace 'install
8625 (lambda* (#:key outputs #:allow-other-keys)
8626 ;; The package's Makefile doesn't provide an "install"
8627 ;; rule so do it by ourselves.
8628 (let ((bin (string-append (assoc-ref outputs "out")
8629 "/bin")))
8630 (install-file "footswitch" bin)
8631 (install-file "scythe" bin)
8632 #t))))
8633 @end lisp
8634
8635 @c TODO: Add more examples.
8636
8637 @node The Store
8638 @section The Store
8639
8640 @cindex store
8641 @cindex store items
8642 @cindex store paths
8643
8644 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
8645 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
8646 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
8647 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
8648 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
8649 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
8650 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
8651 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
8652 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
8653
8654 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
8655 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
8656 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
8657 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
8658
8659 @quotation Note
8660 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
8661 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
8662 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
8663
8664 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
8665 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
8666 accidental modifications.
8667 @end quotation
8668
8669 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
8670 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
8671 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
8672 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
8673 @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
8674
8675 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
8676 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
8677 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
8678 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
8679 supported URI schemes are:
8680
8681 @table @code
8682 @item file
8683 @itemx unix
8684 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
8685 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
8686 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
8687
8688 @item guix
8689 @cindex daemon, remote access
8690 @cindex remote access to the daemon
8691 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
8692 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
8693 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
8694 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
8695 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
8696
8697 @example
8698 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
8699 @end example
8700
8701 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
8702 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
8703 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
8704
8705 The @option{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
8706 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
8707 @option{--listen}}).
8708
8709 @item ssh
8710 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
8711 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH@. This
8712 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
8713 @command{guile} binary in @env{PATH} on the destination machine. It
8714 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
8715 like this:
8716
8717 @example
8718 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
8719 @end example
8720
8721 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
8722 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
8723 @end table
8724
8725 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
8726
8727 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
8728 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
8729 @quotation Note
8730 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
8731 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
8732 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
8733 @end quotation
8734 @end defvr
8735
8736 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
8737 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
8738 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
8739 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
8740 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
8741
8742 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
8743 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
8744 @end deffn
8745
8746 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
8747 Close the connection to @var{server}.
8748 @end deffn
8749
8750 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
8751 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
8752 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
8753 @end defvr
8754
8755 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
8756 argument.
8757
8758 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
8759 @cindex invalid store items
8760 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
8761 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
8762 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
8763 build).
8764
8765 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
8766 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
8767 @end deffn
8768
8769 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
8770 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
8771 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
8772 resulting store path.
8773 @end deffn
8774
8775 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
8776 [@var{mode}]
8777 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
8778 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
8779 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
8780 @end deffn
8781
8782 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
8783 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
8784 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
8785 Store Monad}).
8786
8787 @c FIXME
8788 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
8789
8790 @node Derivations
8791 @section Derivations
8792
8793 @cindex derivations
8794 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
8795 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
8796 following pieces of information:
8797
8798 @itemize
8799 @item
8800 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
8801 directory in the store, but may produce more.
8802
8803 @item
8804 @cindex build-time dependencies
8805 @cindex dependencies, build-time
8806 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
8807 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
8808 etc.).
8809
8810 @item
8811 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
8812
8813 @item
8814 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
8815 to be passed.
8816
8817 @item
8818 A list of environment variables to be defined.
8819
8820 @end itemize
8821
8822 @cindex derivation path
8823 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
8824 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
8825 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
8826 name end in @file{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
8827 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
8828 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
8829 Store}).
8830
8831 @cindex fixed-output derivations
8832 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
8833 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
8834 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
8835 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
8836 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
8837 method and tools being used.
8838
8839 @cindex references
8840 @cindex run-time dependencies
8841 @cindex dependencies, run-time
8842 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
8843 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
8844 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
8845 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
8846 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
8847 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
8848
8849 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
8850 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
8851 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
8852 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
8853
8854 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
8855 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8856 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
8857 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
8858 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8859 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
8860 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
8861 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
8862 @code{<derivation>} object.
8863
8864 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
8865 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
8866 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
8867 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
8868 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
8869 containing this output.
8870
8871 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
8872 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
8873 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
8874 a simple text format.
8875
8876 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
8877 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
8878 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
8879 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
8880
8881 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
8882 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
8883 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
8884 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
8885 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
8886 derivations that download files.
8887
8888 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
8889 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
8890 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
8891 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
8892
8893 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
8894 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
8895 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
8896 host CPU instruction set.
8897
8898 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
8899 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
8900 @end deffn
8901
8902 @noindent
8903 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
8904 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
8905 to a Bash executable in the store:
8906
8907 @lisp
8908 (use-modules (guix utils)
8909 (guix store)
8910 (guix derivations))
8911
8912 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
8913 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
8914 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
8915 (derivation store "foo"
8916 bash `("-e" ,builder)
8917 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
8918 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
8919 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
8920 @end lisp
8921
8922 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
8923 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
8924 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
8925 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
8926 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
8927
8928 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
8929 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
8930 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
8931 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
8932
8933 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
8934 @var{name} @var{exp} @
8935 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
8936 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
8937 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
8938 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
8939 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
8940 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
8941 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
8942 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
8943 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
8944 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
8945 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
8946 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
8947 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
8948 gnu-build-system))}.
8949
8950 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
8951 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
8952 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
8953 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
8954 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
8955 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
8956 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
8957
8958 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
8959 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
8960 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
8961
8962 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
8963 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
8964 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
8965 @var{substitutable?}.
8966 @end deffn
8967
8968 @noindent
8969 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
8970 containing one file:
8971
8972 @lisp
8973 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
8974 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
8975 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
8976 (lambda (p)
8977 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
8978 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
8979
8980 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
8981 @end lisp
8982
8983
8984 @node The Store Monad
8985 @section The Store Monad
8986
8987 @cindex monad
8988
8989 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
8990 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
8991 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
8992 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
8993
8994 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
8995 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
8996 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
8997 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
8998 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
8999
9000 @cindex monadic values
9001 @cindex monadic functions
9002 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
9003 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
9004 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
9005 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
9006 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
9007 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
9008 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
9009 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
9010 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
9011
9012 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
9013
9014 @lisp
9015 (define (sh-symlink store)
9016 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
9017 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
9018 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
9019 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
9020 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
9021 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
9022 @end lisp
9023
9024 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
9025 as a monadic function:
9026
9027 @lisp
9028 (define (sh-symlink)
9029 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
9030 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
9031 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9032 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
9033 #$output))))
9034 @end lisp
9035
9036 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
9037 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
9038 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
9039 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
9040 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
9041
9042 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
9043 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
9044 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
9045
9046 @lisp
9047 (define (sh-symlink)
9048 (gexp->derivation "sh"
9049 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
9050 #$output)))
9051 @end lisp
9052
9053 @c See
9054 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
9055 @c for the funny quote.
9056 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
9057 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
9058 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
9059 @code{run-with-store}:
9060
9061 @lisp
9062 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
9063 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
9064 @end lisp
9065
9066 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
9067 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
9068 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
9069 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
9070
9071 @example
9072 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
9073 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9074 @end example
9075
9076 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
9077 automatically run through the store:
9078
9079 @example
9080 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
9081 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
9082 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
9083 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
9084 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
9085 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
9086 scheme@@(guile-user)>
9087 @end example
9088
9089 @noindent
9090 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
9091 @code{store-monad} REPL.
9092
9093 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
9094 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
9095
9096 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
9097 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
9098 in @var{monad}.
9099 @end deffn
9100
9101 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
9102 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
9103 @end deffn
9104
9105 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
9106 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
9107 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
9108 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
9109 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
9110 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
9111 in this example:
9112
9113 @lisp
9114 (run-with-state
9115 (with-monad %state-monad
9116 (>>= (return 1)
9117 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
9118 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
9119 'some-state)
9120
9121 @result{} 4
9122 @result{} some-state
9123 @end lisp
9124 @end deffn
9125
9126 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9127 @var{body} ...
9128 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
9129 @var{body} ...
9130 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
9131 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
9132 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
9133 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
9134 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
9135 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
9136 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
9137 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
9138 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
9139 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
9140
9141 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
9142 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
9146 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
9147 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
9148 sequence must be a monadic expression.
9149
9150 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
9151 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
9152 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
9153 @end deffn
9154
9155 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9156 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9157 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9158 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9159 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9160 @end deffn
9161
9162 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
9163 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
9164 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
9165 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
9166 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
9167 @end deffn
9168
9169 @cindex state monad
9170 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
9171 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
9172 monadic procedure calls.
9173
9174 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
9175 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
9176 the state that is threaded.
9177
9178 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
9179 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
9180 increments the current state value:
9181
9182 @lisp
9183 (define (square x)
9184 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
9185 (mbegin %state-monad
9186 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
9187 (return (* x x)))))
9188
9189 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
9190 @result{} (0 1 4)
9191 @result{} 3
9192 @end lisp
9193
9194 When ``run'' through @code{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
9195 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
9196 @end defvr
9197
9198 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
9199 Return the current state as a monadic value.
9200 @end deffn
9201
9202 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
9203 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
9204 monadic value.
9205 @end deffn
9206
9207 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
9208 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
9209 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
9210 @end deffn
9211
9212 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
9213 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
9214 The state is assumed to be a list.
9215 @end deffn
9216
9217 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
9218 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
9219 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
9220 @end deffn
9221
9222 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
9223 store)} module, is as follows.
9224
9225 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
9226 The store monad---an alias for @code{%state-monad}.
9227
9228 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
9229 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
9230 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below).
9231 @end defvr
9232
9233 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
9234 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
9235 open store connection.
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
9239 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9240 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
9241 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9242 @end deffn
9243
9244 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
9245 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
9246 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
9247 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
9248 @end deffn
9249
9250 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9251 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
9252 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
9253 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
9254 @var{name} is omitted.
9255
9256 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
9257 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
9258 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
9259
9260 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9261 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9262 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9263 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9264
9265 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
9266
9267 @lisp
9268 (run-with-store (open-connection)
9269 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
9270 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
9271 (return (list a b))))
9272
9273 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
9274 @end lisp
9275
9276 @end deffn
9277
9278 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
9279 monadic procedures:
9280
9281 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
9282 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
9283 [#:output "out"]
9284 Return as a monadic
9285 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
9286 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
9287 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
9288 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
9289
9290 Note that this procedure does @emph{not} build @var{package}. Thus, the
9291 result might or might not designate an existing file. We recommend not
9292 using this procedure unless you know what you are doing.
9293 @end deffn
9294
9295 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
9296 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
9297 @var{target} [@var{system}]
9298 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
9299 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
9300 @end deffn
9301
9302
9303 @node G-Expressions
9304 @section G-Expressions
9305
9306 @cindex G-expression
9307 @cindex build code quoting
9308 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
9309 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
9310 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
9311 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
9312 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
9313
9314 @cindex code staging
9315 @cindex staging, of code
9316 @cindex strata of code
9317 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
9318 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
9319 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
9320 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
9321 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
9322 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
9323 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
9324 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
9325 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
9326 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
9327 @command{make}, and so on (@pxref{Build Phases}).
9328
9329 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
9330 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
9331 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
9332 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
9333 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
9334 expressions.
9335
9336 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
9337 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
9338 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
9339 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
9340 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
9341 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
9342 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
9343 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
9344
9345 @itemize
9346 @item
9347 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
9348 processes.
9349
9350 @item
9351 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
9352 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
9353 introduced.
9354
9355 @item
9356 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
9357 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
9358 processes that use them.
9359 @end itemize
9360
9361 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9362 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
9363 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
9364 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
9365 such that these objects can also be inserted
9366 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
9367 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
9368 add files to the store and to refer to them in
9369 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
9370 below).
9371
9372 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
9373
9374 @lisp
9375 (define build-exp
9376 #~(begin
9377 (mkdir #$output)
9378 (chdir #$output)
9379 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
9380 "list-files")))
9381 @end lisp
9382
9383 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
9384 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
9385 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
9386
9387 @lisp
9388 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
9389 @end lisp
9390
9391 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
9392 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
9393 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
9394 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
9395 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
9396 output of the derivation.
9397
9398 @cindex cross compilation
9399 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
9400 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
9401 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
9402 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
9403 native package build:
9404
9405 @lisp
9406 (gexp->derivation "vi"
9407 #~(begin
9408 (mkdir #$output)
9409 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
9410 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
9411 "-s"
9412 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
9413 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
9414 #:target "aarch64-linux-gnu")
9415 @end lisp
9416
9417 @noindent
9418 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
9419 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
9420 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
9421
9422 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
9423 @findex with-imported-modules
9424 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
9425 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
9426 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
9427 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
9428
9429 @lisp
9430 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
9431 #~(begin
9432 (use-modules (guix build utils))
9433 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
9434 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
9435 #~(begin
9436 #$build
9437 (display "success!\n")
9438 #t)))
9439 @end lisp
9440
9441 @noindent
9442 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
9443 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
9444 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
9445
9446 @cindex module closure
9447 @findex source-module-closure
9448 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
9449 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
9450 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
9451 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
9452 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
9453 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
9454
9455 @lisp
9456 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
9457
9458 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
9459 '((guix build utils)
9460 (gnu build vm)))
9461 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
9462 #~(begin
9463 (use-modules (guix build utils)
9464 (gnu build vm))
9465 @dots{})))
9466 @end lisp
9467
9468 @cindex extensions, for gexps
9469 @findex with-extensions
9470 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
9471 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
9472 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
9473 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
9474
9475 @lisp
9476 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
9477
9478 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
9479 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
9480 #~(begin
9481 (use-modules (json))
9482 @dots{})))
9483 @end lisp
9484
9485 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
9486
9487 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
9488 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
9489 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
9490 or more of the following forms:
9491
9492 @table @code
9493 @item #$@var{obj}
9494 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
9495 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
9496 supported types, for example a package or a
9497 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
9498 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
9499
9500 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
9501 objects are substituted similarly.
9502
9503 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
9504 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
9505
9506 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
9507
9508 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
9509 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
9510 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
9511 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
9512 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
9513
9514 @item #+@var{obj}
9515 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
9516 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
9517 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
9518 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
9519 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
9520
9521 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
9522 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
9523 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
9524 output when @var{output} is omitted.
9525
9526 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9527
9528 @item #$@@@var{lst}
9529 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
9530 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
9531 containing list.
9532
9533 @item #+@@@var{lst}
9534 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
9535 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
9536 @var{lst}.
9537
9538 @end table
9539
9540 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
9541 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below).
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
9545 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
9546 in their execution environment.
9547
9548 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
9549 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
9550 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
9551
9552 @lisp
9553 `((guix build utils)
9554 (guix gcrypt)
9555 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
9556 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
9557 @end lisp
9558
9559 @noindent
9560 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
9561 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
9562
9563 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
9564 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
9565 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
9566 @end deffn
9567
9568 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
9569 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
9570 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
9571 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
9572 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
9573
9574 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
9575 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
9576 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
9577 @var{body}@dots{}.
9578 @end deffn
9579
9580 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
9581 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
9582 @end deffn
9583
9584 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
9585 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
9586 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
9587 information about monads).
9588
9589 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
9590 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
9591 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
9592 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
9593 [#:module-path @code{%load-path}] @
9594 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
9595 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
9596 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
9597 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
9598 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
9599 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
9600 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
9601 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
9602 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
9603 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
9604 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
9605 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
9606 to by @var{exp}.
9607
9608 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
9609 Its meaning is to
9610 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
9611 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
9612 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
9613 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
9614 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
9615
9616 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
9617 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
9618
9619 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
9620 applicable.
9621
9622 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
9623 following forms:
9624
9625 @example
9626 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
9627 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
9628 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
9629 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
9630 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
9631 @end example
9632
9633 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
9634 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
9635 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
9636 text format.
9637
9638 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
9639 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
9640 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
9641 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
9642 referenced by the outputs.
9643
9644 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
9645 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
9646
9647 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
9648 @end deffn
9649
9650 @cindex file-like objects
9651 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
9652 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
9653 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
9654 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
9655
9656 @lisp
9657 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
9658 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
9659 @end lisp
9660
9661 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
9662 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
9663 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
9664 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
9665 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
9666 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
9667 content is directly passed as a string.
9668
9669 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
9670 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
9671 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
9672 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
9673 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
9674 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
9675 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
9676 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
9677 base name of @var{file}.
9678
9679 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
9680 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
9681 permission bits are kept.
9682
9683 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
9684 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
9685 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
9686 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
9687
9688 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
9689 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
9690 @end deffn
9691
9692 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
9693 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
9694 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
9695
9696 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
9697 @end deffn
9698
9699 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
9700 [#:local-build? #t]
9701 [#:options '()]
9702 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
9703 directory computed by @var{gexp}. When @var{local-build?} is true (the
9704 default), the derivation is built locally. @var{options} is a list of
9705 additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
9706
9707 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
9708 @end deffn
9709
9710 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
9711 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9712 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
9713 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
9714 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
9715 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
9716
9717 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
9718 command:
9719
9720 @lisp
9721 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
9722
9723 (gexp->script "list-files"
9724 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
9725 "ls"))
9726 @end lisp
9727
9728 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
9729 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
9730 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
9731
9732 @example
9733 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
9734 !#
9735 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
9736 @end example
9737 @end deffn
9738
9739 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9740 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
9741 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
9742 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
9743 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
9744
9745 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
9746 @end deffn
9747
9748 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9749 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
9750 [#:splice? #f] @
9751 [#:guile (default-guile)]
9752 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
9753 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
9754 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
9755
9756 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
9757 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
9758 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
9759 @var{module-path}.
9760
9761 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
9762 or a subset thereof.
9763 @end deffn
9764
9765 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
9766 [#:splice? #f] [#:set-load-path? #t]
9767 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
9768 @var{exp}.
9769
9770 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
9771 @end deffn
9772
9773 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9774 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
9775 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
9776 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
9777 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
9778 references to all these.
9779
9780 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
9781 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
9782 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
9783 like this:
9784
9785 @lisp
9786 (define (profile.sh)
9787 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
9788 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
9789 (text-file* "profile.sh"
9790 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
9791 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
9792 @end lisp
9793
9794 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
9795 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
9796 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
9797 @end deffn
9798
9799 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
9800 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
9801 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
9802 as in:
9803
9804 @lisp
9805 (mixed-text-file "profile"
9806 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
9807 @end lisp
9808
9809 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
9810 @end deffn
9811
9812 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
9813 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
9814 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
9815 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
9816 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
9817
9818 @lisp
9819 (file-union "etc"
9820 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
9821 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
9822 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
9823 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
9824 @end lisp
9825
9826 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
9827 @end deffn
9828
9829 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
9830 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
9831 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
9832
9833 @lisp
9834 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
9835 @end lisp
9836
9837 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
9838 @end deffn
9839
9840 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
9841 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
9842 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
9843 @var{suffix} is a string.
9844
9845 As an example, consider this gexp:
9846
9847 @lisp
9848 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9849 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
9850 "/bin/uname")))
9851 @end lisp
9852
9853 The same effect could be achieved with:
9854
9855 @lisp
9856 (gexp->script "run-uname"
9857 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
9858 "/bin/uname")))
9859 @end lisp
9860
9861 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
9862 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
9863 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
9864 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
9865 @end deffn
9866
9867 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} let-system @var{system} @var{body}@dots{}
9868 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} let-system (@var{system} @var{target}) @var{body}@dots{}
9869 Bind @var{system} to the currently targeted system---e.g.,
9870 @code{"x86_64-linux"}---within @var{body}.
9871
9872 In the second case, additionally bind @var{target} to the current
9873 cross-compilation target---a GNU triplet such as
9874 @code{"arm-linux-gnueabihf"}---or @code{#f} if we are not
9875 cross-compiling.
9876
9877 @code{let-system} is useful in the occasional case where the object
9878 spliced into the gexp depends on the target system, as in this example:
9879
9880 @lisp
9881 #~(system*
9882 #+(let-system system
9883 (cond ((string-prefix? "armhf-" system)
9884 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-arm"))
9885 ((string-prefix? "x86_64-" system)
9886 (file-append qemu "/bin/qemu-system-x86_64"))
9887 (else
9888 (error "dunno!"))))
9889 "-net" "user" #$image)
9890 @end lisp
9891 @end deffn
9892
9893 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
9894 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
9895 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
9896 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
9897 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
9898 derivation or store item.
9899
9900 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
9901 for a given object:
9902
9903 @lisp
9904 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
9905 coreutils)
9906 @end lisp
9907
9908 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
9909 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
9910 @end deffn
9911
9912
9913 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
9914 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
9915 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
9916 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
9917
9918 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
9919 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
9920 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
9921 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
9922 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
9923
9924 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
9925 [#:target #f]
9926 Return as a value in @code{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
9927 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
9928 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
9929 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
9930 @end deffn
9931
9932 @node Invoking guix repl
9933 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
9934
9935 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop, script
9936 The @command{guix repl} command makes it easier to program Guix in Guile
9937 by launching a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop} (REPL) for interactive
9938 programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
9939 GNU Guile Reference Manual}), or by running Guile scripts
9940 (@pxref{Running Guile Scripts,,, guile,
9941 GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
9942 Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
9943 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
9944 dependencies are available in the search path.
9945
9946 The general syntax is:
9947
9948 @example
9949 guix repl @var{options} [@var{file} @var{args}]
9950 @end example
9951
9952 When a @var{file} argument is provided, @var{file} is
9953 executed as a Guile scripts:
9954
9955 @example
9956 guix repl my-script.scm
9957 @end example
9958
9959 To pass arguments to the script, use @code{--} to prevent them from
9960 being interpreted as arguments to @command{guix repl} itself:
9961
9962 @example
9963 guix repl -- my-script.scm --input=foo.txt
9964 @end example
9965
9966 To make a script executable directly from the shell, using the guix
9967 executable that is on the user's search path, add the following two
9968 lines at the top of the script:
9969
9970 @example
9971 @code{#!/usr/bin/env -S guix repl --}
9972 @code{!#}
9973 @end example
9974
9975 Without a file name argument, a Guile REPL is started:
9976
9977 @example
9978 $ guix repl
9979 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
9980 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
9981 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
9982 @end example
9983
9984 @cindex inferiors
9985 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
9986 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
9987 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
9988 of Guix.
9989
9990 The available options are as follows:
9991
9992 @table @code
9993 @item --type=@var{type}
9994 @itemx -t @var{type}
9995 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
9996
9997 @table @code
9998 @item guile
9999 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
10000 @item machine
10001 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
10002 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
10003 @end table
10004
10005 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
10006 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
10007 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
10008 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
10009
10010 @table @code
10011 @item --listen=tcp:37146
10012 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
10013
10014 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
10015 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
10016 @end table
10017
10018 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10019 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10020 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10021 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10022
10023 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10024 the script or REPL.
10025
10026 @item -q
10027 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
10028 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
10029 @end table
10030
10031 @c *********************************************************************
10032 @node Utilities
10033 @chapter Utilities
10034
10035 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
10036 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
10037 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
10038 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
10039
10040 @menu
10041 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
10042 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
10043 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
10044 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
10045 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
10046 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
10047 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
10048 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
10049 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
10050 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
10051 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
10052 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
10053 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
10054 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
10055 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
10056 @end menu
10057
10058 @node Invoking guix build
10059 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
10060
10061 @cindex package building
10062 @cindex @command{guix build}
10063 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
10064 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
10065 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
10066 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
10067 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
10068
10069 The general syntax is:
10070
10071 @example
10072 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
10073 @end example
10074
10075 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
10076 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
10077 resulting directories:
10078
10079 @example
10080 guix build emacs guile
10081 @end example
10082
10083 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
10084
10085 @example
10086 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
10087 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
10088 @end example
10089
10090 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
10091 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
10092 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
10093 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
10094 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
10095 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10096
10097 Alternatively, the @option{--expression} option may be used to specify a
10098 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
10099 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
10100 needed.
10101
10102 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
10103 described in the subsections below.
10104
10105 @menu
10106 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
10107 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
10108 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
10109 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
10110 @end menu
10111
10112 @node Common Build Options
10113 @subsection Common Build Options
10114
10115 A number of options that control the build process are common to
10116 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
10117 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
10118 following:
10119
10120 @table @code
10121
10122 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10123 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10124 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10125 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10126
10127 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10128 the command-line tools.
10129
10130 @item --keep-failed
10131 @itemx -K
10132 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
10133 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
10134 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
10135 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
10136 build issues.
10137
10138 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
10139 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
10140 Store, the @env{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
10141
10142 @item --keep-going
10143 @itemx -k
10144 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
10145 all the builds have either completed or failed.
10146
10147 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
10148 derivations has failed.
10149
10150 @item --dry-run
10151 @itemx -n
10152 Do not build the derivations.
10153
10154 @anchor{fallback-option}
10155 @item --fallback
10156 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
10157 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
10158
10159 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10160 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
10161 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10162 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
10163 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
10164
10165 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
10166 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
10167 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10168
10169 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
10170 disabled.
10171
10172 @item --no-substitutes
10173 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
10174 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
10175 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10176
10177 @item --no-grafts
10178 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
10179 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10180 information on grafts.
10181
10182 @item --rounds=@var{n}
10183 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
10184 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
10185
10186 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
10187 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
10188 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
10189 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
10190
10191 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10192 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10193 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10194
10195 @item --no-offload
10196 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10197 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
10198 builds to remote machines.
10199
10200 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
10201 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
10202 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10203
10204 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10205 guix-daemon, @option{--max-silent-time}}).
10206
10207 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
10208 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
10209 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
10210
10211 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
10212 guix-daemon, @option{--timeout}}).
10213
10214 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
10215 @c most programs honor it.
10216 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
10217 @cindex build logs, verbosity
10218 @item -v @var{level}
10219 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
10220 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
10221 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
10222 output on standard error.
10223
10224 @item --cores=@var{n}
10225 @itemx -c @var{n}
10226 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
10227 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
10228
10229 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
10230 @itemx -M @var{n}
10231 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
10232 guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
10233 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
10234
10235 @item --debug=@var{level}
10236 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
10237 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
10238 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
10239
10240 @end table
10241
10242 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
10243 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
10244 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
10245 derivations)} module.
10246
10247 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
10248 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
10249 building honor the @env{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
10250
10251 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
10252 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
10253 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
10254 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
10255 below:
10256
10257 @example
10258 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
10259 @end example
10260
10261 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
10262 the parsed command-line options.
10263 @end defvr
10264
10265
10266 @node Package Transformation Options
10267 @subsection Package Transformation Options
10268
10269 @cindex package variants
10270 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
10271 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
10272 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
10273 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
10274 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
10275 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
10276 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10277
10278 Package transformation options are preserved across upgrades:
10279 @command{guix upgrade} attempts to apply transformation options
10280 initially used when creating the profile to the upgraded packages.
10281
10282 The available options are listed below. Most commands support them and
10283 also support a @option{--help-transform} option that lists all the
10284 available options and a synopsis (these options are not shown in the
10285 @option{--help} output for brevity).
10286
10287 @table @code
10288
10289 @item --with-source=@var{source}
10290 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
10291 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
10292 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
10293 its version number.
10294 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
10295 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
10296
10297 When @var{package} is omitted,
10298 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
10299 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
10300 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
10301 package is @code{guile}.
10302
10303 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
10304 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
10305
10306 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
10307 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
10308 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
10309 the @code{ed} package:
10310
10311 @example
10312 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
10313 @end example
10314
10315 As a developer, @option{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
10316 candidates:
10317
10318 @example
10319 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
10320 @end example
10321
10322 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
10323
10324 @example
10325 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
10326 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
10327 @end example
10328
10329 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10330 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
10331 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
10332 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
10333 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
10334
10335 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
10336 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
10337 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
10338
10339 @example
10340 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
10341 @end example
10342
10343 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
10344 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
10345 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
10346
10347 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
10348 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
10349
10350 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
10351 This is similar to @option{--with-input} but with an important difference:
10352 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
10353 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
10354 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
10355 information on grafts.
10356
10357 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
10358 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
10359 they currently refer to:
10360
10361 @example
10362 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
10363 @end example
10364
10365 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
10366 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
10367 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
10368 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
10369 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
10370 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
10371 care!
10372
10373 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
10374 @item --with-debug-info=@var{package}
10375 Build @var{package} in a way that preserves its debugging info and graft
10376 it onto packages that depend on it. This is useful if @var{package}
10377 does not already provide debugging info as a @code{debug} output
10378 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
10379
10380 For example, suppose you're experiencing a crash in Inkscape and would
10381 like to see what's up in GLib, a library deep down in Inkscape's
10382 dependency graph. GLib lacks a @code{debug} output, so debugging is
10383 tough. Fortunately, you rebuild GLib with debugging info and tack it on
10384 Inkscape:
10385
10386 @example
10387 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
10388 @end example
10389
10390 Only GLib needs to be recompiled so this takes a reasonable amount of
10391 time. @xref{Installing Debugging Files}, for more info.
10392
10393 @quotation Note
10394 Under the hood, this option works by passing the @samp{#:strip-binaries?
10395 #f} to the build system of the package of interest (@pxref{Build
10396 Systems}). Most build systems support that option but some do not. In
10397 that case, an error is raised.
10398
10399 Likewise, if a C/C++ package is built without @code{-g} (which is rarely
10400 the case), debugging info will remain unavailable even when
10401 @code{#:strip-binaries?} is false.
10402 @end quotation
10403
10404 @cindex tool chain, changing the build tool chain of a package
10405 @item --with-c-toolchain=@var{package}=@var{toolchain}
10406 This option changes the compilation of @var{package} and everything that
10407 depends on it so that they get built with @var{toolchain} instead of the
10408 default GNU tool chain for C/C++.
10409
10410 Consider this example:
10411
10412 @example
10413 guix build octave-cli \
10414 --with-c-toolchain=fftw=gcc-toolchain@@10 \
10415 --with-c-toolchain=fftwf=gcc-toolchain@@10
10416 @end example
10417
10418 The command above builds a variant of the @code{fftw} and @code{fftwf}
10419 packages using version 10 of @code{gcc-toolchain} instead of the default
10420 tool chain, and then builds a variant of the GNU@tie{}Octave
10421 command-line interface using them. GNU@tie{}Octave itself is also built
10422 with @code{gcc-toolchain@@10}.
10423
10424 This other example builds the Hardware Locality (@code{hwloc}) library
10425 and its dependents up to @code{intel-mpi-benchmarks} with the Clang C
10426 compiler:
10427
10428 @example
10429 guix build --with-c-toolchain=hwloc=clang-toolchain \
10430 intel-mpi-benchmarks
10431 @end example
10432
10433 @quotation Note
10434 There can be application binary interface (ABI) incompatibilities among
10435 tool chains. This is particularly true of the C++ standard library and
10436 run-time support libraries such as that of OpenMP@. By rebuilding all
10437 dependents with the same tool chain, @option{--with-c-toolchain} minimizes
10438 the risks of incompatibility but cannot entirely eliminate them. Choose
10439 @var{package} wisely.
10440 @end quotation
10441
10442 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
10443 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
10444 @cindex latest commit, building
10445 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
10446 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
10447 recursively.
10448
10449 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
10450 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
10451
10452 @example
10453 guix build python-numpy \
10454 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
10455 @end example
10456
10457 This option can also be combined with @option{--with-branch} or
10458 @option{--with-commit} (see below).
10459
10460 @cindex continuous integration
10461 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
10462 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
10463 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
10464 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
10465 integration (CI).
10466
10467 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
10468 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
10469 in a while to save disk space.
10470
10471 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
10472 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
10473 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
10474 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
10475 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
10476 @option{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
10477
10478 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
10479 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
10480 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
10481 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
10482
10483 @example
10484 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
10485 @end example
10486
10487 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
10488 This is similar to @option{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
10489 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
10490 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
10491
10492 @item --with-patch=@var{package}=@var{file}
10493 Add @var{file} to the list of patches applied to @var{package}, where
10494 @var{package} is a spec such as @code{python@@3.8} or @code{glibc}.
10495 @var{file} must contain a patch; it is applied with the flags specified
10496 in the @code{origin} of @var{package} (@pxref{origin Reference}), which
10497 by default includes @code{-p1} (@pxref{patch Directories,,, diffutils,
10498 Comparing and Merging Files}).
10499
10500 As an example, the command below rebuilds Coreutils with the GNU C
10501 Library (glibc) patched with the given patch:
10502
10503 @example
10504 guix build coreutils --with-patch=glibc=./glibc-frob.patch
10505 @end example
10506
10507 In this example, glibc itself as well as everything that leads to
10508 Coreutils in the dependency graph is rebuilt.
10509
10510 @cindex upstream, latest version
10511 @item --with-latest=@var{package}
10512 So you like living on the bleeding edge? This option is for you! It
10513 replaces occurrences of @var{package} in the dependency graph with its
10514 latest upstream version, as reported by @command{guix refresh}
10515 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
10516
10517 It does so by determining the latest upstream release of @var{package}
10518 (if possible), downloading it, and authenticating it @emph{if} it comes
10519 with an OpenPGP signature.
10520
10521 As an example, the command below builds Guix against the latest version
10522 of Guile-JSON:
10523
10524 @example
10525 guix build guix --with-latest=guile-json
10526 @end example
10527
10528 There are limitations. First, in cases where the tool cannot or does
10529 not know how to authenticate source code, you are at risk of running
10530 malicious code; a warning is emitted in this case. Second, this option
10531 simply changes the source used in the existing package definitions,
10532 which is not always sufficient: there might be additional dependencies
10533 that need to be added, patches to apply, and more generally the quality
10534 assurance work that Guix developers normally do will be missing.
10535
10536 You've been warned! In all the other cases, it's a snappy way to stay
10537 on top. We encourage you to submit patches updating the actual package
10538 definitions once you have successfully tested an upgrade
10539 (@pxref{Contributing}).
10540
10541 @cindex test suite, skipping
10542 @item --without-tests=@var{package}
10543 Build @var{package} without running its tests. This can be useful in
10544 situations where you want to skip the lengthy test suite of a
10545 intermediate package, or if a package's test suite fails in a
10546 non-deterministic fashion. It should be used with care because running
10547 the test suite is a good way to ensure a package is working as intended.
10548
10549 Turning off tests leads to a different store item. Consequently, when
10550 using this option, anything that depends on @var{package} must be
10551 rebuilt, as in this example:
10552
10553 @example
10554 guix install --without-tests=python python-notebook
10555 @end example
10556
10557 The command above installs @code{python-notebook} on top of
10558 @code{python} built without running its test suite. To do so, it also
10559 rebuilds everything that depends on @code{python}, including
10560 @code{python-notebook} itself.
10561
10562 Internally, @option{--without-tests} relies on changing the
10563 @code{#:tests?} option of a package's @code{check} phase (@pxref{Build
10564 Systems}). Note that some packages use a customized @code{check} phase
10565 that does not respect a @code{#:tests? #f} setting. Therefore,
10566 @option{--without-tests} has no effect on these packages.
10567
10568 @end table
10569
10570 Wondering how to achieve the same effect using Scheme code, for example
10571 in your manifest, or how to write your own package transformation?
10572 @xref{Defining Package Variants}, for an overview of the programming
10573 interfaces available.
10574
10575 @node Additional Build Options
10576 @subsection Additional Build Options
10577
10578 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
10579 build}.
10580
10581 @table @code
10582
10583 @item --quiet
10584 @itemx -q
10585 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
10586 @option{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
10587 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
10588
10589 @item --file=@var{file}
10590 @itemx -f @var{file}
10591 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
10592 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
10593
10594 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
10595 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
10596
10597 @lisp
10598 @include package-hello.scm
10599 @end lisp
10600
10601 The @var{file} may also contain a JSON representation of one or more
10602 package definitions. Running @code{guix build -f} on @file{hello.json}
10603 with the following contents would result in building the packages
10604 @code{myhello} and @code{greeter}:
10605
10606 @example
10607 @verbatiminclude package-hello.json
10608 @end example
10609
10610 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
10611 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
10612 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
10613 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
10614
10615 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10616 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10617 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
10618
10619 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
10620 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
10621 version 1.8 of Guile.
10622
10623 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
10624 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
10625 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10626
10627 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
10628 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
10629 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
10630
10631 @item --source
10632 @itemx -S
10633 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
10634 themselves.
10635
10636 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
10637 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
10638 source tarball.
10639
10640 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
10641 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
10642 Packages}).
10643
10644 @cindex source, verification
10645 As with other derivations, the result of building a source derivation
10646 can be verified using the @option{--check} option (@pxref{build-check}).
10647 This is useful to validate that a (potentially already built or
10648 substituted, thus cached) package source matches against its declared
10649 hash.
10650
10651 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
10652 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
10653 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
10654 the packages.
10655
10656 @item --sources
10657 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
10658 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
10659 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
10660 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
10661 of the @option{--source} option and can accept one of the following
10662 optional argument values:
10663
10664 @table @code
10665 @item package
10666 This value causes the @option{--sources} option to behave in the same way
10667 as the @option{--source} option.
10668
10669 @item all
10670 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
10671 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
10672
10673 @example
10674 $ guix build --sources tzdata
10675 The following derivations will be built:
10676 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
10677 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10678 @end example
10679
10680 @item transitive
10681 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
10682 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
10683 prefetch package source for later offline building.
10684
10685 @example
10686 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
10687 The following derivations will be built:
10688 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
10689 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
10690 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
10691 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
10692 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
10693 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
10694 @dots{}
10695 @end example
10696
10697 @end table
10698
10699 @item --system=@var{system}
10700 @itemx -s @var{system}
10701 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
10702 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
10703 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
10704 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
10705
10706 @quotation Note
10707 The @option{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
10708 be confused with cross-compilation. See @option{--target} below for
10709 information on cross-compilation.
10710 @end quotation
10711
10712 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
10713 different personalities. For instance, passing
10714 @option{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
10715 @option{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows
10716 you to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
10717
10718 @quotation Note
10719 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
10720 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
10721 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
10722 @end quotation
10723
10724 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
10725 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
10726 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
10727 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
10728
10729 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
10730 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
10731 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
10732
10733 @item --target=@var{triplet}
10734 @cindex cross-compilation
10735 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
10736 as @code{"aarch64-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
10737 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
10738
10739 @anchor{build-check}
10740 @item --check
10741 @cindex determinism, checking
10742 @cindex reproducibility, checking
10743 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
10744 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
10745 identical.
10746
10747 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
10748 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
10749 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
10750 background information and tools.
10751
10752 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
10753 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
10754 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
10755
10756 @item --repair
10757 @cindex repairing store items
10758 @cindex corruption, recovering from
10759 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
10760 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
10761
10762 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
10763
10764 @item --derivations
10765 @itemx -d
10766 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
10767 packages.
10768
10769 @item --root=@var{file}
10770 @itemx -r @var{file}
10771 @cindex GC roots, adding
10772 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
10773 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
10774 collector root.
10775
10776 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
10777 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
10778 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
10779 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
10780 more on GC roots.
10781
10782 @item --log-file
10783 @cindex build logs, access
10784 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
10785 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
10786 missing.
10787
10788 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
10789 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
10790
10791 @example
10792 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
10793 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
10794 guix build --log-file guile
10795 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
10796 @end example
10797
10798 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @option{--no-substitutes} is
10799 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
10800 substitute servers (as specified with @option{--substitute-urls}).
10801
10802 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
10803 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
10804
10805 @example
10806 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s aarch64-linux
10807 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
10808 @end example
10809
10810 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
10811 @end table
10812
10813 @node Debugging Build Failures
10814 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
10815
10816 @cindex build failures, debugging
10817 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
10818 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
10819 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
10820 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
10821 build daemon uses.
10822
10823 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
10824 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
10825 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
10826 @env{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--keep-failed}}).
10827
10828 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
10829 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
10830 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
10831 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
10832 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
10833
10834 @example
10835 $ guix build foo -K
10836 @dots{} @i{build fails}
10837 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10838 $ source ./environment-variables
10839 $ cd foo-1.2
10840 @end example
10841
10842 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
10843 troubleshoot your build process.
10844
10845 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
10846 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
10847 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
10848 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
10849 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
10850
10851 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
10852 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
10853
10854 @example
10855 $ guix build -K foo
10856 @dots{}
10857 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
10858 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
10859 [env]# source ./environment-variables
10860 [env]# cd foo-1.2
10861 @end example
10862
10863 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
10864 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
10865 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
10866 the container, which you may find handy while debugging. The
10867 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
10868 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
10869 info on grafts).
10870
10871 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
10872 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
10873
10874 @example
10875 [env]# rm /bin/sh
10876 @end example
10877
10878 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
10879 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
10880
10881 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
10882 can run:
10883
10884 @example
10885 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
10886 @end example
10887
10888 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
10889 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
10890 similar to the one the daemon uses.
10891
10892
10893 @node Invoking guix edit
10894 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
10895
10896 @cindex @command{guix edit}
10897 @cindex package definition, editing
10898 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
10899 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
10900 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
10901 For instance:
10902
10903 @example
10904 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
10905 @end example
10906
10907 @noindent
10908 launches the program specified in the @env{VISUAL} or in the
10909 @env{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
10910 and that of Vim.
10911
10912 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
10913 have created your own packages on @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
10914 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
10915 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
10916 for packages currently in the store.
10917
10918 Instead of @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
10919 @option{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @option{-L
10920 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
10921 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
10922
10923 @node Invoking guix download
10924 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
10925
10926 @cindex @command{guix download}
10927 @cindex downloading package sources
10928 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
10929 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
10930 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
10931 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
10932 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
10933 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
10934
10935 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
10936 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
10937 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
10938 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
10939 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
10940 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10941
10942 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
10943 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
10944 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
10945 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
10946 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
10947 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
10948 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
10949
10950 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
10951 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
10952 the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
10953 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
10954
10955 The following options are available:
10956
10957 @table @code
10958 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
10959 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
10960 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}. @xref{Invoking guix
10961 hash}, for more information.
10962
10963 @item --format=@var{fmt}
10964 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
10965 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
10966 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
10967
10968 @item --no-check-certificate
10969 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
10970
10971 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
10972 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
10973 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
10974
10975 @item --output=@var{file}
10976 @itemx -o @var{file}
10977 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
10978 store.
10979 @end table
10980
10981 @node Invoking guix hash
10982 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
10983
10984 @cindex @command{guix hash}
10985 The @command{guix hash} command computes the hash of a file.
10986 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
10987 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
10988 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
10989
10990 The general syntax is:
10991
10992 @example
10993 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
10994 @end example
10995
10996 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
10997 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
10998 following options:
10999
11000 @table @code
11001
11002 @item --hash=@var{algorithm}
11003 @itemx -H @var{algorithm}
11004 Compute a hash using the specified @var{algorithm}, @code{sha256} by
11005 default.
11006
11007 @var{algorithm} must the name of a cryptographic hash algorithm
11008 supported by Libgcrypt @i{via} Guile-Gcrypt---e.g., @code{sha512} or
11009 @code{sha3-256} (@pxref{Hash Functions,,, guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt
11010 Reference Manual}).
11011
11012 @item --format=@var{fmt}
11013 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
11014 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
11015
11016 Supported formats: @code{base64}, @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
11017 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
11018
11019 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
11020 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
11021 in the definitions of packages.
11022
11023 @item --recursive
11024 @itemx -r
11025 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
11026
11027 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
11028 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
11029 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
11030 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
11031 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
11032 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
11033 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
11034 @c it exists.
11035
11036 @item --exclude-vcs
11037 @itemx -x
11038 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
11039 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.).
11040
11041 @vindex git-fetch
11042 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
11043 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
11044 Reference}):
11045
11046 @example
11047 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
11048 $ cd foo
11049 $ guix hash -rx .
11050 @end example
11051 @end table
11052
11053 @node Invoking guix import
11054 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
11055
11056 @cindex importing packages
11057 @cindex package import
11058 @cindex package conversion
11059 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
11060 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
11061 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
11062 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
11063 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
11064 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
11065 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11066
11067 The general syntax is:
11068
11069 @example
11070 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
11071 @end example
11072
11073 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
11074 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
11075 options specific to @var{importer}.
11076
11077 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
11078 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
11079 gnupg} if needed.
11080
11081 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
11082
11083 @table @code
11084 @item gnu
11085 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
11086 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
11087 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
11088
11089 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
11090 license needs to be figured out manually.
11091
11092 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
11093 GNU@tie{}Hello:
11094
11095 @example
11096 guix import gnu hello
11097 @end example
11098
11099 Specific command-line options are:
11100
11101 @table @code
11102 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11103 As for @command{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing
11104 OpenPGP keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
11105 refresh, @option{--key-download}}.
11106 @end table
11107
11108 @item pypi
11109 @cindex pypi
11110 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
11111 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
11112 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
11113 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
11114 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
11115 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
11116
11117 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
11118 package:
11119
11120 @example
11121 guix import pypi itsdangerous
11122 @end example
11123
11124 @table @code
11125 @item --recursive
11126 @itemx -r
11127 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11128 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11129 in Guix.
11130 @end table
11131
11132 @item gem
11133 @cindex gem
11134 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
11135 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
11136 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
11137 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
11138 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
11139 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
11140 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
11141 as an exercise to the packager.
11142
11143 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
11144
11145 @example
11146 guix import gem rails
11147 @end example
11148
11149 @table @code
11150 @item --recursive
11151 @itemx -r
11152 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11153 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11154 in Guix.
11155 @end table
11156
11157 @item cpan
11158 @cindex CPAN
11159 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
11160 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
11161 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
11162 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
11163 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
11164 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
11165 list of dependencies.
11166
11167 The command command below imports metadata for the Acme::Boolean Perl
11168 module:
11169
11170 @example
11171 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
11172 @end example
11173
11174 @item cran
11175 @cindex CRAN
11176 @cindex Bioconductor
11177 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
11178 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
11179 statistical and graphical environment}.
11180
11181 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
11182
11183 The command command below imports metadata for the Cairo R package:
11184
11185 @example
11186 guix import cran Cairo
11187 @end example
11188
11189 When @option{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
11190 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
11191 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
11192
11193 When @option{--style=specification} is added, the importer will generate
11194 package definitions whose inputs are package specifications instead of
11195 references to package variables. This is useful when generated package
11196 definitions are to be appended to existing user modules, as the list of
11197 used package modules need not be changed. The default is
11198 @option{--style=variable}.
11199
11200 When @option{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
11201 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
11202 packages for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
11203 genomic data in bioinformatics.
11204
11205 Information is extracted from the @file{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
11206 package archive.
11207
11208 The command below imports metadata for the GenomicRanges R package:
11209
11210 @example
11211 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
11212 @end example
11213
11214 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
11215 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
11216 @option{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
11217
11218 @example
11219 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
11220 @end example
11221
11222 @item texlive
11223 @cindex TeX Live
11224 @cindex CTAN
11225 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
11226 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
11227 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
11228
11229 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
11230 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
11231 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
11232 versioned archives.
11233
11234 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
11235 TeX package:
11236
11237 @example
11238 guix import texlive fontspec
11239 @end example
11240
11241 When @option{--archive=@var{directory}} is added, the source code is
11242 downloaded not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the
11243 @file{texmf-dist/source} tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from
11244 the specified sibling @var{directory} under the same root.
11245
11246 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
11247 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
11248 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
11249
11250 @example
11251 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
11252 @end example
11253
11254 @item json
11255 @cindex JSON, import
11256 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
11257 example package definition in JSON format:
11258
11259 @example
11260 @{
11261 "name": "hello",
11262 "version": "2.10",
11263 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11264 "build-system": "gnu",
11265 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
11266 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
11267 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
11268 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
11269 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
11270 @}
11271 @end example
11272
11273 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
11274 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
11275 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
11276 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
11277
11278 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
11279 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
11280
11281 @example
11282 @{
11283 @dots{}
11284 "source": @{
11285 "method": "url-fetch",
11286 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
11287 "sha256": @{
11288 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
11289 @}
11290 @}
11291 @dots{}
11292 @}
11293 @end example
11294
11295 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
11296 and outputs a package expression:
11297
11298 @example
11299 guix import json hello.json
11300 @end example
11301
11302 @item nix
11303 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
11304 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
11305 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
11306 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
11307 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
11308 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
11309 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
11310 package definition.
11311
11312 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
11313 by their canonical upstream variant.
11314
11315 Usually, you will first need to do:
11316
11317 @example
11318 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
11319 @end example
11320
11321 @noindent
11322 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
11323
11324 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
11325 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
11326 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
11327
11328 @example
11329 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
11330 @end example
11331
11332 @item hackage
11333 @cindex hackage
11334 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
11335 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
11336 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
11337 dependencies.
11338
11339 Specific command-line options are:
11340
11341 @table @code
11342 @item --stdin
11343 @itemx -s
11344 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
11345 @item --no-test-dependencies
11346 @itemx -t
11347 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11348 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
11349 @itemx -e @var{alist}
11350 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
11351 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
11352 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
11353 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
11354 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
11355 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
11356 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
11357 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
11358 @item --recursive
11359 @itemx -r
11360 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11361 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11362 in Guix.
11363 @end table
11364
11365 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
11366 HTTP Haskell package without including test dependencies and
11367 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
11368
11369 @example
11370 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
11371 @end example
11372
11373 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
11374 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
11375
11376 @example
11377 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
11378 @end example
11379
11380 @item stackage
11381 @cindex stackage
11382 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
11383 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
11384 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
11385 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
11386 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
11387 GHC compiler used by Guix.
11388
11389 Specific command-line options are:
11390
11391 @table @code
11392 @item --no-test-dependencies
11393 @itemx -t
11394 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
11395 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
11396 @itemx -l @var{version}
11397 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
11398 release is used.
11399 @item --recursive
11400 @itemx -r
11401 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11402 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11403 in Guix.
11404 @end table
11405
11406 The command below imports metadata for the HTTP Haskell package
11407 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
11408
11409 @example
11410 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
11411 @end example
11412
11413 @item elpa
11414 @cindex elpa
11415 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
11416 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11417
11418 Specific command-line options are:
11419
11420 @table @code
11421 @item --archive=@var{repo}
11422 @itemx -a @var{repo}
11423 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
11424 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
11425 are:
11426 @itemize -
11427 @item
11428 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
11429 identifier. This is the default.
11430
11431 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
11432 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
11433 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
11434 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
11435 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
11436
11437 @item
11438 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
11439 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
11440
11441 @item
11442 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
11443 identifier.
11444 @end itemize
11445
11446 @item --recursive
11447 @itemx -r
11448 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11449 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11450 in Guix.
11451 @end table
11452
11453 @item crate
11454 @cindex crate
11455 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
11456 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
11457
11458 @example
11459 guix import crate blake2-rfc
11460 @end example
11461
11462 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
11463
11464 @example
11465 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
11466 @end example
11467
11468 Additional options include:
11469
11470 @table @code
11471 @item --recursive
11472 @itemx -r
11473 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11474 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11475 in Guix.
11476 @end table
11477
11478 @item opam
11479 @cindex OPAM
11480 @cindex OCaml
11481 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
11482 repository used by the OCaml community.
11483
11484 Additional options include:
11485
11486 @table @code
11487 @item --recursive
11488 @itemx -r
11489 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11490 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11491 in Guix.
11492 @item --repo
11493 Select the given repository (a repository name). Possible values include:
11494 @itemize
11495 @item @code{opam}, the default opam repository,
11496 @item @code{coq} or @code{coq-released}, the stable repository for coq packages,
11497 @item @code{coq-core-dev}, the repository that contains development versions of coq,
11498 @item @code{coq-extra-dev}, the repository that contains development versions
11499 of coq packages.
11500 @end itemize
11501 @end table
11502
11503 @item go
11504 @cindex go
11505 Import metadata for a Go module using
11506 @uref{https://proxy.golang.org, proxy.golang.org}.
11507
11508 This importer is highly experimental. See the source code for more info
11509 about the current state.
11510
11511 @example
11512 guix import go gopkg.in/yaml.v2
11513 @end example
11514
11515 Additional options include:
11516
11517 @table @code
11518 @item --recursive
11519 @itemx -r
11520 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
11521 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
11522 in Guix.
11523 @end table
11524 @end table
11525
11526 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
11527 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
11528 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
11529
11530 @node Invoking guix refresh
11531 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
11532
11533 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
11534 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
11535 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
11536 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
11537 upstream version, like this:
11538
11539 @example
11540 $ guix refresh
11541 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
11542 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
11543 @end example
11544
11545 Alternatively, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
11546 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
11547
11548 @example
11549 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
11550 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
11551 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
11552 @end example
11553
11554 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
11555 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
11556 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
11557 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
11558 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
11559 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
11560 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
11561
11562 @table @code
11563
11564 @item --recursive
11565 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
11566
11567 @example
11568 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
11569 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
11570 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
11571 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
11572 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
11573 @dots{}
11574 @end example
11575
11576 @end table
11577
11578 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
11579 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
11580 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
11581 to that effect:
11582
11583 @lisp
11584 (define-public network-manager
11585 (package
11586 (name "network-manager")
11587 ;; @dots{}
11588 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
11589 @end lisp
11590
11591 When passed @option{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
11592 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
11593 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
11594 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
11595 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
11596 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
11597 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
11598
11599 When the public
11600 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
11601 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
11602 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
11603 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
11604
11605 The following options are supported:
11606
11607 @table @code
11608
11609 @item --expression=@var{expr}
11610 @itemx -e @var{expr}
11611 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
11612
11613 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
11614
11615 @example
11616 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
11617 @end example
11618
11619 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
11620 the packages).
11621
11622 @item --update
11623 @itemx -u
11624 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
11625 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
11626 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11627
11628 @example
11629 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
11630 @end example
11631
11632 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
11633
11634 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
11635 @itemx -s @var{subset}
11636 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
11637 @code{non-core}.
11638
11639 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
11640 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
11641 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
11642 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
11643 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
11644 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
11645
11646 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
11647 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
11648 inconvenient.
11649
11650 @item --manifest=@var{file}
11651 @itemx -m @var{file}
11652 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
11653 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
11654
11655 @item --type=@var{updater}
11656 @itemx -t @var{updater}
11657 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
11658 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
11659
11660 @table @code
11661 @item gnu
11662 the updater for GNU packages;
11663 @item savannah
11664 the updater for packages hosted at @uref{https://savannah.gnu.org, Savannah};
11665 @item gnome
11666 the updater for GNOME packages;
11667 @item kde
11668 the updater for KDE packages;
11669 @item xorg
11670 the updater for X.org packages;
11671 @item kernel.org
11672 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
11673 @item elpa
11674 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
11675 @item cran
11676 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
11677 @item bioconductor
11678 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
11679 @item cpan
11680 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
11681 @item pypi
11682 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
11683 @item gem
11684 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
11685 @item github
11686 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
11687 @item hackage
11688 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
11689 @item stackage
11690 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
11691 @item crate
11692 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
11693 @item launchpad
11694 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
11695 @end table
11696
11697 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
11698 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
11699
11700 @example
11701 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
11702 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
11703 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
11704 @end example
11705
11706 @end table
11707
11708 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
11709 names, as in this example:
11710
11711 @example
11712 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
11713 @end example
11714
11715 @noindent
11716 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
11717 @code{idutils} packages. The @option{--select} option would have no
11718 effect in this case.
11719
11720 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
11721 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
11722 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
11723 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
11724
11725 @table @code
11726
11727 @item --list-updaters
11728 @itemx -L
11729 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above).
11730
11731 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
11732 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
11733
11734 @item --list-dependent
11735 @itemx -l
11736 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
11737 result of upgrading one or more packages.
11738
11739 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
11740 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
11741 dependents of a package.
11742
11743 @end table
11744
11745 Be aware that the @option{--list-dependent} option only
11746 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
11747 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
11748
11749 @example
11750 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
11751 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
11752 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
11753 @end example
11754
11755 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
11756 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
11757
11758 @table @code
11759
11760 @item --list-transitive
11761 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
11762
11763 @example
11764 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
11765 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
11766 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
11767 @end example
11768
11769 @end table
11770
11771 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
11772 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
11773
11774 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
11775
11776 @table @code
11777
11778 @item --gpg=@var{command}
11779 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
11780 for in @code{$PATH}.
11781
11782 @item --keyring=@var{file}
11783 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
11784 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
11785 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
11786 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
11787 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
11788
11789 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
11790 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
11791 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
11792 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
11793 @option{--key-download} below).
11794
11795 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
11796 commands like this one:
11797
11798 @example
11799 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
11800 @end example
11801
11802 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
11803
11804 @example
11805 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
11806 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
11807 @end example
11808
11809 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
11810 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
11811
11812 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
11813 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
11814 of:
11815
11816 @table @code
11817 @item always
11818 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
11819 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
11820
11821 @item never
11822 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
11823
11824 @item interactive
11825 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
11826 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
11827 @end table
11828
11829 @item --key-server=@var{host}
11830 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
11831
11832 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
11833 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
11834 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11835
11836 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
11837 the command-line tools.
11838
11839 @end table
11840
11841 The @code{github} updater uses the
11842 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
11843 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
11844 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
11845 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
11846 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
11847 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
11848 an API token, set the environment variable @env{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
11849 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
11850 otherwise.
11851
11852
11853 @node Invoking guix lint
11854 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
11855
11856 @cindex @command{guix lint}
11857 @cindex package, checking for errors
11858 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
11859 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
11860 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
11861 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
11862 @option{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
11863
11864 @table @code
11865 @item synopsis
11866 @itemx description
11867 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
11868 descriptions and synopses.
11869
11870 @item inputs-should-be-native
11871 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
11872
11873 @item source
11874 @itemx home-page
11875 @itemx mirror-url
11876 @itemx github-url
11877 @itemx source-file-name
11878 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
11879 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
11880 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
11881 URL@. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
11882 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
11883 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
11884
11885 @item source-unstable-tarball
11886 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
11887 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
11888 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
11889
11890 @item derivation
11891 Check that the derivation of the given packages can be successfully
11892 computed for all the supported systems (@pxref{Derivations}).
11893
11894 @item profile-collisions
11895 Check whether installing the given packages in a profile would lead to
11896 collisions. Collisions occur when several packages with the same name
11897 but a different version or a different store file name are propagated.
11898 @xref{package Reference, @code{propagated-inputs}}, for more information
11899 on propagated inputs.
11900
11901 @item archival
11902 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
11903 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
11904 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
11905 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
11906
11907 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
11908 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
11909 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
11910 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
11911 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
11912 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
11913 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
11914
11915 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
11916 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
11917 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
11918 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
11919
11920 Software Heritage
11921 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
11922 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
11923 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
11924 that limit has been reset.
11925
11926 @item cve
11927 @cindex security vulnerabilities
11928 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
11929 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
11930 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
11931 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
11932 NIST}.
11933
11934 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
11935
11936 @itemize
11937 @item
11938 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11939 @item
11940 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
11941 @end itemize
11942
11943 @noindent
11944 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
11945 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
11946
11947 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
11948 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
11949 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
11950 that Guix uses, as in this example:
11951
11952 @lisp
11953 (package
11954 (name "grub")
11955 ;; @dots{}
11956 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
11957 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
11958 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
11959 @end lisp
11960
11961 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
11962 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
11963 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
11964 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
11965 declare them as in this example:
11966
11967 @lisp
11968 (package
11969 (name "t1lib")
11970 ;; @dots{}
11971 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
11972 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
11973 "CVE-2011-1553"
11974 "CVE-2011-1554"
11975 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
11976 @end lisp
11977
11978 @item formatting
11979 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
11980 use of tabulations, etc.
11981 @end table
11982
11983 The general syntax is:
11984
11985 @example
11986 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
11987 @end example
11988
11989 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
11990 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
11991
11992 @table @code
11993 @item --list-checkers
11994 @itemx -l
11995 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
11996 and exit.
11997
11998 @item --checkers
11999 @itemx -c
12000 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
12001 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
12002
12003 @item --exclude
12004 @itemx -x
12005 Only disable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
12006 names returned by @option{--list-checkers}.
12007
12008 @item --no-network
12009 @itemx -n
12010 Only enable the checkers that do not depend on Internet access.
12011
12012 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12013 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12014 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12015 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12016
12017 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12018 the command-line tools.
12019
12020 @end table
12021
12022 @node Invoking guix size
12023 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
12024
12025 @cindex size
12026 @cindex package size
12027 @cindex closure
12028 @cindex @command{guix size}
12029 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
12030 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
12031 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
12032 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
12033 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
12034 @command{guix size} can highlight.
12035
12036 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
12037 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
12038 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
12039 example:
12040
12041 @example
12042 $ guix size coreutils
12043 store item total self
12044 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
12045 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
12046 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
12047 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
12048 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
12049 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
12050 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
12051 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
12052 total: 78.9 MiB
12053 @end example
12054
12055 @cindex closure
12056 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
12057 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
12058 would be returned by:
12059
12060 @example
12061 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
12062 @end example
12063
12064 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
12065 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
12066 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
12067 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
12068 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
12069 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
12070
12071 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
12072 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
12073 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
12074 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
12075 on the system anyway.)
12076
12077 Since the command also accepts store file names, assessing the size of
12078 a build result is straightforward:
12079
12080 @example
12081 guix size $(guix system build config.scm)
12082 @end example
12083
12084 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
12085 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
12086 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
12087 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
12088 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
12089 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
12090 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
12091 Coreutils}).
12092
12093 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
12094 reports information based on the available substitutes
12095 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
12096 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
12097
12098 You can also specify several package names:
12099
12100 @example
12101 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
12102 store item total self
12103 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
12104 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
12105 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
12106 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
12107 @dots{}
12108 total: 102.3 MiB
12109 @end example
12110
12111 @noindent
12112 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
12113 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
12114 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
12115
12116 When looking at the profile returned by @command{guix size}, you may
12117 find yourself wondering why a given package shows up in the profile at
12118 all. To understand it, you can use @command{guix graph --path -t
12119 references} to display the shortest path between the two packages
12120 (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
12121
12122 The available options are:
12123
12124 @table @option
12125
12126 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12127 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
12128 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
12129
12130 @item --sort=@var{key}
12131 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
12132
12133 @table @code
12134 @item self
12135 the size of each item (the default);
12136 @item closure
12137 the total size of the item's closure.
12138 @end table
12139
12140 @item --map-file=@var{file}
12141 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
12142
12143 For the example above, the map looks like this:
12144
12145 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
12146 produced by @command{guix size}}
12147
12148 This option requires that
12149 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
12150 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
12151 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
12152
12153 @item --system=@var{system}
12154 @itemx -s @var{system}
12155 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
12156
12157 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12158 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12159 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12160 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12161
12162 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12163 the command-line tools.
12164 @end table
12165
12166 @node Invoking guix graph
12167 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
12168
12169 @cindex DAG
12170 @cindex @command{guix graph}
12171 @cindex package dependencies
12172 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
12173 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
12174 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
12175 provides a visual representation of the DAG@. By default,
12176 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
12177 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
12178 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
12179 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
12180 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
12181 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
12182 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language. With
12183 @option{--path}, it simply displays the shortest path between two
12184 packages. The general syntax is:
12185
12186 @example
12187 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
12188 @end example
12189
12190 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
12191 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
12192 dependencies:
12193
12194 @example
12195 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
12196 @end example
12197
12198 The output looks like this:
12199
12200 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12201
12202 Nice little graph, no?
12203
12204 You may find it more pleasant to navigate the graph interactively with
12205 @command{xdot} (from the @code{xdot} package):
12206
12207 @example
12208 guix graph coreutils | xdot -
12209 @end example
12210
12211 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
12212 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
12213 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
12214 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
12215 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
12216
12217 @table @code
12218 @item package
12219 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
12220 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
12221 filters out many details.
12222
12223 @item reverse-package
12224 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
12225
12226 @example
12227 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
12228 @end example
12229
12230 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
12231 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
12232 @code{reverse-bag} below).
12233
12234 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
12235 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
12236 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
12237 @option{--list-dependent}}).
12238
12239 @item bag-emerged
12240 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
12241
12242 For instance, the following command:
12243
12244 @example
12245 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils
12246 @end example
12247
12248 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
12249
12250 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
12251
12252 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
12253 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
12254
12255 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
12256 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
12257 here, for conciseness.
12258
12259 @item bag
12260 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
12261 dependencies.
12262
12263 @item bag-with-origins
12264 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
12265
12266 @item reverse-bag
12267 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
12268 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
12269
12270 @example
12271 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
12272 @end example
12273
12274 @noindent
12275 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
12276 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
12277 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
12278 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
12279
12280 @item derivation
12281 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
12282 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
12283 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
12284 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
12285
12286 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
12287 name instead of a package name, as in:
12288
12289 @example
12290 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
12291 @end example
12292
12293 @item module
12294 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12295 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
12296 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
12297
12298 @example
12299 guix graph -t module guile | xdot -
12300 @end example
12301 @end table
12302
12303 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
12304 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
12305
12306 @table @code
12307 @item references
12308 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
12309 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12310
12311 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
12312 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
12313
12314 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
12315 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
12316 (which can be big!):
12317
12318 @example
12319 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12320 @end example
12321
12322 @item referrers
12323 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
12324 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
12325
12326 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
12327 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
12328 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
12329 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
12330 to it.
12331
12332 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
12333 collected.
12334
12335 @end table
12336
12337 @cindex shortest path, between packages
12338 Often, the graph of the package you are interested in does not fit on
12339 your screen, and anyway all you want to know is @emph{why} that package
12340 actually depends on some seemingly unrelated package. The
12341 @option{--path} option instructs @command{guix graph} to display the
12342 shortest path between two packages (or derivations, or store items,
12343 etc.):
12344
12345 @example
12346 $ guix graph --path emacs libunistring
12347 emacs@@26.3
12348 mailutils@@3.9
12349 libunistring@@0.9.10
12350 $ guix graph --path -t derivation emacs libunistring
12351 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3.drv
12352 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mailutils-3.9.drv
12353 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10.drv
12354 $ guix graph --path -t references emacs libunistring
12355 /gnu/store/@dots{}-emacs-26.3
12356 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libidn2-2.2.0
12357 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libunistring-0.9.10
12358 @end example
12359
12360 The available options are the following:
12361
12362 @table @option
12363 @item --type=@var{type}
12364 @itemx -t @var{type}
12365 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
12366 the values listed above.
12367
12368 @item --list-types
12369 List the supported graph types.
12370
12371 @item --backend=@var{backend}
12372 @itemx -b @var{backend}
12373 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
12374
12375 @item --list-backends
12376 List the supported graph backends.
12377
12378 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
12379
12380 @item --path
12381 Display the shortest path between two nodes of the type specified by
12382 @option{--type}. The example below shows the shortest path between
12383 @code{libreoffice} and @code{llvm} according to the references of
12384 @code{libreoffice}:
12385
12386 @example
12387 $ guix graph --path -t references libreoffice llvm
12388 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libreoffice-6.4.2.2
12389 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libepoxy-1.5.4
12390 /gnu/store/@dots{}-mesa-19.3.4
12391 /gnu/store/@dots{}-llvm-9.0.1
12392 @end example
12393
12394 @item --expression=@var{expr}
12395 @itemx -e @var{expr}
12396 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
12397
12398 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
12399
12400 @example
12401 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
12402 @end example
12403
12404 @item --system=@var{system}
12405 @itemx -s @var{system}
12406 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
12407
12408 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
12409 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
12410
12411 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
12412 @itemx -L @var{directory}
12413 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
12414 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
12415
12416 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
12417 the command-line tools.
12418 @end table
12419
12420 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
12421 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
12422 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
12423 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
12424 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
12425 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
12426
12427 @example
12428 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
12429 @end example
12430
12431 So many possibilities, so much fun!
12432
12433 @node Invoking guix publish
12434 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
12435
12436 @cindex @command{guix publish}
12437 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
12438 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
12439 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12440
12441 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
12442 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
12443 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
12444 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
12445 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
12446
12447 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
12448 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
12449 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
12450 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
12451 @option{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
12452
12453 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
12454 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12455 guix archive}).
12456
12457 When the @option{--advertise} option is passed, the server advertises
12458 its availability on the local network using multicast DNS (mDNS) and DNS
12459 service discovery (DNS-SD), currently @i{via} Guile-Avahi (@pxref{Top,,,
12460 guile-avahi, Using Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}).
12461
12462 The general syntax is:
12463
12464 @example
12465 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
12466 @end example
12467
12468 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
12469 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
12470
12471 @example
12472 guix publish
12473 @end example
12474
12475 Once a publishing server has been authorized, the daemon may download
12476 substitutes from it. @xref{Getting Substitutes from Other Servers}.
12477
12478 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
12479 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
12480 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
12481 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
12482 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
12483 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
12484 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
12485
12486 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
12487 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
12488 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
12489 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
12490 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
12491 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
12492
12493 @example
12494 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
12495 @end example
12496
12497 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
12498 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
12499
12500 @cindex build logs, publication
12501 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
12502
12503 @example
12504 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
12505 @end example
12506
12507 @noindent
12508 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
12509 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
12510 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
12511 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
12512 running @command{guix-daemon} with @option{--log-compression=gzip} since
12513 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
12514 Bzip2 compression.
12515
12516 The following options are available:
12517
12518 @table @code
12519 @item --port=@var{port}
12520 @itemx -p @var{port}
12521 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
12522
12523 @item --listen=@var{host}
12524 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
12525 accept connections from any interface.
12526
12527 @item --user=@var{user}
12528 @itemx -u @var{user}
12529 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
12530 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
12531
12532 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12533 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
12534 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
12535 one of @code{lzip}, @code{zstd}, and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is
12536 omitted, @code{gzip} is used.
12537
12538 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
12539 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
12540 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
12541
12542 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a
12543 small increase in CPU usage; see
12544 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip
12545 Web page}. However, @code{lzip} achieves low decompression throughput
12546 (on the order of 50@tie{}MiB/s on modern hardware), which can be a
12547 bottleneck for someone who downloads over a fast network connection.
12548
12549 The compression ratio of @code{zstd} is between that of @code{lzip} and
12550 that of @code{gzip}; its main advantage is a
12551 @uref{https://facebook.github.io/zstd/,high decompression speed}.
12552
12553 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
12554 the compressed streams are not
12555 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
12556 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
12557 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
12558 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
12559 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
12560 to its responses.
12561
12562 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
12563 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
12564 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
12565 the one they support.
12566
12567 @item --cache=@var{directory}
12568 @itemx -c @var{directory}
12569 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
12570 and only serve archives that are in cache.
12571
12572 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
12573 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
12574 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
12575 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
12576 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
12577 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
12578 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
12579
12580 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
12581 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) triggers a
12582 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
12583 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
12584 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
12585 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
12586 the best possible bandwidth.
12587
12588 That first @code{.narinfo} request nonetheless returns 200, provided the
12589 requested store item is ``small enough'', below the cache bypass
12590 threshold---see @option{--cache-bypass-threshold} below. That way,
12591 clients do not have to wait until the archive is baked. For larger
12592 store items, the first @code{.narinfo} request returns 404, meaning that
12593 clients have to wait until the archive is baked.
12594
12595 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
12596 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
12597 @option{--workers} below.
12598
12599 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
12600 when they have expired.
12601
12602 @item --workers=@var{N}
12603 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
12604 threads to ``bake'' archives.
12605
12606 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
12607 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
12608 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
12609 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
12610
12611 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
12612 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
12613 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
12614 for as long as @var{ttl}.
12615
12616 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
12617 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
12618 item in the store, may be deleted.
12619
12620 @item --cache-bypass-threshold=@var{size}
12621 When used in conjunction with @option{--cache}, store items smaller than
12622 @var{size} are immediately available, even when they are not yet in
12623 cache. @var{size} is a size in bytes, or it can be suffixed by @code{M}
12624 for megabytes and so on. The default is @code{10M}.
12625
12626 ``Cache bypass'' allows you to reduce the publication delay for clients
12627 at the expense of possibly additional I/O and CPU use on the server
12628 side: depending on the client access patterns, those store items can end
12629 up being baked several times until a copy is available in cache.
12630
12631 Increasing the threshold may be useful for sites that have few users, or
12632 to guarantee that users get substitutes even for store items that are
12633 not popular.
12634
12635 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
12636 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
12637 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
12638
12639 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
12640 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
12641 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
12642
12643 @item --public-key=@var{file}
12644 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
12645 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
12646 the store items being published.
12647
12648 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
12649 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
12650 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
12651 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
12652 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
12653 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
12654
12655 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
12656 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
12657 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
12658 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
12659 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
12660 @end table
12661
12662 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
12663 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
12664 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
12665 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
12666
12667 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
12668 instructions:
12669
12670 @itemize
12671 @item
12672 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
12673
12674 @example
12675 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
12676 /etc/systemd/system/
12677 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
12678 @end example
12679
12680 @item
12681 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
12682
12683 @example
12684 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
12685 # start guix-publish
12686 @end example
12687
12688 @item
12689 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
12690 @end itemize
12691
12692 @node Invoking guix challenge
12693 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
12694
12695 @cindex reproducible builds
12696 @cindex verifiable builds
12697 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
12698 @cindex challenge
12699 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
12700 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
12701 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
12702 answer.
12703
12704 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
12705 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
12706 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
12707 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
12708 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
12709 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
12710 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
12711
12712 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
12713 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
12714 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
12715 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
12716 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
12717 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
12718 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
12719 any given store item.
12720
12721 The command output looks like this:
12722
12723 @smallexample
12724 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12725 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
12726 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
12727 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
12728 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12729 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
12730 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
12731 differing files:
12732 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
12733 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
12734
12735 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
12736 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
12737 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
12738 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
12739 differing file:
12740 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
12741
12742 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
12743 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12744 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
12745 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
12746 differing file:
12747 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
12748
12749 @dots{}
12750
12751 6,406 store items were analyzed:
12752 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
12753 - 525 (8.2%) differed
12754 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
12755 @end smallexample
12756
12757 @noindent
12758 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
12759 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
12760 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
12761 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
12762 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
12763
12764 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
12765 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
12766 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
12767 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
12768 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
12769 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
12770 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
12771 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
12772 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
12773 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
12774 more information.
12775
12776 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
12777 to run:
12778
12779 @example
12780 guix challenge git \
12781 --diff=diffoscope \
12782 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
12783 @end example
12784
12785 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
12786 information about files that differ.
12787
12788 Alternatively, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
12789 archive}):
12790
12791 @example
12792 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
12793 | lzip -d | guix archive -x /tmp/git
12794 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
12795 @end example
12796
12797 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
12798 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
12799 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
12800 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
12801 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
12802 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
12803 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
12804
12805 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
12806 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
12807 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
12808 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
12809 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
12810 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
12811 the problem.
12812
12813 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
12814 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
12815 same build result as you did with:
12816
12817 @example
12818 $ guix challenge @var{package}
12819 @end example
12820
12821 @noindent
12822 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
12823 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
12824
12825 The general syntax is:
12826
12827 @example
12828 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
12829 @end example
12830
12831 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
12832 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
12833 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
12834 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
12835 errors).
12836
12837 The one option that matters is:
12838
12839 @table @code
12840
12841 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
12842 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
12843 URLs to compare to.
12844
12845 @item --diff=@var{mode}
12846 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
12847
12848 @table @asis
12849 @item @code{simple} (the default)
12850 Show the list of files that differ.
12851
12852 @item @code{diffoscope}
12853 @itemx @var{command}
12854 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
12855 two directories whose contents do not match.
12856
12857 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
12858 of Diffoscope.
12859
12860 @item @code{none}
12861 Do not show further details about the differences.
12862 @end table
12863
12864 Thus, unless @option{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
12865 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
12866 can compare them.
12867
12868 @item --verbose
12869 @itemx -v
12870 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
12871 information about mismatches.
12872
12873 @end table
12874
12875 @node Invoking guix copy
12876 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
12877
12878 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
12879 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
12880 @cindex sharing store items across machines
12881 @cindex transferring store items across machines
12882 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
12883 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
12884 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
12885 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
12886 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
12887 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
12888
12889 @example
12890 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
12891 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
12892 @end example
12893
12894 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
12895 they are not actually sent.
12896
12897 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
12898 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
12899
12900 @example
12901 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
12902 @end example
12903
12904 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
12905 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
12906 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
12907
12908 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
12909 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
12910 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
12911 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
12912 store item authentication.
12913
12914 The general syntax is:
12915
12916 @example
12917 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
12918 @end example
12919
12920 You must always specify one of the following options:
12921
12922 @table @code
12923 @item --to=@var{spec}
12924 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
12925 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
12926 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
12927 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
12928 @end table
12929
12930 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
12931 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
12932
12933 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
12934 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
12935 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
12936
12937
12938 @node Invoking guix container
12939 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
12940 @cindex container
12941 @cindex @command{guix container}
12942 @quotation Note
12943 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
12944 is subject to radical change in the future.
12945 @end quotation
12946
12947 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
12948 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
12949 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
12950 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
12951 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
12952
12953 The general syntax is:
12954
12955 @example
12956 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
12957 @end example
12958
12959 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
12960 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
12961
12962 The following actions are available:
12963
12964 @table @code
12965 @item exec
12966 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
12967
12968 The syntax is:
12969
12970 @example
12971 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
12972 @end example
12973
12974 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
12975 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
12976 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
12977 will be passed to @var{program}.
12978
12979 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
12980 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
12981 process ID is 9001:
12982
12983 @example
12984 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
12985 @end example
12986
12987 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
12988 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
12989
12990 @end table
12991
12992 @node Invoking guix weather
12993 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
12994
12995 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
12996 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
12997 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
12998 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
12999 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
13000 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
13001 publish}).
13002
13003 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
13004 @cindex availability of substitutes
13005 @cindex substitute availability
13006 @cindex weather, substitute availability
13007 Here's a sample run:
13008
13009 @example
13010 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
13011 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
13012 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
13013 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
13014 https://guix.example.org
13015 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
13016 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
13017 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
13018 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
13019 33.5 requests per second
13020
13021 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
13022 867 queued builds
13023 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
13024 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
13025 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
13026 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
13027 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
13028 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
13029 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
13030 @end example
13031
13032 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
13033 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
13034 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
13035 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
13036 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
13037 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
13038 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
13039 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
13040 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
13041 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
13042 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
13043
13044 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
13045 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
13046 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
13047 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
13048 those substitutes.
13049
13050 The general syntax is:
13051
13052 @example
13053 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
13054 @end example
13055
13056 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
13057 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
13058 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
13059 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
13060 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
13061 available substitutes is below 100%.
13062
13063 The available options are listed below.
13064
13065 @table @code
13066 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
13067 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
13068 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
13069 servers is queried.
13070
13071 @item --system=@var{system}
13072 @itemx -s @var{system}
13073 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
13074 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
13075 substitutes for several system types.
13076
13077 @item --manifest=@var{file}
13078 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
13079 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
13080 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
13081 guix package}).
13082
13083 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
13084 are concatenated.
13085
13086 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
13087 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
13088 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
13089 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
13090 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
13091 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
13092 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
13093
13094 @example
13095 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
13096 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
13097 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
13098 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
13099 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
13100 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
13101 @dots{}
13102 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
13103 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
13104 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
13105 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
13106 @dots{}
13107 @end example
13108
13109 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
13110 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at
13111 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}; likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46
13112 packages that depend on it.
13113
13114 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
13115 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
13116 fail to build.
13117
13118 @item --display-missing
13119 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
13120 @end table
13121
13122 @node Invoking guix processes
13123 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
13124
13125 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
13126 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
13127 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
13128 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
13129 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
13130 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
13131
13132 @example
13133 $ sudo guix processes
13134 SessionPID: 19002
13135 ClientPID: 19090
13136 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
13137
13138 SessionPID: 19402
13139 ClientPID: 19367
13140 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
13141
13142 SessionPID: 19444
13143 ClientPID: 19419
13144 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13145 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
13146 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
13147 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
13148 ChildPID: 20495
13149 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13150 ChildPID: 27733
13151 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13152 ChildPID: 27793
13153 ChildCommand: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
13154 @end example
13155
13156 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
13157 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
13158 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
13159 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
13160 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
13161
13162 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked
13163 by this session, which corresponds to store items being built or
13164 substituted (the @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when
13165 @command{guix processes} is not running as root). Last, by looking at
13166 the @code{ChildPID} and @code{ChildCommand} fields, we understand that
13167 these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
13168
13169 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
13170 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
13171 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
13172 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
13173
13174 @example
13175 $ sudo guix processes | \
13176 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
13177 ClientPID: 19419
13178 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
13179 @end example
13180
13181 Additional options are listed below.
13182
13183 @table @code
13184 @item --format=@var{format}
13185 @itemx -f @var{format}
13186 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
13187
13188 @table @code
13189 @item recutils
13190 The default option. It outputs a set of Session recutils records
13191 that include each @code{ChildProcess} as a field.
13192
13193 @item normalized
13194 Normalize the output records into record sets (@pxref{Record Sets,,,
13195 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). Normalizing into record sets allows
13196 joins across record types. The example below lists the PID of each
13197 @code{ChildProcess} and the associated PID for @code{Session} that
13198 spawned the @code{ChildProcess} where the @code{Session} was started
13199 using @command{guix build}.
13200
13201 @example
13202 $ guix processes --format=normalized | \
13203 recsel \
13204 -j Session \
13205 -t ChildProcess \
13206 -p Session.PID,PID \
13207 -e 'Session.ClientCommand ~ "guix build"'
13208 PID: 4435
13209 Session_PID: 4278
13210
13211 PID: 4554
13212 Session_PID: 4278
13213
13214 PID: 4646
13215 Session_PID: 4278
13216 @end example
13217 @end table
13218 @end table
13219
13220 @node System Configuration
13221 @chapter System Configuration
13222
13223 @cindex system configuration
13224 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
13225 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
13226 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
13227 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
13228 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
13229
13230 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
13231 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
13232 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
13233 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
13234 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
13235 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
13236 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
13237 the own tools of the system.
13238 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
13239
13240 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
13241 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
13242 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
13243 instance to support new system services.
13244
13245 @menu
13246 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
13247 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
13248 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
13249 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
13250 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
13251 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
13252 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
13253 * Services:: Specifying system services.
13254 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
13255 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
13256 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
13257 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
13258 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
13259 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
13260 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
13261 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
13262 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
13263 @end menu
13264
13265 @node Using the Configuration System
13266 @section Using the Configuration System
13267
13268 The operating system is configured by providing an
13269 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
13270 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
13271 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
13272 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
13273
13274 @findex operating-system
13275 @lisp
13276 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
13277 @end lisp
13278
13279 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
13280 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
13281 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
13282 which case they get a default value.
13283
13284 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
13285 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
13286 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
13287 @command{guix system}.
13288
13289 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
13290
13291 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
13292 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
13293 @cindex UEFI boot
13294 @cindex EFI boot
13295 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
13296 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
13297 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
13298 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
13299 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
13300
13301 @lisp
13302 (bootloader-configuration
13303 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
13304 (target "/boot/efi"))
13305 @end lisp
13306
13307 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
13308 configuration options.
13309
13310 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
13311
13312 @vindex %base-packages
13313 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
13314 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @env{PATH}
13315 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
13316 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
13317 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
13318 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
13319 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
13320 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
13321 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
13322 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
13323 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
13324 of a package:
13325
13326 @lisp
13327 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13328 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
13329
13330 (operating-system
13331 ;; ...
13332 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
13333 %base-packages)))
13334 @end lisp
13335
13336 @findex specification->package
13337 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
13338 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
13339 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
13340 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
13341 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
13342 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
13343 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
13344 version:
13345
13346 @lisp
13347 (use-modules (gnu packages))
13348
13349 (operating-system
13350 ;; ...
13351 (packages (append (map specification->package
13352 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
13353 %base-packages)))
13354 @end lisp
13355
13356 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
13357
13358 @cindex services
13359 @vindex %base-services
13360 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
13361 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
13362 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
13363 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
13364 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
13365 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
13366 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
13367 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
13368 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
13369
13370 @cindex customization, of services
13371 @findex modify-services
13372 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
13373 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
13374 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
13375
13376 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
13377 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
13378 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
13379 following in your operating system declaration:
13380
13381 @lisp
13382 (define %my-services
13383 ;; My very own list of services.
13384 (modify-services %base-services
13385 (guix-service-type config =>
13386 (guix-configuration
13387 (inherit config)
13388 ;; Fetch substitutes from example.org.
13389 (substitute-urls
13390 (list "https://example.org/guix"
13391 "https://ci.guix.gnu.org"))))
13392 (mingetty-service-type config =>
13393 (mingetty-configuration
13394 (inherit config)
13395 ;; Automatially log in as "guest".
13396 (auto-login "guest")))))
13397
13398 (operating-system
13399 ;; @dots{}
13400 (services %my-services))
13401 @end lisp
13402
13403 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
13404 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
13405 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
13406 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
13407 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
13408 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
13409 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
13410 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
13411 configuration, but with a few modifications.
13412
13413 @cindex encrypted disk
13414 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
13415 root partition, the X11 display
13416 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
13417 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
13418 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
13419
13420 @lisp
13421 @include os-config-desktop.texi
13422 @end lisp
13423
13424 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
13425 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
13426
13427 @lisp
13428 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
13429 @end lisp
13430
13431 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
13432 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
13433 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
13434
13435 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
13436 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
13437 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
13438
13439 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
13440 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
13441 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
13442 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
13443 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
13444 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
13445
13446 @lisp
13447 (remove (lambda (service)
13448 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
13449 %desktop-services)
13450 @end lisp
13451
13452 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
13453
13454 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
13455 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
13456 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
13457 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
13458 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
13459
13460 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
13461 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
13462 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
13463 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
13464 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
13465 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
13466 system, should you ever need to.
13467
13468 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
13469 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
13470 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
13471 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
13472 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
13473 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
13474 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
13475 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
13476 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
13477 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
13478
13479 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
13480 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
13481 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
13482 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
13483 system}).
13484
13485 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
13486
13487 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
13488 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
13489 Monad}):
13490
13491 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
13492 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
13493 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
13494
13495 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
13496 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
13497 instantiate @var{os}.
13498 @end deffn
13499
13500 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
13501 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
13502 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
13503
13504
13505 @node operating-system Reference
13506 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
13507
13508 This section summarizes all the options available in
13509 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
13510 System}).
13511
13512 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
13513 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
13514 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
13515 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
13516
13517 @table @asis
13518 @item @code{kernel} (default: @code{linux-libre})
13519 The package object of the operating system kernel to
13520 use@footnote{Currently only the Linux-libre kernel is fully supported.
13521 Using GNU@tie{}mach with the GNU@tie{}Hurd is experimental and only
13522 available when building a virtual machine disk image.}.
13523
13524 @cindex hurd
13525 @item @code{hurd} (default: @code{#f})
13526 The package object of the Hurd to be started by the kernel. When this
13527 field is set, produce a GNU/Hurd operating system. In that case,
13528 @code{kernel} must also be set to the @code{gnumach} package---the
13529 microkernel the Hurd runs on.
13530
13531 @quotation Warning
13532 This feature is experimental and only supported for disk images.
13533 @end quotation
13534
13535 @item @code{kernel-loadable-modules} (default: '())
13536 A list of objects (usually packages) to collect loadable kernel modules
13537 from--e.g. @code{(list ddcci-driver-linux)}.
13538
13539 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{%default-kernel-arguments})
13540 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
13541 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
13542
13543 @item @code{bootloader}
13544 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
13545
13546 @item @code{label}
13547 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
13548 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
13549
13550 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13551 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
13552 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
13553 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record. @xref{Keyboard Layout},
13554 for more information.
13555
13556 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
13557 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
13558 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
13559 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13560
13561 @quotation Note
13562 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
13563 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
13564 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
13565 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
13566 Window System.
13567 @end quotation
13568
13569 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
13570 @cindex initrd
13571 @cindex initial RAM disk
13572 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
13573 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13574
13575 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
13576 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
13577 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
13578 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
13579
13580 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
13581 @cindex firmware
13582 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
13583
13584 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
13585 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
13586 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
13587 supported hardware.
13588
13589 @item @code{host-name}
13590 The host name.
13591
13592 @item @code{hosts-file}
13593 @cindex hosts file
13594 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
13595 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
13596 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
13597 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
13598
13599 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13600 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
13601
13602 @item @code{file-systems}
13603 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
13604
13605 @cindex swap devices
13606 @cindex swap space
13607 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
13608 A list of UUIDs, file system labels, or strings identifying devices or
13609 files to be used for ``swap
13610 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13611 Manual}). Here are some examples:
13612
13613 @table @code
13614 @item (list (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb"))
13615 Use the swap partition with the given UUID@. You can learn the UUID of a
13616 Linux swap partition by running @command{swaplabel @var{device}}, where
13617 @var{device} is the @file{/dev} file name of that partition.
13618
13619 @item (list (file-system-label "swap"))
13620 Use the partition with label @code{swap}. Again, the
13621 @command{swaplabel} command allows you to view and change the label of a
13622 Linux swap partition.
13623
13624 @item (list "/swapfile")
13625 Use the file @file{/swapfile} as swap space.
13626
13627 @item (list "/dev/sda3" "/dev/sdb2")
13628 Use the @file{/dev/sda3} and @file{/dev/sdb2} partitions as swap space.
13629 We recommend referring to swap devices by UUIDs or labels as shown above
13630 instead.
13631 @end table
13632
13633 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
13634 device (under @file{/dev/mapper}), provided that the necessary device
13635 mapping and file system are also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and
13636 @ref{File Systems}.
13637
13638 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
13639 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
13640 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
13641
13642 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
13643 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
13644
13645 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
13646 A list of target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13647 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
13648 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
13649
13650 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
13651
13652 @lisp
13653 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
13654 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
13655 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
13656 (activate-readline)")))
13657 @end lisp
13658
13659 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
13660 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
13661 displayed when users log in on a text console.
13662
13663 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
13664 A list of packages to be installed in the global profile, which is accessible
13665 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Each element is either a package
13666 variable or a package/output tuple. Here's a simple example of both:
13667
13668 @lisp
13669 (cons* git ; the default "out" output
13670 (list git "send-email") ; another output of git
13671 %base-packages) ; the default set
13672 @end lisp
13673
13674 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
13675 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
13676 package}).
13677
13678 @item @code{timezone}
13679 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
13680
13681 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
13682 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
13683 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
13684
13685 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
13686 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
13687 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
13688
13689 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
13690 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
13691 run time. @xref{Locales}.
13692
13693 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
13694 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
13695 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
13696 considerations that justify this option.
13697
13698 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
13699 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
13700 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
13701 details.
13702
13703 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
13704 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
13705
13706 @cindex essential services
13707 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
13708 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
13709 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
13710 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
13711 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
13712
13713 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
13714 @cindex PAM
13715 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
13716 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
13717 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
13718
13719 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @code{%setuid-programs})
13720 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
13721 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
13722
13723 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @code{%sudoers-specification})
13724 @cindex sudoers file
13725 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
13726 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
13727
13728 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
13729 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
13730 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
13731 @code{sudo}.
13732
13733 @end table
13734
13735 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
13736 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
13737 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
13738
13739 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
13740 the definition of the @code{label} field:
13741
13742 @lisp
13743 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13744
13745 (operating-system
13746 ;; ...
13747 (label (package-full-name
13748 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
13749 @end lisp
13750
13751 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
13752 system definition.
13753 @end deffn
13754
13755 @end deftp
13756
13757 @node File Systems
13758 @section File Systems
13759
13760 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
13761 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
13762 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
13763 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
13764
13765 @lisp
13766 (file-system
13767 (mount-point "/home")
13768 (device "/dev/sda3")
13769 (type "ext4"))
13770 @end lisp
13771
13772 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
13773 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
13774
13775 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
13776 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
13777 contain the following members:
13778
13779 @table @asis
13780 @item @code{type}
13781 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
13782 @code{"ext4"}.
13783
13784 @item @code{mount-point}
13785 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
13786
13787 @item @code{device}
13788 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
13789 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
13790 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
13791 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
13792 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
13793 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
13794 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
13795 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
13796 mounted.}.
13797
13798 @findex file-system-label
13799 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
13800 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
13801 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
13802 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
13803
13804 @lisp
13805 (file-system
13806 (mount-point "/home")
13807 (type "ext4")
13808 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13809 @end lisp
13810
13811 @findex uuid
13812 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
13813 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
13814 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
13815 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
13816 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
13817 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
13818 like this:
13819
13820 @lisp
13821 (file-system
13822 (mount-point "/home")
13823 (type "ext4")
13824 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
13825 @end lisp
13826
13827 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
13828 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
13829 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
13830 This is required so that
13831 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
13832 corresponding device mapping established.
13833
13834 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
13835 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
13836 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
13837 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
13838 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
13839 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
13840 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
13841 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
13842 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13843 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
13844
13845 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
13846 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to
13847 the file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
13848 Library Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for
13849 options for various file systems. Note that the
13850 @code{file-system-options->alist} and @code{alist->file-system-options}
13851 procedures from @code{(gnu system file-systems)} can be used to convert
13852 file system options given as an association list to the string
13853 representation, and vice-versa.
13854
13855 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
13856 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
13857 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
13858 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
13859 is not automatically mounted.
13860
13861 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
13862 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
13863 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
13864 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
13865 instance, for the root file system.
13866
13867 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
13868 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
13869 errors before being mounted.
13870
13871 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
13872 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
13873
13874 @item @code{mount-may-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
13875 When true, this indicates that mounting this file system can fail but
13876 that should not be considered an error. This is useful in unusual
13877 cases; an example of this is @code{efivarfs}, a file system that can
13878 only be mounted on EFI/UEFI systems.
13879
13880 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
13881 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
13882 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
13883 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
13884
13885 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
13886 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
13887 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
13888
13889 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
13890 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
13891 @end table
13892 @end deftp
13893
13894 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-system-label @var{str}
13895 This procedure returns an opaque file system label from @var{str}, a
13896 string:
13897
13898 @lisp
13899 (file-system-label "home")
13900 @result{} #<file-system-label "home">
13901 @end lisp
13902
13903 File system labels are used to refer to file systems by label rather
13904 than by device name. See above for examples.
13905 @end deffn
13906
13907 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
13908 variables.
13909
13910 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
13911 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
13912 such as @code{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @code{%immutable-store} (see
13913 below). Operating system declarations should always contain at least
13914 these.
13915 @end defvr
13916
13917 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
13918 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
13919 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
13920 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
13921 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
13922 @command{xterm}.
13923 @end defvr
13924
13925 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
13926 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
13927 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
13928 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
13929 @end defvr
13930
13931 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
13932 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
13933 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
13934 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
13935 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
13936
13937 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
13938 read-write in its own ``name space.''
13939 @end defvr
13940
13941 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
13942 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
13943 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
13944 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13945 @end defvr
13946
13947 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
13948 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
13949 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
13950 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
13951 @end defvr
13952
13953 The @code{(gnu system uuid)} module provides tools to deal with file
13954 system ``unique identifiers'' (UUIDs).
13955
13956 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} uuid @var{str} [@var{type}]
13957 Return an opaque UUID (unique identifier) object of the given @var{type}
13958 (a symbol) by parsing @var{str} (a string):
13959
13960 @lisp
13961 (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")
13962 @result{} #<<uuid> type: dce bv: @dots{}>
13963
13964 (uuid "1234-ABCD" 'fat)
13965 @result{} #<<uuid> type: fat bv: @dots{}>
13966 @end lisp
13967
13968 @var{type} may be one of @code{dce}, @code{iso9660}, @code{fat},
13969 @code{ntfs}, or one of the commonly found synonyms for these.
13970
13971 UUIDs are another way to unambiguously refer to file systems in
13972 operating system configuration. See the examples above.
13973 @end deffn
13974
13975
13976 @node Btrfs file system
13977 @subsection Btrfs file system
13978
13979 The Btrfs has special features, such as subvolumes, that merit being
13980 explained in more details. The following section attempts to cover
13981 basic as well as complex uses of a Btrfs file system with the Guix
13982 System.
13983
13984 In its simplest usage, a Btrfs file system can be described, for
13985 example, by:
13986
13987 @lisp
13988 (file-system
13989 (mount-point "/home")
13990 (type "btrfs")
13991 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
13992 @end lisp
13993
13994 The example below is more complex, as it makes use of a Btrfs
13995 subvolume, named @code{rootfs}. The parent Btrfs file system is labeled
13996 @code{my-btrfs-pool}, and is located on an encrypted device (hence the
13997 dependency on @code{mapped-devices}):
13998
13999 @lisp
14000 (file-system
14001 (device (file-system-label "my-btrfs-pool"))
14002 (mount-point "/")
14003 (type "btrfs")
14004 (options "subvol=rootfs")
14005 (dependencies mapped-devices))
14006 @end lisp
14007
14008 Some bootloaders, for example GRUB, only mount a Btrfs partition at its
14009 top level during the early boot, and rely on their configuration to
14010 refer to the correct subvolume path within that top level. The
14011 bootloaders operating in this way typically produce their configuration
14012 on a running system where the Btrfs partitions are already mounted and
14013 where the subvolume information is readily available. As an example,
14014 @command{grub-mkconfig}, the configuration generator command shipped
14015 with GRUB, reads @file{/proc/self/mountinfo} to determine the top-level
14016 path of a subvolume.
14017
14018 The Guix System produces a bootloader configuration using the operating
14019 system configuration as its sole input; it is therefore necessary to
14020 extract the subvolume name on which @file{/gnu/store} lives (if any)
14021 from that operating system configuration. To better illustrate,
14022 consider a subvolume named 'rootfs' which contains the root file system
14023 data. In such situation, the GRUB bootloader would only see the top
14024 level of the root Btrfs partition, e.g.:
14025
14026 @example
14027 / (top level)
14028 ├── rootfs (subvolume directory)
14029 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14030 ├── store (normal directory)
14031 [...]
14032 @end example
14033
14034 Thus, the subvolume name must be prepended to the @file{/gnu/store} path
14035 of the kernel, initrd binaries and any other files referred to in the
14036 GRUB configuration that must be found during the early boot.
14037
14038 The next example shows a nested hierarchy of subvolumes and
14039 directories:
14040
14041 @example
14042 / (top level)
14043 ├── rootfs (subvolume)
14044 ├── gnu (normal directory)
14045 ├── store (subvolume)
14046 [...]
14047 @end example
14048
14049 This scenario would work without mounting the 'store' subvolume.
14050 Mounting 'rootfs' is sufficient, since the subvolume name matches its
14051 intended mount point in the file system hierarchy. Alternatively, the
14052 'store' subvolume could be referred to by setting the @code{subvol}
14053 option to either @code{/rootfs/gnu/store} or @code{rootfs/gnu/store}.
14054
14055 Finally, a more contrived example of nested subvolumes:
14056
14057 @example
14058 / (top level)
14059 ├── root-snapshots (subvolume)
14060 ├── root-current (subvolume)
14061 ├── guix-store (subvolume)
14062 [...]
14063 @end example
14064
14065 Here, the 'guix-store' subvolume doesn't match its intended mount point,
14066 so it is necessary to mount it. The subvolume must be fully specified,
14067 by passing its file name to the @code{subvol} option. To illustrate,
14068 the 'guix-store' subvolume could be mounted on @file{/gnu/store} by using
14069 a file system declaration such as:
14070
14071 @lisp
14072 (file-system
14073 (device (file-system-label "btrfs-pool-1"))
14074 (mount-point "/gnu/store")
14075 (type "btrfs")
14076 (options "subvol=root-snapshots/root-current/guix-store,\
14077 compress-force=zstd,space_cache=v2"))
14078 @end lisp
14079
14080 @node Mapped Devices
14081 @section Mapped Devices
14082
14083 @cindex device mapping
14084 @cindex mapped devices
14085 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
14086 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
14087 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
14088 with additional processing over the data that flows through
14089 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
14090 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
14091 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
14092 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
14093 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
14094 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
14095 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
14096 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
14097 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
14098 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
14099 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
14100 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
14101
14102 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
14103 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
14104
14105 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
14106 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
14107 the system boots up.
14108
14109 @table @code
14110 @item source
14111 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
14112 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
14113 need to be assembled for creating a new one. In case of LVM this is a
14114 string specifying name of the volume group to be mapped.
14115
14116 @item target
14117 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
14118 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
14119 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
14120 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
14121 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
14122 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
14123 LVM logical volumes of type @code{lvm-device-mapping} need to
14124 be specified as @code{"VGNAME-LVNAME"}.
14125
14126 @item targets
14127 This list of strings specifies names of the resulting mapped devices in case
14128 there are several. The format is identical to @var{target}.
14129
14130 @item type
14131 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
14132 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
14133 @end table
14134 @end deftp
14135
14136 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
14137 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
14138 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
14139 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
14140 @end defvr
14141
14142 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
14143 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
14144 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
14145 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
14146 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
14147 @end defvr
14148
14149 @cindex LVM, logical volume manager
14150 @defvr {Scheme Variable} lvm-device-mapping
14151 This defines one or more logical volumes for the Linux
14152 @uref{https://www.sourceware.org/lvm2/, Logical Volume Manager (LVM)}.
14153 The volume group is activated by the @command{vgchange} command from the
14154 @code{lvm2} package.
14155 @end defvr
14156
14157 @cindex disk encryption
14158 @cindex LUKS
14159 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
14160 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
14161 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
14162 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
14163 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
14164 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
14165 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14166
14167 @lisp
14168 (mapped-device
14169 (source "/dev/sda3")
14170 (target "home")
14171 (type luks-device-mapping))
14172 @end lisp
14173
14174 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
14175 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
14176 command like:
14177
14178 @example
14179 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
14180 @end example
14181
14182 and use it as follows:
14183
14184 @lisp
14185 (mapped-device
14186 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
14187 (target "home")
14188 (type luks-device-mapping))
14189 @end lisp
14190
14191 @cindex swap encryption
14192 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
14193 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
14194 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
14195 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
14196 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
14197
14198 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
14199 may be declared as follows:
14200
14201 @lisp
14202 (mapped-device
14203 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
14204 (target "/dev/md0")
14205 (type raid-device-mapping))
14206 @end lisp
14207
14208 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
14209 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
14210 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
14211 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
14212 automatically later.
14213
14214 LVM logical volumes ``alpha'' and ``beta'' from volume group ``vg0'' can
14215 be declared as follows:
14216
14217 @lisp
14218 (mapped-device
14219 (source "vg0")
14220 (targets (list "vg0-alpha" "vg0-beta"))
14221 (type lvm-device-mapping))
14222 @end lisp
14223
14224 Devices @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-alpha} and @file{/dev/mapper/vg0-beta} can
14225 then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system} declaration
14226 (@pxref{File Systems}).
14227
14228 @node User Accounts
14229 @section User Accounts
14230
14231 @cindex users
14232 @cindex accounts
14233 @cindex user accounts
14234 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
14235 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
14236 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
14237
14238 @lisp
14239 (user-account
14240 (name "alice")
14241 (group "users")
14242 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
14243 "audio" ;sound card
14244 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
14245 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
14246 (comment "Bob's sister"))
14247 @end lisp
14248
14249 Here's a user account that uses a different shell and a custom home
14250 directory (the default would be @file{"/home/bob"}):
14251
14252 @lisp
14253 (user-account
14254 (name "bob")
14255 (group "users")
14256 (comment "Alice's bro")
14257 (shell (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh"))
14258 (home-directory "/home/robert"))
14259 @end lisp
14260
14261 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
14262 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
14263 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
14264 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
14265 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
14266 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
14267 as declared.
14268
14269 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
14270 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
14271 be specified:
14272
14273 @table @asis
14274 @item @code{name}
14275 The name of the user account.
14276
14277 @item @code{group}
14278 @cindex groups
14279 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
14280 this account belongs to.
14281
14282 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
14283 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
14284 account belongs to.
14285
14286 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
14287 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
14288 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
14289 account is created.
14290
14291 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
14292 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
14293
14294 @item @code{home-directory}
14295 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
14296
14297 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
14298 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
14299 if it does not exist yet.
14300
14301 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
14302 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
14303 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}). For example, you would refer to the
14304 Bash executable like this:
14305
14306 @lisp
14307 (file-append bash "/bin/bash")
14308 @end lisp
14309
14310 @noindent
14311 ... and to the Zsh executable like that:
14312
14313 @lisp
14314 (file-append zsh "/bin/zsh")
14315 @end lisp
14316
14317 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14318 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
14319 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
14320 graphical login managers do not list them.
14321
14322 @anchor{user-account-password}
14323 @cindex password, for user accounts
14324 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14325 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
14326 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
14327 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
14328 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
14329 reconfiguration.
14330
14331 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
14332 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
14333 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
14334
14335 @lisp
14336 (user-account
14337 (name "charlie")
14338 (group "users")
14339
14340 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
14341 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
14342 @end lisp
14343
14344 @quotation Note
14345 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
14346 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
14347 care.
14348 @end quotation
14349
14350 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
14351 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
14352 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
14353
14354 @end table
14355 @end deftp
14356
14357 @cindex groups
14358 User group declarations are even simpler:
14359
14360 @lisp
14361 (user-group (name "students"))
14362 @end lisp
14363
14364 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
14365 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
14366
14367 @table @asis
14368 @item @code{name}
14369 The name of the group.
14370
14371 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
14372 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
14373 automatically allocated when the group is created.
14374
14375 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
14376 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
14377 System groups have low numerical IDs.
14378
14379 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
14380 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
14381 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
14382
14383 @end table
14384 @end deftp
14385
14386 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
14387 expect:
14388
14389 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
14390 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
14391 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
14392 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
14393 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
14394 @end defvr
14395
14396 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
14397 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
14398 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
14399
14400 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
14401 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
14402 @end defvr
14403
14404 @node Keyboard Layout
14405 @section Keyboard Layout
14406
14407 @cindex keyboard layout
14408 @cindex keymap
14409 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
14410 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
14411 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
14412 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
14413 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
14414 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
14415 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
14416
14417 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
14418 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
14419
14420 @itemize
14421 @item
14422 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
14423 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
14424 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
14425 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
14426
14427 @item
14428 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
14429 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14430 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14431
14432 @item
14433 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
14434 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
14435 @end itemize
14436
14437 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
14438 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
14439
14440 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
14441 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
14442 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
14443 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
14444 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
14445 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
14446 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
14447 about.
14448
14449 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} keyboard-layout @var{name} [@var{variant}] @
14450 [#:model] [#:options '()]
14451 Return a new keyboard layout with the given @var{name} and @var{variant}.
14452
14453 @var{name} must be a string such as @code{"fr"}; @var{variant} must be a
14454 string such as @code{"bepo"} or @code{"nodeadkeys"}. See the
14455 @code{xkeyboard-config} package for valid options.
14456 @end deffn
14457
14458 Here are a few examples:
14459
14460 @lisp
14461 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
14462 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
14463 (keyboard-layout "de")
14464
14465 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
14466 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
14467
14468 ;; The Catalan layout.
14469 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
14470
14471 ;; Arabic layout with "Alt-Shift" to switch to US layout.
14472 (keyboard-layout "ar,us" #:options '("grp:alt_shift_toggle"))
14473
14474 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
14475 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
14476 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
14477 ;; accented letters.
14478 (keyboard-layout "latam"
14479 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
14480
14481 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
14482 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
14483
14484 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
14485 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
14486 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
14487 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
14488 @end lisp
14489
14490 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
14491 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
14492
14493 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
14494 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
14495 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
14496 configuration would look like:
14497
14498 @findex set-xorg-configuration
14499 @lisp
14500 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
14501 ;; and for Xorg.
14502
14503 (operating-system
14504 ;; ...
14505 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
14506 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
14507 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
14508 (target "/boot/efi")
14509 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
14510 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
14511 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
14512 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
14513 %desktop-services)))
14514 @end lisp
14515
14516 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
14517 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
14518 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
14519 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
14520 GDM.
14521
14522 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
14523 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
14524
14525 @itemize
14526 @item
14527 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
14528 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
14529
14530 @item
14531 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
14532 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
14533 change the layout to US Dvorak:
14534
14535 @example
14536 setxkbmap us dvorak
14537 @end example
14538
14539 @item
14540 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
14541 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
14542 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
14543 French bépo layout:
14544
14545 @example
14546 loadkeys fr-bepo
14547 @end example
14548 @end itemize
14549
14550 @node Locales
14551 @section Locales
14552
14553 @cindex locale
14554 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
14555 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14556 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
14557 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
14558 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
14559 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
14560
14561 @cindex locale definition
14562 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
14563 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
14564 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
14565
14566 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
14567 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
14568 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
14569 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
14570 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
14571 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
14572 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
14573 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
14574
14575 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
14576 that field may be:
14577
14578 @lisp
14579 (cons (locale-definition
14580 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
14581 %default-locale-definitions)
14582 @end lisp
14583
14584 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
14585 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
14586
14587 @lisp
14588 (list (locale-definition
14589 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
14590 (charset "EUC-JP")))
14591 @end lisp
14592
14593 @vindex LOCPATH
14594 The compiled locale definitions are available at
14595 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
14596 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
14597 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
14598 @env{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14599 @env{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14600
14601 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
14602 locale)} module. Details are given below.
14603
14604 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
14605 This is the data type of a locale definition.
14606
14607 @table @asis
14608
14609 @item @code{name}
14610 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
14611 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
14612
14613 @item @code{source}
14614 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
14615 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
14616
14617 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
14618 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
14619 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
14620 IANA}.
14621
14622 @end table
14623 @end deftp
14624
14625 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
14626 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
14627 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
14628 declarations.
14629
14630 @cindex locale name
14631 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
14632 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
14633 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
14634 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
14635 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
14636 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
14637 @end defvr
14638
14639 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
14640
14641 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
14642 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
14643 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
14644 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
14645 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
14646 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
14647 another.
14648
14649 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
14650 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
14651 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
14652 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
14653 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
14654 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
14655 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
14656 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
14657 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @env{LC_COLLATE}
14658 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
14659 programs will not abort.
14660
14661 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
14662 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
14663 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
14664 used to build the system-wide locale data.
14665
14666 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
14667 and define @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
14668 @env{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
14669
14670 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
14671 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
14672 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
14673 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
14674 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
14675 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
14676
14677 @lisp
14678 (use-package-modules base)
14679
14680 (operating-system
14681 ;; @dots{}
14682 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
14683 @end lisp
14684
14685 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
14686 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
14687 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
14688
14689
14690 @node Services
14691 @section Services
14692
14693 @cindex system services
14694 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
14695 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
14696 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
14697 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
14698 configuring network access.
14699
14700 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
14701 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
14702 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
14703 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
14704 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
14705 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
14706
14707 @example
14708 # herd status
14709 @end example
14710
14711 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
14712 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
14713 service and its associated actions:
14714
14715 @example
14716 # herd doc nscd
14717 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
14718
14719 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
14720 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
14721 @end example
14722
14723 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
14724 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
14725 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
14726
14727 @example
14728 # herd stop nscd
14729 Service nscd has been stopped.
14730 # herd restart xorg-server
14731 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
14732 Service xorg-server has been started.
14733 @end example
14734
14735 The following sections document the available services, starting with
14736 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
14737 declaration.
14738
14739 @menu
14740 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
14741 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
14742 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
14743 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
14744 * Unattended Upgrades:: Automated system upgrades.
14745 * X Window:: Graphical display.
14746 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
14747 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
14748 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
14749 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
14750 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
14751 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
14752 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
14753 * File-Sharing Services:: File-sharing services.
14754 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
14755 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
14756 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
14757 * Web Services:: Web servers.
14758 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
14759 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
14760 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
14761 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
14762 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
14763 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
14764 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
14765 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
14766 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
14767 * Game Services:: Game servers.
14768 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
14769 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
14770 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
14771 * Hurd Services:: Services specific for a Hurd System.
14772 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
14773 @end menu
14774
14775 @node Base Services
14776 @subsection Base Services
14777
14778 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
14779 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
14780 this module are listed below.
14781
14782 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
14783 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
14784 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
14785 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
14786 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
14787 more.
14788
14789 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
14790 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
14791 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
14792 this:
14793
14794 @lisp
14795 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
14796 (service openssh-service-type))
14797 %base-services)
14798 @end lisp
14799 @end defvr
14800
14801 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
14802 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
14803 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
14804
14805 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
14806 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
14807 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
14808
14809 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
14810 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
14811 @lisp
14812 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
14813 @end lisp
14814
14815 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
14816 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
14817 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
14818 change it to:
14819
14820 @lisp
14821 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
14822 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
14823 @end lisp
14824
14825 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
14826 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
14827 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
14828 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
14829 (see below).
14830 @end defvr
14831
14832 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
14833 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
14834
14835 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
14836 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
14837 symlink:
14838
14839 @lisp
14840 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
14841 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
14842 @end lisp
14843 @end deffn
14844
14845 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
14846 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
14847 @end deffn
14848
14849 @defvr {Scheme Variable} console-font-service-type
14850 Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
14851 virtual console on the kernel Linux). The value of this service is a list of
14852 tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the @code{kbd}
14853 package or any valid argument to @command{setfont}, as in this example:
14854
14855 @lisp
14856 `(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
14857 ("tty2" . ,(file-append
14858 font-tamzen
14859 "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
14860 ("tty3" . ,(file-append
14861 font-terminus
14862 "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
14863 @end lisp
14864 @end defvr
14865
14866 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
14867 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
14868 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
14869 among other things.
14870 @end deffn
14871
14872 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
14873 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
14874
14875 @table @asis
14876
14877 @item @code{motd}
14878 @cindex message of the day
14879 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
14880
14881 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14882 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
14883 the 'root' account has just been created.
14884
14885 @end table
14886 @end deftp
14887
14888 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
14889 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
14890 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
14891 other things.
14892 @end deffn
14893
14894 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
14895 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
14896 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
14897
14898 @table @asis
14899
14900 @item @code{tty}
14901 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
14902
14903 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14904 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
14905 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
14906 user name and password must be entered to log in.
14907
14908 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
14909 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
14910 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
14911 the name of the log-in program.
14912
14913 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
14914 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
14915 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
14916
14917 @item @code{clear-on-logout?} (default: @code{#t})
14918 When set to @code{#t}, the screen will be cleared after logout.
14919
14920 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
14921 The Mingetty package to use.
14922
14923 @end table
14924 @end deftp
14925
14926 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
14927 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
14928 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
14929 among other things.
14930 @end deffn
14931
14932 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
14933 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
14934 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
14935 man page for more information.
14936
14937 @table @asis
14938
14939 @item @code{tty}
14940 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
14941 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
14942 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
14943
14944 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
14945 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
14946 from it and use that.
14947
14948 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
14949 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
14950 serial port from it and use that.
14951
14952 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
14953 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
14954 correct values.
14955
14956 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
14957 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
14958 descending order.
14959
14960 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
14961 A string containing the value used for the @env{TERM} environment
14962 variable.
14963
14964 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
14965 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
14966 disabled.
14967
14968 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
14969 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
14970 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
14971
14972 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
14973 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
14974
14975 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
14976 This accepts a string containing the ``login_host'', which will be written
14977 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
14978
14979 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
14980 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
14981 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
14982 specified in @var{login-program}.
14983
14984 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
14985 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
14986
14987 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
14988 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
14989 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
14990
14991 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
14992 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
14993 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
14994
14995 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
14996 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
14997 the login prompt.
14998
14999 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
15000 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
15001 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
15002 Shadow tool suite.
15003
15004 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
15005 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
15006 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
15007 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
15008
15009 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
15010 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
15011 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
15012
15013 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
15014 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
15015 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
15016 systems.
15017
15018 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
15019 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
15020 @file{/etc/issue} file.
15021
15022 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
15023 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
15024 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
15025 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
15026 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
15027 options that could be parsed by the login program.
15028
15029 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
15030 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
15031 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
15032 lazily spawning shells.
15033
15034 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
15035 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
15036 path as a string.
15037
15038 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
15039 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
15040 specified terminal.
15041
15042 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
15043 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
15044 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
15045 character.
15046
15047 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
15048 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
15049 within @var{timeout} seconds.
15050
15051 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
15052 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
15053 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
15054 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
15055 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
15056 Unicode characters.
15057
15058 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
15059 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
15060 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
15061 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
15062 @var{init-string} option.
15063
15064 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
15065 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
15066 locks.
15067
15068 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15069 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
15070 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
15071
15072 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
15073 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
15074 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
15075 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
15076
15077 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15078 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
15079 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
15080
15081 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
15082 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean ``ignore
15083 all previous characters'' (also called a ``kill'' character) when the user
15084 types their login name.
15085
15086 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
15087 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
15088 to before login.
15089
15090 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
15091 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
15092 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
15093
15094 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
15095 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
15096 @command{login} program.
15097
15098 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15099 This option provides an ``escape hatch'' for the user to provide arbitrary
15100 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
15101
15102 @end table
15103 @end deftp
15104
15105 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
15106 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
15107 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
15108 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
15109 @end deffn
15110
15111 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
15112 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
15113 implements virtual console log-in.
15114
15115 @table @asis
15116
15117 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
15118 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
15119
15120 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
15121 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
15122 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
15123
15124 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
15125 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
15126
15127 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
15128 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
15129 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
15130
15131 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
15132 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
15133
15134 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
15135 The Kmscon package to use.
15136
15137 @end table
15138 @end deftp
15139
15140 @cindex name service cache daemon
15141 @cindex nscd
15142 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
15143 [#:name-services '()]
15144 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
15145 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
15146 Service Switch}, for an example.
15147
15148 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
15149
15150 @table @code
15151 @item invalidate
15152 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
15153 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
15154 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
15155
15156 @example
15157 herd invalidate nscd hosts
15158 @end example
15159
15160 @noindent
15161 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
15162
15163 @item statistics
15164 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
15165 and caches.
15166 @end table
15167
15168 @end deffn
15169
15170 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
15171 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
15172 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
15173 @code{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
15174 @end defvr
15175
15176 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
15177 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
15178 configuration.
15179
15180 @table @asis
15181
15182 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
15183 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
15184 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
15185
15186 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
15187 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
15188 command.
15189
15190 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
15191 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
15192 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
15193
15194 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
15195 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
15196 debugging output is logged.
15197
15198 @item @code{caches} (default: @code{%nscd-default-caches})
15199 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
15200 below.
15201
15202 @end table
15203 @end deftp
15204
15205 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
15206 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
15207
15208 @table @asis
15209
15210 @item @code{database}
15211 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
15212 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
15213 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
15214 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
15215
15216 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
15217 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
15218 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
15219 negative lookup result remains in cache.
15220
15221 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
15222 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
15223 @var{database}.
15224
15225 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
15226 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
15227 them into account.
15228
15229 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
15230 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
15231
15232 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
15233 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
15234
15235 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
15236 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
15237
15238 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
15239 @c settings, so leave them out.
15240
15241 @end table
15242 @end deftp
15243
15244 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
15245 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
15246 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
15247
15248 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
15249 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
15250 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
15251 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
15252 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
15253 @end defvr
15254
15255 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
15256 @cindex syslog
15257 @cindex logging
15258 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
15259 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
15260
15261 @table @asis
15262 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
15263 The syslog daemon to use.
15264
15265 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
15266 The syslog configuration file to use.
15267
15268 @end table
15269 @end deftp
15270
15271 @anchor{syslog-service}
15272 @cindex syslog
15273 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
15274 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
15275
15276 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
15277 information on the configuration file syntax.
15278 @end deffn
15279
15280 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
15281 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
15282 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
15283 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
15284 @end defvr
15285
15286 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
15287 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
15288 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
15289 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
15290
15291 @table @asis
15292 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
15293 The Guix package to use.
15294
15295 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
15296 Name of the group for build user accounts.
15297
15298 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
15299 Number of build user accounts to create.
15300
15301 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
15302 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
15303 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
15304 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
15305 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15306
15307 When @code{authorize-key?} is true, @file{/etc/guix/acl} cannot be
15308 changed by invoking @command{guix archive --authorize}. You must
15309 instead adjust @code{guix-configuration} as you wish and reconfigure the
15310 system. This ensures that your operating system configuration file is
15311 self-contained.
15312
15313 @quotation Note
15314 When booting or reconfiguring to a system where @code{authorize-key?}
15315 is true, the existing @file{/etc/guix/acl} file is backed up as
15316 @file{/etc/guix/acl.bak} if it was determined to be a manually modified
15317 file. This is to facilitate migration from earlier versions, which
15318 allowed for in-place modifications to @file{/etc/guix/acl}.
15319 @end quotation
15320
15321 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
15322 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
15323 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
15324 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
15325 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
15326 See @code{substitute-urls} below for an example on how to change it.
15327
15328 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
15329 Whether to use substitutes.
15330
15331 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
15332 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
15333
15334 Suppose you would like to fetch substitutes from @code{guix.example.org}
15335 in addition to @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}. You will need to do
15336 two things: (1) add @code{guix.example.org} to @code{substitute-urls},
15337 and (2) authorize its signing key, having done appropriate checks
15338 (@pxref{Substitute Server Authorization}). The configuration below does
15339 exactly that:
15340
15341 @lisp
15342 (guix-configuration
15343 (substitute-urls
15344 (append (list "https://guix.example.org")
15345 %default-substitute-urls))
15346 (authorized-keys
15347 (append (list (local-file "./guix.example.org-key.pub"))
15348 %default-authorized-guix-keys)))
15349 @end lisp
15350
15351 This example assumes that the file @file{./guix.example.org-key.pub}
15352 contains the public key that @code{guix.example.org} uses to sign
15353 substitutes.
15354
15355 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
15356 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
15357 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
15358 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
15359 disables the timeout.
15360
15361 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
15362 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
15363 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
15364
15365 @item @code{discover?} (default: @code{#f})
15366 Whether to discover substitute servers on the local network using mDNS
15367 and DNS-SD.
15368
15369 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
15370 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
15371
15372 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
15373 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
15374 are written.
15375
15376 @cindex HTTP proxy, for @code{guix-daemon}
15377 @cindex proxy, for @code{guix-daemon} HTTP access
15378 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
15379 The URL of the HTTP and HTTPS proxy used for downloading fixed-output
15380 derivations and substitutes.
15381
15382 It is also possible to change the daemon's proxy at run time through the
15383 @code{set-http-proxy} action, which restarts it:
15384
15385 @example
15386 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon http://localhost:8118
15387 @end example
15388
15389 To clear the proxy settings, run:
15390
15391 @example
15392 herd set-http-proxy guix-daemon
15393 @end example
15394
15395 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
15396 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
15397
15398 @end table
15399 @end deftp
15400
15401 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
15402 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
15403 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
15404 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule}, @code{udev-rules-service}
15405 and @code{file->udev-rule} from @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the
15406 creation of such rule files.
15407
15408 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
15409 directory containing all the active udev rules.
15410 @end deffn
15411
15412 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
15413 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
15414 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
15415
15416 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
15417 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
15418 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
15419
15420 @lisp
15421 (define %example-udev-rule
15422 (udev-rule
15423 "90-usb-thing.rules"
15424 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
15425 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
15426 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
15427 @end lisp
15428 @end deffn
15429
15430 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rules-service [@var{name} @var{rules}] @
15431 [#:groups @var{groups}]
15432 Return a service that extends @code{udev-service-type } with @var{rules}
15433 and @code{account-service-type} with @var{groups} as system groups.
15434 This works by creating a singleton service type
15435 @code{@var{name}-udev-rules}, of which the returned service is an
15436 instance.
15437
15438 Here we show how it can be used to extend @code{udev-service-type} with the
15439 previously defined rule @code{%example-udev-rule}.
15440
15441 @lisp
15442 (operating-system
15443 ;; @dots{}
15444 (services
15445 (cons (udev-rules-service 'usb-thing %example-udev-rule)
15446 %desktop-services)))
15447 @end lisp
15448 @end deffn
15449
15450 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
15451 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
15452 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
15453
15454 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
15455
15456 @lisp
15457 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
15458 (guix packages) ;for origin
15459 @dots{})
15460
15461 (define %android-udev-rules
15462 (file->udev-rule
15463 "51-android-udev.rules"
15464 (let ((version "20170910"))
15465 (origin
15466 (method url-fetch)
15467 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
15468 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
15469 (sha256
15470 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
15471 @end lisp
15472 @end deffn
15473
15474 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
15475 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
15476 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
15477 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
15478 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
15479 packages android)} module.
15480
15481 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
15482 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
15483 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
15484 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
15485 the rules defined within the @code{android-udev-rules} package. To
15486 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
15487 @code{supplementary-groups} of our @code{user-account} declaration, as
15488 well as in the @var{groups} of the @code{udev-rules-service} procedure.
15489
15490 @lisp
15491 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
15492 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
15493 @dots{})
15494
15495 (operating-system
15496 ;; @dots{}
15497 (users (cons (user-account
15498 ;; @dots{}
15499 (supplementary-groups
15500 '("adbusers" ;for adb
15501 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
15502 ;; @dots{}
15503 (services
15504 (cons (udev-rules-service 'android android-udev-rules
15505 #:groups '("adbusers"))
15506 %desktop-services)))
15507 @end lisp
15508
15509 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
15510 Save some entropy in @code{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
15511 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
15512 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
15513 readable.
15514 @end defvr
15515
15516 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
15517 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
15518 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
15519 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
15520 @end defvr
15521
15522 @cindex mouse
15523 @cindex gpm
15524 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
15525 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
15526 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
15527 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
15528 and paste text.
15529
15530 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
15531 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
15532 @end defvr
15533
15534 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
15535 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
15536
15537 @table @asis
15538 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
15539 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
15540 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
15541 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
15542 more information.
15543
15544 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
15545 The GPM package to use.
15546
15547 @end table
15548 @end deftp
15549
15550 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
15551 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
15552 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
15553 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
15554 object, as described below.
15555
15556 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
15557 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
15558 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
15559 @end deffn
15560
15561 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
15562 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
15563 service.
15564
15565 @table @asis
15566 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
15567 The Guix package to use.
15568
15569 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
15570 The TCP port to listen for connections.
15571
15572 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
15573 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
15574 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
15575
15576 @item @code{advertise?} (default: @code{#f})
15577 When true, advertise the service on the local network @i{via} the DNS-SD
15578 protocol, using Avahi.
15579
15580 This allows neighboring Guix devices with discovery on (see
15581 @code{guix-configuration} above) to discover this @command{guix publish}
15582 instance and to automatically download substitutes from it.
15583
15584 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
15585 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
15586 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
15587 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
15588
15589 @lisp
15590 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
15591 @end lisp
15592
15593 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
15594 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression. @xref{Invoking guix
15595 publish}, for more information on the available compression methods and
15596 the tradeoffs involved.
15597
15598 An empty list disables compression altogether.
15599
15600 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
15601 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
15602 publish, @option{--nar-path}}, for details.
15603
15604 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
15605 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
15606 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
15607 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
15608 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15609 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
15610
15611 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
15612 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
15613 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
15614 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
15615
15616 @item @code{cache-bypass-threshold} (default: 10 MiB)
15617 When @code{cache} is true, this is the maximum size in bytes of a store
15618 item for which @command{guix publish} may bypass its cache in case of a
15619 cache miss. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
15620 @option{--cache-bypass-threshold}}, for more information.
15621
15622 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
15623 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
15624 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
15625 for more information.
15626 @end table
15627 @end deftp
15628
15629 @anchor{rngd-service}
15630 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
15631 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
15632 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
15633 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
15634 @var{device} does not exist.
15635 @end deffn
15636
15637 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
15638 @cindex session limits
15639 @cindex ulimit
15640 @cindex priority
15641 @cindex realtime
15642 @cindex jackd
15643 @cindex nofile
15644 @cindex open file descriptors
15645 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
15646
15647 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
15648 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
15649 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
15650 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
15651 @code{ulimit} limits and @code{nice} priority limits to user sessions.
15652
15653 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
15654 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
15655
15656 @lisp
15657 (pam-limits-service
15658 (list
15659 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
15660 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
15661 @end lisp
15662
15663 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
15664 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
15665 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
15666 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
15667
15668 Another useful example is raising the maximum number of open file
15669 descriptors that can be used:
15670
15671 @lisp
15672 (pam-limits-service
15673 (list
15674 (pam-limits-entry "*" 'both 'nofile 100000)))
15675 @end lisp
15676
15677 In the above example, the asterisk means the limit should apply to any
15678 user. It is important to ensure the chosen value doesn't exceed the
15679 maximum system value visible in the @file{/proc/sys/fs/file-max} file,
15680 else the users would be prevented from login in. For more information
15681 about the Pluggable Authentication Module (PAM) limits, refer to the
15682 @samp{pam_limits} man page from the @code{linux-pam} package.
15683 @end deffn
15684
15685 @node Scheduled Job Execution
15686 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
15687
15688 @cindex cron
15689 @cindex mcron
15690 @cindex scheduling jobs
15691 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
15692 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
15693 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
15694 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
15695 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
15696 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
15697
15698 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
15699 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
15700 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
15701 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
15702 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
15703 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
15704 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
15705
15706 @lisp
15707 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
15708 (use-package-modules base idutils)
15709
15710 (define updatedb-job
15711 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
15712 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
15713 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
15714 (lambda ()
15715 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
15716 "updatedb"
15717 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
15718
15719 (define garbage-collector-job
15720 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
15721 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
15722 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
15723 "guix gc -F 1G"))
15724
15725 (define idutils-job
15726 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
15727 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
15728 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
15729 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
15730 #:user "charlie"))
15731
15732 (operating-system
15733 ;; @dots{}
15734
15735 ;; %BASE-SERVICES already includes an instance of
15736 ;; 'mcron-service-type', which we extend with additional
15737 ;; jobs using 'simple-service'.
15738 (services (cons (simple-service 'my-cron-jobs
15739 mcron-service-type
15740 (list garbage-collector-job
15741 updatedb-job
15742 idutils-job))
15743 %base-services)))
15744 @end lisp
15745
15746 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
15747 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
15748 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
15749 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
15750 illustrates that.
15751
15752 @lisp
15753 (define %battery-alert-job
15754 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
15755 #~(job
15756 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
15757 #$(program-file
15758 "battery-alert.scm"
15759 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
15760 '((guix build utils)))
15761 #~(begin
15762 (use-modules (guix build utils)
15763 (ice-9 popen)
15764 (ice-9 regex)
15765 (ice-9 textual-ports)
15766 (srfi srfi-2))
15767
15768 (define %min-level 20)
15769
15770 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
15771 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
15772 OPEN_READ
15773 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
15774 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
15775 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
15776 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
15777 ((< level %min-level)))
15778 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
15779 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
15780 @end lisp
15781
15782 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
15783 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
15784 reference of the mcron service.
15785
15786 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
15787 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
15788
15789 @example
15790 # herd schedule mcron
15791 @end example
15792
15793 @noindent
15794 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
15795 also specify the number of tasks to display:
15796
15797 @example
15798 # herd schedule mcron 10
15799 @end example
15800
15801 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
15802 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
15803 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
15804
15805 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
15806 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
15807 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
15808 mcron jobs to run.
15809 @end defvr
15810
15811 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
15812 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
15813
15814 @table @asis
15815 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
15816 The mcron package to use.
15817
15818 @item @code{jobs}
15819 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
15820 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
15821 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
15822 @end table
15823 @end deftp
15824
15825
15826 @node Log Rotation
15827 @subsection Log Rotation
15828
15829 @cindex rottlog
15830 @cindex log rotation
15831 @cindex logging
15832 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
15833 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
15834 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
15835 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
15836 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15837
15838 This service is part of @code{%base-services}, and thus enabled by
15839 default, with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
15840 The example below shows how to extend it with an additional
15841 @dfn{rotation}, should you need to do that (usually, services that
15842 produce log files already take care of that):
15843
15844 @lisp
15845 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
15846 (use-service-modules admin)
15847
15848 (define my-log-files
15849 ;; Log files that I want to rotate.
15850 '("/var/log/something.log" "/var/log/another.log"))
15851
15852 (operating-system
15853 ;; @dots{}
15854 (services (cons (simple-service 'rotate-my-stuff
15855 rottlog-service-type
15856 (list (log-rotation
15857 (frequency 'daily)
15858 (files my-log-files))))
15859 %base-services)))
15860 @end lisp
15861
15862 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
15863 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
15864 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
15865
15866 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
15867 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
15868
15869 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
15870 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
15871 @end defvr
15872
15873 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
15874 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
15875
15876 @table @asis
15877 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
15878 The Rottlog package to use.
15879
15880 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
15881 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
15882 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
15883
15884 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
15885 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
15886
15887 @item @code{jobs}
15888 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
15889 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
15890 @end table
15891 @end deftp
15892
15893 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
15894 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
15895
15896 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
15897 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
15898 defined like this:
15899
15900 @lisp
15901 (log-rotation
15902 (frequency 'daily)
15903 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
15904 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
15905 "rotate 6"
15906 "notifempty"
15907 "nocompress")))
15908 @end lisp
15909
15910 The list of fields is as follows:
15911
15912 @table @asis
15913 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
15914 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
15915
15916 @item @code{files}
15917 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
15918
15919 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
15920 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
15921 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
15922
15923 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
15924 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
15925 @end table
15926 @end deftp
15927
15928 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
15929 Specifies weekly rotation of @code{%rotated-files} and of
15930 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
15931 @end defvr
15932
15933 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
15934 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
15935 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
15936 "/var/log/maillog")}.
15937 @end defvr
15938
15939 @node Networking Services
15940 @subsection Networking Services
15941
15942 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
15943 the network interface.
15944
15945 @cindex DHCP, networking service
15946 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
15947 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
15948 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
15949 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
15950 @end defvr
15951
15952 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
15953 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
15954 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
15955 For example:
15956
15957 @lisp
15958 (service dhcpd-service-type
15959 (dhcpd-configuration
15960 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
15961 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
15962 @end lisp
15963 @end deffn
15964
15965 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
15966 @table @asis
15967 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
15968 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
15969 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
15970 directory. The default package is the
15971 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
15972 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
15973 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
15974 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
15975 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
15976 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
15977 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
15978 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
15979 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
15980 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
15981 details.
15982 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
15983 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
15984 will be created if it does not exist.
15985 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
15986 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
15987 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15988 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
15989 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
15990 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
15991 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
15992 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
15993 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
15994 @end table
15995 @end deftp
15996
15997 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
15998 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
15999 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
16000 @end defvr
16001
16002 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
16003 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
16004 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
16005 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
16006 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
16007 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
16008 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
16009 interface.
16010
16011 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
16012 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
16013 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
16014 to handle.
16015
16016 For example:
16017
16018 @lisp
16019 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
16020 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
16021 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
16022 @end lisp
16023 @end deffn
16024
16025 @cindex wicd
16026 @cindex wireless
16027 @cindex WiFi
16028 @cindex network management
16029 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
16030 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
16031 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
16032
16033 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
16034 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
16035 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
16036 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
16037 @end deffn
16038
16039 @cindex ModemManager
16040
16041 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
16042 This is the service type for the
16043 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
16044 service. The value for this service type is a
16045 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
16046
16047 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16048 Services}).
16049 @end defvr
16050
16051 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
16052 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
16053
16054 @table @asis
16055 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
16056 The ModemManager package to use.
16057
16058 @end table
16059 @end deftp
16060
16061 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
16062 @cindex Modeswitching
16063
16064 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
16065 This is the service type for the
16066 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch}
16067 service. The value for this service type is
16068 a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
16069
16070 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
16071 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
16072 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
16073 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
16074 plugged in.
16075
16076 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16077 Services}).
16078 @end defvr
16079
16080 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
16081 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
16082
16083 @table @asis
16084 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
16085 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
16086
16087 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
16088 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
16089 USB_ModeSwitch.
16090
16091 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
16092 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
16093 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
16094 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
16095 file is used.
16096
16097 @end table
16098 @end deftp
16099
16100 @cindex NetworkManager
16101
16102 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
16103 This is the service type for the
16104 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
16105 service. The value for this service type is a
16106 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
16107
16108 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
16109 Services}).
16110 @end defvr
16111
16112 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
16113 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
16114
16115 @table @asis
16116 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
16117 The NetworkManager package to use.
16118
16119 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
16120 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
16121 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
16122
16123 @table @samp
16124 @item default
16125 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
16126 provided by currently active connections.
16127
16128 @item dnsmasq
16129 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
16130 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
16131 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
16132
16133 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
16134 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
16135 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
16136 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
16137 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
16138
16139 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
16140 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
16141 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
16142 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
16143 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
16144 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
16145
16146 @example
16147 nmcli connection add type tun \
16148 connection.interface-name tap0 \
16149 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
16150 ipv4.method shared \
16151 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
16152 @end example
16153
16154 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
16155 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
16156 @command{qemu-system-...}.
16157
16158 @item none
16159 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
16160 @end table
16161
16162 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
16163 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
16164 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
16165 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
16166
16167 @end table
16168 @end deftp
16169
16170 @cindex Connman
16171 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
16172 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
16173 a network connection manager.
16174
16175 Its value must be an
16176 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
16177
16178 @lisp
16179 (service connman-service-type
16180 (connman-configuration
16181 (disable-vpn? #t)))
16182 @end lisp
16183
16184 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
16185 @end deffn
16186
16187 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
16188 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
16189
16190 @table @asis
16191 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
16192 The connman package to use.
16193
16194 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
16195 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
16196 @end table
16197 @end deftp
16198
16199 @cindex WPA Supplicant
16200 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
16201 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
16202 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
16203 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
16204 @end defvr
16205
16206 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
16207 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
16208
16209 It takes the following parameters:
16210
16211 @table @asis
16212 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
16213 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
16214
16215 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'(user-processes loopback syslogd)}
16216 List of services that should be started before WPA Supplicant starts.
16217
16218 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
16219 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
16220
16221 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
16222 Where to store the PID file.
16223
16224 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
16225 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
16226 WPA supplicant will control.
16227
16228 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16229 Optional configuration file to use.
16230
16231 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
16232 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
16233 @end table
16234 @end deftp
16235
16236 @cindex hostapd service, for Wi-Fi access points
16237 @cindex Wi-Fi access points, hostapd service
16238 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hostapd-service-type
16239 This is the service type to run the @uref{https://w1.fi/hostapd/,
16240 hostapd} daemon to set up WiFi (IEEE 802.11) access points and
16241 authentication servers. Its associated value must be a
16242 @code{hostapd-configuration} as shown below:
16243
16244 @lisp
16245 ;; Use wlan1 to run the access point for "My Network".
16246 (service hostapd-service-type
16247 (hostapd-configuration
16248 (interface "wlan1")
16249 (ssid "My Network")
16250 (channel 12)))
16251 @end lisp
16252 @end defvr
16253
16254 @deftp {Data Type} hostapd-configuration
16255 This data type represents the configuration of the hostapd service, with
16256 the following fields:
16257
16258 @table @asis
16259 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hostapd})
16260 The hostapd package to use.
16261
16262 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wlan0"})
16263 The network interface to run the WiFi access point.
16264
16265 @item @code{ssid}
16266 The SSID (@dfn{service set identifier}), a string that identifies this
16267 network.
16268
16269 @item @code{broadcast-ssid?} (default: @code{#t})
16270 Whether to broadcast this SSID.
16271
16272 @item @code{channel} (default: @code{1})
16273 The WiFi channel to use.
16274
16275 @item @code{driver} (default: @code{"nl80211"})
16276 The driver interface type. @code{"nl80211"} is used with all Linux
16277 mac80211 drivers. Use @code{"none"} if building hostapd as a standalone
16278 RADIUS server that does # not control any wireless/wired driver.
16279
16280 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
16281 Extra settings to append as-is to the hostapd configuration file. See
16282 @uref{https://w1.fi/cgit/hostap/plain/hostapd/hostapd.conf} for the
16283 configuration file reference.
16284 @end table
16285 @end deftp
16286
16287 @defvr {Scheme Variable} simulated-wifi-service-type
16288 This is the type of a service to simulate WiFi networking, which can be
16289 useful in virtual machines for testing purposes. The service loads the
16290 Linux kernel
16291 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/mac80211_hwsim/mac80211_hwsim.html,
16292 @code{mac80211_hwsim} module} and starts hostapd to create a pseudo WiFi
16293 network that can be seen on @code{wlan0}, by default.
16294
16295 The service's value is a @code{hostapd-configuration} record.
16296 @end defvr
16297
16298 @cindex iptables
16299 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
16300 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
16301 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
16302 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
16303 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
16304 22 is shown below.
16305
16306 @lisp
16307 (service iptables-service-type
16308 (iptables-configuration
16309 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
16310 :INPUT ACCEPT
16311 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16312 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16313 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16314 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
16315 COMMIT
16316 "))
16317 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
16318 :INPUT ACCEPT
16319 :FORWARD ACCEPT
16320 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
16321 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
16322 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
16323 COMMIT
16324 "))))
16325 @end lisp
16326 @end defvr
16327
16328 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
16329 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
16330
16331 @table @asis
16332 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
16333 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
16334 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16335 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16336 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
16337 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16338 objects}).
16339 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
16340 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
16341 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
16342 objects}).
16343 @end table
16344 @end deftp
16345
16346 @cindex nftables
16347 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
16348 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
16349 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
16350 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
16351 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
16352 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
16353 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
16354 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
16355
16356 @lisp
16357 (service nftables-service-type)
16358 @end lisp
16359 @end defvr
16360
16361 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
16362 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
16363
16364 @table @asis
16365 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
16366 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
16367 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
16368 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
16369 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
16370 @end table
16371 @end deftp
16372
16373 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
16374 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
16375 @cindex real time clock
16376 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
16377 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
16378 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
16379 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
16380
16381 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
16382 below.
16383 @end defvr
16384
16385 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
16386 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
16387
16388 @table @asis
16389 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
16390 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
16391 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
16392 definition below.
16393
16394 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
16395 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
16396 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
16397
16398 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
16399 The NTP package to use.
16400 @end table
16401 @end deftp
16402
16403 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
16404 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
16405 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
16406 @end defvr
16407
16408 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
16409 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
16410
16411 @table @asis
16412 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
16413 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
16414 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
16415
16416 @item @code{address}
16417 The address of the server, as a string.
16418
16419 @item @code{options}
16420 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
16421 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
16422 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
16423 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
16424
16425 @example
16426 (ntp-server
16427 (type 'server)
16428 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
16429 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
16430 @end example
16431 @end table
16432 @end deftp
16433
16434 @cindex OpenNTPD
16435 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
16436 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
16437 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
16438 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
16439
16440 @lisp
16441 (service
16442 openntpd-service-type
16443 (openntpd-configuration
16444 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
16445 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
16446 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
16447 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))))
16448
16449 @end lisp
16450 @end deffn
16451
16452 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
16453 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
16454 @code{%ntp-servers}.
16455 @end defvr
16456
16457 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
16458 @table @asis
16459 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
16460 The openntpd executable to use.
16461 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
16462 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
16463 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
16464 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
16465 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
16466 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
16467 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
16468 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
16469 information.
16470 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
16471 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
16472 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%openntp-servers})
16473 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
16474 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
16475 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
16476 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
16477 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
16478 man-in-the-middle attacks.
16479 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
16480 a constraint.
16481 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
16482 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
16483 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
16484 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
16485 @end table
16486 @end deftp
16487
16488 @cindex inetd
16489 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
16490 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
16491 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
16492 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
16493 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
16494
16495 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
16496 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
16497 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
16498 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
16499 gateway @code{hostname}:
16500
16501 @lisp
16502 (service
16503 inetd-service-type
16504 (inetd-configuration
16505 (entries (list
16506 (inetd-entry
16507 (name "echo")
16508 (socket-type 'stream)
16509 (protocol "tcp")
16510 (wait? #f)
16511 (user "root"))
16512 (inetd-entry
16513 (node "127.0.0.1")
16514 (name "smtp")
16515 (socket-type 'stream)
16516 (protocol "tcp")
16517 (wait? #f)
16518 (user "root")
16519 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
16520 (arguments
16521 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
16522 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
16523 @end lisp
16524
16525 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
16526 @end deffn
16527
16528 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
16529 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
16530
16531 @table @asis
16532 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
16533 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
16534
16535 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
16536 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
16537 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
16538 @end table
16539 @end deftp
16540
16541 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
16542 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
16543 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
16544 requests.
16545
16546 @table @asis
16547 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
16548 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
16549 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
16550 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
16551 description of all options.
16552 @item @code{name}
16553 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
16554 @item @code{socket-type}
16555 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
16556 @code{'seqpacket}.
16557 @item @code{protocol}
16558 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
16559 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
16560 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
16561 listening to new service requests.
16562 @item @code{user}
16563 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
16564 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
16565 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
16566 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
16567 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
16568 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
16569 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
16570 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
16571 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
16572 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
16573 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
16574 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
16575 @end table
16576
16577 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
16578 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
16579 @end deftp
16580
16581 @cindex Tor
16582 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
16583 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
16584 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
16585 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
16586 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
16587
16588 @end defvr
16589
16590 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
16591 @table @asis
16592 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
16593 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
16594 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
16595 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
16596 implementation.
16597
16598 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
16599 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
16600 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
16601 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
16602 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
16603 syntax.
16604
16605 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
16606 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
16607 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
16608 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
16609 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
16610 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
16611
16612 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
16613 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
16614 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
16615 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
16616 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
16617 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16618 @code{tor} group.
16619
16620 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
16621 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
16622 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
16623 @code{SocksPort} option.
16624
16625 @item @code{control-socket?} (default: @code{#f})
16626 Whether or not to provide a ``control socket'' by which Tor can be
16627 controlled to, for instance, dynamically instantiate tor onion services.
16628 If @code{#t}, Tor will listen for control commands on the UNIX domain socket
16629 @file{/var/run/tor/control-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
16630 @code{tor} group.
16631
16632 @end table
16633 @end deftp
16634
16635 @cindex hidden service
16636 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
16637 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
16638 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
16639
16640 @example
16641 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
16642 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
16643 @end example
16644
16645 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
16646 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
16647
16648 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
16649 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
16650 service.
16651
16652 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
16653 project's documentation} for more information.
16654 @end deffn
16655
16656 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
16657
16658 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
16659 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
16660 files.
16661
16662 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
16663 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
16664 The value for this service type is a
16665 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
16666
16667 @lisp
16668 (service rsync-service-type)
16669 @end lisp
16670
16671 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
16672 @end deffn
16673
16674 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
16675 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
16676
16677 @table @asis
16678 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
16679 @code{rsync} package to use.
16680
16681 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
16682 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
16683 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
16684 @code{root} user and group.
16685
16686 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
16687 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
16688
16689 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
16690 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
16691
16692 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
16693 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
16694
16695 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
16696 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
16697
16698 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
16699 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16700
16701 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
16702 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
16703
16704 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
16705 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
16706
16707 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
16708 I/O timeout in seconds.
16709
16710 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
16711 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
16712
16713 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
16714 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
16715
16716 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16717 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
16718 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
16719
16720 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
16721 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
16722
16723 @end table
16724 @end deftp
16725
16726 The @code{(gnu services syncthing)} module provides the following services:
16727 @cindex syncthing
16728
16729 You might want a syncthing daemon if you have files between two or more
16730 computers and want to sync them in real time, safely protected from
16731 prying eyes.
16732
16733 @deffn {Scheme Variable} syncthing-service-type
16734 This is the service type for the @uref{https://syncthing.net/,
16735 syncthing} daemon, The value for this service type is a
16736 @command{syncthing-configuration} record as in this example:
16737
16738 @lisp
16739 (service syncthing-service-type
16740 (syncthing-configuration (user "alice")))
16741 @end lisp
16742
16743 See below for details about @code{syncthing-configuration}.
16744
16745 @deftp {Data Type} syncthing-configuration
16746 Data type representing the configuration for @code{syncthing-service-type}.
16747
16748 @table @asis
16749 @item @code{syncthing} (default: @var{syncthing})
16750 @code{syncthing} package to use.
16751
16752 @item @code{arguments} (default: @var{'()})
16753 List of command-line arguments passing to @code{syncthing} binary.
16754
16755 @item @code{logflags} (default: @var{0})
16756 Sum of loging flags, see
16757 @uref{https://docs.syncthing.net/users/syncthing.html#cmdoption-logflags, Syncthing documentation logflags}.
16758
16759 @item @code{user} (default: @var{#f})
16760 The user as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16761 This assumes that the specified user exists.
16762
16763 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"users"})
16764 The group as which the Syncthing service is to be run.
16765 This assumes that the specified group exists.
16766
16767 @item @code{home} (default: @var{#f})
16768 Common configuration and data directory. The default configuration
16769 directory is @file{$HOME} of the specified Syncthing @code{user}.
16770
16771 @end table
16772 @end deftp
16773 @end deffn
16774
16775 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
16776 @cindex SSH
16777 @cindex SSH server
16778
16779 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
16780 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
16781 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
16782 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
16783 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
16784 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
16785 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
16786 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
16787 only by root.
16788
16789 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
16790 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
16791 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
16792 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
16793 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
16794
16795 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
16796 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
16797 require interaction.
16798
16799 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
16800 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
16801 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
16802 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
16803
16804 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
16805 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
16806 or addresses.
16807
16808 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
16809 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
16810 root.
16811
16812 The other options should be self-descriptive.
16813 @end deffn
16814
16815 @cindex SSH
16816 @cindex SSH server
16817 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
16818 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
16819 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
16820 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
16821
16822 @lisp
16823 (service openssh-service-type
16824 (openssh-configuration
16825 (x11-forwarding? #t)
16826 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
16827 (authorized-keys
16828 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
16829 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
16830 @end lisp
16831
16832 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
16833
16834 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
16835 example:
16836
16837 @lisp
16838 (service-extension openssh-service-type
16839 (const `(("charlie"
16840 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
16841 @end lisp
16842 @end deffn
16843
16844 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
16845 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
16846
16847 @table @asis
16848 @item @code{openssh} (default @var{openssh})
16849 The Openssh package to use.
16850
16851 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
16852 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
16853
16854 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
16855 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
16856
16857 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
16858 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
16859 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
16860 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
16861 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
16862
16863 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
16864 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
16865 not.
16866
16867 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16868 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
16869 other authentication methods.
16870
16871 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
16872 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
16873 false, users have to use other authentication method.
16874
16875 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16876 This is used only by protocol version 2.
16877
16878 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
16879 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
16880 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
16881 @option{-Y} will work.
16882
16883 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16884 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
16885
16886 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
16887 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
16888
16889 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
16890 Whether to allow gateway ports.
16891
16892 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
16893 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
16894 PAM).
16895
16896 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
16897 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
16898 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
16899 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
16900 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
16901 module processing for all authentication types.
16902
16903 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
16904 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
16905 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
16906 @code{password-authentication?}.
16907
16908 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
16909 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
16910 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
16911
16912 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
16913 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
16914
16915 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
16916 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
16917 subsystem request.
16918
16919 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
16920 server. Alternatively, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
16921 @lisp
16922 (service openssh-service-type
16923 (openssh-configuration
16924 (subsystems
16925 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
16926 @end lisp
16927
16928 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
16929 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
16930
16931 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
16932 @code{man sshd_config}.
16933
16934 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @env{COLORTERM} variable.
16935 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
16936 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
16937 if this variable is set.
16938
16939 @lisp
16940 (service openssh-service-type
16941 (openssh-configuration
16942 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
16943 @end lisp
16944
16945 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
16946 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
16947 @cindex SSH authorized keys
16948 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
16949 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
16950 keys. For example:
16951
16952 @lisp
16953 (openssh-configuration
16954 (authorized-keys
16955 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
16956 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
16957 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
16958 @end lisp
16959
16960 @noindent
16961 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
16962 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
16963
16964 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
16965 @code{service-extension}.
16966
16967 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
16968 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
16969
16970 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
16971 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
16972 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
16973 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
16974
16975 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
16976 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
16977 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
16978 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
16979 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
16980
16981 @lisp
16982 (openssh-configuration
16983 (extra-content "\
16984 Match Address 192.168.0.1
16985 PermitRootLogin yes"))
16986 @end lisp
16987
16988 @end table
16989 @end deftp
16990
16991 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
16992 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
16993 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
16994 object.
16995
16996 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
16997 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
16998
16999 @lisp
17000 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
17001 (port-number 1234)))
17002 @end lisp
17003 @end deffn
17004
17005 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
17006 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
17007
17008 @table @asis
17009 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
17010 The Dropbear package to use.
17011
17012 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
17013 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
17014
17015 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
17016 Whether to enable syslog output.
17017
17018 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
17019 File name of the daemon's PID file.
17020
17021 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17022 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
17023
17024 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
17025 Whether to allow empty passwords.
17026
17027 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
17028 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
17029 @end table
17030 @end deftp
17031
17032 @cindex AutoSSH
17033 @deffn {Scheme Variable} autossh-service-type
17034 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.harding.motd.ca/autossh,
17035 AutoSSH} program that runs a copy of @command{ssh} and monitors it,
17036 restarting it as necessary should it die or stop passing traffic.
17037 AutoSSH can be run manually from the command-line by passing arguments
17038 to the binary @command{autossh} from the package @code{autossh}, but it
17039 can also be run as a Guix service. This latter use case is documented
17040 here.
17041
17042 AutoSSH can be used to forward local traffic to a remote machine using
17043 an SSH tunnel, and it respects the @file{~/.ssh/config} of the user it
17044 is run as.
17045
17046 For example, to specify a service running autossh as the user
17047 @code{pino} and forwarding all local connections to port @code{8081} to
17048 @code{remote:8081} using an SSH tunnel, add this call to the operating
17049 system's @code{services} field:
17050
17051 @lisp
17052 (service autossh-service-type
17053 (autossh-configuration
17054 (user "pino")
17055 (ssh-options (list "-T" "-N" "-L" "8081:localhost:8081" "remote.net"))))
17056 @end lisp
17057 @end deffn
17058
17059 @deftp {Data Type} autossh-configuration
17060 This data type represents the configuration of an AutoSSH service.
17061
17062 @table @asis
17063
17064 @item @code{user} (default @code{"autossh"})
17065 The user as which the AutoSSH service is to be run.
17066 This assumes that the specified user exists.
17067
17068 @item @code{poll} (default @code{600})
17069 Specifies the connection poll time in seconds.
17070
17071 @item @code{first-poll} (default @code{#f})
17072 Specifies how many seconds AutoSSH waits before the first connection
17073 test. After this first test, polling is resumed at the pace defined in
17074 @code{poll}. When set to @code{#f}, the first poll is not treated
17075 specially and will also use the connection poll specified in
17076 @code{poll}.
17077
17078 @item @code{gate-time} (default @code{30})
17079 Specifies how many seconds an SSH connection must be active before it is
17080 considered successful.
17081
17082 @item @code{log-level} (default @code{1})
17083 The log level, corresponding to the levels used by syslog---so @code{0}
17084 is the most silent while @code{7} is the chattiest.
17085
17086 @item @code{max-start} (default @code{#f})
17087 The maximum number of times SSH may be (re)started before AutoSSH exits.
17088 When set to @code{#f}, no maximum is configured and AutoSSH may restart indefinitely.
17089
17090 @item @code{message} (default @code{""})
17091 The message to append to the echo message sent when testing connections.
17092
17093 @item @code{port} (default @code{"0"})
17094 The ports used for monitoring the connection. When set to @code{"0"},
17095 monitoring is disabled. When set to @code{"@var{n}"} where @var{n} is
17096 a positive integer, ports @var{n} and @var{n}+1 are used for
17097 monitoring the connection, such that port @var{n} is the base
17098 monitoring port and @code{n+1} is the echo port. When set to
17099 @code{"@var{n}:@var{m}"} where @var{n} and @var{m} are positive
17100 integers, the ports @var{n} and @var{m} are used for monitoring the
17101 connection, such that port @var{n} is the base monitoring port and
17102 @var{m} is the echo port.
17103
17104 @item @code{ssh-options} (default @code{'()})
17105 The list of command-line arguments to pass to @command{ssh} when it is
17106 run. Options @option{-f} and @option{-M} are reserved for AutoSSH and
17107 may cause undefined behaviour.
17108
17109 @end table
17110 @end deftp
17111
17112 @cindex WebSSH
17113 @deffn {Scheme Variable} webssh-service-type
17114 This is the type for the @uref{https://webssh.huashengdun.org/, WebSSH}
17115 program that runs a web SSH client. WebSSH can be run manually from the
17116 command-line by passing arguments to the binary @command{wssh} from the
17117 package @code{webssh}, but it can also be run as a Guix service. This
17118 latter use case is documented here.
17119
17120 For example, to specify a service running WebSSH on loopback interface
17121 on port @code{8888} with reject policy with a list of allowed to
17122 connection hosts, and NGINX as a reverse-proxy to this service listening
17123 for HTTPS connection, add this call to the operating system's
17124 @code{services} field:
17125
17126 @lisp
17127 (service webssh-service-type
17128 (webssh-configuration (address "127.0.0.1")
17129 (port 8888)
17130 (policy 'reject)
17131 (known-hosts '("localhost ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"
17132 "127.0.0.1 ecdsa-sha2-nistp256 AAAA…"))))
17133
17134 (service nginx-service-type
17135 (nginx-configuration
17136 (server-blocks
17137 (list
17138 (nginx-server-configuration
17139 (inherit %webssh-configuration-nginx)
17140 (server-name '("webssh.example.com"))
17141 (listen '("443 ssl"))
17142 (ssl-certificate (letsencrypt-certificate "webssh.example.com"))
17143 (ssl-certificate-key (letsencrypt-key "webssh.example.com"))
17144 (locations
17145 (cons (nginx-location-configuration
17146 (uri "/.well-known")
17147 (body '("root /var/www;")))
17148 (nginx-server-configuration-locations %webssh-configuration-nginx))))))))
17149 @end lisp
17150 @end deffn
17151
17152 @deftp {Data Type} webssh-configuration
17153 Data type representing the configuration for @code{webssh-service}.
17154
17155 @table @asis
17156 @item @code{package} (default: @var{webssh})
17157 @code{webssh} package to use.
17158
17159 @item @code{user-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17160 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
17161 place.
17162
17163 @item @code{group-name} (default: @var{"webssh"})
17164 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
17165
17166 @item @code{address} (default: @var{#f})
17167 IP address on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17168
17169 @item @code{port} (default: @var{8888})
17170 TCP port on which @command{webssh} listens for incoming connections.
17171
17172 @item @code{policy} (default: @var{#f})
17173 Connection policy. @var{reject} policy requires to specify @var{known-hosts}.
17174
17175 @item @code{known-hosts} (default: @var{'()})
17176 List of hosts which allowed for SSH connection from @command{webssh}.
17177
17178 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/webssh.log"})
17179 Name of the file where @command{webssh} writes its log file.
17180
17181 @item @code{log-level} (default: @var{#f})
17182 Logging level.
17183
17184 @end table
17185 @end deftp
17186
17187 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
17188 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
17189 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
17190 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
17191 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
17192 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
17193
17194 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
17195 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
17196 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
17197
17198 @lisp
17199 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
17200
17201 (operating-system
17202 (host-name "mymachine")
17203 ;; ...
17204 (hosts-file
17205 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
17206 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
17207 (plain-file "hosts"
17208 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
17209 %facebook-host-aliases))))
17210 @end lisp
17211
17212 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
17213 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
17214 @end defvr
17215
17216 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
17217
17218 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
17219 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
17220 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
17221 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
17222 Its value must be an @code{avahi-configuration} record---see below.
17223
17224 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
17225 resolve @code{.local} host names using
17226 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
17227 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
17228
17229 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
17230 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
17231 @end defvr
17232
17233 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
17234 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
17235
17236 @table @asis
17237
17238 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
17239 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
17240 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
17241
17242 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
17243 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
17244 network.
17245
17246 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
17247 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
17248 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
17249 your local network, you can run:
17250
17251 @example
17252 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
17253 @end example
17254
17255 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
17256 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
17257
17258 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
17259 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
17260 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
17261
17262 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
17263 This is a list of domains to browse.
17264 @end table
17265 @end deftp
17266
17267 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
17268 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
17269 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
17270 object.
17271 @end deffn
17272
17273 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
17274 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
17275 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
17276 through programmatic extension.
17277
17278 @table @asis
17279 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
17280 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
17281
17282 @end table
17283 @end deftp
17284
17285 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
17286 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
17287 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
17288 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
17289 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
17290
17291 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
17292
17293 @lisp
17294 (service pagekite-service-type
17295 (pagekite-configuration
17296 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
17297 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
17298 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
17299 @end lisp
17300 @end defvr
17301
17302 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
17303 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
17304
17305 @table @asis
17306 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
17307 Package object of PageKite.
17308
17309 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
17310 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
17311
17312 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
17313 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
17314 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
17315
17316 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
17317 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
17318 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
17319
17320 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
17321 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
17322 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
17323
17324 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
17325 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
17326 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
17327
17328 @end table
17329 @end deftp
17330
17331 @defvr {Scheme Variable} yggdrasil-service-type
17332 The service type for connecting to the @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/,
17333 Yggdrasil network}, an early-stage implementation of a fully end-to-end
17334 encrypted IPv6 network.
17335
17336 @quotation
17337 Yggdrasil provides name-independent routing with cryptographically generated
17338 addresses. Static addressing means you can keep the same address as long as
17339 you want, even if you move to a new location, or generate a new address (by
17340 generating new keys) whenever you want.
17341 @uref{https://yggdrasil-network.github.io/2018/07/28/addressing.html}
17342 @end quotation
17343
17344 Pass it a value of @code{yggdrasil-configuration} to connect it to public
17345 peers and/or local peers.
17346
17347 Here is an example using public peers and a static address. The static
17348 signing and encryption keys are defined in @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}
17349 (the default value for @code{config-file}).
17350
17351 @lisp
17352 ;; part of the operating-system declaration
17353 (service yggdrasil-service-type
17354 (yggdrasil-configuration
17355 (autoconf? #f) ;; use only the public peers
17356 (json-config
17357 ;; choose one from
17358 ;; https://github.com/yggdrasil-network/public-peers
17359 '((peers . #("tcp://1.2.3.4:1337"))))
17360 ;; /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf is the default value for config-file
17361 ))
17362 @end lisp
17363 @example
17364 # sample content for /etc/yggdrasil-private.conf
17365 @{
17366 # Your public encryption key. Your peers may ask you for this to put
17367 # into their AllowedEncryptionPublicKeys configuration.
17368 EncryptionPublicKey: 378dc5...
17369
17370 # Your private encryption key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17371 EncryptionPrivateKey: 0777...
17372
17373 # Your public signing key. You should not ordinarily need to share
17374 # this with anyone.
17375 SigningPublicKey: e1664...
17376
17377 # Your private signing key. DO NOT share this with anyone!
17378 SigningPrivateKey: 0589d...
17379 @}
17380 @end example
17381 @end defvr
17382
17383 @deftp {Data Type} yggdrasil-configuration
17384 Data type representing the configuration of Yggdrasil.
17385
17386 @table @asis
17387 @item @code{package} (default: @code{yggdrasil})
17388 Package object of Yggdrasil.
17389
17390 @item @code{json-config} (default: @code{'()})
17391 Contents of @file{/etc/yggdrasil.conf}. Will be merged with
17392 @file{/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf}. Note that these settings are stored in
17393 the Guix store, which is readable to all users. @strong{Do not store your
17394 private keys in it}. See the output of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} for a
17395 quick overview of valid keys and their default values.
17396
17397 @item @code{autoconf?} (default: @code{#f})
17398 Whether to use automatic mode. Enabling it makes Yggdrasil use adynamic IP
17399 and peer with IPv6 neighbors.
17400
17401 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
17402 How much detail to include in logs. Use @code{'debug} for more detail.
17403
17404 @item @code{log-to} (default: @code{'stdout})
17405 Where to send logs. By default, the service logs standard output to
17406 @file{/var/log/yggdrasil.log}. The alternative is @code{'syslog}, which
17407 sends output to the running syslog service.
17408
17409 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{"/etc/yggdrasil-private.conf"})
17410 What HJSON file to load sensitive data from. This is where private keys
17411 should be stored, which are necessary to specify if you don't want a
17412 randomized address after each restart. Use @code{#f} to disable. Options
17413 defined in this file take precedence over @code{json-config}. Use the output
17414 of @code{yggdrasil -genconf} as a starting point. To configure a static
17415 address, delete everything except these options:
17416
17417 @itemize
17418 @item @code{EncryptionPublicKey}
17419 @item @code{EncryptionPrivateKey}
17420 @item @code{SigningPublicKey}
17421 @item @code{SigningPrivateKey}
17422 @end itemize
17423 @end table
17424 @end deftp
17425
17426 @cindex keepalived
17427 @deffn {Scheme Variable} keepalived-service-type
17428 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.keepalived.org/, Keepalived}
17429 routing software, @command{keepalived}. Its value must be an
17430 @code{keepalived-configuration} record as in this example for master
17431 machine:
17432
17433 @lisp
17434 (service keepalived-service-type
17435 (keepalived-configuration
17436 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-master.conf"))))
17437 @end lisp
17438
17439 where @file{keepalived-master.conf}:
17440
17441 @example
17442 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17443 state MASTER
17444 interface enp9s0
17445 virtual_router_id 100
17446 priority 100
17447 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.2 @}
17448 virtual_ipaddress @{
17449 10.0.0.4/24
17450 @}
17451 @}
17452 @end example
17453
17454 and for backup machine:
17455
17456 @lisp
17457 (service keepalived-service-type
17458 (keepalived-configuration
17459 (config-file (local-file "keepalived-backup.conf"))))
17460 @end lisp
17461
17462 where @file{keepalived-backup.conf}:
17463
17464 @example
17465 vrrp_instance my-group @{
17466 state BACKUP
17467 interface enp9s0
17468 virtual_router_id 100
17469 priority 99
17470 unicast_peer @{ 10.0.0.3 @}
17471 virtual_ipaddress @{
17472 10.0.0.4/24
17473 @}
17474 @}
17475 @end example
17476 @end deffn
17477
17478 @node Unattended Upgrades
17479 @subsection Unattended Upgrades
17480
17481 @cindex unattended upgrades
17482 @cindex upgrades, unattended
17483 Guix provides a service to perform @emph{unattended upgrades}:
17484 periodically, the system automatically reconfigures itself from the
17485 latest Guix. Guix System has several properties that make unattended
17486 upgrades safe:
17487
17488 @itemize
17489 @item
17490 upgrades are transactional (either the upgrade succeeds or it fails, but
17491 you cannot end up with an ``in-between'' system state);
17492 @item
17493 the upgrade log is kept---you can view it with @command{guix system
17494 list-generations}---and you can roll back to any previous generation,
17495 should the upgraded system fail to behave as intended;
17496 @item
17497 channel code is authenticated so you know you can only run genuine code
17498 (@pxref{Channels});
17499 @item
17500 @command{guix system reconfigure} prevents downgrades, which makes it
17501 immune to @dfn{downgrade attacks}.
17502 @end itemize
17503
17504 To set up unattended upgrades, add an instance of
17505 @code{unattended-upgrade-service-type} like the one below to the list of
17506 your operating system services:
17507
17508 @lisp
17509 (service unattended-upgrade-service-type)
17510 @end lisp
17511
17512 The defaults above set up weekly upgrades: every Sunday at midnight.
17513 You do not need to provide the operating system configuration file: it
17514 uses @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm}, which ensures it
17515 always uses your latest configuration---@pxref{provenance-service-type},
17516 for more information about this file.
17517
17518 There are several things that can be configured, in particular the
17519 periodicity and services (daemons) to be restarted upon completion.
17520 When the upgrade is successful, the service takes care of deleting
17521 system generations older that some threshold, as per @command{guix
17522 system delete-generations}. See the reference below for details.
17523
17524 To ensure that upgrades are actually happening, you can run
17525 @command{guix system describe}. To investigate upgrade failures, visit
17526 the unattended upgrade log file (see below).
17527
17528 @defvr {Scheme Variable} unattended-upgrade-service-type
17529 This is the service type for unattended upgrades. It sets up an mcron
17530 job (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) that runs @command{guix system
17531 reconfigure} from the latest version of the specified channels.
17532
17533 Its value must be a @code{unattended-upgrade-configuration} record (see
17534 below).
17535 @end defvr
17536
17537 @deftp {Data Type} unattended-upgrade-configuration
17538 This data type represents the configuration of the unattended upgrade
17539 service. The following fields are available:
17540
17541 @table @asis
17542 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{"30 01 * * 0"})
17543 This is the schedule of upgrades, expressed as a gexp containing an
17544 mcron job schedule (@pxref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,,
17545 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
17546
17547 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{#~%default-channels})
17548 This gexp specifies the channels to use for the upgrade
17549 (@pxref{Channels}). By default, the tip of the official @code{guix}
17550 channel is used.
17551
17552 @item @code{operating-system-file} (default: @code{"/run/current-system/configuration.scm"})
17553 This field specifies the operating system configuration file to use.
17554 The default is to reuse the config file of the current configuration.
17555
17556 There are cases, though, where referring to
17557 @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} is not enough, for instance
17558 because that file refers to extra files (SSH public keys, extra
17559 configuration files, etc.) @i{via} @code{local-file} and similar
17560 constructs. For those cases, we recommend something along these lines:
17561
17562 @lisp
17563 (unattended-upgrade-configuration
17564 (operating-system-file
17565 (file-append (local-file "." "config-dir" #:recursive? #t)
17566 "/config.scm")))
17567 @end lisp
17568
17569 The effect here is to import all of the current directory into the
17570 store, and to refer to @file{config.scm} within that directory.
17571 Therefore, uses of @code{local-file} within @file{config.scm} will work
17572 as expected. @xref{G-Expressions}, for information about
17573 @code{local-file} and @code{file-append}.
17574
17575 @item @code{services-to-restart} (default: @code{'(mcron)})
17576 This field specifies the Shepherd services to restart when the upgrade
17577 completes.
17578
17579 Those services are restarted right away upon completion, as with
17580 @command{herd restart}, which ensures that the latest version is
17581 running---remember that by default @command{guix system reconfigure}
17582 only restarts services that are not currently running, which is
17583 conservative: it minimizes disruption but leaves outdated services
17584 running.
17585
17586 Use @command{herd status} to find out candidates for restarting.
17587 @xref{Services}, for general information about services. Common
17588 services to restart would include @code{ntpd} and @code{ssh-daemon}.
17589
17590 By default, the @code{mcron} service is restarted. This ensures that
17591 the latest version of the unattended upgrade job will be used next time.
17592
17593 @item @code{system-expiration} (default: @code{(* 3 30 24 3600)})
17594 This is the expiration time in seconds for system generations. System
17595 generations older that this amount of time are deleted with
17596 @command{guix system delete-generations} when an upgrade completes.
17597
17598 @quotation Note
17599 The unattended upgrade service does not run the garbage collector. You
17600 will probably want to set up your own mcron job to run @command{guix gc}
17601 periodically.
17602 @end quotation
17603
17604 @item @code{maximum-duration} (default: @code{3600})
17605 Maximum duration in seconds for the upgrade; past that time, the upgrade
17606 aborts.
17607
17608 This is primarily useful to ensure the upgrade does not end up
17609 rebuilding or re-downloading ``the world''.
17610
17611 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/unattended-upgrade.log"})
17612 File where unattended upgrades are logged.
17613 @end table
17614 @end deftp
17615
17616 @node X Window
17617 @subsection X Window
17618
17619 @cindex X11
17620 @cindex X Window System
17621 @cindex login manager
17622 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
17623 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
17624 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
17625 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
17626
17627 @cindex GDM
17628 @cindex GNOME, login manager
17629 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
17630 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
17631 features such as automatic screen locking.
17632
17633 @cindex window manager
17634 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
17635 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
17636 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
17637 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
17638
17639 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
17640 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
17641 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
17642 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
17643 (see below).
17644
17645 @cindex session types (X11)
17646 @cindex X11 session types
17647 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
17648 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
17649 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
17650 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
17651 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
17652
17653 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
17654 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
17655 and/or other X clients.
17656 @end defvr
17657
17658 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
17659 @table @asis
17660 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17661 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
17662 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
17663
17664 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
17665 @code{default-user}.
17666
17667 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17668 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
17669
17670 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
17671 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
17672
17673 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17674 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17675
17676 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
17677 Script to run before starting a X session.
17678
17679 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
17680 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
17681
17682 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
17683 The GDM package to use.
17684 @end table
17685 @end deftp
17686
17687 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
17688 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
17689
17690 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
17691 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
17692 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
17693
17694 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
17695 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
17696 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
17697 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
17698 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
17699 and tty8.
17700
17701 @lisp
17702 (use-modules (gnu services)
17703 (gnu services desktop)
17704 (gnu services xorg)
17705 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
17706
17707 (operating-system
17708 ;; ...
17709 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17710 (display ":0")
17711 (vt "vt7")))
17712 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
17713 (display ":1")
17714 (vt "vt8")))
17715 (remove (lambda (service)
17716 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
17717 %desktop-services))))
17718 @end lisp
17719
17720 @end defvr
17721
17722 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
17723 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
17724
17725 @table @asis
17726 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
17727 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
17728
17729 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
17730 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
17731 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
17732
17733 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
17734 @code{default-user}.
17735
17736 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
17737 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
17738 The graphical theme to use and its name.
17739
17740 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
17741 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
17742 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
17743
17744 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
17745 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
17746 will be used.
17747
17748 @quotation Note
17749 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
17750 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
17751 false, you will be unable to log in.
17752 @end quotation
17753
17754 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17755 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17756
17757 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
17758 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17759
17760 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
17761 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
17762
17763 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
17764 The XAuth package to use.
17765
17766 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
17767 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
17768 @command{reboot}.
17769
17770 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
17771 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
17772
17773 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
17774 The SLiM package to use.
17775 @end table
17776 @end deftp
17777
17778 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
17779 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
17780 The default SLiM theme and its name.
17781 @end defvr
17782
17783
17784 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17785 This is the data type representing the SDDM service configuration.
17786
17787 @table @asis
17788 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
17789 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are
17790 @samp{"x11"} or @samp{"wayland"}.
17791
17792 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
17793 Valid values are @samp{"on"}, @samp{"off"} or @samp{"none"}.
17794
17795 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
17796 Command to run when halting.
17797
17798 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
17799 Command to run when rebooting.
17800
17801 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
17802 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are @samp{"elarun"},
17803 @samp{"maldives"} or @samp{"maya"}.
17804
17805 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
17806 Directory to look for themes.
17807
17808 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
17809 Directory to look for faces.
17810
17811 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
17812 Default PATH to use.
17813
17814 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
17815 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
17816
17817 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
17818 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
17819
17820 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
17821 Remember last user.
17822
17823 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
17824 Remember last session.
17825
17826 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
17827 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
17828
17829 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
17830 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
17831
17832 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
17833 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
17834
17835 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
17836 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
17837
17838 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
17839 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
17840
17841 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
17842 Path to xauth.
17843
17844 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
17845 Path to Xephyr.
17846
17847 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
17848 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
17849
17850 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
17851 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
17852
17853 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
17854 Script to run before starting a X session.
17855
17856 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
17857 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
17858
17859 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
17860 Minimum VT to use.
17861
17862 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
17863 User to use for auto-login.
17864
17865 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
17866 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
17867
17868 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
17869 Relogin after logout.
17870
17871 @end table
17872 @end deftp
17873
17874 @cindex login manager
17875 @cindex X11 login
17876 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
17877 This is the type of the service to run the
17878 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
17879 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
17880
17881 Here's an example use:
17882
17883 @lisp
17884 (service sddm-service-type
17885 (sddm-configuration
17886 (auto-login-user "alice")
17887 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
17888 @end lisp
17889 @end defvr
17890
17891 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
17892 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
17893 The available fields are:
17894
17895 @table @asis
17896 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
17897 The SDDM package to use.
17898
17899 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
17900 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
17901
17902 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
17903
17904 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
17905 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
17906 automatically.
17907
17908 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
17909 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
17910 auto-login session.
17911 @end table
17912 @end deftp
17913
17914 @cindex Xorg, configuration
17915 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
17916 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
17917 server. Note that there is no Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
17918 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM@. Thus, the configuration
17919 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
17920
17921 @table @asis
17922 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
17923 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
17924 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
17925
17926 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
17927 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
17928
17929 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
17930 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
17931 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
17932 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
17933
17934 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
17935 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
17936 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
17937 768) (640 480))}.
17938
17939 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
17940 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
17941 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
17942 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
17943 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
17944
17945 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
17946 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
17947 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
17948
17949 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
17950 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
17951 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
17952
17953 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
17954 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
17955
17956 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
17957 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
17958 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
17959 @end table
17960 @end deftp
17961
17962 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
17963 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
17964 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
17965 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
17966
17967 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
17968 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
17969 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
17970 @end deffn
17971
17972 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
17973 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
17974 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
17975 @code{startx}.
17976
17977 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
17978 @end deffn
17979
17980
17981 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
17982 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
17983 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
17984 for it. For example:
17985
17986 @lisp
17987 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
17988 @end lisp
17989
17990 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
17991 @end deffn
17992
17993
17994 @node Printing Services
17995 @subsection Printing Services
17996
17997 @cindex printer support with CUPS
17998 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
17999 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
18000 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
18001
18002 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
18003 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
18004 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
18005 write:
18006 @lisp
18007 (service cups-service-type)
18008 @end lisp
18009 @end deffn
18010
18011 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
18012 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
18013 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
18014 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
18015 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
18016 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
18017 secure connections to the print server.
18018
18019 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
18020 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{epson-inkjet-printer-escpr}
18021 package and for HP printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package.
18022 You can do that directly, like this (you need to use the
18023 @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
18024
18025 @lisp
18026 (service cups-service-type
18027 (cups-configuration
18028 (web-interface? #t)
18029 (extensions
18030 (list cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr hplip-minimal))))
18031 @end lisp
18032
18033 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
18034 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
18035 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
18036
18037 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
18038 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
18039 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
18040 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
18041 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
18042 from some other system; see the end for more details.
18043
18044 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
18045 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
18046 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
18047 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
18048 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
18049 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
18050 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
18051
18052
18053 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
18054
18055 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18056 The CUPS package.
18057 @end deftypevr
18058
18059 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions (default: @code{(list brlaser cups-filters epson-inkjet-printer-escpr foomatic-filters hplip-minimal splix)})
18060 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
18061 @end deftypevr
18062
18063 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
18064 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
18065 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
18066
18067 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
18068
18069 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
18070 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18071 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18072 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18073 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18074 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18075 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18076 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
18077
18078 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
18079 @end deftypevr
18080
18081 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
18082 Where CUPS should cache data.
18083
18084 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
18085 @end deftypevr
18086
18087 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
18088 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
18089 writes.
18090
18091 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
18092 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
18093 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
18094 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
18095 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
18096
18097 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
18098 @end deftypevr
18099
18100 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
18101 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18102 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18103 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18104 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18105 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18106 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18107 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
18108
18109 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
18110 @end deftypevr
18111
18112 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
18113 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
18114 kind strings are:
18115
18116 @table @code
18117 @item none
18118 No errors are fatal.
18119
18120 @item all
18121 All of the errors below are fatal.
18122
18123 @item browse
18124 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
18125 to the DNS-SD daemon.
18126
18127 @item config
18128 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
18129
18130 @item listen
18131 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
18132 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
18133
18134 @item log
18135 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
18136
18137 @item permissions
18138 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
18139 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
18140 @end table
18141
18142 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
18143 @end deftypevr
18144
18145 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
18146 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
18147 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
18148
18149 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18150 @end deftypevr
18151
18152 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
18153 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
18154 programs.
18155
18156 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18157 @end deftypevr
18158
18159 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
18160 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
18161
18162 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
18163 @end deftypevr
18164
18165 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
18166 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
18167 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
18168 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
18169 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
18170 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
18171 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
18172 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
18173
18174 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
18175 @end deftypevr
18176
18177 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
18178 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
18179 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
18180
18181 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
18182 @end deftypevr
18183
18184 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
18185 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
18186 data.
18187
18188 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
18189 @end deftypevr
18190
18191 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
18192 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
18193 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
18194 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
18195 used/supported on macOS.
18196
18197 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
18198 @end deftypevr
18199
18200 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
18201 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
18202 look for public and private keys in this directory: @file{.crt} files
18203 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @file{.key} files for
18204 PEM-encoded private keys.
18205
18206 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
18207 @end deftypevr
18208
18209 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
18210 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
18211
18212 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
18213 @end deftypevr
18214
18215 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
18216 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
18217 configuration or state files.
18218
18219 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18220 @end deftypevr
18221
18222 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
18223 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
18224 @end deftypevr
18225
18226 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
18227 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
18228
18229 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
18230 @end deftypevr
18231
18232 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
18233 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
18234 programs.
18235
18236 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
18237 @end deftypevr
18238
18239 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
18240 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
18241
18242 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
18243 @end deftypevr
18244 @end deftypevr
18245
18246 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
18247 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
18248 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
18249 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
18250 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
18251 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
18252 level logs all requests.
18253
18254 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
18255 @end deftypevr
18256
18257 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
18258 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
18259 longer required for quotas.
18260
18261 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18262 @end deftypevr
18263
18264 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
18265 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
18266 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
18267 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
18268
18269 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
18270 @end deftypevr
18271
18272 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
18273 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
18274
18275 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
18276 @end deftypevr
18277
18278 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
18279 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
18280
18281 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18282 @end deftypevr
18283
18284 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
18285 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
18286
18287 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18288 @end deftypevr
18289
18290 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
18291 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
18292 name can be used, including @samp{"classified"}, @samp{"confidential"},
18293 @samp{"secret"}, @samp{"topsecret"}, and @samp{"unclassified"}, or the
18294 banner can be omitted to disable secure printing functions.
18295
18296 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18297 @end deftypevr
18298
18299 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
18300 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
18301 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
18302
18303 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18304 @end deftypevr
18305
18306 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
18307 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
18308
18309 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
18310 @end deftypevr
18311
18312 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
18313 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
18314
18315 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
18316 @end deftypevr
18317
18318 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
18319 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
18320
18321 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
18322 @end deftypevr
18323
18324 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
18325 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
18326 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
18327 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
18328 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
18329
18330 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
18331 @end deftypevr
18332
18333 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
18334 Specifies the default access policy to use.
18335
18336 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
18337 @end deftypevr
18338
18339 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
18340 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
18341
18342 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18343 @end deftypevr
18344
18345 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
18346 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
18347 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
18348 typically within a few milliseconds.
18349
18350 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18351 @end deftypevr
18352
18353 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
18354 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
18355 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
18356 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
18357 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
18358 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
18359
18360 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
18361 @end deftypevr
18362
18363 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
18364 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
18365 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
18366 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
18367 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
18368 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
18369 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
18370 at any time.
18371
18372 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18373 @end deftypevr
18374
18375 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
18376 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
18377 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
18378 lowest priority.
18379
18380 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18381 @end deftypevr
18382
18383 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
18384 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
18385 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
18386 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
18387 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
18388 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
18389 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
18390
18391 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18392 @end deftypevr
18393
18394 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
18395 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
18396 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
18397
18398 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18399 @end deftypevr
18400
18401 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
18402 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
18403 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18404 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18405 @code{retry-current-job}.
18406
18407 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18408 @end deftypevr
18409
18410 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
18411 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
18412 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
18413 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
18414 @code{retry-current-job}.
18415
18416 Defaults to @samp{5}.
18417 @end deftypevr
18418
18419 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
18420 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
18421
18422 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18423 @end deftypevr
18424
18425 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
18426 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
18427
18428 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18429 @end deftypevr
18430
18431 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
18432 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
18433 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
18434
18435 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18436 @end deftypevr
18437
18438 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
18439 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
18440 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
18441 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
18442 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
18443 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
18444 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
18445 @end deftypevr
18446
18447 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
18448 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
18449 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
18450 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
18451 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
18452 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
18453 ones.
18454
18455 Defaults to @samp{128}.
18456 @end deftypevr
18457
18458 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
18459 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
18460
18461 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
18462
18463 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
18464 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
18465 @end deftypevr
18466
18467 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18468 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
18469 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
18470
18471 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18472 @end deftypevr
18473
18474 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
18475 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
18476
18477 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18478
18479 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
18480
18481 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
18482 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
18483 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
18484
18485 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18486 @end deftypevr
18487
18488 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
18489 Methods to which this access control applies.
18490
18491 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18492 @end deftypevr
18493
18494 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
18495 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
18496 one directive, such as @samp{"Order allow,deny"}.
18497
18498 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18499 @end deftypevr
18500 @end deftypevr
18501 @end deftypevr
18502
18503 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
18504 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
18505 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
18506 of the LogLevel setting.
18507
18508 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18509 @end deftypevr
18510
18511 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
18512 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
18513 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
18514
18515 Defaults to @samp{info}.
18516 @end deftypevr
18517
18518 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
18519 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
18520 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
18521
18522 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
18523 @end deftypevr
18524
18525 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
18526 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
18527 the scheduler.
18528
18529 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18530 @end deftypevr
18531
18532 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
18533 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
18534 from a single address.
18535
18536 Defaults to @samp{100}.
18537 @end deftypevr
18538
18539 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
18540 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
18541 job.
18542
18543 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
18544 @end deftypevr
18545
18546 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
18547 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
18548 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
18549 held jobs.
18550
18551 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18552 @end deftypevr
18553
18554 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
18555 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
18556 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
18557
18558 Defaults to @samp{500}.
18559 @end deftypevr
18560
18561 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
18562 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18563 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
18564
18565 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18566 @end deftypevr
18567
18568 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
18569 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
18570 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
18571
18572 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18573 @end deftypevr
18574
18575 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
18576 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
18577 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of ``stuck'' jobs.
18578
18579 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
18580 @end deftypevr
18581
18582 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
18583 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
18584 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
18585
18586 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
18587 @end deftypevr
18588
18589 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
18590 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
18591 multiple file print job, in seconds.
18592
18593 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18594 @end deftypevr
18595
18596 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
18597 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
18598 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
18599 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
18600 sequences are recognized:
18601
18602 @table @samp
18603 @item %%
18604 insert a single percent character
18605
18606 @item %@{name@}
18607 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
18608
18609 @item %C
18610 insert the number of copies for the current page
18611
18612 @item %P
18613 insert the current page number
18614
18615 @item %T
18616 insert the current date and time in common log format
18617
18618 @item %j
18619 insert the job ID
18620
18621 @item %p
18622 insert the printer name
18623
18624 @item %u
18625 insert the username
18626 @end table
18627
18628 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
18629 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
18630 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
18631 standard items.
18632
18633 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18634 @end deftypevr
18635
18636 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
18637 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
18638 of strings.
18639
18640 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18641 @end deftypevr
18642
18643 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
18644 Specifies named access control policies.
18645
18646 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
18647
18648 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
18649 Name of the policy.
18650 @end deftypevr
18651
18652 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
18653 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
18654 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18655 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18656 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18657 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18658 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18659 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18660 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18661 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18662
18663 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18664 @end deftypevr
18665
18666 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
18667 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18668 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18669
18670 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
18671 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
18672 @end deftypevr
18673
18674 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
18675 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
18676 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
18677 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
18678 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
18679 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
18680 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
18681 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
18682 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
18683 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
18684
18685 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
18686 @end deftypevr
18687
18688 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
18689 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
18690 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
18691
18692 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
18693 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
18694 @end deftypevr
18695
18696 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
18697 Access control by IPP operation.
18698
18699 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18700 @end deftypevr
18701 @end deftypevr
18702
18703 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
18704 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
18705 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
18706 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
18707 value applies indefinitely.
18708
18709 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
18710 @end deftypevr
18711
18712 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
18713 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
18714 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
18715 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
18716 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
18717
18718 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18719 @end deftypevr
18720
18721 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
18722 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
18723 restarting the scheduler.
18724
18725 Defaults to @samp{30}.
18726 @end deftypevr
18727
18728 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
18729 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
18730 into bitmaps for a printer.
18731
18732 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
18733 @end deftypevr
18734
18735 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
18736 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
18737
18738 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
18739 @end deftypevr
18740
18741 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
18742 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
18743 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
18744 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
18745 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
18746 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
18747 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
18748 @code{*}.
18749
18750 Defaults to @samp{*}.
18751 @end deftypevr
18752
18753 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
18754 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
18755
18756 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18757 @end deftypevr
18758
18759 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
18760 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
18761 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
18762 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
18763 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
18764 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
18765 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
18766 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
18767
18768 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
18769 @end deftypevr
18770
18771 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
18772 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
18773 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
18774 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
18775 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
18776
18777 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18778 @end deftypevr
18779
18780 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
18781 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
18782 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
18783 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
18784 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
18785 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
18786 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
18787 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
18788 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
18789 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
18790
18791 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18792 @end deftypevr
18793
18794 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
18795 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
18796 the IPP specifications.
18797
18798 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18799 @end deftypevr
18800
18801 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
18802 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
18803
18804 Defaults to @samp{300}.
18805
18806 @end deftypevr
18807
18808 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
18809 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
18810
18811 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18812 @end deftypevr
18813
18814 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
18815 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
18816 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
18817 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
18818 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
18819 @code{cups-service-type}.
18820
18821 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
18822
18823 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
18824 The CUPS package.
18825 @end deftypevr
18826
18827 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
18828 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
18829 @end deftypevr
18830
18831 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
18832 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
18833 @end deftypevr
18834
18835 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
18836 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
18837 this:
18838
18839 @lisp
18840 (service cups-service-type
18841 (opaque-cups-configuration
18842 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
18843 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
18844 @end lisp
18845
18846
18847 @node Desktop Services
18848 @subsection Desktop Services
18849
18850 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
18851 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
18852 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
18853 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
18854 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
18855
18856 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
18857 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
18858 environment and networking:
18859
18860 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
18861 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
18862 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
18863
18864 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
18865 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
18866 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
18867 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
18868 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
18869 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
18870 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
18871 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
18872 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
18873 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
18874 @end defvr
18875
18876 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
18877 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
18878 Reference, @code{services}}).
18879
18880 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
18881 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type},
18882 @code{lxqt-desktop-service-type} and @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type}
18883 procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE and/or Enlightenment to a system. To
18884 ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the backlight adjustment
18885 helpers and the power management utilities are added to the system, extending
18886 @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with
18887 elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose system interfaces.
18888 Additionally, adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds
18889 the GNOME metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce
18890 service not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but
18891 it also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode'' file
18892 management window, if the user authenticates using the administrator's
18893 password via the standard polkit graphical interface. To ``add MATE'' means
18894 that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended appropriately, allowing MATE
18895 to operate with elevated privileges on a limited number of special-purpose
18896 system interfaces. Additionally, adding a service of type
18897 @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE metapackage to the system
18898 profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that @code{dbus} is extended
18899 appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries are set as setuid,
18900 allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other functionality to work as
18901 expected.
18902
18903 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
18904 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
18905 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
18906 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
18907 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM@. Alternatively you can
18908 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
18909 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
18910 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
18911
18912 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
18913 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
18914 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
18915 object (see below).
18916
18917 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
18918 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
18919 @end defvr
18920
18921 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
18922 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
18923
18924 @table @asis
18925 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
18926 The GNOME package to use.
18927 @end table
18928 @end deftp
18929
18930 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
18931 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
18932 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
18933 (see below).
18934
18935 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
18936 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
18937 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
18938 with the administrator's password.
18939
18940 Note that @code{xfce4-panel} and its plugin packages should be installed in
18941 the same profile to ensure compatibility. When using this service, you should
18942 add extra plugins (@code{xfce4-whiskermenu-plugin},
18943 @code{xfce4-weather-plugin}, etc.) to the @code{packages} field of your
18944 @code{operating-system}.
18945 @end defvr
18946
18947 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
18948 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
18949
18950 @table @asis
18951 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
18952 The Xfce package to use.
18953 @end table
18954 @end deftp
18955
18956 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
18957 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
18958 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
18959 object (see below).
18960
18961 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
18962 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
18963 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
18964 @end deffn
18965
18966 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
18967 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
18968
18969 @table @asis
18970 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
18971 The MATE package to use.
18972 @end table
18973 @end deftp
18974
18975 @deffn {Scheme Variable} lxqt-desktop-service-type
18976 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://lxqt.github.io,
18977 LXQt desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{lxqt-desktop-configuration}
18978 object (see below).
18979
18980 This service adds the @code{lxqt} package to the system
18981 profile.
18982 @end deffn
18983
18984 @deftp {Data Type} lxqt-desktop-configuration
18985 Configuration record for the LXQt desktop environment.
18986
18987 @table @asis
18988 @item @code{lxqt} (default: @code{lxqt})
18989 The LXQT package to use.
18990 @end table
18991 @end deftp
18992
18993 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
18994 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
18995 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
18996 @end deffn
18997
18998 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
18999 @table @asis
19000 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
19001 The enlightenment package to use.
19002 @end table
19003 @end deftp
19004
19005 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
19006 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
19007 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
19008 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
19009 @code{operating-system}:
19010
19011 @lisp
19012 (use-modules (gnu))
19013 (use-service-modules desktop)
19014 (operating-system
19015 ...
19016 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
19017 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
19018 (service xfce-desktop-service)
19019 %desktop-services))
19020 ...)
19021 @end lisp
19022
19023 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
19024 graphical login window.
19025
19026 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
19027 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
19028 are described below.
19029
19030 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
19031 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
19032 support for @var{services}.
19033
19034 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
19035 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
19036 and to be notified of system-wide events.
19037
19038 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
19039 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
19040 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
19041 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
19042 @end deffn
19043
19044 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
19045 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
19046 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
19047 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
19048 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
19049 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
19050
19051 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
19052 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
19053 when the power button is pressed.
19054
19055 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
19056 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
19057 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
19058 their default values are:
19059
19060 @table @code
19061 @item kill-user-processes?
19062 @code{#f}
19063 @item kill-only-users
19064 @code{()}
19065 @item kill-exclude-users
19066 @code{("root")}
19067 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
19068 @code{5}
19069 @item handle-power-key
19070 @code{poweroff}
19071 @item handle-suspend-key
19072 @code{suspend}
19073 @item handle-hibernate-key
19074 @code{hibernate}
19075 @item handle-lid-switch
19076 @code{suspend}
19077 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
19078 @code{ignore}
19079 @item handle-lid-switch-external-power
19080 @code{ignore}
19081 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
19082 @code{#f}
19083 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
19084 @code{#f}
19085 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
19086 @code{#f}
19087 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
19088 @code{#t}
19089 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
19090 @code{30}
19091 @item idle-action
19092 @code{ignore}
19093 @item idle-action-seconds
19094 @code{(* 30 60)}
19095 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
19096 @code{10}
19097 @item runtime-directory-size
19098 @code{#f}
19099 @item remove-ipc?
19100 @code{#t}
19101 @item suspend-state
19102 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
19103 @item suspend-mode
19104 @code{()}
19105 @item hibernate-state
19106 @code{("disk")}
19107 @item hibernate-mode
19108 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
19109 @item hybrid-sleep-state
19110 @code{("disk")}
19111 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
19112 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
19113 @end table
19114 @end deffn
19115
19116 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
19117 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
19118 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
19119 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
19120 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
19121 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
19122 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
19123 accountsservice web site} for more information.
19124
19125 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
19126 package to expose as a service.
19127 @end deffn
19128
19129 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
19130 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
19131 Return a service that runs the
19132 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
19133 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
19134 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
19135 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
19136 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
19137 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
19138 @end deffn
19139
19140 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
19141 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
19142 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
19143 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
19144 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
19145 @end defvr
19146
19147 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
19148 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
19149 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
19150 configuration settings.
19151
19152 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
19153 notably used by GNOME.
19154 @end defvr
19155
19156 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
19157 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
19158
19159 @table @asis
19160
19161 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
19162 Package to use for @code{upower}.
19163
19164 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
19165 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
19166
19167 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
19168 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
19169
19170 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
19171 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
19172
19173 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
19174 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
19175 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
19176
19177 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
19178 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19179 at which the battery is considered low.
19180
19181 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
19182 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19183 at which the battery is considered critical.
19184
19185 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
19186 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
19187 at which action will be taken.
19188
19189 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
19190 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19191 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
19192
19193 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
19194 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19195 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
19196
19197 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
19198 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
19199 seconds at which action will be taken.
19200
19201 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
19202 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
19203 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
19204
19205 Possible values are:
19206
19207 @itemize @bullet
19208 @item
19209 @code{'power-off}
19210
19211 @item
19212 @code{'hibernate}
19213
19214 @item
19215 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
19216 @end itemize
19217
19218 @end table
19219 @end deftp
19220
19221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
19222 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
19223 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces
19224 with notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk
19225 to UDisks include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and
19226 GNOME Disks. Note that Udisks relies on the @command{mount} command, so
19227 it will only be able to use the file-system utilities installed in the
19228 system profile. For example if you want to be able to mount NTFS
19229 file-systems in read and write fashion, you'll need to have
19230 @code{ntfs-3g} installed system-wide.
19231 @end deffn
19232
19233 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
19234 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
19235 service with a D-Bus
19236 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
19237 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
19238 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
19239 site} for more information.
19240 @end deffn
19241
19242 @cindex scanner access
19243 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-service-type
19244 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
19245 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary
19246 udev rules. It is included in @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
19247 Services}) and relies by default on @code{sane-backends-minimal} package
19248 (see below) for hardware support.
19249 @end defvr
19250
19251 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends-minimal
19252 The default package which the @code{sane-service-type} installs. It
19253 supports many recent scanners.
19254 @end defvr
19255
19256 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sane-backends
19257 This package includes support for all scanners that
19258 @code{sane-backends-minimal} supports, plus older Hewlett-Packard
19259 scanners supported by @code{hplip} package. In order to use this on
19260 a system which relies on @code{%desktop-services}, you may use
19261 @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service Reference,
19262 @code{modify-services}}) as illustrated below:
19263
19264 @lisp
19265 (use-modules (gnu))
19266 (use-service-modules
19267 @dots{}
19268 desktop)
19269 (use-package-modules
19270 @dots{}
19271 scanner)
19272
19273 (define %my-desktop-services
19274 ;; List of desktop services that supports a broader range of scanners.
19275 (modify-services %desktop-services
19276 (sane-service-type _ => sane-backends)))
19277
19278 (operating-system
19279 @dots{}
19280 (services %my-desktop-services)
19281 @end lisp
19282 @end defvr
19283
19284 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
19285 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
19286 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
19287 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
19288 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
19289 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
19290 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
19291 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
19292 means that all users are allowed.
19293 @end deffn
19294
19295 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
19296 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
19297 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
19298 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
19299 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
19300 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
19301 know the user's location.
19302 @end defvr
19303
19304 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
19305 [#:whitelist '()] @
19306 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
19307 [#:submit-data? #f]
19308 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
19309 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
19310 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
19311 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
19312 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
19313 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
19314 location databases. See
19315 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
19316 web site} for more information.
19317 @end deffn
19318
19319 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
19320 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
19321 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
19322 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
19323 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
19324 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
19325 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
19326
19327 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
19328 @end deffn
19329
19330 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
19331 This is the type of the service that adds the
19332 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
19333 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below).
19334
19335 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
19336 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
19337 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
19338 @end defvr
19339
19340 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
19341 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
19342
19343 @table @asis
19344 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
19345 The GNOME keyring package to use.
19346
19347 @item @code{pam-services}
19348 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
19349 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
19350 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
19351 @code{passwd}.
19352
19353 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
19354 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
19355 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
19356 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
19357 without arguments.
19358
19359 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
19360 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
19361 @end table
19362 @end deftp
19363
19364
19365 @node Sound Services
19366 @subsection Sound Services
19367
19368 @cindex sound support
19369 @cindex ALSA
19370 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
19371
19372 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
19373 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
19374 preferred ALSA output driver.
19375
19376 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
19377 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
19378 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
19379 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
19380 record as in this example:
19381
19382 @lisp
19383 (service alsa-service-type)
19384 @end lisp
19385
19386 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
19387 @end deffn
19388
19389 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
19390 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
19391
19392 @table @asis
19393 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
19394 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
19395
19396 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
19397 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
19398 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
19399
19400 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
19401 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
19402 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
19403
19404 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
19405 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
19406
19407 @end table
19408 @end deftp
19409
19410 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
19411 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
19412
19413 @example
19414 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
19415 pcm_type.jack @{
19416 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
19417 @}
19418
19419 # Routing ALSA to jack:
19420 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
19421 pcm.rawjack @{
19422 type jack
19423 playback_ports @{
19424 0 system:playback_1
19425 1 system:playback_2
19426 @}
19427
19428 capture_ports @{
19429 0 system:capture_1
19430 1 system:capture_2
19431 @}
19432 @}
19433
19434 pcm.!default @{
19435 type plug
19436 slave @{
19437 pcm "rawjack"
19438 @}
19439 @}
19440 @end example
19441
19442 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
19443 details.
19444
19445 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
19446 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
19447 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
19448 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
19449
19450 @quotation Warning
19451 This service overrides per-user configuration files. If you want
19452 PulseAudio to honor configuration files in @file{~/.config/pulse} you
19453 have to unset the environment variables @env{PULSE_CONFIG} and
19454 @env{PULSE_CLIENTCONFIG} in your @file{~/.bash_profile}.
19455 @end quotation
19456
19457 @quotation Warning
19458 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
19459 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
19460 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
19461 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
19462 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
19463 @end quotation
19464 @end deffn
19465
19466 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
19467 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
19468
19469 @table @asis
19470 @item @code{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
19471 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
19472 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
19473 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
19474 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
19475
19476 @item @code{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
19477 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
19478 @var{client-conf}.
19479
19480 @item @code{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
19481 Script file to use as @file{default.pa}.
19482
19483 @item @code{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
19484 Script file to use as @file{system.pa}.
19485 @end table
19486 @end deftp
19487
19488 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
19489 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
19490 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
19491
19492 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
19493 @code{swh-plugins} package:
19494
19495 @lisp
19496 (service ladspa-service-type
19497 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
19498 @end lisp
19499
19500 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
19501 details.
19502
19503 @end deffn
19504
19505 @node Database Services
19506 @subsection Database Services
19507
19508 @cindex database
19509 @cindex SQL
19510 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
19511
19512 @subsubheading PostgreSQL
19513
19514 The following example describes a PostgreSQL service with the default
19515 configuration.
19516
19517 @lisp
19518 (service postgresql-service-type
19519 (postgresql-configuration
19520 (postgresql postgresql-10)))
19521 @end lisp
19522
19523 If the services fails to start, it may be due to an incompatible
19524 cluster already present in @var{data-directory}. Adjust it (or, if you
19525 don't need the cluster anymore, delete @var{data-directory}), then
19526 restart the service.
19527
19528 Peer authentication is used by default and the @code{postgres} user
19529 account has no shell, which prevents the direct execution of @code{psql}
19530 commands as this user. To use @code{psql}, you can temporarily log in
19531 as @code{postgres} using a shell, create a PostgreSQL superuser with the
19532 same name as one of the system users and then create the associated
19533 database.
19534
19535 @example
19536 sudo -u postgres -s /bin/sh
19537 createuser --interactive
19538 createdb $MY_USER_LOGIN # Replace appropriately.
19539 @end example
19540
19541 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-configuration
19542 Data type representing the configuration for the
19543 @code{postgresql-service-type}.
19544
19545 @table @asis
19546 @item @code{postgresql}
19547 PostgreSQL package to use for the service.
19548
19549 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5432})
19550 Port on which PostgreSQL should listen.
19551
19552 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
19553 Locale to use as the default when creating the database cluster.
19554
19555 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(postgresql-config-file)})
19556 The configuration file to use when running PostgreSQL@. The default
19557 behaviour uses the postgresql-config-file record with the default values
19558 for the fields.
19559
19560 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql"})
19561 The directory where @command{pg_ctl} output will be written in a file
19562 named @code{"pg_ctl.log"}. This file can be useful to debug PostgreSQL
19563 configuration errors for instance.
19564
19565 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/postgresql/data"})
19566 Directory in which to store the data.
19567
19568 @item @code{extension-packages} (default: @code{'()})
19569 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
19570 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
19571 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
19572 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
19573 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
19574
19575 @cindex postgis
19576 @lisp
19577 (use-package-modules databases geo)
19578
19579 (operating-system
19580 ...
19581 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
19582 ;; proper operation.
19583 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
19584 (services
19585 (cons*
19586 (service postgresql-service-type
19587 (postgresql-configuration
19588 (postgresql postgresql-10)
19589 (extension-packages (list postgis))))
19590 %base-services)))
19591 @end lisp
19592
19593 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
19594 database in this way:
19595
19596 @example
19597 psql -U postgres
19598 > create database postgistest;
19599 > \connect postgistest;
19600 > create extension postgis;
19601 > create extension postgis_topology;
19602 @end example
19603
19604 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
19605 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
19606 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
19607
19608 @end table
19609 @end deftp
19610
19611 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-config-file
19612 Data type representing the PostgreSQL configuration file. As shown in
19613 the following example, this can be used to customize the configuration
19614 of PostgreSQL@. Note that you can use any G-expression or filename in
19615 place of this record, if you already have a configuration file you'd
19616 like to use for example.
19617
19618 @lisp
19619 (service postgresql-service-type
19620 (postgresql-configuration
19621 (config-file
19622 (postgresql-config-file
19623 (log-destination "stderr")
19624 (hba-file
19625 (plain-file "pg_hba.conf"
19626 "
19627 local all all trust
19628 host all all 127.0.0.1/32 md5
19629 host all all ::1/128 md5"))
19630 (extra-config
19631 '(("session_preload_libraries" "auto_explain")
19632 ("random_page_cost" 2)
19633 ("auto_explain.log_min_duration" "100 ms")
19634 ("work_mem" "500 MB")
19635 ("logging_collector" #t)
19636 ("log_directory" "/var/log/postgresql")))))))
19637 @end lisp
19638
19639 @table @asis
19640 @item @code{log-destination} (default: @code{"syslog"})
19641 The logging method to use for PostgreSQL@. Multiple values are accepted,
19642 separated by commas.
19643
19644 @item @code{hba-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-hba})
19645 Filename or G-expression for the host-based authentication
19646 configuration.
19647
19648 @item @code{ident-file} (default: @code{%default-postgres-ident})
19649 Filename or G-expression for the user name mapping configuration.
19650
19651 @item @code{socket-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
19652 Specifies the directory of the Unix-domain socket(s) on which PostgreSQL
19653 is to listen for connections from client applications. If set to
19654 @code{#false} PostgreSQL does not listen on any Unix-domain sockets, in
19655 which case only TCP/IP sockets can be used to connect to the server.
19656
19657 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
19658 List of additional keys and values to include in the PostgreSQL config
19659 file. Each entry in the list should be a list where the first element
19660 is the key, and the remaining elements are the values.
19661
19662 The values can be numbers, booleans or strings and will be mapped to
19663 PostgreSQL parameters types @code{Boolean}, @code{String},
19664 @code{Numeric}, @code{Numeric with Unit} and @code{Enumerated} described
19665 @uref{https://www.postgresql.org/docs/current/config-setting.html,
19666 here}.
19667
19668 @end table
19669 @end deftp
19670
19671 @deffn {Scheme Variable} postgresql-role-service-type
19672 This service allows to create PostgreSQL roles and databases after
19673 PostgreSQL service start. Here is an example of its use.
19674
19675 @lisp
19676 (service postgresql-role-service-type
19677 (postgresql-role-configuration
19678 (roles
19679 (list (postgresql-role
19680 (name "test")
19681 (create-database? #t))))))
19682 @end lisp
19683
19684 This service can be extended with extra roles, as in this
19685 example:
19686
19687 @lisp
19688 (service-extension postgresql-role-service-type
19689 (const (postgresql-role
19690 (name "alice")
19691 (create-database? #t))))
19692 @end lisp
19693 @end deffn
19694
19695 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role
19696 PostgreSQL manages database access permissions using the concept of
19697 roles. A role can be thought of as either a database user, or a group
19698 of database users, depending on how the role is set up. Roles can own
19699 database objects (for example, tables) and can assign privileges on
19700 those objects to other roles to control who has access to which objects.
19701
19702 @table @asis
19703 @item @code{name}
19704 The role name.
19705
19706 @item @code{permissions} (default: @code{'(createdb login)})
19707 The role permissions list. Supported permissions are @code{bypassrls},
19708 @code{createdb}, @code{createrole}, @code{login}, @code{replication} and
19709 @code{superuser}.
19710
19711 @item @code{create-database?} (default: @code{#f})
19712 Whether to create a database with the same name as the role.
19713
19714 @end table
19715 @end deftp
19716
19717 @deftp {Data Type} postgresql-role-configuration
19718 Data type representing the configuration of
19719 @var{postgresql-role-service-type}.
19720
19721 @table @asis
19722 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"/var/run/postgresql"})
19723 The PostgreSQL host to connect to.
19724
19725 @item @code{log} (default: @code{"/var/log/postgresql_roles.log"})
19726 File name of the log file.
19727
19728 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'()})
19729 The initial PostgreSQL roles to create.
19730 @end table
19731 @end deftp
19732
19733 @subsubheading MariaDB/MySQL
19734
19735 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mysql-service-type
19736 This is the service type for a MySQL or MariaDB database server. Its value
19737 is a @code{mysql-configuration} object that specifies which package to use,
19738 as well as various settings for the @command{mysqld} daemon.
19739 @end defvr
19740
19741 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
19742 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service-type}.
19743
19744 @table @asis
19745 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
19746 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
19747 or @var{mysql}.
19748
19749 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
19750 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
19751
19752 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19753 The IP on which to listen for network connections. Use @code{"0.0.0.0"}
19754 to bind to all available network interfaces.
19755
19756 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
19757 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
19758
19759 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{"/run/mysqld/mysqld.sock"})
19760 Socket file to use for local (non-network) connections.
19761
19762 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19763 Additional settings for the @file{my.cnf} configuration file.
19764
19765 @item @code{auto-upgrade?} (default: @code{#t})
19766 Whether to automatically run @command{mysql_upgrade} after starting the
19767 service. This is necessary to upgrade the @dfn{system schema} after
19768 ``major'' updates (such as switching from MariaDB 10.4 to 10.5), but can
19769 be disabled if you would rather do that manually.
19770
19771 @end table
19772 @end deftp
19773
19774 @subsubheading Memcached
19775
19776 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
19777 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
19778 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
19779 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
19780 @end defvr
19781
19782 @lisp
19783 (service memcached-service-type)
19784 @end lisp
19785
19786 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
19787 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
19788
19789 @table @asis
19790 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
19791 The Memcached package to use.
19792
19793 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
19794 Network interfaces on which to listen.
19795
19796 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19797 Port on which to accept connections.
19798
19799 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
19800 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19801 listening on a UDP socket.
19802
19803 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
19804 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
19805 @end table
19806 @end deftp
19807
19808 @subsubheading MongoDB
19809
19810 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
19811 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
19812 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
19813 @end defvr
19814
19815 @lisp
19816 (service mongodb-service-type)
19817 @end lisp
19818
19819 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
19820 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
19821
19822 @table @asis
19823 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
19824 The MongoDB package to use.
19825
19826 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
19827 The configuration file for MongoDB.
19828
19829 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
19830 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
19831 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
19832 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
19833 @end table
19834 @end deftp
19835
19836 @subsubheading Redis
19837
19838 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
19839 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
19840 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
19841 @end defvr
19842
19843 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
19844 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
19845
19846 @table @asis
19847 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
19848 The Redis package to use.
19849
19850 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
19851 Network interface on which to listen.
19852
19853 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
19854 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
19855 listening on a TCP socket.
19856
19857 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
19858 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
19859 @end table
19860 @end deftp
19861
19862 @node Mail Services
19863 @subsection Mail Services
19864
19865 @cindex mail
19866 @cindex email
19867 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
19868 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
19869 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
19870 in the subsections below.
19871
19872 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
19873
19874 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
19875 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
19876 @end deffn
19877
19878 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
19879 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
19880 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
19881 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
19882 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
19883 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
19884 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
19885 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
19886
19887 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
19888 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
19889
19890 @lisp
19891 (dovecot-service #:config
19892 (dovecot-configuration
19893 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
19894 @end lisp
19895
19896 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
19897 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
19898 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
19899 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
19900 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
19901 from some other system; see the end for more details.
19902
19903 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
19904 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
19905 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
19906 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
19907 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
19908 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
19909 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
19910
19911 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
19912
19913 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
19914 The dovecot package.
19915 @end deftypevr
19916
19917 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
19918 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
19919 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
19920 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
19921 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
19922 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
19923 @end deftypevr
19924
19925 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
19926 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
19927 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
19928
19929 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
19930
19931 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
19932 The name of the protocol.
19933 @end deftypevr
19934
19935 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
19936 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
19937 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
19938 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
19939 @end deftypevr
19940
19941 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
19942 Space separated list of plugins to load.
19943 @end deftypevr
19944
19945 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
19946 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
19947 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
19948 Defaults to @samp{10}.
19949 @end deftypevr
19950
19951 @end deftypevr
19952
19953 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
19954 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
19955 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
19956 @samp{lmtp}.
19957
19958 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
19959
19960 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
19961 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
19962 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
19963 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
19964 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
19965 @end deftypevr
19966
19967 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
19968 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
19969 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
19970 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
19971 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19972
19973 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
19974
19975 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19976 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
19977 the section name.
19978 @end deftypevr
19979
19980 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
19981 The access mode for the socket.
19982 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
19983 @end deftypevr
19984
19985 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
19986 The user to own the socket.
19987 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19988 @end deftypevr
19989
19990 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
19991 The group to own the socket.
19992 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19993 @end deftypevr
19994
19995
19996 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
19997
19998 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
19999 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
20000 the section name.
20001 @end deftypevr
20002
20003 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
20004 The access mode for the socket.
20005 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
20006 @end deftypevr
20007
20008 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
20009 The user to own the socket.
20010 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20011 @end deftypevr
20012
20013 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
20014 The group to own the socket.
20015 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20016 @end deftypevr
20017
20018
20019 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
20020
20021 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
20022 The protocol to listen for.
20023 @end deftypevr
20024
20025 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
20026 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
20027 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20028 @end deftypevr
20029
20030 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
20031 The port on which to listen.
20032 @end deftypevr
20033
20034 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
20035 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
20036 @samp{required}.
20037 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20038 @end deftypevr
20039
20040 @end deftypevr
20041
20042 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
20043 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
20044 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
20045 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
20046 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
20047
20048 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20049
20050 @end deftypevr
20051
20052 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
20053 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
20054 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
20055 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
20056 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20057
20058 @end deftypevr
20059
20060 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
20061 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
20062 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
20063
20064 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20065
20066 @end deftypevr
20067
20068 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
20069 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
20070 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20071 @end deftypevr
20072
20073 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
20074 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
20075 this.
20076 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20077 @end deftypevr
20078
20079 @end deftypevr
20080
20081 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
20082 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
20083 constructor.
20084
20085 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
20086
20087 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
20088 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
20089 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20090 @end deftypevr
20091
20092 @end deftypevr
20093
20094 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
20095 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
20096 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
20097
20098 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
20099
20100 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20101 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
20102 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
20103 @samp{static}.
20104 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
20105 @end deftypevr
20106
20107 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20108 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
20109 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20110 @end deftypevr
20111
20112 @end deftypevr
20113
20114 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
20115 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
20116 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
20117
20118 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
20119
20120 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
20121 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
20122 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
20123 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
20124 @end deftypevr
20125
20126 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
20127 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
20128 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20129 @end deftypevr
20130
20131 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
20132 Override fields from passwd.
20133 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20134 @end deftypevr
20135
20136 @end deftypevr
20137
20138 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
20139 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
20140 constructor.
20141 @end deftypevr
20142
20143 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
20144 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
20145 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
20146
20147 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
20148
20149 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
20150 Name for this namespace.
20151 @end deftypevr
20152
20153 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
20154 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
20155 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
20156 @end deftypevr
20157
20158 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
20159 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
20160 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
20161 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
20162 format.
20163 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20164 @end deftypevr
20165
20166 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
20167 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
20168 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
20169 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20170 @end deftypevr
20171
20172 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
20173 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
20174 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
20175 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20176 @end deftypevr
20177
20178 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
20179 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
20180 namespace has it.
20181 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20182 @end deftypevr
20183
20184 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
20185 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
20186 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
20187 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
20188 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
20189 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
20190 and @samp{mail/}.
20191 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20192 @end deftypevr
20193
20194 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
20195 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
20196 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
20197 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
20198 hides the namespace prefix.
20199 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20200 @end deftypevr
20201
20202 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
20203 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
20204 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
20205 as @code{#t}).
20206 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20207 @end deftypevr
20208
20209 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
20210 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
20211 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20212
20213 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
20214
20215 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
20216 Name for this mailbox.
20217 @end deftypevr
20218
20219 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
20220 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
20221 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
20222 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20223 @end deftypevr
20224
20225 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
20226 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
20227 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
20228 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
20229 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20230 @end deftypevr
20231
20232 @end deftypevr
20233
20234 @end deftypevr
20235
20236 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
20237 Base directory where to store runtime data.
20238 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
20239 @end deftypevr
20240
20241 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
20242 Greeting message for clients.
20243 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
20244 @end deftypevr
20245
20246 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
20247 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
20248 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
20249 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
20250 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
20251 here.
20252 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20253 @end deftypevr
20254
20255 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
20256 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
20257 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20258 @end deftypevr
20259
20260 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
20261 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
20262 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
20263 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
20264 accounts).
20265 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20266 @end deftypevr
20267
20268 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
20269 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
20270 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
20271 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
20272 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
20273 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20274 @end deftypevr
20275
20276 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
20277 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
20278 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
20279 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20280 @end deftypevr
20281
20282 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
20283 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
20284 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
20285 @end deftypevr
20286
20287 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
20288 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
20289 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
20290 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
20291 @end deftypevr
20292
20293 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
20294 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
20295 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
20296 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
20297 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
20298 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
20299 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20300 @end deftypevr
20301
20302 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
20303 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
20304 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
20305 for caching to be used.
20306 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20307 @end deftypevr
20308
20309 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
20310 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
20311 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
20312 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
20313 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
20314 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
20315 authentication.
20316 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20317 @end deftypevr
20318
20319 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
20320 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
20321 0 disables caching them completely.
20322 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
20323 @end deftypevr
20324
20325 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
20326 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
20327 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
20328 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
20329 realm first.
20330 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20331 @end deftypevr
20332
20333 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
20334 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
20335 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
20336 logins.
20337 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20338 @end deftypevr
20339
20340 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
20341 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
20342 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
20343 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
20344 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
20345 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
20346 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
20347 @end deftypevr
20348
20349 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
20350 Username character translations before it's looked up from
20351 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
20352 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
20353 translated to @samp{@@}.
20354 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20355 @end deftypevr
20356
20357 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
20358 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
20359 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
20360 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
20361 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
20362 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
20363 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20364 @end deftypevr
20365
20366 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
20367 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
20368 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
20369 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
20370 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
20371 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
20372 choice.
20373 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20374 @end deftypevr
20375
20376 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
20377 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
20378 mechanism.
20379 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
20380 @end deftypevr
20381
20382 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
20383 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
20384 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
20385 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
20386 Defaults to @samp{30}.
20387 @end deftypevr
20388
20389 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
20390 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
20391 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
20392 allow all keytab entries.
20393 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20394 @end deftypevr
20395
20396 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
20397 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
20398 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
20399 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
20400 file.
20401 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20402 @end deftypevr
20403
20404 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
20405 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
20406 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
20407 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
20408 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20409 @end deftypevr
20410
20411 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
20412 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
20413 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
20414 @end deftypevr
20415
20416 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
20417 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
20418 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
20419 @end deftypevr
20420
20421 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
20422 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
20423 fails.
20424 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20425 @end deftypevr
20426
20427 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
20428 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
20429 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
20430 CommonName.
20431 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20432 @end deftypevr
20433
20434 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
20435 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
20436 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
20437 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
20438 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
20439 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
20440 @end deftypevr
20441
20442 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
20443 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
20444 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
20445 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
20446 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20447 @end deftypevr
20448
20449 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
20450 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
20451 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
20452 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20453 @end deftypevr
20454
20455 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
20456 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
20457 has any connections.
20458 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
20459 @end deftypevr
20460
20461 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
20462 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
20463 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
20464 are shared within domain.
20465 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
20466 @end deftypevr
20467
20468 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
20469 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
20470 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
20471 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
20472 @end deftypevr
20473
20474 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
20475 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
20476 @samp{log-path}.
20477 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20478 @end deftypevr
20479
20480 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
20481 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
20482 @samp{info-log-path}.
20483 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20484 @end deftypevr
20485
20486 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
20487 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
20488 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
20489 standard facilities are supported.
20490 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
20491 @end deftypevr
20492
20493 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
20494 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
20495 failed.
20496 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20497 @end deftypevr
20498
20499 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
20500 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
20501 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
20502 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
20503 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
20504 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
20505 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
20506 @end deftypevr
20507
20508 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
20509 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
20510 SQL queries.
20511 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20512 @end deftypevr
20513
20514 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
20515 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
20516 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
20517 @samp{auth-debug}.
20518 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20519 @end deftypevr
20520
20521 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
20522 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
20523 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
20524 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20525 @end deftypevr
20526
20527 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
20528 Show protocol level SSL errors.
20529 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20530 @end deftypevr
20531
20532 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
20533 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
20534 strftime(3) format.
20535 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
20536 @end deftypevr
20537
20538 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
20539 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
20540 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
20541 string.
20542 @end deftypevr
20543
20544 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
20545 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
20546 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
20547 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
20548 @end deftypevr
20549
20550 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
20551 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
20552 of possible variables you can use.
20553 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
20554 @end deftypevr
20555
20556 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
20557 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
20558 @table @code
20559 @item %$
20560 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
20561 @item %m
20562 Message-ID
20563 @item %s
20564 Subject
20565 @item %f
20566 From address
20567 @item %p
20568 Physical size
20569 @item %w
20570 Virtual size.
20571 @end table
20572 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
20573 @end deftypevr
20574
20575 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
20576 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
20577 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
20578 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
20579 Dovecot the full location.
20580
20581 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
20582 file (e.g.@: @file{/var/mail/%u}) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
20583 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the @emph{root mail
20584 directory}, and it must be the first path given in the
20585 @samp{mail-location} setting.
20586
20587 There are a few special variables you can use, e.g.:
20588
20589 @table @samp
20590 @item %u
20591 username
20592 @item %n
20593 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
20594 @item %d
20595 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
20596 @item %h
20597 home director
20598 @end table
20599
20600 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
20601 @table @samp
20602 @item maildir:~/Maildir
20603 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
20604 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
20605 @end table
20606 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20607 @end deftypevr
20608
20609 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
20610 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
20611 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
20612 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
20613 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20614 @end deftypevr
20615
20616 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
20617
20618 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20619 @end deftypevr
20620
20621 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
20622 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
20623 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
20624 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to @samp{"mail"} to give access to
20625 @file{/var/mail}.
20626 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20627 @end deftypevr
20628
20629 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
20630 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
20631 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
20632 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create symlinks
20633 (e.g.@: if @samp{mail} group is set here, @code{ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var}
20634 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or @code{ln -s
20635 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox} would allow reading it). Defaults to
20636 @samp{""}.
20637 @end deftypevr
20638
20639 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
20640 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
20641 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID@. It
20642 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
20643 names with e.g.@: @file{/path/} or @file{~user/}.
20644 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20645 @end deftypevr
20646
20647 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
20648 Don't use @code{mmap()} at all. This is required if you store indexes to
20649 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
20650 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20651 @end deftypevr
20652
20653 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
20654 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
20655 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
20656 nowadays by default.
20657 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20658 @end deftypevr
20659
20660 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
20661 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
20662 @table @code
20663 @item optimized
20664 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
20665 @item always
20666 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when @code{write()}s are delayed
20667 @item never
20668 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
20669 @end table
20670 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
20671 @end deftypevr
20672
20673 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
20674 Mail storage exists in NFS@. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
20675 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
20676 this isn't needed.
20677 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20678 @end deftypevr
20679
20680 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
20681 Mail index files also exist in NFS@. Setting this to yes requires
20682 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
20683 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20684 @end deftypevr
20685
20686 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
20687 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
20688 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
20689 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
20690 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
20691 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
20692 @end deftypevr
20693
20694 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
20695 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
20696 kB.
20697 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
20698 @end deftypevr
20699
20700 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
20701 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
20702 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
20703 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
20704 is set to 0.
20705 Defaults to @samp{500}.
20706 @end deftypevr
20707
20708 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
20709
20710 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20711 @end deftypevr
20712
20713 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
20714 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
20715 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
20716 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
20717 Defaults to @samp{1}.
20718 @end deftypevr
20719
20720 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
20721
20722 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20723 @end deftypevr
20724
20725 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
20726 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
20727 trying to create new keywords.
20728 Defaults to @samp{50}.
20729 @end deftypevr
20730
20731 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
20732 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
20733 processes (i.e.@: @file{/var/mail} will allow chrooting to @file{/var/mail/foo/bar}
20734 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
20735 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
20736 @samp{/./} in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
20737 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
20738 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
20739 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20740 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20741 @end deftypevr
20742
20743 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
20744 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
20745 for specific users in user database by giving @samp{/./} in user's home
20746 directory (e.g.@: @samp{/home/./user} chroots into @file{/home}). Note that usually
20747 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
20748 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
20749 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append @samp{/.} to
20750 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
20751 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20752 @end deftypevr
20753
20754 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
20755 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
20756 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
20757 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
20758 @end deftypevr
20759
20760 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
20761 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
20762 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
20763 @end deftypevr
20764
20765 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
20766 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
20767 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
20768 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20769 @end deftypevr
20770
20771 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
20772 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
20773 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
20774 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
20775 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20776 @end deftypevr
20777
20778 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
20779 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
20780 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
20781 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
20782 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
20783 occur.
20784 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
20785 @end deftypevr
20786
20787 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
20788 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF@. This makes sending those
20789 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
20790 FreeBSD@. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
20791 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
20792 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
20793 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20794 @end deftypevr
20795
20796 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
20797 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
20798 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
20799 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
20800 causes more disk I/O.
20801 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
20802 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
20803 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20804 @end deftypevr
20805
20806 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
20807 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
20808 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
20809 side effects.
20810 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20811 @end deftypevr
20812
20813 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
20814 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
20815 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
20816 the mail otherwise.
20817 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20818 @end deftypevr
20819
20820 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
20821 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
20822 available:
20823
20824 @table @code
20825 @item dotlock
20826 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
20827 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
20828 need write access to that directory.
20829 @item dotlock-try
20830 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
20831 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
20832 @item fcntl
20833 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
20834 @item flock
20835 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20836 @item lockf
20837 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
20838 @end table
20839
20840 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
20841 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
20842 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
20843 them simultaneously.
20844 @end deftypevr
20845
20846 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
20847
20848 @end deftypevr
20849
20850 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
20851 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
20852 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
20853 @end deftypevr
20854
20855 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
20856 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
20857 override the lock file after this much time.
20858 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
20859 @end deftypevr
20860
20861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
20862 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
20863 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
20864 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
20865 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
20866 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
20867 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
20868 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
20869 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
20870 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
20871 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20872 @end deftypevr
20873
20874 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
20875 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
20876 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
20877 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
20878 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20879 @end deftypevr
20880
20881 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
20882 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
20883 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
20884 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
20885 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
20886 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20887 @end deftypevr
20888
20889 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
20890 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
20891 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
20892 updated.
20893 Defaults to @samp{0}.
20894 @end deftypevr
20895
20896 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
20897 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
20898 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
20899 @end deftypevr
20900
20901 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
20902 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
20903 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
20904 disabled.
20905 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
20906 @end deftypevr
20907
20908 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
20909 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
20910 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
20911 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
20912 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20913 @end deftypevr
20914
20915 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
20916 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
20917 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
20918 don't support this for now.
20919
20920 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
20921
20922 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
20923 Defaults to @samp{""}.
20924 @end deftypevr
20925
20926 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
20927 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
20928 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
20929 externally.
20930 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
20931 @end deftypevr
20932
20933 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
20934 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
20935 @table @code
20936 @item posix
20937 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
20938 @item sis posix
20939 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
20940 @item sis-queue posix
20941 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
20942 @end table
20943 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
20944 @end deftypevr
20945
20946 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
20947 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
20948 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
20949 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
20950 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
20951 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
20952 @end deftypevr
20953
20954 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
20955
20956 Defaults to @samp{100}.
20957 @end deftypevr
20958
20959 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
20960
20961 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
20962 @end deftypevr
20963
20964 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
20965 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
20966 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
20967 before they eat up everything.
20968 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
20969 @end deftypevr
20970
20971 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
20972 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
20973 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
20974 at all.
20975 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
20976 @end deftypevr
20977
20978 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
20979 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
20980 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
20981 processes.
20982 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
20983 @end deftypevr
20984
20985 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
20986 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
20987 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
20988 @end deftypevr
20989
20990 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
20991 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
20992 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
20993 @end deftypevr
20994
20995 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
20996 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
20997 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
20998 root.
20999 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
21000 @end deftypevr
21001
21002 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
21003 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
21004 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
21005 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
21006 instead to a different.
21007 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21008 @end deftypevr
21009
21010 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
21011 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
21012 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
21013 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
21014 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
21015 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21016 @end deftypevr
21017
21018 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
21019 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
21020 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21021 @end deftypevr
21022
21023 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
21024 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
21025 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
21026 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21027 @end deftypevr
21028
21029 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
21030 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
21031 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
21032 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
21033 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
21034 @end deftypevr
21035
21036 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
21037 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
21038 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
21039 @end deftypevr
21040
21041 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
21042 SSL ciphers to use.
21043 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
21044 @end deftypevr
21045
21046 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
21047 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
21048 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21049 @end deftypevr
21050
21051 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
21052 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
21053 %d expands to recipient domain.
21054 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
21055 @end deftypevr
21056
21057 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
21058 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
21059 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
21060 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21061 @end deftypevr
21062
21063 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
21064 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
21065 bouncing the mail.
21066 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21067 @end deftypevr
21068
21069 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
21070 Binary to use for sending mails.
21071 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
21072 @end deftypevr
21073
21074 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
21075 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
21076 sendmail.
21077 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21078 @end deftypevr
21079
21080 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
21081 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
21082 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
21083 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
21084 @end deftypevr
21085
21086 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
21087 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
21088 variables:
21089
21090 @table @code
21091 @item %n
21092 CRLF
21093 @item %r
21094 reason
21095 @item %s
21096 original subject
21097 @item %t
21098 recipient
21099 @end table
21100 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
21101 @end deftypevr
21102
21103 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
21104 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
21105 address.
21106 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
21107 @end deftypevr
21108
21109 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
21110 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
21111 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
21112 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
21113 X-Original-To.
21114 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21115 @end deftypevr
21116
21117 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
21118 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
21119 it?.
21120 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21121 @end deftypevr
21122
21123 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
21124 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
21125 subscribed?.
21126 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21127 @end deftypevr
21128
21129 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
21130 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
21131 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
21132 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
21133 often.
21134 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
21135 @end deftypevr
21136
21137 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
21138 IMAP logout format string:
21139 @table @code
21140 @item %i
21141 total number of bytes read from client
21142 @item %o
21143 total number of bytes sent to client.
21144 @end table
21145 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
21146 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
21147 @end deftypevr
21148
21149 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
21150 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
21151 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
21152 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21153 @end deftypevr
21154
21155 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
21156 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
21157 is IDLEing.
21158 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
21159 @end deftypevr
21160
21161 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
21162 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
21163 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
21164 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
21165 support-email.
21166 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21167 @end deftypevr
21168
21169 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
21170 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
21171 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21172 @end deftypevr
21173
21174 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
21175 Workarounds for various client bugs:
21176
21177 @table @code
21178 @item delay-newmail
21179 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
21180 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
21181 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
21182 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
21183 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
21184 "Headers Only".
21185
21186 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
21187 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
21188 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
21189 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
21190
21191 @item tb-lsub-flags
21192 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
21193 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
21194 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
21195 @end table
21196 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21197 @end deftypevr
21198
21199 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
21200 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
21201 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21202 @end deftypevr
21203
21204
21205 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
21206 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
21207 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
21208 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
21209 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
21210
21211 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
21212 and running. In that case, you can pass an
21213 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
21214 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
21215 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
21216
21217 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
21218
21219 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
21220 The dovecot package.
21221 @end deftypevr
21222
21223 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
21224 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
21225 @end deftypevr
21226
21227 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
21228 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
21229
21230 @lisp
21231 (dovecot-service #:config
21232 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
21233 (string "")))
21234 @end lisp
21235
21236 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
21237
21238 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
21239 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
21240 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
21241 as in this example:
21242
21243 @lisp
21244 (service opensmtpd-service-type
21245 (opensmtpd-configuration
21246 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
21247 @end lisp
21248 @end deffn
21249
21250 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
21251 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
21252
21253 @table @asis
21254 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
21255 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
21256
21257 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
21258 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
21259 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
21260 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
21261 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
21262
21263 @end table
21264 @end deftp
21265
21266 @subsubheading Exim Service
21267
21268 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
21269 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
21270 @cindex SMTP
21271
21272 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
21273 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
21274 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
21275 as in this example:
21276
21277 @lisp
21278 (service exim-service-type
21279 (exim-configuration
21280 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
21281 @end lisp
21282 @end deffn
21283
21284 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
21285 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
21286 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
21287
21288 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
21289 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
21290
21291 @table @asis
21292 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
21293 Package object of the Exim server.
21294
21295 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
21296 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
21297 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
21298 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
21299 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
21300 variables.
21301
21302 @end table
21303 @end deftp
21304
21305 @subsubheading Getmail service
21306
21307 @cindex IMAP
21308 @cindex POP
21309
21310 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
21311 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
21312 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
21313 @end deffn
21314
21315 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
21316
21317 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
21318 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
21319
21320 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
21321
21322 @end deftypevr
21323
21324 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
21325 The getmail package to use.
21326
21327 @end deftypevr
21328
21329 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
21330 The user to run getmail as.
21331
21332 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21333
21334 @end deftypevr
21335
21336 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
21337 The group to run getmail as.
21338
21339 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
21340
21341 @end deftypevr
21342
21343 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
21344 The getmail directory to use.
21345
21346 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
21347
21348 @end deftypevr
21349
21350 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
21351 The getmail configuration file to use.
21352
21353 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
21354
21355 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
21356 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
21357
21358 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
21359
21360 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
21361 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
21362 and @samp{static}.
21363
21364 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
21365
21366 @end deftypevr
21367
21368 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
21369 Username to login to the mail server with.
21370
21371 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21372
21373 @end deftypevr
21374
21375 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
21376 Username to login to the mail server with.
21377
21378 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21379
21380 @end deftypevr
21381
21382 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
21383 Port number to connect to.
21384
21385 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21386
21387 @end deftypevr
21388
21389 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
21390 Override fields from passwd.
21391
21392 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21393
21394 @end deftypevr
21395
21396 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
21397 Override fields from passwd.
21398
21399 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21400
21401 @end deftypevr
21402
21403 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
21404 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21405
21406 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21407
21408 @end deftypevr
21409
21410 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
21411 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
21412
21413 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21414
21415 @end deftypevr
21416
21417 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
21418 CA certificates to use.
21419
21420 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21421
21422 @end deftypevr
21423
21424 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21425 Extra retriever parameters.
21426
21427 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21428
21429 @end deftypevr
21430
21431 @end deftypevr
21432
21433 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
21434 What to do with retrieved messages.
21435
21436 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
21437
21438 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
21439 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
21440 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
21441
21442 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
21443
21444 @end deftypevr
21445
21446 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
21447 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
21448 chosen type.
21449
21450 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21451
21452 @end deftypevr
21453
21454 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21455 Extra destination parameters
21456
21457 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21458
21459 @end deftypevr
21460
21461 @end deftypevr
21462
21463 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
21464 Configure getmail.
21465
21466 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
21467
21468 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
21469 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
21470 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
21471 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
21472 about each of it's actions.
21473
21474 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21475
21476 @end deftypevr
21477
21478 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
21479 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
21480 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
21481
21482 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21483
21484 @end deftypevr
21485
21486 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
21487 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
21488 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
21489 be left on the server.
21490
21491 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21492
21493 @end deftypevr
21494
21495 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
21496 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
21497 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
21498 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
21499 disabled this feature.
21500
21501 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21502
21503 @end deftypevr
21504
21505 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
21506 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
21507 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
21508 disables this feature.
21509
21510 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21511
21512 @end deftypevr
21513
21514 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
21515 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
21516 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
21517
21518 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21519
21520 @end deftypevr
21521
21522 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
21523 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
21524 @samp{0} disables this feature.
21525
21526 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21527
21528 @end deftypevr
21529
21530 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
21531 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
21532
21533 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21534
21535 @end deftypevr
21536
21537 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
21538 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
21539
21540 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21541
21542 @end deftypevr
21543
21544 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
21545 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
21546 @samp{""} disables this feature.
21547
21548 Defaults to @samp{""}.
21549
21550 @end deftypevr
21551
21552 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
21553 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
21554 logger.
21555
21556 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21557
21558 @end deftypevr
21559
21560 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
21561 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
21562 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
21563 information lines.
21564
21565 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21566
21567 @end deftypevr
21568
21569 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
21570 Extra options to include.
21571
21572 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21573
21574 @end deftypevr
21575
21576 @end deftypevr
21577
21578 @end deftypevr
21579
21580 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
21581 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
21582 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
21583 extension.
21584
21585 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21586
21587 @end deftypevr
21588
21589 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
21590 Environment variables to set for getmail.
21591
21592 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21593
21594 @end deftypevr
21595
21596 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
21597
21598 @cindex email aliases
21599 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
21600
21601 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
21602 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
21603 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
21604
21605 @lisp
21606 (service mail-aliases-service-type
21607 '(("postmaster" "bob")
21608 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
21609 @end lisp
21610 @end deffn
21611
21612 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
21613 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
21614 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
21615 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
21616 where to deliver this user's mail.
21617
21618 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
21619 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
21620 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
21621 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
21622 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
21623
21624 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21625 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
21626
21627 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
21628 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
21629 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
21630 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
21631
21632 @lisp
21633 (service imap4d-service-type
21634 (imap4d-configuration
21635 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
21636 @end lisp
21637 @end deffn
21638
21639 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
21640 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
21641
21642 @table @asis
21643 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
21644 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
21645
21646 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
21647 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21648 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
21649 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
21650
21651 @end table
21652 @end deftp
21653
21654 @subsubheading Radicale Service
21655 @cindex CalDAV
21656 @cindex CardDAV
21657
21658 @deffn {Scheme Variable} radicale-service-type
21659 This is the type of the @uref{https://radicale.org, Radicale} CalDAV/CardDAV
21660 server whose value should be a @code{radicale-configuration}.
21661 @end deffn
21662
21663 @deftp {Data Type} radicale-configuration
21664 Data type representing the configuration of @command{radicale}.
21665
21666 @table @asis
21667 @item @code{package} (default: @code{radicale})
21668 The package that provides @command{radicale}.
21669
21670 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-radicale-config-file})
21671 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
21672 on TCP port 5232 of @code{localhost} and use the @code{htpasswd} file at
21673 @file{/var/lib/radicale/users} with no (@code{plain}) encryption.
21674
21675 @end table
21676 @end deftp
21677
21678 @node Messaging Services
21679 @subsection Messaging Services
21680
21681 @cindex messaging
21682 @cindex jabber
21683 @cindex XMPP
21684 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
21685 definitions for messaging services. Currently it provides the following
21686 services:
21687
21688 @subsubheading Prosody Service
21689
21690 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
21691 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
21692 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
21693 record as in this example:
21694
21695 @lisp
21696 (service prosody-service-type
21697 (prosody-configuration
21698 (modules-enabled (cons* "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
21699 (int-components
21700 (list
21701 (int-component-configuration
21702 (hostname "conference.example.net")
21703 (plugin "muc")
21704 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
21705 (virtualhosts
21706 (list
21707 (virtualhost-configuration
21708 (domain "example.net"))))))
21709 @end lisp
21710
21711 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
21712
21713 @end deffn
21714
21715 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
21716 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
21717 Prosody to serve.
21718
21719 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
21720 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
21721
21722 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
21723 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
21724 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
21725
21726 @example
21727 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
21728 @end example
21729
21730 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
21731 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
21732 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
21733 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
21734 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21735
21736 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
21737 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
21738 some other system; see the end for more details.
21739
21740 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
21741 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
21742
21743 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21744 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
21745 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21746 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21747 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21748 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21749 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
21750
21751 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
21752
21753 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
21754 The Prosody package.
21755 @end deftypevr
21756
21757 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
21758 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
21759 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
21760 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
21761 @end deftypevr
21762
21763 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
21764 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
21765 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
21766 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21767 @end deftypevr
21768
21769 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
21770 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
21771 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
21772 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
21773 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
21774 @end deftypevr
21775
21776 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
21777 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
21778 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
21779 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21780 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
21781 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21782 @end deftypevr
21783
21784 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
21785 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
21786 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
21787 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21788 @end deftypevr
21789
21790 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
21791 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
21792 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
21793 Documentation on modules can be found at:
21794 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
21795 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
21796 @end deftypevr
21797
21798 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
21799 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
21800 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
21801 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21802 @end deftypevr
21803
21804 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
21805 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
21806 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
21807 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
21808 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
21809 @end deftypevr
21810
21811 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
21812 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
21813 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
21814 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21815 @end deftypevr
21816
21817 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
21818 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
21819 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
21820 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
21821 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
21822
21823 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
21824
21825 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
21826 This determines what handshake to use.
21827 @end deftypevr
21828
21829 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
21830 Path to your private key file.
21831 @end deftypevr
21832
21833 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
21834 Path to your certificate file.
21835 @end deftypevr
21836
21837 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
21838 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
21839 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
21840 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
21841 @end deftypevr
21842
21843 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
21844 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
21845 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
21846 @end deftypevr
21847
21848 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
21849 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
21850 @code{set_verify()} flags).
21851 @end deftypevr
21852
21853 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
21854 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS@. These map to OpenSSL's
21855 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
21856 LuaSec source.
21857 @end deftypevr
21858
21859 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
21860 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
21861 trusted root certificate.
21862 @end deftypevr
21863
21864 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
21865 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
21866 clients, and in what order.
21867 @end deftypevr
21868
21869 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
21870 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
21871 can create such a file with:
21872 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
21873 @end deftypevr
21874
21875 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
21876 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
21877 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
21878 @end deftypevr
21879
21880 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
21881 A list of ``extra'' verification options.
21882 @end deftypevr
21883
21884 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
21885 Password for encrypted private keys.
21886 @end deftypevr
21887
21888 @end deftypevr
21889
21890 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
21891 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21892 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21893 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21894 @end deftypevr
21895
21896 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
21897 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
21898 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
21899 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
21900 @end deftypevr
21901
21902 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
21903 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
21904 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
21905 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21906 @end deftypevr
21907
21908 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
21909 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
21910 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
21911 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
21912 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21913 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21914 @end deftypevr
21915
21916 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
21917 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
21918 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
21919 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS@. See
21920 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21921 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21922 @end deftypevr
21923
21924 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
21925 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
21926 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
21927 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
21928 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21929 @end deftypevr
21930
21931 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
21932 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
21933 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
21934 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
21935 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
21936 about using the hashed backend. See also
21937 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
21938 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
21939 @end deftypevr
21940
21941 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
21942 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
21943 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
21944 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
21945 @end deftypevr
21946
21947 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
21948 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
21949 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
21950 @end deftypevr
21951
21952 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
21953 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
21954 @end deftypevr
21955
21956 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
21957 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
21958 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
21959 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
21960 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
21961 @end deftypevr
21962
21963 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
21964 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
21965 example if you want your users to have addresses like
21966 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
21967 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
21968
21969 Note: the name @emph{virtual} host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
21970 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
21971 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
21972 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
21973 have just one VirtualHost entry.
21974
21975 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
21976
21977 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
21978
21979 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
21980 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
21981 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
21982 @end deftypevr
21983
21984 @end deftypevr
21985
21986 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
21987 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
21988 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
21989 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
21990 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
21991
21992 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
21993 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
21994 to use for the component.
21995
21996 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
21997 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21998
21999 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
22000
22001 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
22002 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22003 Hostname of the component.
22004 @end deftypevr
22005
22006 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
22007 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
22008 @end deftypevr
22009
22010 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
22011 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
22012 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
22013
22014 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
22015 in the ``Chatrooms'' documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
22016 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
22017
22018 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
22019
22020 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
22021
22022 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
22023 The name to return in service discovery responses.
22024 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
22025 @end deftypevr
22026
22027 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
22028 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
22029 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
22030 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
22031 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
22032 restricts to service administrators only.
22033 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22034 @end deftypevr
22035
22036 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
22037 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
22038 just joined the room.
22039 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22040 @end deftypevr
22041
22042 @end deftypevr
22043
22044 @end deftypevr
22045
22046 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
22047 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
22048 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
22049 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
22050 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22051
22052 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
22053
22054 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
22055 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
22056 Password which the component will use to log in.
22057 @end deftypevr
22058
22059 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
22060 Hostname of the component.
22061 @end deftypevr
22062
22063 @end deftypevr
22064
22065 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
22066 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
22067 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
22068 @end deftypevr
22069
22070 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
22071 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
22072 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
22073 @end deftypevr
22074
22075 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
22076 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
22077 @end deftypevr
22078
22079 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
22080 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
22081 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
22082 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
22083 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
22084 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
22085
22086 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
22087 The prosody package.
22088 @end deftypevr
22089
22090 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
22091 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
22092 @end deftypevr
22093
22094 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
22095 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
22096
22097 @lisp
22098 (service prosody-service-type
22099 (opaque-prosody-configuration
22100 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
22101 @end lisp
22102
22103 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
22104
22105 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
22106
22107 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22108 @cindex IRC gateway
22109 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
22110 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
22111
22112 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
22113 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
22114 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
22115 below).
22116
22117 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
22118 services:
22119
22120 @lisp
22121 (service bitlbee-service-type)
22122 @end lisp
22123 @end defvr
22124
22125 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
22126 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
22127
22128 @table @asis
22129 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
22130 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
22131 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
22132 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
22133
22134 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
22135 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
22136 networking interface.
22137
22138 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
22139 The BitlBee package to use.
22140
22141 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
22142 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
22143
22144 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
22145 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
22146 @end table
22147 @end deftp
22148
22149 @subsubheading Quassel Service
22150
22151 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
22152 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
22153 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
22154 central core.
22155
22156 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
22157 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
22158 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
22159 (see below).
22160 @end defvr
22161
22162 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
22163 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
22164
22165 @table @asis
22166 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
22167 The Quassel package to use.
22168
22169 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
22170 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
22171 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
22172 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
22173 @var{port}.
22174
22175 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
22176 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
22177 and Error.
22178 @end table
22179 @end deftp
22180
22181 @node Telephony Services
22182 @subsection Telephony Services
22183
22184 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
22185 @cindex VoIP server
22186 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
22187 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
22188 (VoIP) suite.
22189
22190 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
22191 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
22192 look like this:
22193
22194 @lisp
22195 (service murmur-service-type
22196 (murmur-configuration
22197 (welcome-text
22198 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
22199 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
22200 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
22201 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
22202 @end lisp
22203
22204 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
22205 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
22206
22207 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
22208 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
22209 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
22210 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
22211 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
22212 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
22213 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
22214 rights and create some channels.
22215
22216 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
22217
22218 @table @asis
22219 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
22220 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
22221
22222 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22223 User who will run the Murmur server.
22224
22225 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
22226 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
22227
22228 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
22229 Port on which the server will listen.
22230
22231 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
22232 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
22233
22234 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
22235 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
22236
22237 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
22238 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
22239
22240 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
22241 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
22242
22243 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
22244 File name of the sqlite database.
22245 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22246
22247 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
22248 File name of the log file.
22249 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
22250
22251 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
22252 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
22253 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
22254
22255 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
22256 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
22257
22258 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
22259 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
22260 when violating the autoban limits.
22261
22262 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
22263 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
22264 before switching over to opus audio codec.
22265
22266 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
22267 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
22268
22269 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22270 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
22271
22272 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
22273 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
22274
22275 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
22276 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
22277
22278 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
22279 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
22280
22281 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
22282 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
22283 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
22284
22285 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
22286 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
22287 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
22288
22289 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
22290 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
22291
22292 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
22293 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
22294 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
22295 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
22296
22297 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
22298
22299 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
22300 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
22301
22302 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
22303 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
22304
22305 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
22306 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
22307 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
22308 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
22309
22310 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
22311 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
22312
22313 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
22314 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
22315
22316 @lisp
22317 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
22318 @end lisp
22319 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
22320 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
22321 @lisp
22322 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
22323 @end lisp
22324
22325 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
22326 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
22327 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
22328 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
22329 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
22330
22331 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
22332 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
22333 in SSL/TLS.
22334
22335 This option is specified using
22336 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
22337 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
22338
22339 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
22340 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
22341 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
22342 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
22343
22344 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
22345 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
22346 to connect to it.
22347
22348 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
22349 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
22350
22351 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
22352 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
22353 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
22354 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
22355
22356 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
22357
22358 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
22359 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
22360 @end table
22361 @end deftp
22362
22363 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
22364 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
22365
22366 @table @asis
22367 @item @code{name}
22368 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
22369
22370 @item @code{password}
22371 A password to identify your registration.
22372 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
22373
22374 @item @code{url}
22375 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
22376 site.
22377
22378 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
22379 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
22380 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
22381 @end table
22382 @end deftp
22383
22384
22385
22386 @node File-Sharing Services
22387 @subsection File-Sharing Services
22388
22389 The @code{(gnu services file-sharing)} module provides services that
22390 assist with transferring files over peer-to-peer file-sharing networks.
22391
22392 @subsubheading Transmission Daemon Service
22393
22394 @uref{https://transmissionbt.com/, Transmission} is a flexible
22395 BitTorrent client that offers a variety of graphical and command-line
22396 interfaces. A @code{transmission-daemon-service-type} service provides
22397 Transmission's headless variant, @command{transmission-daemon}, as a
22398 system service, allowing users to share files via BitTorrent even when
22399 they are not logged in.
22400
22401 @deffn {Scheme Variable} transmission-daemon-service-type
22402 The service type for the Transmission Daemon BitTorrent client. Its
22403 value must be a @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} object as in
22404 this example:
22405
22406 @lisp
22407 (service transmission-daemon-service-type
22408 (transmission-daemon-configuration
22409 ;; Restrict access to the RPC ("control") interface
22410 (rpc-authentication-required? #t)
22411 (rpc-username "transmission")
22412 (rpc-password
22413 (transmission-password-hash
22414 "transmission" ; desired password
22415 "uKd1uMs9")) ; arbitrary salt value
22416
22417 ;; Accept requests from this and other hosts on the
22418 ;; local network
22419 (rpc-whitelist-enabled? #t)
22420 (rpc-whitelist '("::1" "127.0.0.1" "192.168.0.*"))
22421
22422 ;; Limit bandwidth use during work hours
22423 (alt-speed-down (* 1024 2)) ; 2 MB/s
22424 (alt-speed-up 512) ; 512 kB/s
22425
22426 (alt-speed-time-enabled? #t)
22427 (alt-speed-time-day 'weekdays)
22428 (alt-speed-time-begin
22429 (+ (* 60 8) 30)) ; 8:30 am
22430 (alt-speed-time-end
22431 (+ (* 60 (+ 12 5)) 30)))) ; 5:30 pm
22432 @end lisp
22433 @end deffn
22434
22435 Once the service is started, users can interact with the daemon through
22436 its Web interface (at @code{http://localhost:9091/}) or by using the
22437 @command{transmission-remote} command-line tool, available in the
22438 @code{transmission} package. (Emacs users may want to also consider the
22439 @code{emacs-transmission} package.) Both communicate with the daemon
22440 through its remote procedure call (RPC) interface, which by default is
22441 available to all users on the system; you may wish to change this by
22442 assigning values to the @code{rpc-authentication-required?},
22443 @code{rpc-username} and @code{rpc-password} settings, as shown in the
22444 example above and documented further below.
22445
22446 The value for @code{rpc-password} must be a password hash of the type
22447 generated and used by Transmission clients. This can be copied verbatim
22448 from an existing @file{settings.json} file, if another Transmission
22449 client is already being used. Otherwise, the
22450 @code{transmission-password-hash} and @code{transmission-random-salt}
22451 procedures provided by this module can be used to obtain a suitable hash
22452 value.
22453
22454 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-password-hash @var{password} @var{salt}
22455 Returns a string containing the result of hashing @var{password}
22456 together with @var{salt}, in the format recognized by Transmission
22457 clients for their @code{rpc-password} configuration setting.
22458
22459 @var{salt} must be an eight-character string. The
22460 @code{transmission-random-salt} procedure can be used to generate a
22461 suitable salt value at random.
22462 @end deffn
22463
22464 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} transmission-random-salt
22465 Returns a string containing a random, eight-character salt value of the
22466 type generated and used by Transmission clients, suitable for passing to
22467 the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
22468 @end deffn
22469
22470 These procedures are accessible from within a Guile REPL started with
22471 the @command{guix repl} command (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). This is
22472 useful for obtaining a random salt value to provide as the second
22473 parameter to `transmission-password-hash`, as in this example session:
22474
22475 @example
22476 $ guix repl
22477 scheme@@(guix-user)> ,use (gnu services file-sharing)
22478 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-random-salt)
22479 $1 = "uKd1uMs9"
22480 @end example
22481
22482 Alternatively, a complete password hash can generated in a single step:
22483
22484 @example
22485 scheme@@(guix-user)> (transmission-password-hash "transmission"
22486 (transmission-random-salt))
22487 $2 = "@{c8bbc6d1740cd8dc819a6e25563b67812c1c19c9VtFPfdsX"
22488 @end example
22489
22490 The resulting string can be used as-is for the value of
22491 @code{rpc-password}, allowing the password to be kept hidden even in the
22492 operating-system configuration.
22493
22494 Torrent files downloaded by the daemon are directly accessible only to
22495 users in the ``transmission'' user group, who receive read-only access
22496 to the directory specified by the @code{download-dir} configuration
22497 setting (and also the directory specified by @code{incomplete-dir}, if
22498 @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}). Downloaded files can be
22499 moved to another directory or deleted altogether using
22500 @command{transmission-remote} with its @code{--move} and
22501 @code{--remove-and-delete} options.
22502
22503 If the @code{watch-dir-enabled?} setting is set to @code{#t}, users in
22504 the ``transmission'' group are able also to place @file{.torrent} files
22505 in the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} to have the corresponding
22506 torrents added by the daemon. (The @code{trash-original-torrent-files?}
22507 setting controls whether the daemon deletes these files after processing
22508 them.)
22509
22510 Some of the daemon's configuration settings can be changed temporarily
22511 by @command{transmission-remote} and similar tools. To undo these
22512 changes, use the service's @code{reload} action to have the daemon
22513 reload its settings from disk:
22514
22515 @example
22516 # herd reload transmission-daemon
22517 @end example
22518
22519 The full set of available configuration settings is defined by the
22520 @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} data type.
22521
22522 @deftp {Data Type} transmission-daemon-configuration
22523 The data type representing configuration settings for Transmission
22524 Daemon. These correspond directly to the settings recognized by
22525 Transmission clients in their @file{settings.json} file.
22526 @end deftp
22527
22528 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
22529 @c (generate-transmission-daemon-documentation) in (gnu services
22530 @c file-sharing). Manually maintained documentation is better, so we
22531 @c shouldn't hesitate to edit below as needed. However if the change
22532 @c you want to make to this documentation can be done in an automated
22533 @c way, it's probably easier to change (generate-documentation) than to
22534 @c make it below and have to deal with the churn as Transmission Daemon
22535 @c updates.
22536
22537 @c %start of fragment
22538
22539 Available @code{transmission-daemon-configuration} fields are:
22540
22541 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} package transmission
22542 The Transmission package to use.
22543
22544 @end deftypevr
22545
22546 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer stop-wait-period
22547 The period, in seconds, to wait when stopping the service for
22548 @command{transmission-daemon} to exit before killing its process. This
22549 allows the daemon time to complete its housekeeping and send a final
22550 update to trackers as it shuts down. On slow hosts, or hosts with a
22551 slow network connection, this value may need to be increased.
22552
22553 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22554
22555 @end deftypevr
22556
22557 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string download-dir
22558 The directory to which torrent files are downloaded.
22559
22560 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/transmission-daemon/downloads"}.
22561
22562 @end deftypevr
22563
22564 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean incomplete-dir-enabled?
22565 If @code{#t}, files will be held in @code{incomplete-dir} while their
22566 torrent is being downloaded, then moved to @code{download-dir} once the
22567 torrent is complete. Otherwise, files for all torrents (including those
22568 still being downloaded) will be placed in @code{download-dir}.
22569
22570 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22571
22572 @end deftypevr
22573
22574 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string incomplete-dir
22575 The directory in which files from incompletely downloaded torrents will
22576 be held when @code{incomplete-dir-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22577
22578 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22579
22580 @end deftypevr
22581
22582 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} umask umask
22583 The file mode creation mask used for downloaded files. (See the
22584 @command{umask} man page for more information.)
22585
22586 Defaults to @samp{18}.
22587
22588 @end deftypevr
22589
22590 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rename-partial-files?
22591 When @code{#t}, ``.part'' is appended to the name of partially
22592 downloaded files.
22593
22594 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22595
22596 @end deftypevr
22597
22598 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} preallocation-mode preallocation
22599 The mode by which space should be preallocated for downloaded files, one
22600 of @code{none}, @code{fast} (or @code{sparse}) and @code{full}.
22601 Specifying @code{full} will minimize disk fragmentation at a cost to
22602 file-creation speed.
22603
22604 Defaults to @samp{fast}.
22605
22606 @end deftypevr
22607
22608 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean watch-dir-enabled?
22609 If @code{#t}, the directory specified by @code{watch-dir} will be
22610 watched for new @file{.torrent} files and the torrents they describe
22611 added automatically (and the original files removed, if
22612 @code{trash-original-torrent-files?} is @code{#t}).
22613
22614 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22615
22616 @end deftypevr
22617
22618 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string watch-dir
22619 The directory to be watched for @file{.torrent} files indicating new
22620 torrents to be added, when @code{watch-dir-enabled} is @code{#t}.
22621
22622 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22623
22624 @end deftypevr
22625
22626 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean trash-original-torrent-files?
22627 When @code{#t}, @file{.torrent} files will be deleted from the watch
22628 directory once their torrent has been added (see
22629 @code{watch-directory-enabled?}).
22630
22631 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22632
22633 @end deftypevr
22634
22635 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-down-enabled?
22636 When @code{#t}, the daemon's download speed will be limited to the rate
22637 specified by @code{speed-limit-down}.
22638
22639 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22640
22641 @end deftypevr
22642
22643 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-down
22644 The default global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
22645
22646 Defaults to @samp{100}.
22647
22648 @end deftypevr
22649
22650 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean speed-limit-up-enabled?
22651 When @code{#t}, the daemon's upload speed will be limited to the rate
22652 specified by @code{speed-limit-up}.
22653
22654 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22655
22656 @end deftypevr
22657
22658 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer speed-limit-up
22659 The default global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
22660
22661 Defaults to @samp{100}.
22662
22663 @end deftypevr
22664
22665 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-enabled?
22666 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
22667 @code{alt-speed-up} are used (in place of @code{speed-limit-down} and
22668 @code{speed-limit-up}, if they are enabled) to constrain the daemon's
22669 bandwidth usage. This can be scheduled to occur automatically at
22670 certain times during the week; see @code{alt-speed-time-enabled?}.
22671
22672 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22673
22674 @end deftypevr
22675
22676 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-down
22677 The alternate global-maximum download speed, in kilobytes per second.
22678
22679 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22680
22681 @end deftypevr
22682
22683 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-up
22684 The alternate global-maximum upload speed, in kilobytes per second.
22685
22686 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22687
22688 @end deftypevr
22689
22690 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean alt-speed-time-enabled?
22691 When @code{#t}, the alternate speed limits @code{alt-speed-down} and
22692 @code{alt-speed-up} will be enabled automatically during the periods
22693 specified by @code{alt-speed-time-day}, @code{alt-speed-time-begin} and
22694 @code{alt-time-speed-end}.
22695
22696 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22697
22698 @end deftypevr
22699
22700 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} day-list alt-speed-time-day
22701 The days of the week on which the alternate-speed schedule should be
22702 used, specified either as a list of days (@code{sunday}, @code{monday},
22703 and so on) or using one of the symbols @code{weekdays}, @code{weekends}
22704 or @code{all}.
22705
22706 Defaults to @samp{all}.
22707
22708 @end deftypevr
22709
22710 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-begin
22711 The time of day at which to enable the alternate speed limits, expressed
22712 as a number of minutes since midnight.
22713
22714 Defaults to @samp{540}.
22715
22716 @end deftypevr
22717
22718 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer alt-speed-time-end
22719 The time of day at which to disable the alternate speed limits,
22720 expressed as a number of minutes since midnight.
22721
22722 Defaults to @samp{1020}.
22723
22724 @end deftypevr
22725
22726 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv4
22727 The IP address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``0.0.0.0''
22728 to listen at all available IP addresses.
22729
22730 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
22731
22732 @end deftypevr
22733
22734 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string bind-address-ipv6
22735 The IPv6 address at which to listen for peer connections, or ``::'' to
22736 listen at all available IPv6 addresses.
22737
22738 Defaults to @samp{"::"}.
22739
22740 @end deftypevr
22741
22742 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean peer-port-random-on-start?
22743 If @code{#t}, when the daemon starts it will select a port at random on
22744 which to listen for peer connections, from the range specified
22745 (inclusively) by @code{peer-port-random-low} and
22746 @code{peer-port-random-high}. Otherwise, it listens on the port
22747 specified by @code{peer-port}.
22748
22749 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22750
22751 @end deftypevr
22752
22753 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-low
22754 The lowest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start?}
22755 is @code{#t}.
22756
22757 Defaults to @samp{49152}.
22758
22759 @end deftypevr
22760
22761 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port-random-high
22762 The highest selectable port number when @code{peer-port-random-on-start}
22763 is @code{#t}.
22764
22765 Defaults to @samp{65535}.
22766
22767 @end deftypevr
22768
22769 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number peer-port
22770 The port on which to listen for peer connections when
22771 @code{peer-port-random-on-start?} is @code{#f}.
22772
22773 Defaults to @samp{51413}.
22774
22775 @end deftypevr
22776
22777 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean port-forwarding-enabled?
22778 If @code{#t}, the daemon will attempt to configure port-forwarding on an
22779 upstream gateway automatically using @acronym{UPnP} and
22780 @acronym{NAT-PMP}.
22781
22782 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22783
22784 @end deftypevr
22785
22786 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} encryption-mode encryption
22787 The encryption preference for peer connections, one of
22788 @code{prefer-unencrypted-connections},
22789 @code{prefer-encrypted-connections} or
22790 @code{require-encrypted-connections}.
22791
22792 Defaults to @samp{prefer-encrypted-connections}.
22793
22794 @end deftypevr
22795
22796 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string peer-congestion-algorithm
22797 The TCP congestion-control algorithm to use for peer connections,
22798 specified using a string recognized by the operating system in calls to
22799 @code{setsockopt} (or set to @code{disabled}, in which case the
22800 operating-system default is used).
22801
22802 Note that on GNU/Linux systems, the kernel must be configured to allow
22803 processes to use a congestion-control algorithm not in the default set;
22804 otherwise, it will deny these requests with ``Operation not permitted''.
22805 To see which algorithms are available on your system and which are
22806 currently permitted for use, look at the contents of the files
22807 @file{tcp_available_congestion_control} and
22808 @file{tcp_allowed_congestion_control} in the @file{/proc/sys/net/ipv4}
22809 directory.
22810
22811 As an example, to have Transmission Daemon use
22812 @uref{http://www-ece.rice.edu/networks/TCP-LP/,the TCP Low Priority
22813 congestion-control algorithm}, you'll need to modify your kernel
22814 configuration to build in support for the algorithm, then update your
22815 operating-system configuration to allow its use by adding a
22816 @code{sysctl-service-type} service (or updating the existing one's
22817 configuration) with lines like the following:
22818
22819 @lisp
22820 (service sysctl-service-type
22821 (sysctl-configuration
22822 (settings
22823 ("net.ipv4.tcp_allowed_congestion_control" .
22824 "reno cubic lp"))))
22825 @end lisp
22826
22827 The Transmission Daemon configuration can then be updated with
22828
22829 @lisp
22830 (peer-congestion-algorithm "lp")
22831 @end lisp
22832
22833 and the system reconfigured to have the changes take effect.
22834
22835 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22836
22837 @end deftypevr
22838
22839 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} tcp-type-of-service peer-socket-tos
22840 The type of service to request in outgoing @acronym{TCP} packets, one of
22841 @code{default}, @code{low-cost}, @code{throughput}, @code{low-delay} and
22842 @code{reliability}.
22843
22844 Defaults to @samp{default}.
22845
22846 @end deftypevr
22847
22848 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-global
22849 The global limit on the number of connected peers.
22850
22851 Defaults to @samp{200}.
22852
22853 @end deftypevr
22854
22855 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-limit-per-torrent
22856 The per-torrent limit on the number of connected peers.
22857
22858 Defaults to @samp{50}.
22859
22860 @end deftypevr
22861
22862 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer upload-slots-per-torrent
22863 The maximum number of peers to which the daemon will upload data
22864 simultaneously for each torrent.
22865
22866 Defaults to @samp{14}.
22867
22868 @end deftypevr
22869
22870 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer peer-id-ttl-hours
22871 The maximum lifespan, in hours, of the peer ID associated with each
22872 public torrent before it is regenerated.
22873
22874 Defaults to @samp{6}.
22875
22876 @end deftypevr
22877
22878 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean blocklist-enabled?
22879 When @code{#t}, the daemon will ignore peers mentioned in the blocklist
22880 it has most recently downloaded from @code{blocklist-url}.
22881
22882 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22883
22884 @end deftypevr
22885
22886 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string blocklist-url
22887 The URL of a peer blocklist (in @acronym{P2P}-plaintext or eMule
22888 @file{.dat} format) to be periodically downloaded and applied when
22889 @code{blocklist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22890
22891 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22892
22893 @end deftypevr
22894
22895 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean download-queue-enabled?
22896 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to downloading at most
22897 @code{download-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
22898
22899 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22900
22901 @end deftypevr
22902
22903 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer download-queue-size
22904 The size of the daemon's download queue, which limits the number of
22905 non-stalled torrents it will download at any one time when
22906 @code{download-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22907
22908 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22909
22910 @end deftypevr
22911
22912 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean seed-queue-enabled?
22913 If @code{#t}, the daemon will be limited to seeding at most
22914 @code{seed-queue-size} non-stalled torrents simultaneously.
22915
22916 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22917
22918 @end deftypevr
22919
22920 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer seed-queue-size
22921 The size of the daemon's seed queue, which limits the number of
22922 non-stalled torrents it will seed at any one time when
22923 @code{seed-queue-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22924
22925 Defaults to @samp{10}.
22926
22927 @end deftypevr
22928
22929 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean queue-stalled-enabled?
22930 When @code{#t}, the daemon will consider torrents for which it has not
22931 shared data in the past @code{queue-stalled-minutes} minutes to be
22932 stalled and not count them against its @code{download-queue-size} and
22933 @code{seed-queue-size} limits.
22934
22935 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22936
22937 @end deftypevr
22938
22939 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer queue-stalled-minutes
22940 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent may be idle before it is
22941 considered to be stalled, when @code{queue-stalled-enabled?} is
22942 @code{#t}.
22943
22944 Defaults to @samp{30}.
22945
22946 @end deftypevr
22947
22948 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean ratio-limit-enabled?
22949 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
22950 it reaches the ratio specified by @code{ratio-limit}.
22951
22952 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22953
22954 @end deftypevr
22955
22956 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-rational ratio-limit
22957 The ratio at which a torrent being seeded will be paused, when
22958 @code{ratio-limit-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
22959
22960 Defaults to @samp{2.0}.
22961
22962 @end deftypevr
22963
22964 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean idle-seeding-limit-enabled?
22965 When @code{#t}, a torrent being seeded will automatically be paused once
22966 it has been idle for @code{idle-seeding-limit} minutes.
22967
22968 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22969
22970 @end deftypevr
22971
22972 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer idle-seeding-limit
22973 The maximum period, in minutes, a torrent being seeded may be idle
22974 before it is paused, when @code{idle-seeding-limit-enabled?} is
22975 @code{#t}.
22976
22977 Defaults to @samp{30}.
22978
22979 @end deftypevr
22980
22981 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean dht-enabled?
22982 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0005.html,the distributed
22983 hash table (@acronym{DHT}) protocol}, which supports the use of
22984 trackerless torrents.
22985
22986 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22987
22988 @end deftypevr
22989
22990 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean lpd-enabled?
22991 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Local_Peer_Discovery,local
22992 peer discovery} (@acronym{LPD}), which allows the discovery of peers on
22993 the local network and may reduce the amount of data sent over the public
22994 Internet.
22995
22996 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22997
22998 @end deftypevr
22999
23000 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean pex-enabled?
23001 Enable @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Peer_exchange,peer exchange}
23002 (@acronym{PEX}), which reduces the daemon's reliance on external
23003 trackers and may improve its performance.
23004
23005 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23006
23007 @end deftypevr
23008
23009 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean utp-enabled?
23010 Enable @uref{http://bittorrent.org/beps/bep_0029.html,the micro
23011 transport protocol} (@acronym{uTP}), which aims to reduce the impact of
23012 BitTorrent traffic on other users of the local network while maintaining
23013 full utilization of the available bandwidth.
23014
23015 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23016
23017 @end deftypevr
23018
23019 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-enabled?
23020 If @code{#t}, enable the remote procedure call (@acronym{RPC})
23021 interface, which allows remote control of the daemon via its Web
23022 interface, the @command{transmission-remote} command-line client, and
23023 similar tools.
23024
23025 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23026
23027 @end deftypevr
23028
23029 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-bind-address
23030 The IP address at which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections, or
23031 ``0.0.0.0'' to listen at all available IP addresses.
23032
23033 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
23034
23035 @end deftypevr
23036
23037 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} port-number rpc-port
23038 The port on which to listen for @acronym{RPC} connections.
23039
23040 Defaults to @samp{9091}.
23041
23042 @end deftypevr
23043
23044 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string rpc-url
23045 The path prefix to use in the @acronym{RPC}-endpoint @acronym{URL}.
23046
23047 Defaults to @samp{"/transmission/"}.
23048
23049 @end deftypevr
23050
23051 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-authentication-required?
23052 When @code{#t}, clients must authenticate (see @code{rpc-username} and
23053 @code{rpc-password}) when using the @acronym{RPC} interface. Note this
23054 has the side effect of disabling host-name whitelisting (see
23055 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?}.
23056
23057 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23058
23059 @end deftypevr
23060
23061 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rpc-username
23062 The username required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23063 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23064
23065 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23066
23067 @end deftypevr
23068
23069 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-transmission-password-hash rpc-password
23070 The password required by clients to access the @acronym{RPC} interface
23071 when @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}. This must be
23072 specified using a password hash in the format recognized by Transmission
23073 clients, either copied from an existing @file{settings.json} file or
23074 generated using the @code{transmission-password-hash} procedure.
23075
23076 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23077
23078 @end deftypevr
23079
23080 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-whitelist-enabled?
23081 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23082 originate from an address specified in @code{rpc-whitelist}.
23083
23084 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23085
23086 @end deftypevr
23087
23088 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-whitelist
23089 The list of IP and IPv6 addresses from which @acronym{RPC} requests will
23090 be accepted when @code{rpc-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}. Wildcards
23091 may be specified using @samp{*}.
23092
23093 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1" "::1")}.
23094
23095 @end deftypevr
23096
23097 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?
23098 When @code{#t}, @acronym{RPC} requests will be accepted only when they
23099 are addressed to a host named in @code{rpc-host-whitelist}. Note that
23100 requests to ``localhost'' or ``localhost.'', or to a numeric address,
23101 are always accepted regardless of these settings.
23102
23103 Note also this functionality is disabled when
23104 @code{rpc-authentication-required?} is @code{#t}.
23105
23106 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23107
23108 @end deftypevr
23109
23110 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} string-list rpc-host-whitelist
23111 The list of host names recognized by the @acronym{RPC} server when
23112 @code{rpc-host-whitelist-enabled?} is @code{#t}.
23113
23114 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23115
23116 @end deftypevr
23117
23118 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} message-level message-level
23119 The minimum severity level of messages to be logged (to
23120 @file{/var/log/transmission.log}) by the daemon, one of @code{none} (no
23121 logging), @code{error}, @code{info} and @code{debug}.
23122
23123 Defaults to @samp{info}.
23124
23125 @end deftypevr
23126
23127 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean start-added-torrents?
23128 When @code{#t}, torrents are started as soon as they are added;
23129 otherwise, they are added in ``paused'' state.
23130
23131 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23132
23133 @end deftypevr
23134
23135 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean script-torrent-done-enabled?
23136 When @code{#t}, the script specified by
23137 @code{script-torrent-done-filename} will be invoked each time a torrent
23138 completes.
23139
23140 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23141
23142 @end deftypevr
23143
23144 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object script-torrent-done-filename
23145 A file name or file-like object specifying a script to run each time a
23146 torrent completes, when @code{script-torrent-done-enabled?} is
23147 @code{#t}.
23148
23149 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23150
23151 @end deftypevr
23152
23153 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean scrape-paused-torrents-enabled?
23154 When @code{#t}, the daemon will scrape trackers for a torrent even when
23155 the torrent is paused.
23156
23157 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23158
23159 @end deftypevr
23160
23161 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer cache-size-mb
23162 The amount of memory, in megabytes, to allocate for the daemon's
23163 in-memory cache. A larger value may increase performance by reducing
23164 the frequency of disk I/O.
23165
23166 Defaults to @samp{4}.
23167
23168 @end deftypevr
23169
23170 @deftypevr {@code{transmission-daemon-configuration} parameter} boolean prefetch-enabled?
23171 When @code{#t}, the daemon will try to improve I/O performance by
23172 hinting to the operating system which data is likely to be read next
23173 from disk to satisfy requests from peers.
23174
23175 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23176
23177 @end deftypevr
23178
23179
23180 @c %end of fragment
23181
23182
23183
23184 @node Monitoring Services
23185 @subsection Monitoring Services
23186
23187 @subsubheading Tailon Service
23188
23189 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
23190 viewing and searching log files.
23191
23192 The following example will configure the service with default values.
23193 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
23194
23195 @lisp
23196 (service tailon-service-type)
23197 @end lisp
23198
23199 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
23200 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
23201
23202 @lisp
23203 (service tailon-service-type
23204 (tailon-configuration
23205 (config-file
23206 (tailon-configuration-file
23207 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
23208 @end lisp
23209
23210
23211 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
23212 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
23213 This type has the following parameters:
23214
23215 @table @asis
23216 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
23217 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
23218 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
23219 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
23220
23221 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
23222 can be used:
23223
23224 @lisp
23225 (service tailon-service-type
23226 (tailon-configuration
23227 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
23228 @end lisp
23229
23230 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
23231 The tailon package to use.
23232
23233 @end table
23234 @end deftp
23235
23236 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
23237 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
23238 This type has the following parameters:
23239
23240 @table @asis
23241 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
23242 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
23243 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
23244 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
23245 subsection.
23246
23247 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
23248 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
23249
23250 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
23251 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
23252
23253 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
23254 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
23255
23256 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
23257 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
23258
23259 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
23260 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
23261
23262 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
23263 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
23264
23265 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
23266 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
23267
23268 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
23269 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
23270 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
23271 wrap lines.
23272
23273 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
23274 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
23275 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
23276 @code{"basic"}.
23277
23278 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
23279 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
23280 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
23281 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
23282 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
23283
23284 @lisp
23285 (tailon-configuration-file
23286 (http-auth "basic")
23287 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
23288 ("user2" . "password2"))))
23289 @end lisp
23290
23291 @end table
23292 @end deftp
23293
23294
23295 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
23296 @cindex darkstat
23297 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
23298 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
23299
23300 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
23301 This is the service type for the
23302 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
23303 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
23304 this example:
23305
23306 @lisp
23307 (service darkstat-service-type
23308 (darkstat-configuration
23309 (interface "eno1")))
23310 @end lisp
23311 @end defvar
23312
23313 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
23314 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
23315
23316 @table @asis
23317 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
23318 The darkstat package to use.
23319
23320 @item @code{interface}
23321 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
23322
23323 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
23324 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
23325
23326 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
23327 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
23328
23329 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
23330 Specify the path of the base URL@. This can be useful if
23331 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
23332
23333 @end table
23334 @end deftp
23335
23336 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
23337
23338 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
23339 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
23340 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
23341 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
23342 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
23343
23344 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
23345 This is the service type for the
23346 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
23347 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}.
23348
23349 @lisp
23350 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type)
23351 @end lisp
23352 @end defvar
23353
23354 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
23355 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
23356
23357 @table @asis
23358 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
23359 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
23360
23361 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
23362 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
23363
23364 @item @code{textfile-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/prometheus/node-exporter"})
23365 This directory can be used to export metrics specific to this machine.
23366 Files containing metrics in the text format, with the filename ending in
23367 @code{.prom} should be placed in this directory.
23368
23369 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
23370 Extra options to pass to the Prometheus node exporter.
23371
23372 @end table
23373 @end deftp
23374
23375 @subsubheading Zabbix server
23376 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
23377 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
23378 and disk space consumption:
23379
23380 @itemize
23381 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
23382 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
23383 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
23384 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
23385 @item Native high performance agents.
23386 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
23387 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
23388 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
23389 @end itemize
23390
23391 @c %start of fragment
23392
23393 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
23394
23395 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
23396 The zabbix-server package.
23397
23398 @end deftypevr
23399
23400 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
23401 User who will run the Zabbix server.
23402
23403 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23404
23405 @end deftypevr
23406
23407 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
23408 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
23409
23410 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23411
23412 @end deftypevr
23413
23414 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
23415 Database host name.
23416
23417 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
23418
23419 @end deftypevr
23420
23421 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
23422 Database name.
23423
23424 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23425
23426 @end deftypevr
23427
23428 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
23429 Database user.
23430
23431 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23432
23433 @end deftypevr
23434
23435 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
23436 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
23437 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
23438
23439 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23440
23441 @end deftypevr
23442
23443 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
23444 Database port.
23445
23446 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
23447
23448 @end deftypevr
23449
23450 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
23451 Specifies where log messages are written to:
23452
23453 @itemize @bullet
23454 @item
23455 @code{system} - syslog.
23456
23457 @item
23458 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
23459
23460 @item
23461 @code{console} - standard output.
23462
23463 @end itemize
23464
23465 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23466
23467 @end deftypevr
23468
23469 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
23470 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
23471
23472 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
23473
23474 @end deftypevr
23475
23476 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
23477 Name of PID file.
23478
23479 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
23480
23481 @end deftypevr
23482
23483 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
23484 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
23485 certificate verification.
23486
23487 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
23488
23489 @end deftypevr
23490
23491 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
23492 Location of SSL client certificates.
23493
23494 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
23495
23496 @end deftypevr
23497
23498 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
23499 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
23500
23501 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23502
23503 @end deftypevr
23504
23505 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
23506 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
23507 configuration file.
23508
23509 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23510
23511 @end deftypevr
23512
23513 @c %end of fragment
23514
23515 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
23516 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
23517
23518 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
23519
23520 @c %start of fragment
23521
23522 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
23523
23524 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
23525 The zabbix-agent package.
23526
23527 @end deftypevr
23528
23529 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
23530 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
23531
23532 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23533
23534 @end deftypevr
23535
23536 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
23537 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
23538
23539 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23540
23541 @end deftypevr
23542
23543 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
23544 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
23545 must match hostname as configured on the server.
23546
23547 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23548
23549 @end deftypevr
23550
23551 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
23552 Specifies where log messages are written to:
23553
23554 @itemize @bullet
23555 @item
23556 @code{system} - syslog.
23557
23558 @item
23559 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
23560
23561 @item
23562 @code{console} - standard output.
23563
23564 @end itemize
23565
23566 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23567
23568 @end deftypevr
23569
23570 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
23571 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
23572
23573 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
23574
23575 @end deftypevr
23576
23577 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
23578 Name of PID file.
23579
23580 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
23581
23582 @end deftypevr
23583
23584 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
23585 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
23586 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
23587 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
23588
23589 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
23590
23591 @end deftypevr
23592
23593 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
23594 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
23595 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
23596 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
23597
23598 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
23599
23600 @end deftypevr
23601
23602 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
23603 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
23604
23605 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23606
23607 @end deftypevr
23608
23609 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
23610 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
23611 configuration file.
23612
23613 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23614
23615 @end deftypevr
23616
23617 @c %end of fragment
23618
23619 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
23620 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
23621
23622 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
23623
23624 @c %start of fragment
23625
23626 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
23627
23628 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
23629 NGINX configuration.
23630
23631 @end deftypevr
23632
23633 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
23634 Database host name.
23635
23636 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
23637
23638 @end deftypevr
23639
23640 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
23641 Database port.
23642
23643 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
23644
23645 @end deftypevr
23646
23647 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
23648 Database name.
23649
23650 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23651
23652 @end deftypevr
23653
23654 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
23655 Database user.
23656
23657 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
23658
23659 @end deftypevr
23660
23661 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
23662 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
23663
23664 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23665
23666 @end deftypevr
23667
23668 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
23669 Secret file containing the credentials for the Zabbix front-end. The value
23670 must be a local file name, not a G-expression. You are expected to create
23671 this file manually. Its contents will be copied into @file{zabbix.conf.php}
23672 as the value of @code{$DB['PASSWORD']}.
23673
23674 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23675
23676 @end deftypevr
23677
23678 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
23679 Zabbix server hostname.
23680
23681 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
23682
23683 @end deftypevr
23684
23685 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
23686 Zabbix server port.
23687
23688 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
23689
23690 @end deftypevr
23691
23692
23693 @c %end of fragment
23694
23695 @node Kerberos Services
23696 @subsection Kerberos Services
23697 @cindex Kerberos
23698
23699 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
23700 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
23701
23702 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
23703
23704 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
23705 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
23706 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
23707 operating system declaration.
23708 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
23709
23710 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
23711 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
23712 Other implementations have not been tested.
23713
23714 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
23715 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
23716 @end defvr
23717
23718 @noindent
23719 Here is an example of its use:
23720 @lisp
23721 (service krb5-service-type
23722 (krb5-configuration
23723 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
23724 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
23725 (realms (list
23726 (krb5-realm
23727 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
23728 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
23729 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
23730 (krb5-realm
23731 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
23732 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
23733 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
23734 @end lisp
23735
23736 @noindent
23737 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
23738 @itemize
23739 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
23740 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
23741 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
23742 specified by clients;
23743 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
23744 @end itemize
23745
23746 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
23747 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
23748 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
23749 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
23750 documentation.
23751
23752
23753 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
23754 @cindex realm, kerberos
23755 @table @asis
23756 @item @code{name}
23757 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
23758 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
23759 converted to upper case.
23760
23761 @item @code{admin-server}
23762 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
23763 running.
23764
23765 @item @code{kdc}
23766 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
23767 for the realm.
23768 @end table
23769 @end deftp
23770
23771 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
23772
23773 @table @asis
23774 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
23775 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
23776 known to be weak will be accepted.
23777
23778 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
23779 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
23780 realm for the client.
23781 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
23782 If this value is @code{#f}
23783 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
23784 such as @command{kinit}.
23785
23786 @item @code{realms}
23787 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
23788 access.
23789 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
23790 field.
23791 @end table
23792 @end deftp
23793
23794
23795 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
23796 @cindex pam-krb5
23797
23798 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
23799 management via Kerberos.
23800 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
23801 users using Kerberos.
23802
23803 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
23804 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
23805 @end defvr
23806
23807 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
23808 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
23809 This type has the following parameters:
23810 @table @asis
23811 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
23812 The pam-krb5 package to use.
23813
23814 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
23815 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
23816 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
23817 @end table
23818 @end deftp
23819
23820
23821 @node LDAP Services
23822 @subsection LDAP Services
23823 @cindex LDAP
23824 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
23825
23826 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
23827 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
23828 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
23829 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
23830 Switch} for detailed information.
23831
23832 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
23833 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
23834 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
23835
23836 @lisp
23837 (use-service-modules authentication)
23838 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
23839 ...
23840 (operating-system
23841 ...
23842 (services
23843 (cons*
23844 (service nslcd-service-type)
23845 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
23846 %base-services))
23847 (name-service-switch
23848 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
23849 (name-service (name "files"))
23850 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
23851 (name-service-switch
23852 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
23853 (password services)
23854 (shadow services)
23855 (group services)
23856 (netgroup services)
23857 (gshadow services)))))
23858 @end lisp
23859
23860 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
23861
23862 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
23863
23864 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
23865 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
23866
23867 @end deftypevr
23868
23869 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
23870 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
23871 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
23872 The default is to start 5 threads.
23873
23874 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23875
23876 @end deftypevr
23877
23878 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
23879 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
23880
23881 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
23882
23883 @end deftypevr
23884
23885 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
23886 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
23887
23888 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
23889
23890 @end deftypevr
23891
23892 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
23893 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
23894 SCHEME and LEVEL@. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols
23895 @samp{none} or @samp{syslog}, or an absolute file name. The LEVEL
23896 argument is optional and specifies the log level. The log level may be
23897 one of the following symbols: @samp{crit}, @samp{error}, @samp{warning},
23898 @samp{notice}, @samp{info} or @samp{debug}. All messages with the
23899 specified log level or higher are logged.
23900
23901 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
23902
23903 @end deftypevr
23904
23905 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
23906 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
23907 used with the following servers as fall-back.
23908
23909 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
23910
23911 @end deftypevr
23912
23913 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
23914 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
23915 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
23916
23917 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23918
23919 @end deftypevr
23920
23921 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
23922 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
23923 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
23924
23925 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23926
23927 @end deftypevr
23928
23929 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
23930 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
23931 applicable when used with binddn.
23932
23933 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23934
23935 @end deftypevr
23936
23937 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
23938 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
23939 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
23940
23941 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23942
23943 @end deftypevr
23944
23945 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
23946 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
23947 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
23948 rootpwmoddn
23949
23950 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23951
23952 @end deftypevr
23953
23954 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
23955 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
23956 authentication.
23957
23958 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23959
23960 @end deftypevr
23961
23962 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
23963 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
23964
23965 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23966
23967 @end deftypevr
23968
23969 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
23970 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
23971 authentication.
23972
23973 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23974
23975 @end deftypevr
23976
23977 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
23978 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
23979 authentication.
23980
23981 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23982
23983 @end deftypevr
23984
23985 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
23986 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
23987 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
23988 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
23989 performed or not.
23990
23991 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23992
23993 @end deftypevr
23994
23995 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
23996 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
23997
23998 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23999
24000 @end deftypevr
24001
24002 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
24003 The directory search base.
24004
24005 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
24006
24007 @end deftypevr
24008
24009 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
24010 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
24011 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
24012 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
24013
24014 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
24015
24016 @end deftypevr
24017
24018 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
24019 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
24020 to never dereference aliases.
24021
24022 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24023
24024 @end deftypevr
24025
24026 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
24027 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
24028 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
24029
24030 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24031
24032 @end deftypevr
24033
24034 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
24035 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
24036 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
24037 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
24038 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
24039
24040 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24041
24042 @end deftypevr
24043
24044 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
24045 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
24046 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
24047
24048 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24049
24050 @end deftypevr
24051
24052 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
24053 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
24054 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
24055
24056 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24057
24058 @end deftypevr
24059
24060 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
24061 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
24062 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
24063 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
24064
24065 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24066
24067 @end deftypevr
24068
24069 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
24070 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
24071 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
24072 out connections.
24073
24074 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24075
24076 @end deftypevr
24077
24078 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
24079 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
24080 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
24081 failure and the first retry.
24082
24083 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24084
24085 @end deftypevr
24086
24087 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
24088 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
24089 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
24090 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
24091
24092 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24093
24094 @end deftypevr
24095
24096 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
24097 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
24098 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
24099 SSL.
24100
24101 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24102
24103 @end deftypevr
24104
24105 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
24106 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
24107 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
24108
24109 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24110
24111 @end deftypevr
24112
24113 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
24114 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
24115 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
24116
24117 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24118
24119 @end deftypevr
24120
24121 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
24122 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
24123
24124 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24125
24126 @end deftypevr
24127
24128 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
24129 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
24130 using GnuTLS.
24131
24132 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24133
24134 @end deftypevr
24135
24136 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
24137 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
24138
24139 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24140
24141 @end deftypevr
24142
24143 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
24144 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
24145 client TLS authentication.
24146
24147 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24148
24149 @end deftypevr
24150
24151 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
24152 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
24153 authentication.
24154
24155 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24156
24157 @end deftypevr
24158
24159 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
24160 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
24161 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
24162 request paged results.
24163
24164 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24165
24166 @end deftypevr
24167
24168 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
24169 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
24170 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
24171 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
24172
24173 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24174
24175 @end deftypevr
24176
24177 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
24178 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
24179 the specified value are ignored.
24180
24181 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24182
24183 @end deftypevr
24184
24185 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
24186 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
24187 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
24188
24189 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24190
24191 @end deftypevr
24192
24193 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
24194 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
24195 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
24196
24197 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24198
24199 @end deftypevr
24200
24201 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
24202 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
24203 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
24204 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
24205 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
24206 groups.
24207
24208 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24209
24210 @end deftypevr
24211
24212 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
24213 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
24214 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
24215 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
24216 groups assigned on login.
24217
24218 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24219
24220 @end deftypevr
24221
24222 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
24223 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
24224 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
24225 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
24226 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
24227 most configurations.
24228
24229 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24230
24231 @end deftypevr
24232
24233 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
24234 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
24235 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
24236 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
24237
24238 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24239
24240 @end deftypevr
24241
24242 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
24243 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
24244 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
24245 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
24246 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
24247
24248 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24249
24250 @end deftypevr
24251
24252 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
24253 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
24254 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
24255
24256 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24257
24258 @end deftypevr
24259
24260 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
24261 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
24262 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
24263 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
24264 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
24265 It should return at least one entry.
24266
24267 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24268
24269 @end deftypevr
24270
24271 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
24272 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
24273 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
24274 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
24275
24276 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24277
24278 @end deftypevr
24279
24280 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
24281 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
24282 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
24283 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
24284 changing their password.
24285
24286 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24287
24288 @end deftypevr
24289
24290 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
24291 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
24292
24293 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24294
24295 @end deftypevr
24296
24297 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
24298
24299
24300 @node Web Services
24301 @subsection Web Services
24302
24303 @cindex web
24304 @cindex www
24305 @cindex HTTP
24306 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
24307 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
24308
24309 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
24310
24311 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
24312 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
24313 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
24314 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
24315
24316 A simple example configuration is given below.
24317
24318 @lisp
24319 (service httpd-service-type
24320 (httpd-configuration
24321 (config
24322 (httpd-config-file
24323 (server-name "www.example.com")
24324 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
24325 @end lisp
24326
24327 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
24328 the configuration.
24329
24330 @lisp
24331 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
24332 (list
24333 (httpd-virtualhost
24334 "*:80"
24335 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
24336 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
24337 "\n")))))
24338 @end lisp
24339 @end deffn
24340
24341 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
24342 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
24343 given below.
24344
24345 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
24346 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
24347
24348 @table @asis
24349 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
24350 The httpd package to use.
24351
24352 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
24353 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
24354
24355 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
24356 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
24357 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
24358 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
24359 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
24360
24361 @end table
24362 @end deffn
24363
24364 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
24365 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
24366
24367 @table @asis
24368 @item @code{name}
24369 The name of the module.
24370
24371 @item @code{file}
24372 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
24373 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
24374 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
24375 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
24376
24377 @end table
24378 @end deffn
24379
24380 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
24381 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
24382 @end defvr
24383
24384 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
24385 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
24386
24387 @table @asis
24388 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
24389 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
24390 additional configuration.
24391
24392 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
24393 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
24394
24395 @lisp
24396 (service httpd-service-type
24397 (httpd-configuration
24398 (config
24399 (httpd-config-file
24400 (modules (cons*
24401 (httpd-module
24402 (name "proxy_module")
24403 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
24404 (httpd-module
24405 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
24406 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
24407 %default-httpd-modules))
24408 (extra-config (list "\
24409 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
24410 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
24411 </FilesMatch>"))))))
24412 (service php-fpm-service-type
24413 (php-fpm-configuration
24414 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
24415 (socket-group "httpd")))
24416 @end lisp
24417
24418 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
24419 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
24420 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
24421 taken as relative to the server root.
24422
24423 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
24424 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
24425 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
24426 itself.
24427
24428 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
24429 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
24430 @code{ServerName}.
24431
24432 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
24433 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
24434
24435 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
24436 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
24437 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
24438 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
24439 protocol to use.
24440
24441 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
24442 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
24443 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
24444 configured correctly.
24445
24446 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
24447 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
24448
24449 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24450 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
24451
24452 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
24453 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
24454
24455 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
24456 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
24457 of the configuration file.
24458
24459 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
24460 list.
24461
24462 @end table
24463 @end deffn
24464
24465 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
24466 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
24467
24468 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
24469
24470 @lisp
24471 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
24472 (list
24473 (httpd-virtualhost
24474 "*:80"
24475 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
24476 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
24477 "\n")))))
24478 @end lisp
24479
24480 @table @asis
24481 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
24482 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
24483
24484 @item @code{contents}
24485 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
24486 of strings and G-expressions.
24487
24488 @end table
24489 @end deffn
24490
24491 @subsubheading NGINX
24492
24493 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
24494 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
24495 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
24496
24497 A simple example configuration is given below.
24498
24499 @lisp
24500 (service nginx-service-type
24501 (nginx-configuration
24502 (server-blocks
24503 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24504 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24505 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
24506 @end lisp
24507
24508 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
24509 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
24510 blocks, as in this example:
24511
24512 @lisp
24513 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
24514 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24515 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
24516 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
24517 @end lisp
24518 @end deffn
24519
24520 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
24521 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
24522 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
24523 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
24524 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
24525 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
24526 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
24527 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
24528
24529 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
24530 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
24531 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
24532 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
24533
24534 @table @asis
24535 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
24536 The nginx package to use.
24537
24538 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
24539 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
24540
24541 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
24542 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
24543 files.
24544
24545 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
24546 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
24547 file, the elements should be of type
24548 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
24549
24550 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
24551 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
24552 HTTPS.
24553 @lisp
24554 (service nginx-service-type
24555 (nginx-configuration
24556 (server-blocks
24557 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24558 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24559 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
24560 @end lisp
24561
24562 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
24563 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
24564 file, the elements should be of type
24565 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
24566
24567 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
24568 when combined with @code{locations} in the
24569 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
24570 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
24571 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
24572 requests with two servers.
24573
24574 @lisp
24575 (service
24576 nginx-service-type
24577 (nginx-configuration
24578 (server-blocks
24579 (list (nginx-server-configuration
24580 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
24581 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
24582 (locations
24583 (list
24584 (nginx-location-configuration
24585 (uri "/path1")
24586 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
24587 (upstream-blocks
24588 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
24589 (name "server-proxy")
24590 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
24591 "server2.example.com")))))))
24592 @end lisp
24593
24594 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
24595 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
24596 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
24597 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
24598 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
24599 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
24600
24601 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
24602 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
24603 nginx-configuration record.
24604
24605 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
24606 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
24607 use the size of the processors cache line.
24608
24609 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
24610 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
24611
24612 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
24613 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
24614 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
24615
24616 @lisp
24617 (modules
24618 (list
24619 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
24620 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")
24621 (file-append nginx-lua-module "\
24622 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_lua_module.so")))
24623 @end lisp
24624
24625 @item @code{lua-package-path} (default: @code{'()})
24626 List of nginx lua packages to load. This should be a list of package
24627 names of loadable lua modules, as in this example:
24628
24629 @lisp
24630 (lua-package-path (list lua-resty-core
24631 lua-resty-lrucache
24632 lua-resty-signal
24633 lua-tablepool
24634 lua-resty-shell))
24635 @end lisp
24636
24637 @item @code{lua-package-cpath} (default: @code{'()})
24638 List of nginx lua C packages to load. This should be a list of package
24639 names of loadable lua C modules, as in this example:
24640
24641 @lisp
24642 (lua-package-cpath (list lua-resty-signal))
24643 @end lisp
24644
24645 @item @code{global-directives} (default: @code{'((events . ()))})
24646 Association list of global directives for the top level of the nginx
24647 configuration. Values may themselves be association lists.
24648
24649 @lisp
24650 (global-directives
24651 `((worker_processes . 16)
24652 (pcre_jit . on)
24653 (events . ((worker_connections . 1024)))))
24654 @end lisp
24655
24656 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
24657 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
24658 valued G-expression.
24659
24660 @end table
24661 @end deffn
24662
24663 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
24664 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
24665 This type has the following parameters:
24666
24667 @table @asis
24668 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
24669 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
24670 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
24671 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
24672 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
24673
24674 @lisp
24675 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
24676 @end lisp
24677
24678 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
24679 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
24680 default server for connections matching no other server.
24681
24682 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
24683 Root of the website nginx will serve.
24684
24685 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
24686 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
24687 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
24688 server block.
24689
24690 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
24691 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
24692 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
24693
24694 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
24695 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
24696 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
24697
24698 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
24699 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
24700 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
24701
24702 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
24703 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
24704 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
24705
24706 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
24707 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
24708
24709 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
24710 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
24711
24712 @end table
24713 @end deftp
24714
24715 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
24716 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
24717 block. This type has the following parameters:
24718
24719 @table @asis
24720 @item @code{name}
24721 Name for this group of servers.
24722
24723 @item @code{servers}
24724 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
24725 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
24726 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
24727 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
24728 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
24729 explicitly.
24730
24731 @end table
24732 @end deftp
24733
24734 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
24735 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
24736 block. This type has the following parameters:
24737
24738 @table @asis
24739 @item @code{uri}
24740 URI which this location block matches.
24741
24742 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
24743 @item @code{body}
24744 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
24745 many
24746 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
24747 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
24748 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
24749 http://upstream-name;")}.
24750
24751 @end table
24752 @end deftp
24753
24754 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
24755 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
24756 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
24757 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
24758 parameters:
24759
24760 @table @asis
24761 @item @code{name}
24762 Name to identify this location block.
24763
24764 @item @code{body}
24765 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
24766 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
24767 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
24768 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
24769
24770 @end table
24771 @end deftp
24772
24773 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
24774 @cindex Varnish
24775 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
24776 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
24777 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
24778 creates one request to the back-end.
24779
24780 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
24781 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
24782 @end defvr
24783
24784 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
24785 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
24786 This type has the following parameters:
24787
24788 @table @asis
24789 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
24790 The Varnish package to use.
24791
24792 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
24793 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
24794 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
24795 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
24796 directory name.
24797
24798 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
24799 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
24800
24801 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
24802 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
24803
24804 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
24805 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
24806 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
24807 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
24808 VCL syntax.
24809
24810 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
24811 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
24812 can do something along these lines:
24813
24814 @lisp
24815 (define %gnu-mirror
24816 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
24817 "vcl 4.1;
24818 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
24819
24820 (operating-system
24821 ;; @dots{}
24822 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
24823 (varnish-configuration
24824 (listen '(":80"))
24825 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
24826 %base-services)))
24827 @end lisp
24828
24829 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
24830 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
24831
24832 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
24833 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
24834 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
24835
24836 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
24837 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
24838
24839 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
24840 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
24841
24842 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
24843 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
24844
24845 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
24846 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
24847
24848 @end table
24849 @end deftp
24850
24851 @subsubheading Patchwork
24852 @cindex Patchwork
24853 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
24854 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
24855
24856 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
24857 Service type for Patchwork.
24858 @end defvr
24859
24860 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
24861 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
24862
24863 @lisp
24864 (service patchwork-service-type
24865 (patchwork-configuration
24866 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
24867 (settings-module
24868 (patchwork-settings-module
24869 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
24870 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
24871 (getmail-retriever-config
24872 (getmail-retriever-configuration
24873 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
24874 (server "imap.example.com")
24875 (port 993)
24876 (username "patchwork")
24877 (password-command
24878 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
24879 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
24880 (extra-parameters
24881 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
24882
24883 @end lisp
24884
24885 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
24886 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
24887 within the HTTPD service.
24888
24889 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
24890 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
24891 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
24892
24893 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
24894 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
24895 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
24896
24897 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
24898 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
24899 following parameters:
24900
24901 @table @asis
24902 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
24903 The Patchwork package to use.
24904
24905 @item @code{domain}
24906 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
24907 host.
24908
24909 @item @code{settings-module}
24910 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
24911 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
24912 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
24913 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
24914 store.
24915
24916 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
24917 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
24918
24919 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
24920 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
24921 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
24922 delivered to Patchwork.
24923
24924 @end table
24925 @end deftp
24926
24927 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
24928 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
24929 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
24930 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
24931 has the following parameters:
24932
24933 @table @asis
24934 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
24935 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
24936 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
24937
24938 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
24939 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
24940 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
24941
24942 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
24943 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
24944
24945 This setting relates to Django.
24946
24947 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
24948 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
24949 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
24950
24951 This is a Django setting.
24952
24953 @item @code{default-from-email}
24954 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
24955
24956 This is a Patchwork setting.
24957
24958 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
24959 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
24960 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
24961
24962 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
24963 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
24964
24965 This is a Django setting.
24966
24967 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
24968 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
24969 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
24970
24971 This is a Django setting.
24972
24973 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
24974 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
24975 messages will be shown.
24976
24977 This is a Django setting.
24978
24979 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
24980 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
24981
24982 This is a Patchwork setting.
24983
24984 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
24985 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
24986
24987 This is a Patchwork setting.
24988
24989 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
24990 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
24991
24992 This is a Patchwork setting.
24993
24994 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
24995 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
24996
24997 @end table
24998 @end deftp
24999
25000 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
25001 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
25002
25003 @table @asis
25004 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
25005 The database engine to use.
25006
25007 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
25008 The name of the database to use.
25009
25010 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
25011 The user to connect to the database as.
25012
25013 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
25014 The password to use when connecting to the database.
25015
25016 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
25017 The host to make the database connection to.
25018
25019 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
25020 The port on which to connect to the database.
25021
25022 @end table
25023 @end deftp
25024
25025 @subsubheading Mumi
25026
25027 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
25028 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
25029 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
25030 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
25031 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
25032 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
25033
25034 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
25035 This is the service type for Mumi.
25036 @end defvr
25037
25038 @deftp {Data Type} mumi-configuration
25039 Data type representing the Mumi service configuration. This type has the
25040 following fields:
25041
25042 @table @asis
25043 @item @code{mumi} (default: @code{mumi})
25044 The Mumi package to use.
25045
25046 @item @code{mailer?} (default: @code{#true})
25047 Whether to enable or disable the mailer component.
25048
25049 @item @code{mumi-configuration-sender}
25050 The email address used as the sender for comments.
25051
25052 @item @code{mumi-configuration-smtp}
25053 A URI to configure the SMTP settings for Mailutils. This could be
25054 something like @code{sendmail:///path/to/bin/msmtp} or any other URI
25055 supported by Mailutils. @xref{SMTP Mailboxes, SMTP Mailboxes,,
25056 mailutils, GNU@tie{}Mailutils}.
25057
25058 @end table
25059 @end deftp
25060
25061
25062 @subsubheading FastCGI
25063 @cindex fastcgi
25064 @cindex fcgiwrap
25065 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
25066 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
25067 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
25068 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
25069 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
25070 support for it in Guix.
25071
25072 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
25073 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
25074 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
25075 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
25076 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
25077 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
25078
25079 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
25080 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
25081 @end defvr
25082
25083 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
25084 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
25085 This type has the following parameters:
25086 @table @asis
25087 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25088 The fcgiwrap package to use.
25089
25090 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
25091 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
25092 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
25093 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
25094 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
25095 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
25096
25097 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25098 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
25099 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
25100 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
25101 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
25102 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
25103
25104 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
25105 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
25106 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
25107 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
25108 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
25109 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
25110 @end table
25111 @end deftp
25112
25113 @cindex php-fpm
25114 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
25115 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
25116
25117 These features include:
25118 @itemize @bullet
25119 @item Adaptive process spawning
25120 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
25121 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
25122 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
25123 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
25124 @item Stdout & stderr logging
25125 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
25126 @item Accelerated upload support
25127 @item Support for a "slowlog"
25128 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
25129 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
25130 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
25131 @end itemize
25132 ...@: and much more.
25133
25134 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
25135 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
25136 @end defvr
25137
25138 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
25139 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
25140 @table @asis
25141 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
25142 The php package to use.
25143 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
25144 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
25145 @table @asis
25146 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
25147 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
25148 @item @code{"port"}
25149 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
25150 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
25151 Listen on a unix socket.
25152 @end table
25153
25154 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25155 User who will own the php worker processes.
25156 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25157 Group of the worker processes.
25158 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
25159 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25160 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
25161 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
25162 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
25163 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
25164 once the service has started.
25165 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
25166 Log for the php-fpm master process.
25167 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
25168 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
25169 Must be one of:
25170 @table @asis
25171 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
25172 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
25173 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
25174 @end table
25175 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
25176 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
25177 and displayed in their browsers.
25178 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
25179 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
25180 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
25181 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
25182 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
25183 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
25184 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
25185 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
25186 An optional override of the whole configuration.
25187 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25188 @item @code{php-ini-file} (default @code{#f})
25189 An optional override of the default php settings.
25190 It may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
25191 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
25192
25193 For local development it is useful to set a higher timeout and memory
25194 limit for spawned php processes. This be accomplished with the
25195 following operating system configuration snippet:
25196 @lisp
25197 (define %local-php-ini
25198 (plain-file "php.ini"
25199 "memory_limit = 2G
25200 max_execution_time = 1800"))
25201
25202 (operating-system
25203 ;; @dots{}
25204 (services (cons (service php-fpm-service-type
25205 (php-fpm-configuration
25206 (php-ini-file %local-php-ini)))
25207 %base-services)))
25208 @end lisp
25209
25210 Consult the @url{https://www.php.net/manual/en/ini.core.php,core php.ini
25211 directives} for comprehensive documentation on the acceptable
25212 @file{php.ini} directives.
25213 @end table
25214 @end deftp
25215
25216 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
25217 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
25218 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
25219 based on it's configured limits.
25220 @table @asis
25221 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25222 Maximum of worker processes.
25223 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
25224 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
25225 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
25226 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
25227 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
25228 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
25229 @end table
25230 @end deftp
25231
25232 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
25233 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
25234 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
25235 are created.
25236 @table @asis
25237 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25238 Maximum of worker processes.
25239 @end table
25240 @end deftp
25241
25242 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
25243 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
25244 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
25245 requests arrive.
25246 @table @asis
25247 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
25248 Maximum of worker processes.
25249 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
25250 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
25251 @end table
25252 @end deftp
25253
25254
25255 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-location @
25256 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
25257 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
25258 (version-major (package-version php)) @
25259 "-fpm.sock")]
25260 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
25261 @end deffn
25262
25263 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
25264 @lisp
25265 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
25266 (service php-fpm-service-type)
25267 (service nginx-service-type
25268 (nginx-server-configuration
25269 (server-name '("example.com"))
25270 (root "/srv/http/")
25271 (locations
25272 (list (nginx-php-location)))
25273 (listen '("80"))
25274 (ssl-certificate #f)
25275 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
25276 %base-services))
25277 @end lisp
25278
25279 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
25280 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
25281 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
25282 the hash of a user's email address.
25283
25284 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
25285 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
25286 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
25287 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
25288 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
25289 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
25290 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
25291 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
25292 @end deffn
25293
25294 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
25295 @lisp
25296 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
25297 #:configuration
25298 (nginx-server-configuration
25299 (server-name '("example.com"))))
25300 ...
25301 %base-services))
25302 @end lisp
25303
25304 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
25305
25306 @cindex hpcguix-web
25307 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
25308 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
25309 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
25310 clusters.
25311
25312 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
25313 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
25314 @end defvr
25315
25316 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
25317 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
25318
25319 @table @asis
25320 @item @code{specs}
25321 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
25322 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
25323
25324 @table @asis
25325 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
25326 The page title prefix.
25327
25328 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
25329 The @command{guix} command.
25330
25331 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
25332 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
25333
25334 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
25335 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
25336
25337 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
25338 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
25339
25340 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
25341 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
25342
25343 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
25344 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
25345 the latest instances of the given channels.
25346 @end table
25347
25348 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
25349 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
25350 complete example}.
25351
25352 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
25353 The hpcguix-web package to use.
25354 @end table
25355 @end deftp
25356
25357 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
25358
25359 @lisp
25360 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
25361 (hpcguix-web-configuration
25362 (specs
25363 #~(define site-config
25364 (hpcweb-configuration
25365 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
25366 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
25367 @end lisp
25368
25369 @quotation Note
25370 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
25371 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
25372 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
25373 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
25374
25375 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
25376 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
25377 more information on X.509 certificates.
25378 @end quotation
25379
25380 @subsubheading gmnisrv
25381
25382 @cindex gmnisrv
25383 The @uref{https://git.sr.ht/~sircmpwn/gmnisrv, gmnisrv} program is a
25384 simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini} protocol server.
25385
25386 @deffn {Scheme Variable} gmnisrv-service-type
25387 This is the type of the gmnisrv service, whose value should be a
25388 @code{gmnisrv-configuration} object, as in this example:
25389
25390 @lisp
25391 (service gmnisrv-service-type
25392 (gmnisrv-configuration
25393 (config-file (local-file "./my-gmnisrv.ini"))))
25394 @end lisp
25395 @end deffn
25396
25397 @deftp {Data Type} gmnisrv-configuration
25398 Data type representing the configuration of gmnisrv.
25399
25400 @table @asis
25401 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gmnisrv})
25402 Package object of the gmnisrv server.
25403
25404 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-gmnisrv-config-file})
25405 File-like object of the gmnisrv configuration file to use. The default
25406 configuration listens on port 1965 and serves files from
25407 @file{/srv/gemini}. Certificates are stored in
25408 @file{/var/lib/gemini/certs}. For more information, run @command{man
25409 gmnisrv} and @command{man gmnisrv.ini}.
25410
25411 @end table
25412 @end deftp
25413
25414 @subsubheading Agate
25415
25416 @cindex agate
25417 The @uref{gemini://qwertqwefsday.eu/agate.gmi, Agate}
25418 (@uref{https://github.com/mbrubeck/agate, GitHub page over HTTPS})
25419 program is a simple @uref{https://gemini.circumlunar.space/, Gemini}
25420 protocol server written in Rust.
25421
25422 @deffn {Scheme Variable} agate-service-type
25423 This is the type of the agate service, whose value should be an
25424 @code{agate-service-type} object, as in this example:
25425
25426 @lisp
25427 (service agate-service-type
25428 (agate-configuration
25429 (content "/srv/gemini")
25430 (cert "/srv/cert.pem")
25431 (key "/srv/key.rsa")))
25432 @end lisp
25433
25434 The example above represents the minimal tweaking necessary to get Agate
25435 up and running. Specifying the path to the certificate and key is
25436 always necessary, as the Gemini protocol requires TLS by default.
25437
25438 To obtain a certificate and a key, you could, for example, use OpenSSL,
25439 running a command similar to the following example:
25440
25441 @example
25442 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:4096 -keyout key.rsa -out cert.pem \
25443 -days 3650 -nodes -subj "/CN=example.com"
25444 @end example
25445
25446 Of course, you'll have to replace @i{example.com} with your own domain
25447 name, and then point the Agate configuration towards the path of the
25448 generated key and certificate.
25449
25450 @end deffn
25451
25452 @deftp {Data Type} agate-configuration
25453 Data type representing the configuration of Agate.
25454
25455 @table @asis
25456 @item @code{package} (default: @code{agate})
25457 The package object of the Agate server.
25458
25459 @item @code{content} (default: @file{"/srv/gemini"})
25460 The directory from which Agate will serve files.
25461
25462 @item @code{cert} (default: @code{#f})
25463 The path to the TLS certificate PEM file to be used for encrypted
25464 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
25465
25466 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
25467 The path to the PKCS8 private key file to be used for encrypted
25468 connections. Must be filled in with a value from the user.
25469
25470 @item @code{addr} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0:1965" "[::]:1965")})
25471 A list of the addresses to listen on.
25472
25473 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
25474 The domain name of this Gemini server. Optional.
25475
25476 @item @code{lang} (default: @code{#f})
25477 RFC 4646 language code(s) for text/gemini documents. Optional.
25478
25479 @item @code{silent?} (default: @code{#f})
25480 Set to @code{#t} to disable logging output.
25481
25482 @item @code{serve-secret?} (default: @code{#f})
25483 Set to @code{#t} to serve secret files (files/directories starting with
25484 a dot).
25485
25486 @item @code{log-ip?} (default: @code{#t})
25487 Whether or not to output IP addresses when logging.
25488
25489 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"agate"})
25490 Owner of the @code{agate} process.
25491
25492 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"agate"})
25493 Owner's group of the @code{agate} process.
25494
25495 @item @code{log-file} (default: @file{"/var/log/agate.log"})
25496 The file which should store the logging output of Agate.
25497
25498 @end table
25499 @end deftp
25500
25501 @node Certificate Services
25502 @subsection Certificate Services
25503
25504 @cindex Web
25505 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
25506 @cindex Let's Encrypt
25507 @cindex TLS certificates
25508 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
25509 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
25510 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
25511 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
25512 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
25513 authenticity.
25514
25515 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
25516 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
25517 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
25518 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
25519 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
25520 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
25521 response over HTTP@. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
25522 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
25523 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
25524 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
25525 signature.
25526
25527 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
25528 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
25529 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
25530 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
25531 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
25532 with different permissions).
25533
25534 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
25535 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
25536 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
25537 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
25538 some reason.
25539
25540 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
25541 can be found there:
25542 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
25543
25544 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
25545 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
25546 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
25547
25548 @lisp
25549 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
25550 (program-file
25551 "nginx-deploy-hook"
25552 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
25553 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
25554
25555 (service certbot-service-type
25556 (certbot-configuration
25557 (email "foo@@example.net")
25558 (certificates
25559 (list
25560 (certificate-configuration
25561 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
25562 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
25563 (certificate-configuration
25564 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
25565 @end lisp
25566
25567 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
25568 @end defvr
25569
25570 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
25571 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
25572 This type has the following parameters:
25573
25574 @table @asis
25575 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
25576 The certbot package to use.
25577
25578 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
25579 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
25580 files.
25581
25582 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
25583 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
25584 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
25585 and several @code{domains}.
25586
25587 @item @code{email} (default: @code{#f})
25588 Optional email address used for registration and recovery contact.
25589 Setting this is encouraged as it allows you to receive important
25590 notifications about the account and issued certificates.
25591
25592 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
25593 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
25594 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
25595
25596 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
25597 Size of the RSA key.
25598
25599 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
25600 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
25601 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
25602 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
25603 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
25604 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
25605 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
25606 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
25607 these nginx configuration data types.
25608
25609 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
25610 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
25611 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
25612
25613 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
25614 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
25615 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
25616
25617 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
25618 @end table
25619 @end deftp
25620
25621 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
25622 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
25623 This type has the following parameters:
25624
25625 @table @asis
25626 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
25627 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
25628 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
25629 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
25630
25631 Its default is the first provided domain.
25632
25633 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
25634 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
25635 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
25636
25637 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
25638 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
25639 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
25640 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
25641 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
25642 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
25643 requesting machine.
25644
25645 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25646 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
25647 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
25648 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
25649 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
25650 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
25651
25652 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25653 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
25654 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
25655 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
25656 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
25657 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
25658
25659 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
25660 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
25661 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
25662 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
25663 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
25664 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
25665 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
25666 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
25667
25668 @end table
25669 @end deftp
25670
25671 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
25672 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
25673 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
25674 @node DNS Services
25675 @subsection DNS Services
25676 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
25677 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
25678
25679 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
25680 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
25681 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
25682 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
25683 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
25684 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
25685
25686 @subsubheading Knot Service
25687
25688 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
25689 and one slave, is:
25690
25691 @lisp
25692 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
25693 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
25694 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
25695 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
25696 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
25697
25698 (define master-zone
25699 (knot-zone-configuration
25700 (domain "example.org")
25701 (zone (zone-file
25702 (origin "example.org")
25703 (entries example.org.zone)))))
25704
25705 (define slave-zone
25706 (knot-zone-configuration
25707 (domain "plop.org")
25708 (dnssec-policy "default")
25709 (master (list "plop-master"))))
25710
25711 (define plop-master
25712 (knot-remote-configuration
25713 (id "plop-master")
25714 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
25715
25716 (operating-system
25717 ;; ...
25718 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
25719 (knot-configuration
25720 (remotes (list plop-master))
25721 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
25722 ;; ...
25723 %base-services)))
25724 @end lisp
25725
25726 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
25727 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
25728
25729 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
25730 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
25731 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
25732 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
25733 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
25734 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
25735 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
25736
25737 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
25738 @end deffn
25739
25740 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
25741 Data type representing a key.
25742 This type has the following parameters:
25743
25744 @table @asis
25745 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25746 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
25747 be unique and must not be empty.
25748
25749 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
25750 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
25751 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
25752 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
25753
25754 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
25755 The secret key itself.
25756
25757 @end table
25758 @end deftp
25759
25760 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
25761 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
25762 This type has the following parameters:
25763
25764 @table @asis
25765 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25766 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
25767 unique and must not be empty.
25768
25769 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
25770 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
25771 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
25772 address match is not required.
25773
25774 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
25775 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
25776 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
25777 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
25778
25779 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
25780 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL@. Possible
25781 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
25782 and @code{'update}.
25783
25784 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
25785 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
25786 false, listed actions are allowed.
25787
25788 @end table
25789 @end deftp
25790
25791 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
25792 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
25793 This type has the following parameters:
25794
25795 @table @asis
25796 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
25797 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
25798 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
25799 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
25800 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
25801 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
25802
25803 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
25804 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
25805
25806 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
25807 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
25808 partially @code{"CH"}.
25809
25810 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
25811 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
25812 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
25813 defined.
25814
25815 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
25816 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
25817 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
25818 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
25819
25820 @end table
25821 @end deftp
25822
25823 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
25824 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
25825 This type has the following parameters:
25826
25827 @table @asis
25828 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
25829 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
25830 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
25831 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
25832 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
25833 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
25834 field of the @code{zone-file}.
25835
25836 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
25837 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
25838
25839 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
25840 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
25841 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
25842 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
25843 to an IP address in the list of entries.
25844
25845 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
25846 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
25847 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
25848
25849 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
25850 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
25851 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
25852 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
25853
25854 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
25855 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
25856 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
25857 @code{(string->duration)}.
25858
25859 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
25860 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
25861 to do so a first time.
25862
25863 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
25864 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
25865 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
25866 and check again that it still exists.
25867
25868 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
25869 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
25870 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
25871
25872 @end table
25873 @end deftp
25874
25875 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
25876 Data type representing a remote configuration.
25877 This type has the following parameters:
25878
25879 @table @asis
25880 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25881 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
25882 be unique and must not be empty.
25883
25884 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
25885 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
25886 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
25887 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
25888
25889 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
25890 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
25891 an appropriate source IP@. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
25892 The default is to choose at random.
25893
25894 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
25895 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
25896 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
25897
25898 @end table
25899 @end deftp
25900
25901 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
25902 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
25903 This type has the following parameters:
25904
25905 @table @asis
25906 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25907 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
25908
25909 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
25910 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
25911
25912 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
25913 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
25914 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
25915 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
25916
25917 @end table
25918 @end deftp
25919
25920 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
25921 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
25922 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
25923 use keys that you generate.
25924
25925 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
25926 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
25927 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
25928 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
25929 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
25930 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
25931
25932 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
25933 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
25934 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
25935 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
25936 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
25937
25938 This type has the following parameters:
25939
25940 @table @asis
25941 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
25942 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
25943
25944 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
25945 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
25946 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
25947 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
25948 was setup by this service).
25949
25950 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
25951 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
25952
25953 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
25954 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
25955
25956 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
25957 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
25958
25959 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
25960 The length of the KSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
25961 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
25962
25963 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
25964 The length of the ZSK@. Note that this value is correct for the default
25965 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
25966
25967 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
25968 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
25969 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
25970
25971 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
25972 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
25973
25974 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
25975 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
25976 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
25977
25978 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
25979 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
25980
25981 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
25982 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
25983
25984 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
25985 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
25986
25987 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
25988 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
25989
25990 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
25991 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
25992 name before hashing.
25993
25994 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
25995 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
25996
25997 @end table
25998 @end deftp
25999
26000 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
26001 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
26002 This type has the following parameters:
26003
26004 @table @asis
26005 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
26006 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
26007
26008 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
26009 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
26010 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
26011
26012 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
26013 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
26014 must contain a zone-file record.
26015
26016 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
26017 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
26018 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
26019
26020 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
26021 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
26022 masters.
26023
26024 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
26025 A list of slave remote identifiers.
26026
26027 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
26028 A list of acl identifiers.
26029
26030 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
26031 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
26032
26033 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
26034 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
26035
26036 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
26037 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
26038 synchronization.
26039
26040 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
26041 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
26042 are:
26043
26044 @itemize
26045 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
26046 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
26047 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
26048 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
26049 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
26050 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
26051 automatically.
26052 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
26053 @end itemize
26054
26055 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
26056 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
26057 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
26058 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26059 default value from Knot is used.
26060
26061 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
26062 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
26063 so the default value from Knot is used.
26064
26065 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
26066 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
26067 default value from Knot is used.
26068
26069 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
26070 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
26071 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
26072 value from Knot is used.
26073
26074 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
26075 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
26076 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
26077 on this zone.
26078
26079 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
26080 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
26081
26082 @end table
26083 @end deftp
26084
26085 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
26086 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
26087 This type has the following parameters:
26088
26089 @table @asis
26090 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
26091 The Knot package.
26092
26093 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
26094 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
26095
26096 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
26097 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
26098 included at the top of the configuration file.
26099
26100 @cindex secrets, Knot service
26101 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
26102 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
26103 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
26104 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
26105 to the @code{includes} list.
26106
26107 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
26108 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
26109 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
26110 tsig key:
26111
26112 @example
26113 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26114 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
26115 @end example
26116
26117 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
26118 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
26119 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
26120 to that key.
26121
26122 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
26123
26124 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
26125 An ip address on which to listen.
26126
26127 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
26128 An ip address on which to listen.
26129
26130 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
26131 A port on which to listen.
26132
26133 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
26134 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
26135
26136 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
26137 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
26138
26139 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
26140 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
26141
26142 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
26143 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
26144
26145 @end table
26146 @end deftp
26147
26148 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
26149
26150 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
26151 This is the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
26152 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
26153
26154 @lisp
26155 (service knot-resolver-service-type
26156 (knot-resolver-configuration
26157 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
26158 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
26159 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
26160 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
26161 cache.size = 100 * MB
26162 "))))
26163 @end lisp
26164
26165 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
26166 @end deffn
26167
26168 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
26169 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
26170
26171 @table @asis
26172 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
26173 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
26174
26175 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
26176 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
26177 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
26178
26179 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
26180 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
26181
26182 @end table
26183 @end deftp
26184
26185
26186 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
26187
26188 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
26189 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
26190 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
26191
26192 @lisp
26193 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26194 (dnsmasq-configuration
26195 (no-resolv? #t)
26196 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
26197 @end lisp
26198 @end deffn
26199
26200 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
26201 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
26202
26203 @table @asis
26204 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
26205 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
26206
26207 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
26208 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
26209
26210 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
26211 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
26212 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
26213
26214 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
26215 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
26216 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
26217
26218 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26219 Listen on the given IP addresses.
26220
26221 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
26222 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
26223
26224 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
26225 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
26226
26227 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
26228 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
26229
26230 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'()})
26231 For each entry, specify an IP address to return for any host in the
26232 given domains. Queries in the domains are never forwarded and always
26233 replied to with the specified IP address.
26234
26235 This is useful for redirecting hosts locally, for example:
26236
26237 @lisp
26238 (service dnsmasq-service-type
26239 (dnsmasq-configuration
26240 (addresses
26241 '(; Redirect to a local web-server.
26242 "/example.org/127.0.0.1"
26243 ; Redirect subdomain to a specific IP.
26244 "/subdomain.example.org/192.168.1.42"))))
26245 @end lisp
26246
26247 Note that rules in @file{/etc/hosts} take precedence over this.
26248
26249 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
26250 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
26251 disables caching.
26252
26253 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
26254 When false, disable negative caching.
26255
26256 @item @code{tftp-enable?} (default: @code{#f})
26257 Whether to enable the built-in TFTP server.
26258
26259 @item @code{tftp-no-fail?} (default: @code{#f})
26260 If true, does not fail dnsmasq if the TFTP server could not start up.
26261
26262 @item @code{tftp-single-port?} (default: @code{#f})
26263 Whether to use only one single port for TFTP.
26264
26265 @item @code{tftp-secure?} (default: @code{#f})
26266 If true, only files owned by the user running the dnsmasq process are accessible.
26267
26268 If dnsmasq is being run as root, different rules apply:
26269 @code{tftp-secure?} has no effect, but only files which have the
26270 world-readable bit set are accessible.
26271
26272 @item @code{tftp-max} (default: @code{#f})
26273 If set, sets the maximal number of concurrent connections allowed.
26274
26275 @item @code{tftp-mtu} (default: @code{#f})
26276 If set, sets the MTU for TFTP packets to that value.
26277
26278 @item @code{tftp-no-blocksize?} (default: @code{#f})
26279 If true, stops the TFTP server from negotiating the blocksize with a client.
26280
26281 @item @code{tftp-lowercase?} (default: @code{#f})
26282 Whether to convert all filenames in TFTP requests to lowercase.
26283
26284 @item @code{tftp-port-range} (default: @code{#f})
26285 If set, fixes the dynamical ports (one per client) to the given range
26286 (@code{"<start>,<end>"}).
26287
26288 @item @code{tftp-root} (default: @code{/var/empty,lo})
26289 Look for files to transfer using TFTP relative to the given directory.
26290 When this is set, TFTP paths which include @samp{..} are rejected, to stop clients
26291 getting outside the specified root. Absolute paths (starting with @samp{/}) are
26292 allowed, but they must be within the TFTP-root. If the optional interface
26293 argument is given, the directory is only used for TFTP requests via that
26294 interface.
26295
26296 @item @code{tftp-unique-root} (default: @code{#f})
26297 If set, add the IP or hardware address of the TFTP client as a path component
26298 on the end of the TFTP-root. Only valid if a TFTP root is set and the
26299 directory exists. Defaults to adding IP address (in standard dotted-quad
26300 format).
26301
26302 For instance, if @option{--tftp-root} is @samp{/tftp} and client
26303 @samp{1.2.3.4} requests file @file{myfile} then the effective path will
26304 be @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4/myfile} if @file{/tftp/1.2.3.4} exists or
26305 @file{/tftp/myfile} otherwise. When @samp{=mac} is specified it will
26306 append the MAC address instead, using lowercase zero padded digits
26307 separated by dashes, e.g.: @samp{01-02-03-04-aa-bb}. Note that
26308 resolving MAC addresses is only possible if the client is in the local
26309 network or obtained a DHCP lease from dnsmasq.
26310
26311 @end table
26312 @end deftp
26313
26314 @subsubheading ddclient Service
26315
26316 @cindex ddclient
26317 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
26318 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
26319 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
26320
26321 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
26322 configuration:
26323
26324 @lisp
26325 (service ddclient-service-type)
26326 @end lisp
26327
26328 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
26329 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
26330 @code{secret-file} below). You are expected to create this file manually, in
26331 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
26332 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
26333 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}). See the examples in the
26334 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
26335
26336 @c %start of fragment
26337
26338 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
26339
26340 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
26341 The ddclient package.
26342
26343 @end deftypevr
26344
26345 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
26346 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
26347
26348 Defaults to @samp{300}.
26349
26350 @end deftypevr
26351
26352 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
26353 Use syslog for the output.
26354
26355 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26356
26357 @end deftypevr
26358
26359 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
26360 Mail to user.
26361
26362 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26363
26364 @end deftypevr
26365
26366 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
26367 Mail failed update to user.
26368
26369 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
26370
26371 @end deftypevr
26372
26373 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
26374 The ddclient PID file.
26375
26376 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
26377
26378 @end deftypevr
26379
26380 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
26381 Enable SSL support.
26382
26383 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26384
26385 @end deftypevr
26386
26387 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
26388 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
26389 program.
26390
26391 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
26392
26393 @end deftypevr
26394
26395 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
26396 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
26397
26398 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
26399
26400 @end deftypevr
26401
26402 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
26403 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
26404 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
26405 create it manually.
26406
26407 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
26408
26409 @end deftypevr
26410
26411 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
26412 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
26413
26414 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26415
26416 @end deftypevr
26417
26418
26419 @c %end of fragment
26420
26421
26422 @node VPN Services
26423 @subsection VPN Services
26424 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
26425 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
26426
26427 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
26428 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs).
26429
26430 @subsubheading OpenVPN
26431
26432 It provides a @emph{client} service for your machine to connect to a
26433 VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine to host a VPN@.
26434
26435 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
26436 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
26437
26438 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
26439 @end deffn
26440
26441 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
26442 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
26443
26444 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
26445
26446 Both can be run simultaneously.
26447 @end deffn
26448
26449 @c %automatically generated documentation
26450
26451 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
26452
26453 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
26454 The OpenVPN package.
26455
26456 @end deftypevr
26457
26458 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
26459 The OpenVPN pid file.
26460
26461 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
26462
26463 @end deftypevr
26464
26465 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
26466 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
26467 servers.
26468
26469 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
26470
26471 @end deftypevr
26472
26473 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
26474 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
26475
26476 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
26477
26478 @end deftypevr
26479
26480 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
26481 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
26482 it to @code{'disabled}.
26483
26484 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
26485 The certificate authority to check connections against.
26486
26487 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
26488
26489 @end deftypevr
26490
26491 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
26492 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
26493 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
26494
26495 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
26496
26497 @end deftypevr
26498
26499 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
26500 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
26501 certificate is @code{cert}.
26502
26503 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
26504
26505 @end deftypevr
26506
26507 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
26508 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
26509
26510 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26511
26512 @end deftypevr
26513
26514 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
26515 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
26516
26517 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26518
26519 @end deftypevr
26520
26521 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
26522 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
26523 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
26524
26525 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26526
26527 @end deftypevr
26528
26529 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
26530 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
26531 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
26532
26533 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26534 @end deftypevr
26535
26536 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
26537 Verbosity level.
26538
26539 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26540
26541 @end deftypevr
26542
26543 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
26544 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
26545 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
26546
26547 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26548
26549 @end deftypevr
26550
26551 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
26552 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
26553 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
26554 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
26555
26556 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
26557 @end deftypevr
26558
26559 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
26560 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
26561
26562 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26563
26564 @end deftypevr
26565
26566 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
26567 Bind to a specific local port number.
26568
26569 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26570
26571 @end deftypevr
26572
26573 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
26574 Retry resolving server address.
26575
26576 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26577
26578 @end deftypevr
26579
26580 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
26581 A list of remote servers to connect to.
26582
26583 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26584
26585 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
26586
26587 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
26588 Server name.
26589
26590 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
26591
26592 @end deftypevr
26593
26594 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
26595 Port number the server listens to.
26596
26597 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
26598
26599 @end deftypevr
26600
26601 @end deftypevr
26602 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
26603
26604 @c %automatically generated documentation
26605
26606 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
26607
26608 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
26609 The OpenVPN package.
26610
26611 @end deftypevr
26612
26613 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
26614 The OpenVPN pid file.
26615
26616 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
26617
26618 @end deftypevr
26619
26620 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
26621 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
26622 servers.
26623
26624 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
26625
26626 @end deftypevr
26627
26628 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
26629 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
26630
26631 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
26632
26633 @end deftypevr
26634
26635 If you do not have some of these files (eg.@: you use a username and
26636 password), you can disable any of the following three fields by setting
26637 it to @code{'disabled}.
26638
26639 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ca
26640 The certificate authority to check connections against.
26641
26642 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
26643
26644 @end deftypevr
26645
26646 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string cert
26647 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
26648 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
26649
26650 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
26651
26652 @end deftypevr
26653
26654 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} maybe-string key
26655 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
26656 certificate is @code{cert}.
26657
26658 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
26659
26660 @end deftypevr
26661
26662 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
26663 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
26664
26665 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26666
26667 @end deftypevr
26668
26669 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
26670 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
26671
26672 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26673
26674 @end deftypevr
26675
26676 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
26677 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
26678 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
26679
26680 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
26681
26682 @end deftypevr
26683
26684 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
26685 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
26686 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
26687
26688 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26689 @end deftypevr
26690
26691 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
26692 Verbosity level.
26693
26694 Defaults to @samp{3}.
26695
26696 @end deftypevr
26697
26698 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
26699 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
26700 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
26701
26702 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26703
26704 @end deftypevr
26705
26706 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
26707 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
26708
26709 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
26710
26711 @end deftypevr
26712
26713 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
26714 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
26715
26716 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
26717
26718 @end deftypevr
26719
26720 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
26721 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
26722
26723 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26724
26725 @end deftypevr
26726
26727 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
26728 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
26729
26730 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
26731
26732 @end deftypevr
26733
26734 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
26735 The file that records client IPs.
26736
26737 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
26738
26739 @end deftypevr
26740
26741 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
26742 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
26743
26744 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26745
26746 @end deftypevr
26747
26748 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
26749 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
26750
26751 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26752
26753 @end deftypevr
26754
26755 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
26756 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
26757 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
26758 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
26759 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
26760 down.
26761
26762 @end deftypevr
26763
26764 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
26765 The maximum number of clients.
26766
26767 Defaults to @samp{100}.
26768
26769 @end deftypevr
26770
26771 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
26772 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
26773 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
26774
26775 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
26776
26777 @end deftypevr
26778
26779 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
26780 The list of configuration for some clients.
26781
26782 Defaults to @samp{()}.
26783
26784 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
26785
26786 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
26787 Client name.
26788
26789 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
26790
26791 @end deftypevr
26792
26793 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
26794 Client own network
26795
26796 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26797
26798 @end deftypevr
26799
26800 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
26801 Client VPN IP.
26802
26803 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
26804
26805 @end deftypevr
26806
26807 @end deftypevr
26808
26809
26810 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
26811
26812 @subsubheading Wireguard
26813
26814 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wireguard-service-type
26815 A service type for a Wireguard tunnel interface. Its value must be a
26816 @code{wireguard-configuration} record as in this example:
26817
26818 @lisp
26819 (service wireguard-service-type
26820 (wireguard-configuration
26821 (peers
26822 (list
26823 (wireguard-peer
26824 (name "my-peer")
26825 (endpoint "my.wireguard.com:51820")
26826 (public-key "hzpKg9X1yqu1axN6iJp0mWf6BZGo8m1wteKwtTmDGF4=")
26827 (allowed-ips '("10.0.0.2/32")))))))
26828 @end lisp
26829
26830 @end defvr
26831
26832 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-configuration
26833 Data type representing the configuration of the Wireguard service.
26834
26835 @table @asis
26836 @item @code{wireguard}
26837 The wireguard package to use for this service.
26838
26839 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"wg0"})
26840 The interface name for the VPN.
26841
26842 @item @code{addresses} (default: @code{'("10.0.0.1/32")})
26843 The IP addresses to be assigned to the above interface.
26844
26845 @item @code{private-key} (default: @code{"/etc/wireguard/private.key"})
26846 The private key file for the interface. It is automatically generated if
26847 the file does not exist.
26848
26849 @item @code{peers} (default: @code{'()})
26850 The authorized peers on this interface. This is a list of
26851 @var{wireguard-peer} records.
26852
26853 @end table
26854 @end deftp
26855
26856 @deftp {Data Type} wireguard-peer
26857 Data type representing a Wireguard peer attached to a given interface.
26858
26859 @table @asis
26860 @item @code{name}
26861 The peer name.
26862
26863 @item @code{endpoint} (default: @code{#f})
26864 The optional endpoint for the peer, such as
26865 @code{"demo.wireguard.com:51820"}.
26866
26867 @item @code{public-key}
26868 The peer public-key represented as a base64 string.
26869
26870 @item @code{allowed-ips}
26871 A list of IP addresses from which incoming traffic for this peer is
26872 allowed and to which incoming traffic for this peer is directed.
26873
26874 @end table
26875 @end deftp
26876
26877 @node Network File System
26878 @subsection Network File System
26879 @cindex NFS
26880
26881 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
26882 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
26883 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
26884
26885 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
26886 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
26887 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
26888
26889 @subsubheading NFS Service
26890 @cindex NFS, server
26891
26892 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
26893 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
26894 the locations that NFS expects.
26895
26896 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
26897 A service type for a complete NFS server.
26898 @end defvr
26899
26900 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
26901 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
26902 of its subsystems.
26903
26904 It has the following parameters:
26905 @table @asis
26906 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
26907 The nfs-utils package to use.
26908
26909 @item @code{nfs-versions} (default: @code{'("4.2" "4.1" "4.0")})
26910 If a list of string values is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon
26911 will be limited to supporting the given versions of the NFS protocol.
26912
26913 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
26914 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
26915 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
26916 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
26917 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
26918
26919 @lisp
26920 (nfs-configuration
26921 (exports
26922 '(("/export"
26923 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
26924 @end lisp
26925
26926 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
26927 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
26928
26929 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
26930 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
26931
26932 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
26933 The rpcbind package to use.
26934
26935 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
26936 The local NFSv4 domain name.
26937
26938 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
26939 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
26940
26941 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
26942 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
26943
26944 @item @code{nfsd-tcp?} (default: @code{#t})
26945 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a TCP socket.
26946
26947 @item @code{nfsd-udp?} (default: @code{#f})
26948 Whether the @command{nfsd} daemon should listen on a UDP socket.
26949
26950 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
26951 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
26952
26953 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
26954 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
26955 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
26956 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
26957 @end table
26958 @end deftp
26959
26960 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
26961 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
26962
26963 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
26964 @cindex rpcbind
26965
26966 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
26967 universal addresses.
26968 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
26969 started when a dependent service starts.
26970
26971 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
26972 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
26973 @end defvr
26974
26975
26976 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
26977 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
26978 This type has the following parameters:
26979 @table @asis
26980 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
26981 The rpcbind package to use.
26982
26983 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
26984 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
26985 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
26986 instance.
26987 @end table
26988 @end deftp
26989
26990
26991 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
26992 @cindex pipefs
26993 @cindex rpc_pipefs
26994
26995 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
26996 between the kernel and user space programs.
26997
26998 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
26999 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
27000 @end defvr
27001
27002 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
27003 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
27004 This type has the following parameters:
27005 @table @asis
27006 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27007 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
27008 @end table
27009 @end deftp
27010
27011
27012 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
27013 @cindex GSSD
27014 @cindex GSS
27015 @cindex global security system
27016
27017 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
27018 based protocols.
27019 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
27020 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
27021 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
27022
27023 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
27024 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
27025 @end defvr
27026
27027 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
27028 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
27029 This type has the following parameters:
27030 @table @asis
27031 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27032 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
27033
27034 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27035 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27036
27037 @end table
27038 @end deftp
27039
27040
27041 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
27042 @cindex idmapd
27043 @cindex name mapper
27044
27045 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
27046 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
27047
27048 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
27049 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
27050 @end defvr
27051
27052 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
27053 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
27054 This type has the following parameters:
27055 @table @asis
27056 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
27057 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
27058
27059 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
27060 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
27061
27062 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
27063 The local NFSv4 domain name.
27064 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
27065 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
27066
27067 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
27068 The verbosity level of the daemon.
27069
27070 @end table
27071 @end deftp
27072
27073 @node Continuous Integration
27074 @subsection Continuous Integration
27075
27076 @cindex continuous integration
27077 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
27078 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
27079 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
27080
27081 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
27082
27083 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
27084 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
27085 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
27086 @end defvr
27087
27088 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
27089 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
27090 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
27091 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
27092 @env{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
27093
27094 @lisp
27095 (define %cuirass-specs
27096 #~(list
27097 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
27098 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
27099 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
27100 (#:proc-input . "guix")
27101 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
27102 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
27103 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
27104 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
27105 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
27106 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
27107 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
27108 (#:load-path . ".")
27109 (#:branch . "master")
27110 (#:no-compile? . #t))
27111 ((#:name . "config")
27112 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
27113 (#:load-path . ".")
27114 (#:branch . "master")
27115 (#:no-compile? . #t))
27116 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
27117 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
27118 (#:load-path . ".")
27119 (#:branch . "master")
27120 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
27121
27122 (service cuirass-service-type
27123 (cuirass-configuration
27124 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
27125 @end lisp
27126
27127 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
27128 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
27129 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
27130
27131 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
27132 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
27133
27134 @table @asis
27135 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
27136 Location of the log file.
27137
27138 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
27139 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
27140
27141 @item @code{queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
27142 Location of the SQL queries log file. By default, SQL queries logging is
27143 disabled.
27144
27145 @item @code{web-queries-log-file} (default: @code{#f})
27146 Location of the web SQL queries log file. By default, web SQL queries
27147 logging is disabled.
27148
27149 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
27150 Location of the repository cache.
27151
27152 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27153 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
27154
27155 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
27156 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
27157
27158 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
27159 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
27160 Cuirass jobs.
27161
27162 @item @code{queue-size} (default: @code{1})
27163 Size of the database writer queue.
27164
27165 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
27166 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
27167 added specifications.
27168
27169 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
27170 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
27171 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
27172 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
27173
27174 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
27175 Port number used by the HTTP server.
27176
27177 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
27178 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
27179 accept connections from localhost.
27180
27181 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
27182 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
27183 where a specification is an association list
27184 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
27185 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
27186 above.
27187
27188 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
27189 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
27190 from source.
27191
27192 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
27193 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
27194
27195 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
27196 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
27197 packages locally.
27198
27199 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
27200 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
27201
27202 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
27203 The Cuirass package to use.
27204 @end table
27205 @end deftp
27206
27207 @cindex simple cuirass
27208 @subsubheading Simple Cuirass
27209
27210 The Cuirass service configuration described above can be a little
27211 intimidating. In particular, getting the right @code{specifications}
27212 can prove difficult. The @code{simple-cuirass-configuration->specs}
27213 procedure offers a way to generate those @code{specifications} and thus
27214 setup a continuous integration server more readily.
27215
27216 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-cuirass-configuration->specs @var{configuration}
27217 This procedure takes a @code{simple-cuirass-configuration} record as
27218 argument and returns the corresponding Cuirass specifications gexp.
27219 @end deffn
27220
27221 @deftp {Data Type} simple-cuirass-configuration
27222 Data type representing the configuration of a simple Cuirass instance.
27223
27224 @table @asis
27225 @item @code{build} (default: @code{all})
27226 The packages to be built by Cuirass. It defaults to @code{all}, which
27227 means that all the discovered packages in the subsequent @code{channels}
27228 field are to be selected.
27229
27230 It is also possible to set this field to a list of @code{build-manifest}
27231 records, so that only the packages that are part of the declared
27232 manifests are built. This record is described below.
27233
27234 @deftp {Data Type} build-manifest
27235 @table @asis
27236 @item @code{channel-name}
27237 The name of the channel where the manifest is located.
27238
27239 @item @code{manifest}
27240 The manifest path inside the channel.
27241
27242 @end table
27243 @end deftp
27244
27245 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
27246 The channels to be fetched by Cuirass (@pxref{Channels}).
27247
27248 @item @code{non-package-channels} (default: @code{'()})
27249 List the channel names that must not be searched for packages. That is
27250 often the case for the channel containing the manifest.
27251
27252 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{(list (%current-system))})
27253 Build every discovered package for each system in this list. By default
27254 only the current system is selected.
27255
27256 @end table
27257 @end deftp
27258
27259 Here is an example of how to setup a Cuirass instance that builds all
27260 the packages declared by Guix and a user repository. The package list
27261 is re-evaluated each time a commit is pushed in one of the declared
27262 channels.
27263
27264 @lisp
27265 (service cuirass-service-type
27266 (cuirass-configuration
27267 (specifications
27268 (simple-cuirass-configuration->specs
27269 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27270 (build 'all)
27271 (channels (cons (channel
27272 (name 'my-guix)
27273 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27274 %default-channels)))))))
27275 @end lisp
27276
27277 In the same spirit, this builds all the packages that are part of the
27278 @code{guix} or @code{my-guix} channels and declared in the manifest
27279 located in the @code{conf} channel.
27280
27281 @lisp
27282 (service cuirass-service-type
27283 (cuirass-configuration
27284 (specifications
27285 (simple-cuirass-configuration->specs
27286 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27287 (build (list
27288 (build-manifest
27289 (channel-name 'conf)
27290 (manifest "guix/manifest.scm"))))
27291 (channels (cons* (channel
27292 (name 'my-guix)
27293 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27294 (channel
27295 (name 'conf)
27296 (url "https://my-git-repo/conf.git"))
27297 %default-channels))
27298 (non-package-channels '(conf)))))))
27299 @end lisp
27300
27301 Finally, @code{simple-cuirass-services} takes as a second optional
27302 argument a @code{cuirass-configuration} record. It can be used to
27303 customize the configuration of the Cuirass instance.
27304
27305 @lisp
27306 (simple-cuirass-services
27307 (simple-cuirass-configuration
27308 (build 'all)
27309 (channels (cons (channel
27310 (name 'my-guix)
27311 (url "https://my-git-repo/guix.git"))
27312 %default-channels))
27313 (non-package-channels '(conf)))
27314 (cuirass-configuration
27315 (inherit %default-cuirass-config)
27316 (host "0.0.0.0"))) ;listen on all interfaces.
27317 @end lisp
27318
27319 @node Power Management Services
27320 @subsection Power Management Services
27321
27322 @cindex tlp
27323 @cindex power management with TLP
27324 @subsubheading TLP daemon
27325
27326 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
27327 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
27328
27329 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
27330 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
27331 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
27332 source is detected. More information can be found at
27333 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
27334
27335 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
27336 The service type for the TLP tool. The default settings are optimised
27337 for battery life on most systems, but you can tweak them to your heart's
27338 content by adding a valid @code{tlp-configuration}:
27339 @lisp
27340 (service tlp-service-type
27341 (tlp-configuration
27342 (cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac (list "performance"))
27343 (sched-powersave-on-bat? #t)))
27344 @end lisp
27345 @end deffn
27346
27347 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
27348 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
27349 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
27350 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
27351 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
27352
27353 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
27354 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
27355 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
27356 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
27357 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
27358 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
27359 @c the churn as TLP updates.
27360
27361 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
27362
27363 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
27364 The TLP package.
27365
27366 @end deftypevr
27367
27368 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
27369 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
27370
27371 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27372
27373 @end deftypevr
27374
27375 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
27376 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
27377 and BAT.
27378
27379 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
27380
27381 @end deftypevr
27382
27383 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
27384 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
27385 before syncing on AC.
27386
27387 Defaults to @samp{0}.
27388
27389 @end deftypevr
27390
27391 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
27392 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
27393
27394 Defaults to @samp{2}.
27395
27396 @end deftypevr
27397
27398 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
27399 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
27400
27401 Defaults to @samp{15}.
27402
27403 @end deftypevr
27404
27405 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
27406 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27407
27408 Defaults to @samp{60}.
27409
27410 @end deftypevr
27411
27412 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
27413 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
27414 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
27415 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
27416
27417 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27418
27419 @end deftypevr
27420
27421 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
27422 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27423
27424 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27425
27426 @end deftypevr
27427
27428 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
27429 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
27430
27431 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27432
27433 @end deftypevr
27434
27435 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
27436 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
27437
27438 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27439
27440 @end deftypevr
27441
27442 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
27443 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
27444
27445 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27446
27447 @end deftypevr
27448
27449 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
27450 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
27451
27452 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27453
27454 @end deftypevr
27455
27456 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
27457 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
27458 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
27459
27460 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27461
27462 @end deftypevr
27463
27464 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
27465 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
27466 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
27467
27468 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27469
27470 @end deftypevr
27471
27472 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
27473 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27474
27475 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27476
27477 @end deftypevr
27478
27479 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
27480 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27481
27482 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27483
27484 @end deftypevr
27485
27486 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
27487 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
27488
27489 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27490
27491 @end deftypevr
27492
27493 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
27494 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
27495
27496 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27497
27498 @end deftypevr
27499
27500 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
27501 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
27502 used under light load conditions.
27503
27504 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27505
27506 @end deftypevr
27507
27508 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
27509 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
27510
27511 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27512
27513 @end deftypevr
27514
27515 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
27516 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
27517
27518 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27519
27520 @end deftypevr
27521
27522 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
27523 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
27524 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
27525
27526 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27527
27528 @end deftypevr
27529
27530 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
27531 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC@. Alternatives are
27532 performance, normal, powersave.
27533
27534 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27535
27536 @end deftypevr
27537
27538 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
27539 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
27540
27541 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
27542
27543 @end deftypevr
27544
27545 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
27546 Hard disk devices.
27547
27548 @end deftypevr
27549
27550 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
27551 Hard disk advanced power management level.
27552
27553 @end deftypevr
27554
27555 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
27556 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
27557
27558 @end deftypevr
27559
27560 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
27561 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
27562 declared hard disk.
27563
27564 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27565
27566 @end deftypevr
27567
27568 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
27569 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
27570
27571 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27572
27573 @end deftypevr
27574
27575 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
27576 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
27577 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
27578 noop.
27579
27580 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27581
27582 @end deftypevr
27583
27584 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
27585 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
27586 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
27587
27588 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
27589
27590 @end deftypevr
27591
27592 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
27593 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
27594
27595 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
27596
27597 @end deftypevr
27598
27599 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
27600 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
27601
27602 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27603
27604 @end deftypevr
27605
27606 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
27607 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
27608 mode.
27609
27610 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27611
27612 @end deftypevr
27613
27614 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
27615 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
27616
27617 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27618
27619 @end deftypevr
27620
27621 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
27622 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
27623
27624 Defaults to @samp{15}.
27625
27626 @end deftypevr
27627
27628 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
27629 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
27630 default, performance, powersave.
27631
27632 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27633
27634 @end deftypevr
27635
27636 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
27637 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
27638
27639 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
27640
27641 @end deftypevr
27642
27643 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
27644 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
27645 auto, default.
27646
27647 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
27648
27649 @end deftypevr
27650
27651 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
27652 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
27653
27654 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
27655
27656 @end deftypevr
27657
27658 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
27659 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
27660 performance.
27661
27662 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
27663
27664 @end deftypevr
27665
27666 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
27667 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
27668
27669 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
27670
27671 @end deftypevr
27672
27673 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
27674 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
27675
27676 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27677
27678 @end deftypevr
27679
27680 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
27681 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
27682
27683 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27684
27685 @end deftypevr
27686
27687 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
27688 Wifi power saving mode.
27689
27690 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27691
27692 @end deftypevr
27693
27694 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
27695 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
27696
27697 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27698
27699 @end deftypevr
27700
27701 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
27702 Disable wake on LAN.
27703
27704 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27705
27706 @end deftypevr
27707
27708 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
27709 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
27710 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
27711
27712 Defaults to @samp{0}.
27713
27714 @end deftypevr
27715
27716 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
27717 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
27718
27719 Defaults to @samp{1}.
27720
27721 @end deftypevr
27722
27723 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
27724 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
27725
27726 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27727
27728 @end deftypevr
27729
27730 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
27731 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
27732 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
27733 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
27734
27735 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27736
27737 @end deftypevr
27738
27739 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
27740 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
27741
27742 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
27743
27744 @end deftypevr
27745
27746 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
27747 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
27748 and auto.
27749
27750 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
27751
27752 @end deftypevr
27753
27754 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
27755 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
27756
27757 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
27758
27759 @end deftypevr
27760
27761 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
27762 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
27763 ones.
27764
27765 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27766
27767 @end deftypevr
27768
27769 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
27770 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
27771
27772 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27773
27774 @end deftypevr
27775
27776 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
27777 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
27778 Power Management.
27779
27780 @end deftypevr
27781
27782 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
27783 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
27784
27785 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27786
27787 @end deftypevr
27788
27789 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
27790 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
27791
27792 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27793
27794 @end deftypevr
27795
27796 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
27797 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
27798
27799 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
27800
27801 @end deftypevr
27802
27803 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
27804 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
27805 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
27806
27807 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27808
27809 @end deftypevr
27810
27811 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
27812 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
27813
27814 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
27815
27816 @end deftypevr
27817
27818 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
27819 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
27820 shutdown on system startup.
27821
27822 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
27823
27824 @end deftypevr
27825
27826 @cindex thermald
27827 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
27828 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
27829
27830 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
27831 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
27832
27833 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
27834 This is the service type for
27835 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
27836 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
27837 of processors and preventing overheating.
27838 @end defvr
27839
27840 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
27841 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
27842
27843 @table @asis
27844 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
27845 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
27846
27847 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
27848 Package object of thermald.
27849
27850 @end table
27851 @end deftp
27852
27853 @node Audio Services
27854 @subsection Audio Services
27855
27856 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
27857 (the Music Player Daemon).
27858
27859 @cindex mpd
27860 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
27861
27862 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
27863 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
27864 of clients.
27865
27866 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
27867 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
27868
27869 @lisp
27870 (service mpd-service-type
27871 (mpd-configuration
27872 (user "bob")
27873 (port "6666")))
27874 @end lisp
27875
27876 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
27877 The service type for @command{mpd}
27878 @end defvr
27879
27880 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
27881 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
27882
27883 @table @asis
27884 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
27885 The user to run mpd as.
27886
27887 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
27888 The directory to scan for music files.
27889
27890 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
27891 The directory to store playlists.
27892
27893 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
27894 The location of the music database.
27895
27896 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
27897 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
27898
27899 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
27900 The location of the sticker database.
27901
27902 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
27903 The port to run mpd on.
27904
27905 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
27906 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
27907 an absolute path can be specified here.
27908
27909 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
27910 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
27911
27912 @end table
27913 @end deftp
27914
27915 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
27916 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
27917
27918 @table @asis
27919 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
27920 The name of the audio output.
27921
27922 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
27923 The type of audio output.
27924
27925 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
27926 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
27927 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
27928 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
27929 state is restored.
27930
27931 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
27932 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
27933 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
27934 @code{httpd} output plugin.
27935
27936 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
27937 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
27938 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
27939 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
27940
27941 @item @code{mixer-type}
27942 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
27943 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
27944 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
27945 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
27946 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
27947
27948 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
27949 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
27950 the audio output configuration.
27951
27952 @end table
27953 @end deftp
27954
27955 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
27956 an HTTP audio streaming output.
27957
27958 @lisp
27959 (service mpd-service-type
27960 (mpd-configuration
27961 (outputs
27962 (list (mpd-output
27963 (name "streaming")
27964 (type "httpd")
27965 (mixer-type 'null)
27966 (extra-options
27967 `((encoder . "vorbis")
27968 (port . "8080"))))))))
27969 @end lisp
27970
27971
27972 @node Virtualization Services
27973 @subsection Virtualization Services
27974
27975 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
27976 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
27977 services.
27978
27979 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
27980
27981 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
27982 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
27983 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
27984
27985 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
27986 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
27987 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
27988
27989 @lisp
27990 (service libvirt-service-type
27991 (libvirt-configuration
27992 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
27993 (tls-port "16555")))
27994 @end lisp
27995 @end deffn
27996
27997 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
27998 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
27999
28000 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
28001 Libvirt package.
28002
28003 @end deftypevr
28004
28005 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
28006 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
28007 You must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
28008
28009 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
28010 this capability.
28011
28012 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
28013
28014 @end deftypevr
28015
28016 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
28017 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. You must
28018 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
28019
28020 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
28021 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
28022 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5).
28023
28024 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28025
28026 @end deftypevr
28027
28028 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
28029 Port for accepting secure TLS connections. This can be a port number,
28030 or service name.
28031
28032 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
28033
28034 @end deftypevr
28035
28036 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
28037 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections. This can be a port number,
28038 or service name.
28039
28040 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
28041
28042 @end deftypevr
28043
28044 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
28045 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
28046
28047 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
28048
28049 @end deftypevr
28050
28051 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
28052 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
28053
28054 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
28055 Avahi daemon.
28056
28057 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28058
28059 @end deftypevr
28060
28061 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
28062 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
28063 broadcast network.
28064
28065 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
28066
28067 @end deftypevr
28068
28069 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
28070 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
28071 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
28072 becoming root.
28073
28074 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
28075
28076 @end deftypevr
28077
28078 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
28079 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
28080 VM status only.
28081
28082 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28083
28084 @end deftypevr
28085
28086 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
28087 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
28088 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
28089 everyone (eg, 0777)
28090
28091 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
28092
28093 @end deftypevr
28094
28095 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
28096 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
28097 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
28098 the access to.
28099
28100 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
28101
28102 @end deftypevr
28103
28104 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
28105 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
28106
28107 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
28108
28109 @end deftypevr
28110
28111 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
28112 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
28113 permissions allow anyone to connect
28114
28115 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28116
28117 @end deftypevr
28118
28119 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
28120 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
28121 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
28122 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
28123
28124 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
28125
28126 @end deftypevr
28127
28128 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
28129 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
28130 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
28131 scenario.
28132
28133 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
28134
28135 @end deftypevr
28136
28137 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
28138 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
28139 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
28140 by certificates.
28141
28142 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
28143 by using 'sasl' for this option
28144
28145 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
28146
28147 @end deftypevr
28148
28149 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
28150 API access control scheme.
28151
28152 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
28153 drivers can place restrictions on this.
28154
28155 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28156
28157 @end deftypevr
28158
28159 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
28160 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
28161 loaded.
28162
28163 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28164
28165 @end deftypevr
28166
28167 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
28168 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
28169 loaded.
28170
28171 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28172
28173 @end deftypevr
28174
28175 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
28176 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
28177 is loaded.
28178
28179 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28180
28181 @end deftypevr
28182
28183 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
28184 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
28185 CRL is loaded.
28186
28187 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28188
28189 @end deftypevr
28190
28191 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
28192 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
28193
28194 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
28195 certificates.
28196
28197 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28198
28199 @end deftypevr
28200
28201 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
28202 Disable verification of client certificates.
28203
28204 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
28205 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
28206 rejected.
28207
28208 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28209
28210 @end deftypevr
28211
28212 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
28213 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
28214
28215 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28216
28217 @end deftypevr
28218
28219 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
28220 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
28221 the SASL authentication mechanism.
28222
28223 Defaults to @samp{()}.
28224
28225 @end deftypevr
28226
28227 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
28228 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
28229 usually @samp{"NORMAL"} unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
28230 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
28231
28232 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
28233
28234 @end deftypevr
28235
28236 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
28237 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
28238 sockets combined.
28239
28240 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
28241
28242 @end deftypevr
28243
28244 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
28245 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
28246 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
28247 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
28248
28249 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
28250
28251 @end deftypevr
28252
28253 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
28254 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
28255 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
28256
28257 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28258
28259 @end deftypevr
28260
28261 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
28262 Number of workers to start up initially.
28263
28264 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28265
28266 @end deftypevr
28267
28268 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
28269 Maximum number of worker threads.
28270
28271 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
28272 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
28273 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
28274
28275 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28276
28277 @end deftypevr
28278
28279 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
28280 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
28281 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
28282 executed in this pool.
28283
28284 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28285
28286 @end deftypevr
28287
28288 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
28289 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
28290
28291 Defaults to @samp{20}.
28292
28293 @end deftypevr
28294
28295 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
28296 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
28297 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
28298 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
28299
28300 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28301
28302 @end deftypevr
28303
28304 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
28305 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
28306
28307 Defaults to @samp{1}.
28308
28309 @end deftypevr
28310
28311 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
28312 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
28313
28314 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28315
28316 @end deftypevr
28317
28318 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
28319 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
28320
28321 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28322
28323 @end deftypevr
28324
28325 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
28326 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
28327
28328 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28329
28330 @end deftypevr
28331
28332 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
28333 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
28334
28335 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28336
28337 @end deftypevr
28338
28339 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
28340 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
28341
28342 Defaults to @samp{3}.
28343
28344 @end deftypevr
28345
28346 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
28347 Logging filters.
28348
28349 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
28350 of logs. The format for a filter is one of:
28351
28352 @itemize @bullet
28353 @item
28354 x:name
28355
28356 @item
28357 x:+name
28358
28359 @end itemize
28360
28361 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
28362 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
28363 file, e.g., @samp{"remote"}, @samp{"qemu"}, or @samp{"util.json"} (the
28364 name in the filter can be a substring of the full category name, in
28365 order to match multiple similar categories), the optional @samp{"+"}
28366 prefix tells libvirt to log stack trace for each message matching name,
28367 and @code{x} is the minimal level where matching messages should be
28368 logged:
28369
28370 @itemize @bullet
28371 @item
28372 1: DEBUG
28373
28374 @item
28375 2: INFO
28376
28377 @item
28378 3: WARNING
28379
28380 @item
28381 4: ERROR
28382
28383 @end itemize
28384
28385 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
28386 need to be separated by spaces.
28387
28388 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
28389
28390 @end deftypevr
28391
28392 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
28393 Logging outputs.
28394
28395 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
28396 for an output can be:
28397
28398 @table @code
28399 @item x:stderr
28400 output goes to stderr
28401
28402 @item x:syslog:name
28403 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
28404
28405 @item x:file:file_path
28406 output to a file, with the given filepath
28407
28408 @item x:journald
28409 output to journald logging system
28410
28411 @end table
28412
28413 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
28414
28415 @itemize @bullet
28416 @item
28417 1: DEBUG
28418
28419 @item
28420 2: INFO
28421
28422 @item
28423 3: WARNING
28424
28425 @item
28426 4: ERROR
28427
28428 @end itemize
28429
28430 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
28431 spaces.
28432
28433 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
28434
28435 @end deftypevr
28436
28437 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
28438 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
28439
28440 @itemize @bullet
28441 @item
28442 0: disable all auditing
28443
28444 @item
28445 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
28446
28447 @item
28448 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
28449
28450 @end itemize
28451
28452 Defaults to @samp{1}.
28453
28454 @end deftypevr
28455
28456 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
28457 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
28458
28459 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
28460
28461 @end deftypevr
28462
28463 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
28464 Host UUID@. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
28465
28466 Defaults to @samp{""}.
28467
28468 @end deftypevr
28469
28470 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
28471 Source to read host UUID.
28472
28473 @itemize @bullet
28474 @item
28475 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
28476
28477 @item
28478 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
28479
28480 @end itemize
28481
28482 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
28483 be generated.
28484
28485 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
28486
28487 @end deftypevr
28488
28489 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
28490 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
28491 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
28492 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
28493 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
28494
28495 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28496
28497 @end deftypevr
28498
28499 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
28500 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
28501 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
28502 broken.
28503
28504 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
28505 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
28506 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
28507 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
28508 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
28509 keepalive messages.
28510
28511 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28512
28513 @end deftypevr
28514
28515 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
28516 Same as above but for admin interface.
28517
28518 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28519
28520 @end deftypevr
28521
28522 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
28523 Same as above but for admin interface.
28524
28525 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28526
28527 @end deftypevr
28528
28529 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
28530 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
28531
28532 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
28533 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
28534 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
28535
28536 Defaults to @samp{5}.
28537
28538 @end deftypevr
28539
28540 @c %end of autogenerated docs
28541
28542 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
28543 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
28544 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
28545
28546 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
28547 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
28548 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
28549 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
28550 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
28551
28552 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
28553 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
28554 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
28555
28556 @lisp
28557 (service virtlog-service-type
28558 (virtlog-configuration
28559 (max-clients 1000)))
28560 @end lisp
28561 @end deffn
28562
28563 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
28564 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
28565
28566 Defaults to @samp{3}.
28567
28568 @end deftypevr
28569
28570 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
28571 Logging filters.
28572
28573 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
28574 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
28575
28576 @itemize @bullet
28577 @item
28578 x:name
28579
28580 @item
28581 x:+name
28582
28583 @end itemize
28584
28585 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
28586 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
28587 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
28588 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
28589 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
28590 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
28591 where matching messages should be logged:
28592
28593 @itemize @bullet
28594 @item
28595 1: DEBUG
28596
28597 @item
28598 2: INFO
28599
28600 @item
28601 3: WARNING
28602
28603 @item
28604 4: ERROR
28605
28606 @end itemize
28607
28608 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
28609 need to be separated by spaces.
28610
28611 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
28612
28613 @end deftypevr
28614
28615 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
28616 Logging outputs.
28617
28618 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
28619 for an output can be:
28620
28621 @table @code
28622 @item x:stderr
28623 output goes to stderr
28624
28625 @item x:syslog:name
28626 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
28627
28628 @item x:file:file_path
28629 output to a file, with the given filepath
28630
28631 @item x:journald
28632 output to journald logging system
28633
28634 @end table
28635
28636 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
28637
28638 @itemize @bullet
28639 @item
28640 1: DEBUG
28641
28642 @item
28643 2: INFO
28644
28645 @item
28646 3: WARNING
28647
28648 @item
28649 4: ERROR
28650
28651 @end itemize
28652
28653 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
28654 spaces.
28655
28656 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
28657
28658 @end deftypevr
28659
28660 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
28661 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
28662 sockets combined.
28663
28664 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
28665
28666 @end deftypevr
28667
28668 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
28669 Maximum file size before rolling over.
28670
28671 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
28672
28673 @end deftypevr
28674
28675 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
28676 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
28677
28678 Defaults to @samp{3}
28679
28680 @end deftypevr
28681
28682 @anchor{transparent-emulation-qemu}
28683 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
28684
28685 @cindex emulation
28686 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
28687 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
28688 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
28689 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
28690 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
28691 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
28692 This feature only allows you to emulate GNU/Linux on a different
28693 architecture, but see below for GNU/Hurd support.
28694
28695 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
28696 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
28697 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
28698 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
28699 emulated:
28700
28701 @lisp
28702 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
28703 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
28704 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64"))))
28705 @end lisp
28706
28707 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
28708 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
28709 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
28710 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
28711 @end defvr
28712
28713 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
28714 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
28715
28716 @table @asis
28717 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
28718 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
28719 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
28720
28721 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#t})
28722 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
28723 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
28724 @option{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
28725 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
28726 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
28727
28728 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
28729 service:
28730
28731 @lisp
28732 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
28733 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
28734 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
28735 (guix-support? #t)))
28736 @end lisp
28737
28738 You can run:
28739
28740 @example
28741 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
28742 @end example
28743
28744 @noindent
28745 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
28746 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU@. Pretty handy
28747 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
28748 access to!
28749
28750 When @code{guix-support?} is set to @code{#f}, programs for other
28751 architectures can still be executed transparently, but invoking commands
28752 like @command{guix build -s armhf-linux @dots{}} will fail.
28753
28754 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
28755 The QEMU package to use.
28756 @end table
28757 @end deftp
28758
28759 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
28760 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
28761 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
28762 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
28763 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
28764 @end deffn
28765
28766 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
28767 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
28768 @end deffn
28769
28770 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
28771 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
28772 @end deffn
28773
28774
28775 @subsubheading The Hurd in a Virtual Machine
28776
28777 @cindex @code{hurd}
28778 @cindex the Hurd
28779 @cindex childhurd
28780
28781 Service @code{hurd-vm} provides support for running GNU/Hurd in a
28782 virtual machine (VM), a so-called @dfn{childhurd}. This service is meant
28783 to be used on GNU/Linux and the given GNU/Hurd operating system
28784 configuration is cross-compiled. The virtual machine is a Shepherd
28785 service that can be referred to by the names @code{hurd-vm} and
28786 @code{childhurd} and be controlled with commands such as:
28787
28788 @example
28789 herd start hurd-vm
28790 herd stop childhurd
28791 @end example
28792
28793 When the service is running, you can view its console by connecting to
28794 it with a VNC client, for example with:
28795
28796 @example
28797 guix environment --ad-hoc tigervnc-client -- \
28798 vncviewer localhost:5900
28799 @end example
28800
28801 The default configuration (see @code{hurd-vm-configuration} below)
28802 spawns a secure shell (SSH) server in your GNU/Hurd system, which QEMU
28803 (the virtual machine emulator) redirects to port 10222 on the host.
28804 Thus, you can connect over SSH to the childhurd with:
28805
28806 @example
28807 ssh root@@localhost -p 10022
28808 @end example
28809
28810 The childhurd is volatile and stateless: it starts with a fresh root
28811 file system every time you restart it. By default though, all the files
28812 under @file{/etc/childhurd} on the host are copied as is to the root
28813 file system of the childhurd when it boots. This allows you to
28814 initialize ``secrets'' inside the VM: SSH host keys, authorized
28815 substitute keys, and so on---see the explanation of @code{secret-root}
28816 below.
28817
28818 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-vm-service-type
28819 This is the type of the Hurd in a Virtual Machine service. Its value
28820 must be a @code{hurd-vm-configuration} object, which specifies the
28821 operating system (@pxref{operating-system Reference}) and the disk size
28822 for the Hurd Virtual Machine, the QEMU package to use as well as the
28823 options for running it.
28824
28825 For example:
28826
28827 @lisp
28828 (service hurd-vm-service-type
28829 (hurd-vm-configuration
28830 (disk-size (* 5000 (expt 2 20))) ;5G
28831 (memory-size 1024))) ;1024MiB
28832 @end lisp
28833
28834 would create a disk image big enough to build GNU@tie{}Hello, with some
28835 extra memory.
28836 @end defvr
28837
28838 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-vm-configuration
28839 The data type representing the configuration for
28840 @code{hurd-vm-service-type}.
28841
28842 @table @asis
28843 @item @code{os} (default: @var{%hurd-vm-operating-system})
28844 The operating system to instantiate. This default is bare-bones with a
28845 permissive OpenSSH secure shell daemon listening on port 2222
28846 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}).
28847
28848 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu-minimal})
28849 The QEMU package to use.
28850
28851 @item @code{image} (default: @var{hurd-vm-disk-image})
28852 The procedure used to build the disk-image built from this
28853 configuration.
28854
28855 @item @code{disk-size} (default: @code{'guess})
28856 The size of the disk image.
28857
28858 @item @code{memory-size} (default: @code{512})
28859 The memory size of the Virtual Machine in mebibytes.
28860
28861 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'("--snapshot")})
28862 The extra options for running QEMU.
28863
28864 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
28865 If set, a non-zero positive integer used to parameterize Childhurd
28866 instances. It is appended to the service's name,
28867 e.g. @code{childhurd1}.
28868
28869 @item @code{net-options} (default: @var{hurd-vm-net-options})
28870 The procedure used to produce the list of QEMU networking options.
28871
28872 By default, it produces
28873
28874 @lisp
28875 '("--device" "rtl8139,netdev=net0"
28876 "--netdev" "user,id=net0\
28877 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{secrets-port}-:1004\
28878 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{ssh-port}-:2222\
28879 ,hostfwd=tcp:127.0.0.1:@var{vnc-port}-:5900")
28880 @end lisp
28881
28882 with forwarded ports:
28883
28884 @example
28885 @var{secrets-port}: @code{(+ 11004 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28886 @var{ssh-port}: @code{(+ 10022 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28887 @var{vnc-port}: @code{(+ 15900 (* 1000 @var{ID}))}
28888 @end example
28889
28890 @item @code{secret-root} (default: @file{/etc/childhurd})
28891 The root directory with out-of-band secrets to be installed into the
28892 childhurd once it runs. Childhurds are volatile which means that on
28893 every startup, secrets such as the SSH host keys and Guix signing key
28894 are recreated.
28895
28896 If the @file{/etc/childhurd} directory does not exist, the
28897 @code{secret-service} running in the Childhurd will be sent an empty
28898 list of secrets.
28899
28900 By default, the service automatically populates @file{/etc/childhurd}
28901 with the following non-volatile secrets, unless they already exist:
28902
28903 @example
28904 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/acl
28905 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
28906 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.sec
28907 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key
28908 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key
28909 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub
28910 /etc/childhurd/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ecdsa_key.pub
28911 @end example
28912
28913 These files are automatically sent to the guest Hurd VM when it boots,
28914 including permissions.
28915
28916 @cindex childhurd, offloading
28917 @cindex Hurd, offloading
28918 Having these files in place means that only a couple of things are
28919 missing to allow the host to offload @code{i586-gnu} builds to the
28920 childhurd:
28921
28922 @enumerate
28923 @item
28924 Authorizing the childhurd's key on the host so that the host accepts
28925 build results coming from the childhurd, which can be done like so:
28926
28927 @example
28928 guix archive --authorize < \
28929 /etc/childhurd/etc/guix/signing-key.pub
28930 @end example
28931
28932 @item
28933 Adding the childhurd to @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} (@pxref{Daemon
28934 Offload Setup}).
28935 @end enumerate
28936
28937 We're working towards making that happen automatically---get in touch
28938 with us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to discuss it!
28939 @end table
28940 @end deftp
28941
28942 Note that by default the VM image is volatile, i.e., once stopped the
28943 contents are lost. If you want a stateful image instead, override the
28944 configuration's @code{image} and @code{options} without
28945 the @code{--snapshot} flag using something along these lines:
28946
28947 @lisp
28948 (service hurd-vm-service-type
28949 (hurd-vm-configuration
28950 (image (const "/out/of/store/writable/hurd.img"))
28951 (options '())))
28952 @end lisp
28953
28954 @subsubheading Ganeti
28955
28956 @cindex ganeti
28957
28958 @quotation Note
28959 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be changed
28960 in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have been thorougly
28961 tested. Users of this service are encouraged to share their experience at
28962 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
28963 @end quotation
28964
28965 Ganeti is a virtual machine management system. It is designed to keep virtual
28966 machines running on a cluster of servers even in the event of hardware failures,
28967 and to make maintenance and recovery tasks easy. It consists of multiple
28968 services which are described later in this section. In addition to the Ganeti
28969 service, you will need the OpenSSH service (@pxref{Networking Services,
28970 @code{openssh-service-type}}), and update the @file{/etc/hosts} file
28971 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{hosts-file}}) with the cluster name
28972 and address (or use a DNS server).
28973
28974 All nodes participating in a Ganeti cluster should have the same Ganeti and
28975 @file{/etc/hosts} configuration. Here is an example configuration for a Ganeti
28976 cluster node that supports multiple storage backends, and installs the
28977 @code{debootstrap} and @code{guix} @dfn{OS providers}:
28978
28979 @lisp
28980 (use-package-modules virtualization)
28981 (use-service-modules base ganeti networking ssh)
28982 (operating-system
28983 ;; @dots{}
28984 (host-name "node1")
28985 (hosts-file (plain-file "hosts" (format #f "
28986 127.0.0.1 localhost
28987 ::1 localhost
28988
28989 192.168.1.200 ganeti.example.com
28990 192.168.1.201 node1.example.com node1
28991 192.168.1.202 node2.example.com node2
28992 ")))
28993
28994 ;; Install QEMU so we can use KVM-based instances, and LVM, DRBD and Ceph
28995 ;; in order to use the "plain", "drbd" and "rbd" storage backends.
28996 (packages (append (map specification->package
28997 '("qemu" "lvm2" "drbd-utils" "ceph"
28998 ;; Add the debootstrap and guix OS providers.
28999 "ganeti-instance-guix" "ganeti-instance-debootstrap"))
29000 %base-packages))
29001 (services
29002 (append (list (static-networking-service "eth0" "192.168.1.201"
29003 #:netmask "255.255.255.0"
29004 #:gateway "192.168.1.254"
29005 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.252"
29006 "192.168.1.253"))
29007
29008 ;; Ganeti uses SSH to communicate between nodes.
29009 (service openssh-service-type
29010 (openssh-configuration
29011 (permit-root-login 'without-password)))
29012
29013 (service ganeti-service-type
29014 (ganeti-configuration
29015 ;; This list specifies allowed file system paths
29016 ;; for storing virtual machine images.
29017 (file-storage-paths '("/srv/ganeti/file-storage"))
29018 ;; This variable configures a single "variant" for
29019 ;; both Debootstrap and Guix that works with KVM.
29020 (os %default-ganeti-os))))
29021 %base-services)))
29022 @end lisp
29023
29024 Users are advised to read the
29025 @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/admin.html,Ganeti
29026 administrators guide} to learn about the various cluster options and
29027 day-to-day operations. There is also a
29028 @url{https://guix.gnu.org/blog/2020/running-a-ganeti-cluster-on-guix/,blog post}
29029 describing how to configure and initialize a small cluster.
29030
29031 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-service-type
29032 This is a service type that includes all the various services that Ganeti
29033 nodes should run.
29034
29035 Its value is a @code{ganeti-configuration} object that defines the package
29036 to use for CLI operations, as well as configuration for the various daemons.
29037 Allowed file storage paths and available guest operating systems are also
29038 configured through this data type.
29039 @end defvr
29040
29041 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-configuration
29042 The @code{ganeti} service takes the following configuration options:
29043
29044 @table @asis
29045 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29046 The @code{ganeti} package to use. It will be installed to the system profile
29047 and make @command{gnt-cluster}, @command{gnt-instance}, etc available. Note
29048 that the value specified here does not affect the other services as each refer
29049 to a specific @code{ganeti} package (see below).
29050
29051 @item @code{noded-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-noded-configuration)})
29052 @itemx @code{confd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-confd-configuration)})
29053 @itemx @code{wconfd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-wconfd-configuration)})
29054 @itemx @code{luxid-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-luxid-configuration)})
29055 @itemx @code{rapi-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-rapi-configuration)})
29056 @itemx @code{kvmd-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-kvmd-configuration)})
29057 @itemx @code{mond-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-mond-configuration)})
29058 @itemx @code{metad-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-metad-configuration)})
29059 @itemx @code{watcher-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-watcher-configuration)})
29060 @itemx @code{cleaner-configuration} (default: @code{(ganeti-cleaner-configuration)})
29061
29062 These options control the various daemons and cron jobs that are distributed
29063 with Ganeti. The possible values for these are described in detail below.
29064 To override a setting, you must use the configuration type for that service:
29065
29066 @lisp
29067 (service ganeti-service-type
29068 (ganeti-configuration
29069 (rapi-configuration
29070 (ganeti-rapi-configuration
29071 (interface "eth1"))))
29072 (watcher-configuration
29073 (ganeti-watcher-configuration
29074 (rapi-ip "10.0.0.1"))))
29075 @end lisp
29076
29077 @item @code{file-storage-paths} (default: @code{'()})
29078 List of allowed directories for file storage backend.
29079
29080 @item @code{os} (default: @code{%default-ganeti-os})
29081 List of @code{<ganeti-os>} records.
29082 @end table
29083
29084 In essence @code{ganeti-service-type} is shorthand for declaring each service
29085 individually:
29086
29087 @lisp
29088 (service ganeti-noded-service-type)
29089 (service ganeti-confd-service-type)
29090 (service ganeti-wconfd-service-type)
29091 (service ganeti-luxid-service-type)
29092 (service ganeti-kvmd-service-type)
29093 (service ganeti-mond-service-type)
29094 (service ganeti-metad-service-type)
29095 (service ganeti-watcher-service-type)
29096 (service ganeti-cleaner-service-type)
29097 @end lisp
29098
29099 Plus a service extension for @code{etc-service-type} that configures the file
29100 storage backend and OS variants.
29101
29102 @end deftp
29103
29104 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os
29105 This data type is suitable for passing to the @code{os} parameter of
29106 @code{ganeti-configuration}. It takes the following parameters:
29107
29108 @table @asis
29109 @item @code{name}
29110 The name for this OS provider. It is only used to specify where the
29111 configuration ends up. Setting it to ``debootstrap'' will create
29112 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap}.
29113
29114 @item @code{extension}
29115 The file extension for variants of this OS type. For example
29116 @file{.conf} or @file{.scm}.
29117
29118 @item @code{variants} (default: @code{'()})
29119 List of @code{ganeti-os-variant} objects for this OS.
29120
29121 @end table
29122 @end deftp
29123
29124 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-os-variant
29125 This is the data type for a Ganeti OS variant. It takes the following
29126 parameters:
29127
29128 @table @asis
29129 @item @code{name}
29130 The name of this variant.
29131
29132 @item @code{configuration}
29133 A configuration file for this variant.
29134 @end table
29135 @end deftp
29136
29137 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-hooks
29138 This variable contains hooks to configure networking and the GRUB bootloader.
29139 @end defvr
29140
29141 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs
29142 This variable contains a list of packages suitable for a fully-virtualized guest.
29143 @end defvr
29144
29145 @deftp {Data Type} debootstrap-configuration
29146
29147 This data type creates configuration files suitable for the debootstrap OS provider.
29148
29149 @table @asis
29150 @item @code{hooks} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-hooks})
29151 When not @code{#f}, this must be a G-expression that specifies a directory with
29152 scripts that will run when the OS is installed. It can also be a list of
29153 @code{(name . file-like)} pairs. For example:
29154
29155 @lisp
29156 `((99-hello-world . ,(plain-file "#!/bin/sh\necho Hello, World")))
29157 @end lisp
29158
29159 That will create a directory with one executable named @code{99-hello-world}
29160 and run it every time this variant is installed. If set to @code{#f}, hooks
29161 in @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-debootstrap/hooks} will be used, if any.
29162 @item @code{proxy} (default: @code{#f})
29163 Optional HTTP proxy to use.
29164 @item @code{mirror} (default: @code{#f})
29165 The Debian mirror. Typically something like @code{http://ftp.no.debian.org/debian}.
29166 The default varies depending on the distribution.
29167 @item @code{arch} (default: @code{#f})
29168 The dpkg architecture. Set to @code{armhf} to debootstrap an ARMv7 instance
29169 on an AArch64 host. Default is to use the current system architecture.
29170 @item @code{suite} (default: @code{"stable"})
29171 When set, this must be a Debian distribution ``suite'' such as @code{buster}
29172 or @code{focal}. If set to @code{#f}, the default for the OS provider is used.
29173 @item @code{extra-pkgs} (default: @code{%default-debootstrap-extra-pkgs})
29174 List of extra packages that will get installed by dpkg in addition
29175 to the minimal system.
29176 @item @code{components} (default: @code{#f})
29177 When set, must be a list of Debian repository ``components''. For example
29178 @code{'("main" "contrib")}.
29179 @item @code{generate-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
29180 Whether to automatically cache the generated debootstrap archive.
29181 @item @code{clean-cache} (default: @code{14})
29182 Discard the cache after this amount of days. Use @code{#f} to never
29183 clear the cache.
29184 @item @code{partition-style} (default: @code{'msdos})
29185 The type of partition to create. When set, it must be one of
29186 @code{'msdos}, @code{'none} or a string.
29187 @item @code{partition-alignment} (default: @code{2048})
29188 Alignment of the partition in sectors.
29189 @end table
29190 @end deftp
29191
29192 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
29193 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record. It
29194 takes two parameters: a name and a @code{debootstrap-configuration} object.
29195 @end deffn
29196
29197 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} debootstrap-os @var{variants}@dots{}
29198 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It takes
29199 a list of variants created with @code{debootstrap-variant}.
29200 @end deffn
29201
29202 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-variant @var{name} @var{configuration}
29203 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os-variant} record for
29204 use with the Guix OS provider. It takes a name and a G-expression that returns
29205 a ``file-like'' (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) object containing a
29206 Guix System configuration.
29207 @end deffn
29208
29209 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-os @var{variants}@dots{}
29210 This is a helper procedure that creates a @code{ganeti-os} record. It
29211 takes a list of variants produced by @code{guix-variant}.
29212 @end deffn
29213
29214 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-debootstrap-variants
29215 This is a convenience variable to make the debootstrap provider work
29216 ``out of the box'' without users having to declare variants manually. It
29217 contains a single debootstrap variant with the default configuration:
29218
29219 @lisp
29220 (list (debootstrap-variant
29221 "default"
29222 (debootstrap-configuration)))
29223 @end lisp
29224 @end defvr
29225
29226 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-guix-variants
29227 This is a convenience variable to make the Guix OS provider work without
29228 additional configuration. It creates a virtual machine that has an SSH
29229 server, a serial console, and authorizes the Ganeti hosts SSH keys.
29230
29231 @lisp
29232 (list (guix-variant
29233 "default"
29234 (file-append ganeti-instance-guix
29235 "/share/doc/ganeti-instance-guix/examples/dynamic.scm")))
29236 @end lisp
29237 @end defvr
29238
29239 Users can implement support for OS providers unbeknownst to Guix by extending
29240 the @code{ganeti-os} and @code{ganeti-os-variant} records appropriately.
29241 For example:
29242
29243 @lisp
29244 (ganeti-os
29245 (name "custom")
29246 (extension ".conf")
29247 (variants
29248 (list (ganeti-os-variant
29249 (name "foo")
29250 (configuration (plain-file "bar" "this is fine"))))))
29251 @end lisp
29252
29253 That creates @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/foo.conf} which points
29254 to a file in the store with contents @code{this is fine}. It also creates
29255 @file{/etc/ganeti/instance-custom/variants/variants.list} with contents @code{foo}.
29256
29257 Obviously this may not work for all OS providers out there. If you find the
29258 interface limiting, please reach out to @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
29259
29260 The rest of this section documents the various services that are included by
29261 @code{ganeti-service-type}.
29262
29263 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-noded-service-type
29264 @command{ganeti-noded} is the daemon responsible for node-specific functions
29265 within the Ganeti system. The value of this service must be a
29266 @code{ganeti-noded-configuration} object.
29267 @end defvr
29268
29269 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-noded-configuration
29270 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-noded} service.
29271
29272 @table @asis
29273 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29274 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29275
29276 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1811})
29277 The TCP port on which the node daemon listens for network requests.
29278
29279 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29280 The network address that the daemon will bind to. The default address means
29281 bind to all available addresses.
29282
29283 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
29284 When this is set, it must be a specific network interface (e.g.@: @code{eth0})
29285 that the daemon will bind to.
29286
29287 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
29288 This sets a limit on the maximum number of simultaneous client connections
29289 that the daemon will handle. Connections above this count are accepted, but
29290 no responses will be sent until enough connections have closed.
29291
29292 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
29293 Whether to use SSL/TLS to encrypt network communications. The certificate
29294 is automatically provisioned by the cluster and can be rotated with
29295 @command{gnt-cluster renew-crypto}.
29296
29297 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29298 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
29299
29300 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29301 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
29302
29303 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29304 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29305 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
29306
29307 @end table
29308 @end deftp
29309
29310 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-confd-service-type
29311 @command{ganeti-confd} answers queries related to the configuration of a
29312 Ganeti cluster. The purpose of this daemon is to have a highly available
29313 and fast way to query cluster configuration values. It is automatically
29314 active on all @dfn{master candidates}. The value of this service must be a
29315 @code{ganeti-confd-configuration} object.
29316
29317 @end defvr
29318
29319 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-confd-configuration
29320 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-confd} service.
29321
29322 @table @asis
29323 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29324 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29325
29326 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1814})
29327 The UDP port on which to listen for network requests.
29328
29329 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29330 Network address that the daemon will bind to.
29331
29332 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29333 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29334
29335 @end table
29336 @end deftp
29337
29338 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-wconfd-service-type
29339 @command{ganeti-wconfd} is the daemon that has authoritative knowledge
29340 about the cluster configuration and is the only entity that can accept
29341 changes to it. All jobs that need to modify the configuration will do so
29342 by sending appropriate requests to this daemon. It only runs on the
29343 @dfn{master node} and will automatically disable itself on other nodes.
29344
29345 The value of this service must be a
29346 @code{ganeti-wconfd-configuration} object.
29347 @end defvr
29348
29349 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-wconfd-configuration
29350 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
29351
29352 @table @asis
29353 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29354 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29355
29356 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
29357 The daemon will refuse to start if the majority of cluster nodes does not
29358 agree that it is running on the master node. Set to @code{#t} to start
29359 even if a quorum can not be reached (dangerous, use with caution).
29360
29361 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29362 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29363
29364 @end table
29365 @end deftp
29366
29367 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-luxid-service-type
29368 @command{ganeti-luxid} is a daemon used to answer queries related to the
29369 configuration and the current live state of a Ganeti cluster. Additionally,
29370 it is the authoritative daemon for the Ganeti job queue. Jobs can be
29371 submitted via this daemon and it schedules and starts them.
29372
29373 It takes a @code{ganeti-luxid-configuration} object.
29374 @end defvr
29375
29376 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-luxid-configuration
29377 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-wconfd} service.
29378
29379 @table @asis
29380 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29381 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29382
29383 @item @code{no-voting?} (default: @code{#f})
29384 The daemon will refuse to start if it cannot verify that the majority of
29385 cluster nodes believes that it is running on the master node. Set to
29386 @code{#t} to ignore such checks and start anyway (this can be dangerous).
29387
29388 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29389 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29390
29391 @end table
29392 @end deftp
29393
29394 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-rapi-service-type
29395 @command{ganeti-rapi} provides a remote API for Ganeti clusters. It runs on
29396 the master node and can be used to perform cluster actions programmatically
29397 via a JSON-based RPC protocol.
29398
29399 Most query operations are allowed without authentication (unless
29400 @var{require-authentication?} is set), whereas write operations require
29401 explicit authorization via the @file{/var/lib/ganeti/rapi/users} file. See
29402 the @url{http://docs.ganeti.org/ganeti/master/html/rapi.html, Ganeti Remote
29403 API documentation} for more information.
29404
29405 The value of this service must be a @code{ganeti-rapi-configuration} object.
29406 @end defvr
29407
29408 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-rapi-configuration
29409 This is the configuration for the @code{ganeti-rapi} service.
29410
29411 @table @asis
29412 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29413 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29414
29415 @item @code{require-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
29416 Whether to require authentication even for read-only operations.
29417
29418 @item @code{port} (default: @code{5080})
29419 The TCP port on which to listen to API requests.
29420
29421 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29422 The network address that the service will bind to. By default it listens
29423 on all configured addresses.
29424
29425 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
29426 When set, it must specify a specific network interface such as @code{eth0}
29427 that the daemon will bind to.
29428
29429 @item @code{max-clients} (default: @code{20})
29430 The maximum number of simultaneous client requests to handle. Further
29431 connections are allowed, but no responses are sent until enough connections
29432 have closed.
29433
29434 @item @code{ssl?} (default: @code{#t})
29435 Whether to use SSL/TLS encryption on the RAPI port.
29436
29437 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29438 This can be used to provide a specific encryption key for TLS communications.
29439
29440 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @file{"/var/lib/ganeti/server.pem"})
29441 This can be used to provide a specific certificate for TLS communications.
29442
29443 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29444 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29445 Note that this will leak encryption details to the log files, use with caution.
29446
29447 @end table
29448 @end deftp
29449
29450 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-kvmd-service-type
29451 @command{ganeti-kvmd} is responsible for determining whether a given KVM
29452 instance was shut down by an administrator or a user. Normally Ganeti will
29453 restart an instance that was not stopped through Ganeti itself. If the
29454 cluster option @code{user_shutdown} is true, this daemon monitors the
29455 @code{QMP} socket provided by QEMU and listens for shutdown events, and
29456 marks the instance as @dfn{USER_down} instead of @dfn{ERROR_down} when
29457 it shuts down gracefully by itself.
29458
29459 It takes a @code{ganeti-kvmd-configuration} object.
29460 @end defvr
29461
29462 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-kvmd-configuration
29463
29464 @table @asis
29465 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29466 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29467
29468 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29469 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29470
29471 @end table
29472 @end deftp
29473
29474 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-mond-service-type
29475 @command{ganeti-mond} is an optional daemon that provides Ganeti monitoring
29476 functionality. It is responsible for running data collectors and publish the
29477 collected information through a HTTP interface.
29478
29479 It takes a @code{ganeti-mond-configuration} object.
29480 @end defvr
29481
29482 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-mond-configuration
29483
29484 @table @asis
29485 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29486 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29487
29488 @item @code{port} (default: @code{1815})
29489 The port on which the daemon will listen.
29490
29491 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
29492 The network address that the daemon will bind to. By default it binds to all
29493 available interfaces.
29494
29495 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29496 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29497
29498 @end table
29499 @end deftp
29500
29501 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-metad-service-type
29502 @command{ganeti-metad} is an optional daemon that can be used to provide
29503 information about the cluster to instances or OS install scripts.
29504
29505 It takes a @code{ganeti-metad-configuration} object.
29506 @end defvr
29507
29508 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-metad-configuration
29509
29510 @table @asis
29511 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29512 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29513
29514 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
29515 The port on which the daemon will listen.
29516
29517 @item @code{address} (default: @code{#f})
29518 If set, the daemon will bind to this address only. If left unset, the behavior
29519 depends on the cluster configuration.
29520
29521 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29522 When true, the daemon performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29523
29524 @end table
29525 @end deftp
29526
29527 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-watcher-service-type
29528 @command{ganeti-watcher} is a script designed to run periodically and ensure
29529 the health of a cluster. It will automatically restart instances that have
29530 stopped without Ganeti's consent, and repairs DRBD links in case a node has
29531 rebooted. It also archives old cluster jobs and restarts Ganeti daemons
29532 that are not running. If the cluster parameter @code{ensure_node_health}
29533 is set, the watcher will also shutdown instances and DRBD devices if the
29534 node it is running on is declared offline by known master candidates.
29535
29536 It can be paused on all nodes with @command{gnt-cluster watcher pause}.
29537
29538 The service takes a @code{ganeti-watcher-configuration} object.
29539 @end defvr
29540
29541 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-watcher-configuration
29542
29543 @table @asis
29544 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29545 The @code{ganeti} package to use for this service.
29546
29547 @item @code{schedule} (default: @code{'(next-second-from (next-minute (range 0 60 5)))})
29548 How often to run the script. The default is every five minutes.
29549
29550 @item @code{rapi-ip} (default: @code{#f})
29551 This option needs to be specified only if the RAPI daemon is configured to use
29552 a particular interface or address. By default the cluster address is used.
29553
29554 @item @code{job-age} (default: @code{(* 6 3600)})
29555 Archive cluster jobs older than this age, specified in seconds. The default
29556 is 6 hours. This keeps @command{gnt-job list} manageable.
29557
29558 @item @code{verify-disks?} (default: @code{#t})
29559 If this is @code{#f}, the watcher will not try to repair broken DRBD links
29560 automatically. Administrators will need to use @command{gnt-cluster verify-disks}
29561 manually instead.
29562
29563 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
29564 When @code{#t}, the script performs additional logging for debugging purposes.
29565
29566 @end table
29567 @end deftp
29568
29569 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ganeti-cleaner-service-type
29570 @command{ganeti-cleaner} is a script designed to run periodically and remove
29571 old files from the cluster. This service type controls two @dfn{cron jobs}:
29572 one intended for the master node that permanently purges old cluster jobs,
29573 and one intended for every node that removes expired X509 certificates, keys,
29574 and outdated @command{ganeti-watcher} information. Like all Ganeti services,
29575 it is safe to include even on non-master nodes as it will disable itself as
29576 necessary.
29577
29578 It takes a @code{ganeti-cleaner-configuration} object.
29579 @end defvr
29580
29581 @deftp {Data Type} ganeti-cleaner-configuration
29582
29583 @table @asis
29584 @item @code{ganeti} (default: @code{ganeti})
29585 The @code{ganeti} package to use for the @command{gnt-cleaner} command.
29586
29587 @item @code{master-schedule} (default: @code{"45 1 * * *"})
29588 How often to run the master cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
29589 01:45:00.
29590
29591 @item @code{node-schedule} (default: @code{"45 2 * * *"})
29592 How often to run the node cleaning job. The default is once per day, at
29593 02:45:00.
29594
29595 @end table
29596 @end deftp
29597
29598 @node Version Control Services
29599 @subsection Version Control Services
29600
29601 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
29602 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
29603 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
29604 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
29605 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
29606 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
29607 @code{cgit-service-type}.
29608
29609 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
29610
29611 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
29612 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
29613
29614 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
29615 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
29616 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
29617 @file{git-daemon-export-ok} in the repository directory.} repositories under
29618 @file{/srv/git}.
29619
29620 @end deffn
29621
29622 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
29623 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
29624
29625 @table @asis
29626 @item @code{package} (default: @code{git})
29627 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
29628
29629 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
29630 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
29631 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
29632
29633 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
29634 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
29635 If you run @command{git daemon} with @code{(base-path "/srv/git")} on
29636 @samp{example.com}, then if you later try to pull
29637 @indicateurl{git://example.com/hello.git}, git daemon will interpret the
29638 path as @file{/srv/git/hello.git}.
29639
29640 @item @code{user-path} (default: @code{#f})
29641 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
29642 specified with empty string, requests to
29643 @indicateurl{git://host/~alice/foo} is taken as a request to access
29644 @code{foo} repository in the home directory of user @code{alice}. If
29645 @code{(user-path "@var{path}")} is specified, the same request is taken
29646 as a request to access @file{@var{path}/foo} repository in the home
29647 directory of user @code{alice}.
29648
29649 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'()})
29650 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
29651 all.
29652
29653 @item @code{port} (default: @code{#f})
29654 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
29655
29656 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @code{'()})
29657 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
29658
29659 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
29660 Extra options will be passed to @command{git daemon}, please run
29661 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
29662
29663 @end table
29664 @end deftp
29665
29666 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
29667 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
29668 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
29669 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
29670 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
29671 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
29672 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
29673 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
29674 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
29675 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
29676
29677 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
29678 over HTTP.
29679
29680 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
29681 Data type representing the configuration for a future
29682 @code{git-http-service-type}; can currently be used to configure Nginx
29683 through @code{git-http-nginx-location-configuration}.
29684
29685 @table @asis
29686 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
29687 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
29688
29689 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
29690 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
29691
29692 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @code{#f})
29693 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
29694 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
29695
29696 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @samp{/git/})
29697 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @samp{/git/} prefix, this
29698 will map @indicateurl{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
29699 @file{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
29700 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
29701
29702 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
29703 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
29704 Services}.
29705 @end table
29706 @end deftp
29707
29708 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
29709 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
29710 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
29711 server.
29712
29713 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
29714 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
29715 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
29716 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
29717 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
29718
29719 @lisp
29720 (service nginx-service-type
29721 (nginx-configuration
29722 (server-blocks
29723 (list
29724 (nginx-server-configuration
29725 (listen '("443 ssl"))
29726 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
29727 (ssl-certificate
29728 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
29729 (ssl-certificate-key
29730 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
29731 (locations
29732 (list
29733 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
29734 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
29735 @end lisp
29736
29737 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
29738 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
29739 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
29740 HTTPS@. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
29741 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
29742 @end deffn
29743
29744 @subsubheading Cgit Service
29745
29746 @cindex Cgit service
29747 @cindex Git, web interface
29748 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
29749 repositories written in C.
29750
29751 The following example will configure the service with default values.
29752 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
29753
29754 @lisp
29755 (service cgit-service-type)
29756 @end lisp
29757
29758 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
29759 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
29760
29761 @c %start of fragment
29762
29763 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
29764
29765 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
29766 The CGIT package.
29767
29768 @end deftypevr
29769
29770 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
29771 NGINX configuration.
29772
29773 @end deftypevr
29774
29775 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
29776 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
29777 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
29778
29779 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29780
29781 @end deftypevr
29782
29783 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
29784 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
29785 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
29786
29787 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29788
29789 @end deftypevr
29790
29791 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
29792 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
29793 access.
29794
29795 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29796
29797 @end deftypevr
29798
29799 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
29800 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
29801 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
29802
29803 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
29804
29805 @end deftypevr
29806
29807 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
29808 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
29809
29810 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
29811
29812 @end deftypevr
29813
29814 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
29815 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29816 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
29817
29818 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
29819
29820 @end deftypevr
29821
29822 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
29823 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29824 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
29825
29826 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29827
29828 @end deftypevr
29829
29830 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
29831 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29832 version of the repository summary page.
29833
29834 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29835
29836 @end deftypevr
29837
29838 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
29839 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29840 version of the repository index page.
29841
29842 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29843
29844 @end deftypevr
29845
29846 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
29847 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
29848 scanning a path for Git repositories.
29849
29850 Defaults to @samp{15}.
29851
29852 @end deftypevr
29853
29854 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
29855 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29856 version of the repository about page.
29857
29858 Defaults to @samp{15}.
29859
29860 @end deftypevr
29861
29862 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
29863 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
29864 version of snapshots.
29865
29866 Defaults to @samp{5}.
29867
29868 @end deftypevr
29869
29870 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
29871 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
29872 caching is disabled.
29873
29874 Defaults to @samp{0}.
29875
29876 @end deftypevr
29877
29878 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
29879 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
29880
29881 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29882
29883 @end deftypevr
29884
29885 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
29886 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
29887 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
29888
29889 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29890
29891 @end deftypevr
29892
29893 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
29894 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
29895
29896 Defaults to @samp{()}.
29897
29898 @end deftypevr
29899
29900 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
29901 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
29902
29903 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29904
29905 @end deftypevr
29906
29907 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
29908 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
29909 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
29910 ordering.
29911
29912 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
29913
29914 @end deftypevr
29915
29916 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
29917 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
29918
29919 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
29920
29921 @end deftypevr
29922
29923 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
29924 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
29925 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
29926 places throughout the cgit interface.
29927
29928 Defaults to @samp{""}.
29929
29930 @end deftypevr
29931
29932 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
29933 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
29934 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
29935
29936 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29937
29938 @end deftypevr
29939
29940 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
29941 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
29942 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
29943 repository log page.
29944
29945 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29946
29947 @end deftypevr
29948
29949 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
29950 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
29951 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
29952
29953 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29954
29955 @end deftypevr
29956
29957 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
29958 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
29959 log view.
29960
29961 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29962
29963 @end deftypevr
29964
29965 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
29966 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
29967 clones.
29968
29969 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29970
29971 @end deftypevr
29972
29973 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
29974 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
29975 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
29976
29977 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29978
29979 @end deftypevr
29980
29981 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
29982 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
29983 each repo in the repository index.
29984
29985 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
29986
29987 @end deftypevr
29988
29989 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
29990 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
29991 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
29992
29993 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
29994
29995 @end deftypevr
29996
29997 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
29998 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
29999 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
30000
30001 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30002
30003 @end deftypevr
30004
30005 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
30006 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
30007 branches in the summary and refs views.
30008
30009 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30010
30011 @end deftypevr
30012
30013 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
30014 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
30015 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
30016 commit view.
30017
30018 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30019
30020 @end deftypevr
30021
30022 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
30023 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
30024 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
30025 commit view.
30026
30027 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30028
30029 @end deftypevr
30030
30031 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
30032 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
30033 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
30034
30035 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
30036
30037 @end deftypevr
30038
30039 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
30040 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
30041 set any repo specific settings.
30042
30043 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30044
30045 @end deftypevr
30046
30047 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
30048 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
30049
30050 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
30051
30052 @end deftypevr
30053
30054 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
30055 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30056 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
30057 "generated by..."@: message).
30058
30059 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30060
30061 @end deftypevr
30062
30063 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
30064 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30065 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
30066
30067 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30068
30069 @end deftypevr
30070
30071 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
30072 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30073 verbatim at the top of all pages.
30074
30075 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30076
30077 @end deftypevr
30078
30079 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
30080 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
30081 file is parsed.
30082
30083 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30084
30085 @end deftypevr
30086
30087 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
30088 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30089 verbatim above the repository index.
30090
30091 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30092
30093 @end deftypevr
30094
30095 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
30096 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30097 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
30098
30099 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30100
30101 @end deftypevr
30102
30103 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
30104 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
30105 in the servers timezone.
30106
30107 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30108
30109 @end deftypevr
30110
30111 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
30112 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
30113 on all cgit pages.
30114
30115 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
30116
30117 @end deftypevr
30118
30119 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
30120 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
30121
30122 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30123
30124 @end deftypevr
30125
30126 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
30127 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
30128 page.
30129
30130 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30131
30132 @end deftypevr
30133
30134 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
30135 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
30136
30137 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30138
30139 @end deftypevr
30140
30141 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
30142 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
30143
30144 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30145
30146 @end deftypevr
30147
30148 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
30149 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
30150
30151 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30152
30153 @end deftypevr
30154
30155 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
30156 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
30157 page.
30158
30159 Defaults to @samp{50}.
30160
30161 @end deftypevr
30162
30163 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
30164 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
30165 on the repository index page.
30166
30167 Defaults to @samp{80}.
30168
30169 @end deftypevr
30170
30171 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
30172 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
30173
30174 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30175
30176 @end deftypevr
30177
30178 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
30179 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
30180 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
30181
30182 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30183
30184 @end deftypevr
30185
30186 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
30187 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
30188
30189 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
30190 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
30191 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
30192
30193 @end deftypevr
30194
30195 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
30196 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
30197
30198 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30199
30200 @end deftypevr
30201
30202 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
30203 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30204 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
30205
30206 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30207
30208 @end deftypevr
30209
30210 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
30211 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
30212
30213 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30214
30215 @end deftypevr
30216
30217 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
30218 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
30219 disabled.
30220
30221 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30222
30223 @end deftypevr
30224
30225 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
30226 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
30227 header on all pages.
30228
30229 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30230
30231 @end deftypevr
30232
30233 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
30234 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
30235 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
30236 all subdirectories will be loaded.
30237
30238 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30239
30240 @end deftypevr
30241
30242 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
30243 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
30244
30245 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30246
30247 @end deftypevr
30248
30249 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
30250 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
30251 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
30252 removed for the URL and name.
30253
30254 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30255
30256 @end deftypevr
30257
30258 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
30259 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
30260
30261 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
30262
30263 @end deftypevr
30264
30265 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
30266 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
30267
30268 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30269
30270 @end deftypevr
30271
30272 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
30273 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
30274
30275 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
30276
30277 @end deftypevr
30278
30279 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
30280 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
30281
30282 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
30283
30284 @end deftypevr
30285
30286 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
30287 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
30288 verbatim below the ``about'' link on the repository index page.
30289
30290 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30291
30292 @end deftypevr
30293
30294 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
30295 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
30296
30297 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30298
30299 @end deftypevr
30300
30301 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
30302 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
30303 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
30304 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
30305 directories, considered as ``hidden''. Note that this does not apply to
30306 the @file{.git} directory in non-bare repos.
30307
30308 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30309
30310 @end deftypevr
30311
30312 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
30313 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
30314 generates links for.
30315
30316 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30317
30318 @end deftypevr
30319
30320 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
30321 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
30322 @code{scan-path}).
30323
30324 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
30325
30326 @end deftypevr
30327
30328 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
30329 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
30330 after this option will inherit the current section name.
30331
30332 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30333
30334 @end deftypevr
30335
30336 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
30337 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
30338 repository listing by name.
30339
30340 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30341
30342 @end deftypevr
30343
30344 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
30345 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
30346 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
30347
30348 Defaults to @samp{0}.
30349
30350 @end deftypevr
30351
30352 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
30353 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
30354 default.
30355
30356 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30357
30358 @end deftypevr
30359
30360 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
30361 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
30362 the tree view.
30363
30364 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30365
30366 @end deftypevr
30367
30368 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
30369 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository ``summary''
30370 view.
30371
30372 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30373
30374 @end deftypevr
30375
30376 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
30377 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
30378 ``summary'' view.
30379
30380 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30381
30382 @end deftypevr
30383
30384 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
30385 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository ``summary''
30386 view.
30387
30388 Defaults to @samp{10}.
30389
30390 @end deftypevr
30391
30392 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
30393 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
30394 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
30395
30396 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30397
30398 @end deftypevr
30399
30400 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
30401 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
30402
30403 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
30404
30405 @end deftypevr
30406
30407 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
30408 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
30409
30410 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30411
30412 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
30413
30414 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
30415 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
30416 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
30417
30418 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30419
30420 @end deftypevr
30421
30422 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
30423 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
30424
30425 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30426
30427 @end deftypevr
30428
30429 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
30430 The relative URL used to access the repository.
30431
30432 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30433
30434 @end deftypevr
30435
30436 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
30437 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
30438
30439 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30440
30441 @end deftypevr
30442
30443 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
30444 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
30445 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
30446
30447 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30448
30449 @end deftypevr
30450
30451 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
30452 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
30453
30454 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30455
30456 @end deftypevr
30457
30458 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
30459 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
30460
30461 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30462
30463 @end deftypevr
30464
30465 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
30466 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
30467 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
30468 ordering.
30469
30470 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30471
30472 @end deftypevr
30473
30474 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
30475 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
30476 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
30477 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or ``master'' if
30478 there is no suitable HEAD.
30479
30480 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30481
30482 @end deftypevr
30483
30484 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
30485 The value to show as repository description.
30486
30487 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30488
30489 @end deftypevr
30490
30491 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
30492 The value to show as repository homepage.
30493
30494 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30495
30496 @end deftypevr
30497
30498 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
30499 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
30500
30501 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30502
30503 @end deftypevr
30504
30505 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
30506 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30507 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
30508
30509 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30510
30511 @end deftypevr
30512
30513 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
30514 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30515 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
30516
30517 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30518
30519 @end deftypevr
30520
30521 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
30522 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
30523 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
30524
30525 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30526
30527 @end deftypevr
30528
30529 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
30530 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
30531 branches in the summary and refs views.
30532
30533 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30534
30535 @end deftypevr
30536
30537 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
30538 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
30539 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
30540
30541 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30542
30543 @end deftypevr
30544
30545 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
30546 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
30547 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
30548
30549 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
30550
30551 @end deftypevr
30552
30553 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
30554 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
30555 repository index.
30556
30557 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30558
30559 @end deftypevr
30560
30561 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
30562 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
30563
30564 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
30565
30566 @end deftypevr
30567
30568 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
30569 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
30570 on this repo’s pages.
30571
30572 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30573
30574 @end deftypevr
30575
30576 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
30577 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
30578
30579 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30580
30581 @end deftypevr
30582
30583 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
30584 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
30585
30586 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30587
30588 @end deftypevr
30589
30590 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
30591 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30592 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
30593 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
30594
30595 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30596
30597 @end deftypevr
30598
30599 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
30600 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
30601 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
30602 listing.
30603
30604 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30605
30606 @end deftypevr
30607
30608 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
30609 Override the default maximum statistics period.
30610
30611 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30612
30613 @end deftypevr
30614
30615 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
30616 The value to show as repository name.
30617
30618 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30619
30620 @end deftypevr
30621
30622 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
30623 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
30624
30625 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30626
30627 @end deftypevr
30628
30629 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
30630 An absolute path to the repository directory.
30631
30632 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30633
30634 @end deftypevr
30635
30636 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
30637 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
30638 the ``About'' page for this repo.
30639
30640 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30641
30642 @end deftypevr
30643
30644 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
30645 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
30646 after this option will inherit the current section name.
30647
30648 Defaults to @samp{""}.
30649
30650 @end deftypevr
30651
30652 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
30653 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
30654
30655 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30656
30657 @end deftypevr
30658
30659 @end deftypevr
30660
30661 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
30662 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
30663
30664 Defaults to @samp{()}.
30665
30666 @end deftypevr
30667
30668
30669 @c %end of fragment
30670
30671 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
30672 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
30673 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
30674 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
30675
30676 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
30677
30678 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
30679 The cgit package.
30680 @end deftypevr
30681
30682 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
30683 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
30684 @end deftypevr
30685
30686 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
30687 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
30688
30689 @lisp
30690 (service cgit-service-type
30691 (opaque-cgit-configuration
30692 (cgitrc "")))
30693 @end lisp
30694
30695 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
30696
30697 @cindex Gitolite service
30698 @cindex Git, hosting
30699 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
30700 repositories on a central server.
30701
30702 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
30703 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
30704
30705 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
30706 user, and the provided SSH public key.
30707
30708 @lisp
30709 (service gitolite-service-type
30710 (gitolite-configuration
30711 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
30712 "yourname.pub"
30713 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
30714 @end lisp
30715
30716 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
30717 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
30718 following command to clone the admin repository.
30719
30720 @example
30721 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
30722 @end example
30723
30724 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
30725 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
30726 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
30727 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
30728
30729 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
30730 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
30731
30732 @table @asis
30733 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
30734 Gitolite package to use.
30735
30736 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
30737 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
30738 Gitolite over SSH.
30739
30740 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
30741 Group to use for Gitolite.
30742
30743 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
30744 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
30745
30746 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
30747 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
30748 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
30749
30750 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
30751 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
30752 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
30753 within the gitolite-admin repository.
30754
30755 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
30756
30757 @lisp
30758 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
30759 @end lisp
30760
30761 @end table
30762 @end deftp
30763
30764 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
30765 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
30766
30767 @table @asis
30768 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
30769 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
30770 contents.
30771
30772 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
30773 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
30774 like cgit or gitweb.
30775
30776 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
30777 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the @samp{config}
30778 keyword. This setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
30779
30780 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
30781 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
30782
30783 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
30784 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
30785
30786 @end table
30787 @end deftp
30788
30789
30790 @node Game Services
30791 @subsection Game Services
30792
30793 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
30794 @cindex wesnothd
30795 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
30796 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
30797 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
30798
30799 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
30800 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
30801 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
30802 configuration, instantiate it as:
30803
30804 @lisp
30805 (service wesnothd-service-type)
30806 @end lisp
30807 @end defvar
30808
30809 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
30810 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
30811
30812 @table @asis
30813 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
30814 The wesnoth server package to use.
30815
30816 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
30817 The port to bind the server to.
30818 @end table
30819 @end deftp
30820
30821
30822 @node PAM Mount Service
30823 @subsection PAM Mount Service
30824 @cindex pam-mount
30825
30826 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
30827 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
30828 volume format supported by the system.
30829
30830 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
30831 Service type for PAM Mount support.
30832 @end defvar
30833
30834 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
30835 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
30836
30837 It takes the following parameters:
30838
30839 @table @asis
30840 @item @code{rules}
30841 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
30842 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
30843
30844 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
30845 Guile Reference Manual}), and the default ones don't mount anything for
30846 anyone at login:
30847
30848 @lisp
30849 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
30850 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
30851 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
30852 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
30853 "allow_root" "allow_other")
30854 ","))))
30855 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
30856 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
30857 (hup "0")
30858 (term "no")
30859 (kill "no")))
30860 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
30861 (remove "true"))))
30862 @end lisp
30863
30864 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
30865 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
30866 encrypted @env{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
30867 the partition where he stores his data:
30868
30869 @lisp
30870 (define pam-mount-rules
30871 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
30872 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
30873 (fstype "crypt")
30874 (path "/dev/sda2")
30875 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
30876 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
30877 (fstype "auto")
30878 (path "/dev/sdb3")
30879 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
30880 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
30881 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
30882 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
30883 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
30884 "allow_root" "allow_other")
30885 ","))))
30886 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
30887 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
30888 (hup "0")
30889 (term "no")
30890 (kill "no")))
30891 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
30892 (remove "true")))))
30893
30894 (service pam-mount-service-type
30895 (pam-mount-configuration
30896 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
30897 @end lisp
30898
30899 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
30900 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
30901 @end table
30902 @end deftp
30903
30904
30905 @node Guix Services
30906 @subsection Guix Services
30907
30908 @subsubheading Guix Build Coordinator
30909 The @uref{https://git.cbaines.net/guix/build-coordinator/,Guix Build
30910 Coordinator} aids in distributing derivation builds among machines
30911 running an @dfn{agent}. The build daemon is still used to build the
30912 derivations, but the Guix Build Coordinator manages allocating builds
30913 and working with the results.
30914
30915 @quotation Note
30916 This service is considered experimental. Configuration options may be
30917 changed in a backwards-incompatible manner, and not all features have
30918 been thorougly tested.
30919 @end quotation
30920
30921 The Guix Build Coordinator consists of one @dfn{coordinator}, and one or
30922 more connected @dfn{agent} processes. The coordinator process handles
30923 clients submitting builds, and allocating builds to agents. The agent
30924 processes talk to a build daemon to actually perform the builds, then
30925 send the results back to the coordinator.
30926
30927 There is a script to run the coordinator component of the Guix Build
30928 Coordinator, but the Guix service uses a custom Guile script instead, to
30929 provide better integration with G-expressions used in the configuration.
30930
30931 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-service-type
30932 Service type for the Guix Build Coordinator. Its value must be a
30933 @code{guix-build-coordinator-configuration} object.
30934 @end defvar
30935
30936 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-configuration
30937 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Build Coordinator.
30938
30939 @table @asis
30940 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
30941 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
30942
30943 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
30944 The system user to run the service as.
30945
30946 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator"})
30947 The system group to run the service as.
30948
30949 @item @code{database-uri-string} (default: @code{"sqlite:///var/lib/guix-build-coordinator/guix_build_coordinator.db"})
30950 The URI to use for the database.
30951
30952 @item @code{agent-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://0.0.0.0:8745"})
30953 The URI describing how to listen to requests from agent processes.
30954
30955 @item @code{client-communication-uri} (default: @code{"http://127.0.0.1:8746"})
30956 The URI describing how to listen to requests from clients. The client
30957 API allows submitting builds and currently isn't authenticated, so take
30958 care when configuring this value.
30959
30960 @item @code{allocation-strategy} (default: @code{#~basic-build-allocation-strategy})
30961 A G-expression for the allocation strategy to be used. This is a
30962 procedure that takes the datastore as an argument and populates the
30963 allocation plan in the database.
30964
30965 @item @code{hooks} (default: @var{'()})
30966 An association list of hooks. These provide a way to execute arbitrary
30967 code upon certain events, like a build result being processed.
30968
30969 @item @code{guile} (default: @code{guile-3.0-latest})
30970 The Guile package with which to run the Guix Build Coordinator.
30971
30972 @end table
30973 @end deftp
30974
30975 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-agent-service-type
30976 Service type for a Guix Build Coordinator agent. Its value must be a
30977 @code{guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration} object.
30978 @end defvar
30979
30980 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-configuration
30981 Data type representing the configuration a Guix Build Coordinator agent.
30982
30983 @table @asis
30984 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
30985 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
30986
30987 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-agent"})
30988 The system user to run the service as.
30989
30990 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
30991 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
30992
30993 @item @code{authentication}
30994 Record describing how this agent should authenticate with the
30995 coordinator. Possible record types are described below.
30996
30997 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
30998 The systems for which this agent should fetch builds. The agent process
30999 will use the current system it's running on as the default.
31000
31001 @item @code{max-parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
31002 The number of builds to perform in parallel.
31003
31004 @item @code{derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
31005 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for derivations, if the
31006 derivations aren't already available.
31007
31008 @item @code{non-derivation-substitute-urls} (default: @code{#f})
31009 URLs from which to attempt to fetch substitutes for build inputs, if the
31010 input store items aren't already available.
31011
31012 @end table
31013 @end deftp
31014
31015 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-password-auth
31016 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31017 UUID and password.
31018
31019 @table @asis
31020 @item @code{uuid}
31021 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
31022 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
31023 agent.
31024
31025 @item @code{password}
31026 The password to use when connecting to the coordinator.
31027
31028 @end table
31029 @end deftp
31030
31031 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-password-file-auth
31032 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31033 UUID and password read from a file.
31034
31035 @table @asis
31036 @item @code{uuid}
31037 The UUID of the agent. This should be generated by the coordinator
31038 process, stored in the coordinator database, and used by the intended
31039 agent.
31040
31041 @item @code{password-file}
31042 A file containing the password to use when connecting to the
31043 coordinator.
31044
31045 @end table
31046 @end deftp
31047
31048 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-dynamic-auth
31049 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31050 dyanmic auth token and agent name.
31051
31052 @table @asis
31053 @item @code{agent-name}
31054 Name of an agent, this is used to match up to an existing entry in the
31055 database if there is one. When no existing entry is found, a new entry
31056 is automatically added.
31057
31058 @item @code{token}
31059 Dynamic auth token, this is created and stored in the coordinator
31060 database, and is used by the agent to authenticate.
31061
31062 @end table
31063 @end deftp
31064
31065 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-agent-dynamic-auth-with-file
31066 Data type representing an agent authenticating with a coordinator via a
31067 dyanmic auth token read from a file and agent name.
31068
31069 @table @asis
31070 @item @code{agent-name}
31071 Name of an agent, this is used to match up to an existing entry in the
31072 database if there is one. When no existing entry is found, a new entry
31073 is automatically added.
31074
31075 @item @code{token-file}
31076 File containing the dynamic auth token, this is created and stored in
31077 the coordinator database, and is used by the agent to authenticate.
31078
31079 @end table
31080 @end deftp
31081
31082 The Guix Build Coordinator package contains a script to query an
31083 instance of the Guix Data Service for derivations to build, and then
31084 submit builds for those derivations to the coordinator. The service
31085 type below assists in running this script. This is an additional tool
31086 that may be useful when building derivations contained within an
31087 instance of the Guix Data Service.
31088
31089 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-service-type
31090 Service type for the
31091 guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-from-guix-data-service script. Its
31092 value must be a @code{guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration}
31093 object.
31094 @end defvar
31095
31096 @deftp {Data Type} guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds-configuration
31097 Data type representing the options to the queue builds from guix data
31098 service script.
31099
31100 @table @asis
31101 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-build-coordinator})
31102 The Guix Build Coordinator package to use.
31103
31104 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds"})
31105 The system user to run the service as.
31106
31107 @item @code{coordinator} (default: @code{"http://localhost:8745"})
31108 The URI to use when connecting to the coordinator.
31109
31110 @item @code{systems} (default: @code{#f})
31111 The systems for which to fetch derivations to build.
31112
31113 @item @code{systems-and-targets} (default: @code{#f})
31114 An association list of system and target pairs for which to fetch
31115 derivations to build.
31116
31117 @item @code{guix-data-service} (default: @code{"https://data.guix.gnu.org"})
31118 The Guix Data Service instance from which to query to find out about
31119 derivations to build.
31120
31121 @item @code{processed-commits-file} (default: @code{"/var/cache/guix-build-coordinator-queue-builds/processed-commits"})
31122 A file to record which commits have been processed, to avoid needlessly
31123 processing them again if the service is restarted.
31124
31125 @end table
31126 @end deftp
31127
31128 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
31129 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
31130 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
31131 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
31132
31133 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
31134 interface.
31135
31136 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
31137 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
31138 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
31139 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
31140 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
31141 @end defvar
31142
31143 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
31144 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
31145
31146 @table @asis
31147 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
31148 The Guix Data Service package to use.
31149
31150 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
31151 The system user to run the service as.
31152
31153 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
31154 The system group to run the service as.
31155
31156 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
31157 The port to bind the web service to.
31158
31159 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
31160 The host to bind the web service to.
31161
31162 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
31163 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
31164 configured to listen to.
31165
31166 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
31167 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
31168 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
31169 list.
31170
31171 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
31172 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
31173
31174 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
31175 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
31176
31177 @end table
31178 @end deftp
31179
31180 @node Linux Services
31181 @subsection Linux Services
31182
31183 @cindex oom
31184 @cindex out of memory killer
31185 @cindex earlyoom
31186 @cindex early out of memory daemon
31187 @subsubheading Early OOM Service
31188
31189 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
31190 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
31191 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
31192 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
31193 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
31194
31195 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
31196 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
31197 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
31198 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
31199 with:
31200
31201 @lisp
31202 (service earlyoom-service-type)
31203 @end lisp
31204 @end deffn
31205
31206 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
31207 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
31208
31209 @table @asis
31210 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
31211 The Earlyoom package to use.
31212
31213 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
31214 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
31215
31216 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
31217 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
31218
31219 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
31220 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
31221 that should be preferably killed.
31222
31223 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
31224 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
31225 that should @emph{not} be killed.
31226
31227 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
31228 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
31229 disabled by default.
31230
31231 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
31232 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
31233 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj} should be ignored.
31234
31235 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
31236 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
31237 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
31238
31239 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
31240 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
31241 notifications.
31242 @end table
31243 @end deftp
31244
31245 @cindex modprobe
31246 @cindex kernel module loader
31247 @subsubheading Kernel Module Loader Service
31248
31249 The kernel module loader service allows one to load loadable kernel
31250 modules at boot. This is especially useful for modules that don't
31251 autoload and need to be manually loaded, as it's the case with
31252 @code{ddcci}.
31253
31254 @deffn {Scheme Variable} kernel-module-loader-service-type
31255 The service type for loading loadable kernel modules at boot with
31256 @command{modprobe}. Its value must be a list of strings representing
31257 module names. For example loading the drivers provided by
31258 @code{ddcci-driver-linux}, in debugging mode by passing some module
31259 parameters, can be done as follow:
31260
31261 @lisp
31262 (use-modules (gnu) (gnu services))
31263 (use-package-modules linux)
31264 (use-service-modules linux)
31265
31266 (define ddcci-config
31267 (plain-file "ddcci.conf"
31268 "options ddcci dyndbg delay=120"))
31269
31270 (operating-system
31271 ...
31272 (services (cons* (service kernel-module-loader-service-type
31273 '("ddcci" "ddcci_backlight"))
31274 (simple-service 'ddcci-config etc-service-type
31275 (list `("modprobe.d/ddcci.conf"
31276 ,ddcci-config)))
31277 %base-services))
31278 (kernel-loadable-modules (list ddcci-driver-linux)))
31279 @end lisp
31280 @end deffn
31281
31282 @cindex zram
31283 @cindex compressed swap
31284 @cindex Compressed RAM-based block devices
31285 @subsubheading Zram Device Service
31286
31287 The Zram device service provides a compressed swap device in system
31288 memory. The Linux Kernel documentation has more information about
31289 @uref{https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/admin-guide/blockdev/zram.html,zram}
31290 devices.
31291
31292 @deffn {Scheme Variable} zram-device-service-type
31293 This service creates the zram block device, formats it as swap and
31294 enables it as a swap device. The service's value is a
31295 @code{zram-device-configuration} record.
31296
31297 @deftp {Data Type} zram-device-configuration
31298 This is the data type representing the configuration for the zram-device
31299 service.
31300
31301 @table @asis
31302 @item @code{size} (default @code{"1G"})
31303 This is the amount of space you wish to provide for the zram device. It
31304 accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a suffix, eg.:
31305 @code{"512M"} or @code{1024000}.
31306 @item @code{compression-algorithm} (default @code{'lzo})
31307 This is the compression algorithm you wish to use. It is difficult to
31308 list all the possible compression options, but common ones supported by
31309 Guix's Linux Libre Kernel include @code{'lzo}, @code{'lz4} and @code{'zstd}.
31310 @item @code{memory-limit} (default @code{0})
31311 This is the maximum amount of memory which the zram device can use.
31312 Setting it to '0' disables the limit. While it is generally expected
31313 that compression will be 2:1, it is possible that uncompressable data
31314 can be written to swap and this is a method to limit how much memory can
31315 be used. It accepts a string and can be a number of bytes or use a
31316 suffix, eg.: @code{"2G"}.
31317 @item @code{priority} (default @code{-1})
31318 This is the priority of the swap device created from the zram device.
31319 @code{swapon} accepts values between -1 and 32767, with higher values
31320 indicating higher priority. Higher priority swap will generally be used
31321 first.
31322 @end table
31323
31324 @end deftp
31325 @end deffn
31326
31327 @node Hurd Services
31328 @subsection Hurd Services
31329
31330 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-console-service-type
31331 This service starts the fancy @code{VGA} console client on the Hurd.
31332
31333 The service's value is a @code{hurd-console-configuration} record.
31334 @end defvr
31335
31336 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-console-configuration
31337 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
31338 hurd-console-service.
31339
31340 @table @asis
31341 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
31342 The Hurd package to use.
31343 @end table
31344 @end deftp
31345
31346 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hurd-getty-service-type
31347 This service starts a tty using the Hurd @code{getty} program.
31348
31349 The service's value is a @code{hurd-getty-configuration} record.
31350 @end defvr
31351
31352 @deftp {Data Type} hurd-getty-configuration
31353 This is the data type representing the configuration for the
31354 hurd-getty-service.
31355
31356 @table @asis
31357 @item @code{hurd} (default: @var{hurd})
31358 The Hurd package to use.
31359
31360 @item @code{tty}
31361 The name of the console this Getty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
31362
31363 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{38400})
31364 An integer specifying the baud rate of the tty.
31365
31366 @end table
31367 @end deftp
31368
31369 @node Miscellaneous Services
31370 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
31371
31372 @cindex fingerprint
31373 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
31374
31375 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
31376 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
31377
31378 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
31379 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
31380 reading capability.
31381
31382 @lisp
31383 (service fprintd-service-type)
31384 @end lisp
31385 @end defvr
31386
31387 @cindex sysctl
31388 @subsubheading System Control Service
31389
31390 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
31391 parameters at boot.
31392
31393 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
31394 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
31395 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
31396 instantiated as:
31397
31398 @lisp
31399 (service sysctl-service-type
31400 (sysctl-configuration
31401 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
31402 @end lisp
31403 @end defvr
31404
31405 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
31406 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
31407
31408 @table @asis
31409 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
31410 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
31411
31412 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
31413 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
31414 @end table
31415 @end deftp
31416
31417 @cindex pcscd
31418 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
31419
31420 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
31421 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
31422 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
31423 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
31424 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
31425
31426 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
31427 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
31428 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
31429 configuration, instantiate it as:
31430
31431 @lisp
31432 (service pcscd-service-type)
31433 @end lisp
31434 @end defvr
31435
31436 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
31437 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
31438
31439 @table @asis
31440 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
31441 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
31442 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
31443 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
31444 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
31445 @end table
31446 @end deftp
31447
31448 @cindex lirc
31449 @subsubheading Lirc Service
31450
31451 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
31452
31453 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
31454 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
31455 [#:extra-options '()]
31456 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
31457 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
31458
31459 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
31460 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
31461 for details.
31462
31463 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
31464 passed to @command{lircd}.
31465 @end deffn
31466
31467 @cindex spice
31468 @subsubheading Spice Service
31469
31470 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
31471
31472 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
31473 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
31474 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
31475 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
31476 @end deffn
31477
31478 @cindex inputattach
31479 @subsubheading inputattach Service
31480
31481 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
31482 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
31483 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
31484 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
31485 Xorg display server.
31486
31487 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
31488 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
31489 dispatches events from it.
31490 @end deffn
31491
31492 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
31493 @table @asis
31494 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
31495 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
31496 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
31497
31498 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
31499 The device file to connect to the device.
31500
31501 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
31502 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
31503 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
31504
31505 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
31506 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
31507 @end table
31508 @end deftp
31509
31510 @subsubheading Dictionary Service
31511 @cindex dictionary
31512 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
31513
31514 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dicod-service-type
31515 This is the type of the service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an
31516 implementation of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31517 @end defvr
31518
31519 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
31520 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
31521 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31522
31523 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
31524 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
31525 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
31526
31527 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
31528 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
31529 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31530 @end deffn
31531
31532 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
31533 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
31534
31535 @table @asis
31536 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
31537 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
31538
31539 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
31540 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
31541 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
31542 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31543
31544 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
31545 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
31546
31547 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
31548 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
31549 @end table
31550 @end deftp
31551
31552 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
31553 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
31554
31555 @table @asis
31556 @item @code{name}
31557 Name of the handler (module instance).
31558
31559 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
31560 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
31561 the module has the same name as the handler.
31562 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31563
31564 @item @code{options}
31565 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
31566 @end table
31567 @end deftp
31568
31569 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
31570 Data type representing a dictionary database.
31571
31572 @table @asis
31573 @item @code{name}
31574 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
31575
31576 @item @code{handler}
31577 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
31578 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31579
31580 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
31581 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
31582 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
31583
31584 @item @code{options}
31585 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
31586 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
31587 @end table
31588 @end deftp
31589
31590 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
31591 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
31592 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
31593 @end defvr
31594
31595 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
31596
31597 @lisp
31598 (dicod-service #:config
31599 (dicod-configuration
31600 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
31601 (name "wordnet")
31602 (module "dictorg")
31603 (options
31604 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
31605 (databases (list (dicod-database
31606 (name "wordnet")
31607 (complex? #t)
31608 (handler "wordnet")
31609 (options '("database=wn")))
31610 %dicod-database:gcide))))
31611 @end lisp
31612
31613 @cindex Docker
31614 @subsubheading Docker Service
31615
31616 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
31617
31618 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
31619
31620 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
31621 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
31622 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
31623
31624 @end defvr
31625
31626 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
31627 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
31628
31629 @table @asis
31630
31631 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
31632 The Docker daemon package to use.
31633
31634 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker-cli})
31635 The Docker client package to use.
31636
31637 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
31638 The Containerd package to use.
31639
31640 @item @code{proxy} (default @var{docker-libnetwork-cmd-proxy})
31641 The Docker user-land networking proxy package to use.
31642
31643 @item @code{enable-proxy?} (default @code{#t})
31644 Enable or disable the use of the Docker user-land networking proxy.
31645
31646 @item @code{debug?} (default @code{#f})
31647 Enable or disable debug output.
31648
31649 @item @code{enable-iptables?} (default @code{#t})
31650 Enable or disable the addition of iptables rules.
31651
31652 @end table
31653 @end deftp
31654
31655 @cindex Singularity, container service
31656 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
31657 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
31658 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
31659 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
31660 service is the Singularity package to use.
31661
31662 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
31663 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
31664 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
31665 @end defvr
31666
31667 @cindex Audit
31668 @subsubheading Auditd Service
31669
31670 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
31671
31672 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
31673
31674 This is the type of the service that runs
31675 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
31676 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
31677
31678 Examples of things that can be tracked:
31679
31680 @enumerate
31681 @item
31682 File accesses
31683 @item
31684 System calls
31685 @item
31686 Invoked commands
31687 @item
31688 Failed login attempts
31689 @item
31690 Firewall filtering
31691 @item
31692 Network access
31693 @end enumerate
31694
31695 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
31696 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
31697 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
31698 of auditctl into a file called @code{audit.rules} in the configuration
31699 directory (see below).
31700 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
31701 to view a report of all recorded events.
31702 The audit daemon by default logs into the file
31703 @file{/var/log/audit.log}.
31704
31705 @end defvr
31706
31707 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
31708 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
31709
31710 @table @asis
31711
31712 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
31713 The audit package to use.
31714
31715 @item @code{configuration-directory} (default: @code{%default-auditd-configuration-directory})
31716 The directory containing the configuration file for the audit package, which
31717 must be named @code{auditd.conf}, and optionally some audit rules to
31718 instantiate on startup.
31719
31720 @end table
31721 @end deftp
31722
31723 @cindex rshiny
31724 @subsubheading R-Shiny service
31725
31726 The @code{(gnu services science)} module provides the following service.
31727
31728 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rshiny-service-type
31729
31730 This is a type of service which is used to run a webapp created with
31731 @code{r-shiny}. This service sets the @env{R_LIBS_USER} environment
31732 variable and runs the provided script to call @code{runApp}.
31733
31734 @deftp {Data Type} rshiny-configuration
31735 This is the data type representing the configuration of rshiny.
31736
31737 @table @asis
31738
31739 @item @code{package} (default: @code{r-shiny})
31740 The package to use.
31741
31742 @item @code{binary} (defaunlt @code{"rshiny"})
31743 The name of the binary or shell script located at @code{package/bin/} to
31744 run when the service is run.
31745
31746 The common way to create this file is as follows:
31747
31748 @lisp
31749 @dots{}
31750 (let* ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out"))
31751 (targetdir (string-append out "/share/" ,name))
31752 (app (string-append out "/bin/" ,name))
31753 (Rbin (string-append (assoc-ref %build-inputs "r-min")
31754 "/bin/Rscript")))
31755 ;; @dots{}
31756 (mkdir-p (string-append out "/bin"))
31757 (call-with-output-file app
31758 (lambda (port)
31759 (format port
31760 "#!~a
31761 library(shiny)
31762 setwd(\"~a\")
31763 runApp(launch.browser=0, port=4202)~%\n"
31764 Rbin targetdir))))
31765 @end lisp
31766
31767 @end table
31768 @end deftp
31769 @end defvr
31770
31771 @cindex Nix
31772 @subsubheading Nix service
31773
31774 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
31775
31776 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
31777
31778 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
31779 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
31780 how to use it:
31781
31782 @lisp
31783 (use-modules (gnu))
31784 (use-service-modules nix)
31785 (use-package-modules package-management)
31786
31787 (operating-system
31788 ;; @dots{}
31789 (packages (append (list nix)
31790 %base-packages))
31791
31792 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
31793 %base-services)))
31794 @end lisp
31795
31796 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
31797
31798 @itemize
31799 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
31800 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
31801
31802 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
31803 @end itemize
31804
31805 @example
31806 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
31807 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
31808 @end example
31809
31810 @end defvr
31811
31812 @deftp {Data Type} nix-configuration
31813 This data type represents the configuration of the Nix daemon.
31814
31815 @table @asis
31816 @item @code{nix} (default: @code{nix})
31817 The Nix package to use.
31818
31819 @item @code{sandbox} (default: @code{#t})
31820 Specifies whether builds are sandboxed by default.
31821
31822 @item @code{build-sandbox-items} (default: @code{'()})
31823 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the
31824 @code{build-sandbox-items} field of the configuration file.
31825
31826 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
31827 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file.
31828 It is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration
31829 file.
31830
31831 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
31832 Extra command line options for @code{nix-service-type}.
31833 @end table
31834 @end deftp
31835
31836 @node Setuid Programs
31837 @section Setuid Programs
31838
31839 @cindex setuid programs
31840 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
31841 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
31842 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
31843 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
31844 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
31845 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
31846 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
31847 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
31848 for more info about the setuid mechanism).
31849
31850 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
31851 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
31852 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
31853 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
31854 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
31855 should be setuid root.
31856
31857 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
31858 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
31859 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
31860 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
31861 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
31862
31863 @example
31864 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
31865 @end example
31866
31867 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
31868 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
31869
31870 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
31871 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
31872
31873 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
31874 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
31875 @end defvr
31876
31877 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
31878 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
31879 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
31880 store.
31881
31882 @node X.509 Certificates
31883 @section X.509 Certificates
31884
31885 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
31886 @cindex X.509 certificates
31887 @cindex TLS
31888 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
31889 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
31890 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
31891 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
31892 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
31893 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
31894
31895 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
31896 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
31897 out-of-the-box.
31898
31899 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
31900 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
31901 certificates can be found.
31902
31903 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
31904 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
31905 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
31906 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
31907 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
31908 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
31909
31910 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
31911 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
31912 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
31913 to the certificates installed globally.
31914
31915 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
31916 can also install their own certificate package in
31917 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
31918 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
31919 OpenSSL library honors the @env{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @env{SSL_CERT_FILE}
31920 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
31921 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
31922 pointed to by the @env{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
31923 would typically run something like:
31924
31925 @example
31926 guix install nss-certs
31927 export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
31928 export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
31929 export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
31930 @end example
31931
31932 As another example, R requires the @env{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
31933 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
31934 something like this:
31935
31936 @example
31937 guix install nss-certs
31938 export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
31939 @end example
31940
31941 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
31942 variable in the relevant documentation.
31943
31944
31945 @node Name Service Switch
31946 @section Name Service Switch
31947
31948 @cindex name service switch
31949 @cindex NSS
31950 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
31951 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
31952 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
31953 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
31954 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
31955 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
31956 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
31957 C Library Reference Manual}).
31958
31959 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
31960 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
31961 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
31962 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
31963 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
31964 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
31965
31966 @cindex nss-mdns
31967 @cindex .local, host name lookup
31968 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
31969 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
31970 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
31971 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
31972
31973 @lisp
31974 (name-service-switch
31975 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
31976
31977 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
31978 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
31979 (name-service
31980 (name "mdns_minimal")
31981
31982 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
31983 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
31984 ;; no need to try the next methods.
31985 (reaction (lookup-specification
31986 (not-found => return))))
31987
31988 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
31989 (name-service
31990 (name "dns"))
31991
31992 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
31993 (name-service
31994 (name "mdns")))))
31995 @end lisp
31996
31997 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
31998 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
31999 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
32000
32001 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
32002 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
32003 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
32004 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
32005 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
32006 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
32007 @code{nscd-service}}).
32008
32009 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
32010 configurations.
32011
32012 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
32013 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
32014 @code{name-service-switch} object.
32015 @end defvr
32016
32017 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
32018 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
32019 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
32020 @end defvr
32021
32022 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
32023 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
32024 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
32025 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
32026 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
32027 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
32028 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
32029 run @command{guix system}.
32030
32031 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
32032
32033 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
32034 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
32035 system databases.
32036
32037 @table @code
32038 @item aliases
32039 @itemx ethers
32040 @itemx group
32041 @itemx gshadow
32042 @itemx hosts
32043 @itemx initgroups
32044 @itemx netgroup
32045 @itemx networks
32046 @itemx password
32047 @itemx public-key
32048 @itemx rpc
32049 @itemx services
32050 @itemx shadow
32051 The system databases handled by the NSS@. Each of these fields must be a
32052 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
32053 @end table
32054 @end deftp
32055
32056 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
32057
32058 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
32059 associated lookup action.
32060
32061 @table @code
32062 @item name
32063 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
32064 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
32065
32066 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
32067 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
32068 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
32069 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
32070
32071 @item reaction
32072 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
32073 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
32074 Reference Manual}). For example:
32075
32076 @lisp
32077 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
32078 (success => return))
32079 @end lisp
32080 @end table
32081 @end deftp
32082
32083 @node Initial RAM Disk
32084 @section Initial RAM Disk
32085
32086 @cindex initrd
32087 @cindex initial RAM disk
32088 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
32089 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
32090 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
32091 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
32092 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
32093
32094 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
32095 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
32096 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
32097 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
32098 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
32099 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
32100 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
32101 file system, you would write:
32102
32103 @lisp
32104 (operating-system
32105 ;; @dots{}
32106 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
32107 @end lisp
32108
32109 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
32110 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
32111 @end defvr
32112
32113 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
32114 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
32115 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
32116 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
32117 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
32118 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
32119
32120 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
32121 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
32122 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
32123 system declaration like this:
32124
32125 @lisp
32126 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
32127 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
32128 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
32129 (apply base-initrd file-systems
32130 #:qemu-networking? #t
32131 rest)))
32132 @end lisp
32133
32134 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
32135 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
32136 volatile root file system.
32137
32138 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
32139 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
32140 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
32141 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
32142 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
32143 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
32144
32145 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
32146 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
32147 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
32148 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
32149
32150 @table @code
32151 @item --load=@var{boot}
32152 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
32153 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
32154
32155 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
32156 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
32157 initialization system.
32158
32159 @item --root=@var{root}
32160 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
32161 name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system UUID.
32162 When unspecified, the device name from the root file system of the
32163 operating system declaration is used.
32164
32165 @item --system=@var{system}
32166 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
32167 @var{system}.
32168
32169 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
32170 @cindex module, black-listing
32171 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
32172 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
32173 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
32174 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
32175 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
32176
32177 @item --repl
32178 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
32179 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
32180 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
32181 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
32182 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
32183
32184 @end table
32185
32186 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
32187 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
32188 here is how to use it and customize it further.
32189
32190 @cindex initrd
32191 @cindex initial RAM disk
32192 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
32193 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
32194 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
32195 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
32196 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
32197 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
32198 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @option{--root}.
32199 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
32200 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
32201 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
32202 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd.
32203 It may
32204 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
32205 the root file system.
32206
32207 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
32208 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
32209 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
32210 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
32211 intended keyboard layout.
32212
32213 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
32214 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
32215 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
32216
32217 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
32218 to it are lost.
32219 @end deffn
32220
32221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
32222 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
32223 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
32224 [#:linux-modules '()]
32225 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
32226 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
32227 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
32228 on the kernel command line via @option{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
32229 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
32230
32231 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
32232 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
32233 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
32234 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
32235 intended keyboard layout.
32236
32237 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
32238
32239 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
32240 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
32241 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
32242 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
32243 @end deffn
32244
32245 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
32246 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
32247 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
32248 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
32249 program to run in that initrd.
32250
32251 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
32252 [#:guile %guile-3.0-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
32253 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
32254 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
32255 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
32256 automatically copied to the initrd.
32257 @end deffn
32258
32259 @node Bootloader Configuration
32260 @section Bootloader Configuration
32261
32262 @cindex bootloader
32263 @cindex boot loader
32264
32265 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
32266 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
32267 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
32268 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
32269 installed.
32270
32271 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
32272 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
32273 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
32274 field.
32275
32276 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
32277 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
32278
32279 @table @asis
32280
32281 @item @code{bootloader}
32282 @cindex EFI, bootloader
32283 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
32284 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
32285 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
32286 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
32287 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, @code{extlinux-bootloader} and
32288 @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
32289
32290 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
32291 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
32292 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
32293 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
32294 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
32295 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
32296
32297 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
32298 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
32299 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
32300 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
32301 when you boot it on your system.
32302
32303 @vindex grub-bootloader
32304 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
32305 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
32306
32307 @vindex grub-efi-netboot-bootloader
32308 @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} allows you to boot your system over network
32309 through TFTP@. In combination with an NFS root file system this allows you to
32310 build a diskless Guix system.
32311
32312 The installation of the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader} generates the content
32313 of the TFTP root directory at @code{target}
32314 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{target}}), to be served by a TFTP server.
32315 You may want to mount your TFTP server directory onto @code{target} to move the
32316 required files to the TFTP server automatically.
32317
32318 If you plan to use an NFS root file system as well (actually if you mount the
32319 store from an NFS share), then the TFTP server needs to serve the file
32320 @file{/boot/grub/grub.cfg} and other files from the store (like GRUBs background
32321 image, the kernel (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{kernel}}) and the
32322 initrd (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{initrd}})), too. All these
32323 files from the store will be accessed by GRUB through TFTP with their normal
32324 store path, for example as
32325 @file{tftp://tftp-server/gnu/store/…-initrd/initrd.cpio.gz}.
32326
32327 Two symlinks are created to make this possible. The first symlink is
32328 @code{target}@file{/efi/Guix/boot/grub/grub.cfg} pointing to
32329 @file{../../../boot/grub/grub.cfg},
32330 where @code{target} may be @file{/boot}. In this case the link is not leaving
32331 the served TFTP root directory, but otherwise it does. The second link is
32332 @code{target}@file{/gnu/store} and points to @file{../gnu/store}. This link
32333 is leaving the served TFTP root directory.
32334
32335 The assumption behind all this is that you have an NFS server exporting the root
32336 file system for your Guix system, and additionally a TFTP server exporting your
32337 @code{target} directory—usually @file{/boot}—from that same root file system for
32338 your Guix system. In this constellation the symlinks will work.
32339
32340 For other constellations you will have to program your own bootloader installer,
32341 which then takes care to make necessary files from the store accessible through
32342 TFTP, for example by copying them into the TFTP root directory at @code{target}.
32343
32344 It is important to note that symlinks pointing outside the TFTP root directory
32345 may need to be allowed in the configuration of your TFTP server. Further the
32346 store link exposes the whole store through TFTP@. Both points need to be
32347 considered carefully for security aspects.
32348
32349 Beside the @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader}, the already mentioned TFTP and
32350 NFS servers, you also need a properly configured DHCP server to make the booting
32351 over netboot possible. For all this we can currently only recommend you to look
32352 for instructions about @acronym{PXE, Preboot eXecution Environment}.
32353
32354 @item @code{target}
32355 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
32356 bootloader.
32357
32358 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
32359 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
32360 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
32361 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
32362 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
32363 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}. For @code{grub-efi-netboot-bootloader},
32364 @code{target} should be the mount point corresponding to the TFTP root
32365 directory of your TFTP server.
32366
32367 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
32368 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
32369 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
32370 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
32371
32372 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
32373 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
32374 current system.
32375
32376 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
32377 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
32378 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
32379
32380 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
32381 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
32382 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
32383 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
32384
32385 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
32386 Layout}).
32387
32388 @quotation Note
32389 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
32390 @code{grub-efi}.
32391 @end quotation
32392
32393 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
32394 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
32395 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
32396 for GRUB.
32397
32398 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
32399 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
32400 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
32401 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
32402 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
32403 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
32404 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32405
32406 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
32407 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
32408 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
32409 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
32410 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
32411 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
32412 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
32413 manual}).
32414
32415 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
32416 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
32417 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
32418 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32419
32420 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
32421 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
32422 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
32423 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
32424 @end table
32425
32426 @end deftp
32427
32428 @cindex dual boot
32429 @cindex boot menu
32430 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
32431 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
32432 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
32433 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
32434 along these lines:
32435
32436 @lisp
32437 (menu-entry
32438 (label "The Other Distro")
32439 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
32440 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
32441 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
32442 @end lisp
32443
32444 Details below.
32445
32446 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
32447 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
32448
32449 @table @asis
32450
32451 @item @code{label}
32452 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
32453
32454 @item @code{linux} (default: @code{#f})
32455 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
32456
32457 @lisp
32458 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
32459 @end lisp
32460
32461 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
32462 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
32463 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
32464
32465 @example
32466 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
32467 @end example
32468
32469 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
32470 field is ignored entirely.
32471
32472 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
32473 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
32474 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
32475
32476 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{#f})
32477 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
32478 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
32479
32480 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
32481 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
32482 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
32483
32484 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
32485 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
32486 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
32487 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
32488 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
32489
32490 @item @code{multiboot-kernel} (default: @code{#f})
32491 The kernel to boot in Multiboot-mode (@pxref{multiboot,,, grub, GNU GRUB
32492 manual}). When this field is set, a Multiboot menu-entry is generated.
32493 For example:
32494
32495 @lisp
32496 (file-append mach "/boot/gnumach")
32497 @end lisp
32498
32499 @item @code{multiboot-arguments} (default: @code{()})
32500 The list of extra command-line arguments for the multiboot-kernel.
32501
32502 @item @code{multiboot-modules} (default: @code{()})
32503 The list of commands for loading Multiboot modules. For example:
32504
32505 @lisp
32506 (list (list (file-append hurd "/hurd/ext2fs.static") "ext2fs"
32507 @dots{})
32508 (list (file-append libc "/lib/ld.so.1") "exec"
32509 @dots{}))
32510 @end lisp
32511
32512 @end table
32513 @end deftp
32514
32515 @cindex HDPI
32516 @cindex HiDPI
32517 @cindex resolution
32518 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
32519 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
32520 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
32521
32522 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
32523 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
32524
32525 @table @asis
32526 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
32527 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings,
32528 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
32529 @end table
32530 @end deftp
32531
32532 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} grub-theme
32533 Return the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
32534 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
32535 record.
32536
32537 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
32538 logos.
32539 @end deffn
32540
32541 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
32542 like
32543
32544 @lisp
32545 (bootloader
32546 (bootloader-configuration
32547 ;; @dots{}
32548 (theme (grub-theme
32549 (inherit (grub-theme))
32550 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
32551 @end lisp
32552
32553 @node Invoking guix system
32554 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
32555
32556 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
32557 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
32558 system} command. The synopsis is:
32559
32560 @example
32561 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
32562 @end example
32563
32564 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
32565 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
32566 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
32567 supported:
32568
32569 @table @code
32570 @item search
32571 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
32572 expressions, sorted by relevance:
32573
32574 @cindex HDPI
32575 @cindex HiDPI
32576 @cindex resolution
32577 @example
32578 $ guix system search console
32579 name: console-fonts
32580 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
32581 extends: shepherd-root
32582 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
32583 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
32584 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
32585 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
32586 +
32587 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
32588 + ("tty2" . (file-append
32589 + font-tamzen
32590 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
32591 + ("tty3" . (file-append
32592 + font-terminus
32593 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
32594 relevance: 9
32595
32596 name: mingetty
32597 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
32598 extends: shepherd-root
32599 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
32600 relevance: 2
32601
32602 name: login
32603 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
32604 extends: pam
32605 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
32606 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
32607 relevance: 2
32608
32609 @dots{}
32610 @end example
32611
32612 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
32613 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
32614 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
32615
32616 @item reconfigure
32617 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
32618 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
32619 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
32620 systems already running Guix System.}.
32621
32622 @quotation Note
32623 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
32624 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
32625 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
32626 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
32627 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
32628 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
32629 @end quotation
32630
32631 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
32632 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
32633 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
32634 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
32635 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
32636 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
32637
32638 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
32639 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
32640 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
32641 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
32642 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
32643
32644 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
32645 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
32646 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
32647 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
32648
32649 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32650 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
32651 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
32652 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
32653 @var{file} itself, when available. You can view it by running:
32654
32655 @example
32656 guix system describe
32657 @end example
32658
32659 This information is useful should you later want to inspect how this
32660 particular generation was built. In fact, assuming @var{file} is
32661 self-contained, you can later rebuild generation @var{n} of your
32662 operating system with:
32663
32664 @example
32665 guix time-machine \
32666 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
32667 system reconfigure \
32668 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
32669 @end example
32670
32671 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
32672 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
32673 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
32674 information on provenance tracking.
32675
32676 By default, @command{reconfigure} @emph{prevents you from downgrading
32677 your system}, which could (re)introduce security vulnerabilities and
32678 also cause problems with ``stateful'' services such as database
32679 management systems. You can override that behavior by passing
32680 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
32681
32682 @item switch-generation
32683 @cindex generations
32684 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
32685 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
32686 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
32687 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
32688 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
32689 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
32690 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
32691
32692 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
32693 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
32694 configuration file.
32695
32696 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
32697 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
32698 generation 7:
32699
32700 @example
32701 guix system switch-generation 7
32702 @end example
32703
32704 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
32705 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
32706 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
32707 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
32708 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
32709 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
32710
32711 @example
32712 guix system switch-generation -- -1
32713 @end example
32714
32715 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
32716 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
32717 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
32718 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
32719 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
32720 like activating and deactivating services.
32721
32722 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
32723
32724 @item roll-back
32725 @cindex rolling back
32726 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
32727 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
32728 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
32729 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
32730
32731 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
32732 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
32733 generation.
32734
32735 @item delete-generations
32736 @cindex deleting system generations
32737 @cindex saving space
32738 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
32739 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
32740 collector'').
32741
32742 This works in the same way as @samp{guix package --delete-generations}
32743 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @option{--delete-generations}}). With no
32744 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
32745
32746 @example
32747 guix system delete-generations
32748 @end example
32749
32750 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
32751 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
32752
32753 @example
32754 guix system delete-generations 2m
32755 @end example
32756
32757 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
32758 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
32759 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
32760
32761 @item build
32762 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
32763 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
32764 This action does not actually install anything.
32765
32766 @item init
32767 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
32768 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
32769 installations of Guix System. For instance:
32770
32771 @example
32772 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
32773 @end example
32774
32775 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
32776 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
32777 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
32778 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
32779 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
32780
32781 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
32782 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
32783 passed.
32784
32785 @item vm
32786 @cindex virtual machine
32787 @cindex VM
32788 @anchor{guix system vm}
32789 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
32790 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
32791
32792 @quotation Note
32793 The @code{vm} action and others below
32794 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
32795 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
32796 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
32797 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
32798 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
32799 @end quotation
32800
32801 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
32802 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
32803 emulated machine:
32804
32805 @example
32806 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
32807 @end example
32808
32809 The VM shares its store with the host system.
32810
32811 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
32812 the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} command-line options: the former
32813 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
32814 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
32815
32816 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
32817 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
32818 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
32819
32820 @example
32821 guix system vm my-config.scm \
32822 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
32823 @end example
32824
32825 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
32826 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
32827 store of the host can then be mounted.
32828
32829 The @option{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
32830 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
32831 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
32832 be created. The @option{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
32833 size of the image.
32834
32835 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
32836 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
32837 @item image
32838 @itemx docker-image
32839 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
32840 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
32841 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
32842 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
32843 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
32844 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
32845 @code{docker-image}.
32846
32847 @cindex image, creating disk images
32848 The @code{image} command can produce various image types. The
32849 image type can be selected using the @option{--image-type} option. It
32850 defaults to @code{efi-raw}. When its value is @code{iso9660}, the
32851 @option{--label} option can be used to specify a volume ID with
32852 @code{image}. By default, the root file system of a disk image is
32853 mounted non-volatile; the @option{--volatile} option can be provided to
32854 make it volatile instead. When using @code{image}, the bootloader
32855 installed on the generated image is taken from the provided
32856 @code{operating-system} definition. The following example demonstrates
32857 how to generate an image that uses the @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
32858 bootloader and boot it with QEMU:
32859
32860 @example
32861 image=$(guix system image --image-type=qcow2 \
32862 gnu/system/examples/lightweight-desktop.tmpl)
32863 cp $image /tmp/my-image.qcow2
32864 chmod +w /tmp/my-image.qcow2
32865 qemu-system-x86_64 -enable-kvm -hda /tmp/my-image.qcow2 -m 1000 \
32866 -bios $(guix build ovmf)/share/firmware/ovmf_x64.bin
32867 @end example
32868
32869 When using the @code{efi-raw} image type, a raw disk image is produced;
32870 it can be copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming
32871 @code{/dev/sdc} is the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy
32872 the image to it using the following command:
32873
32874 @example
32875 # dd if=$(guix system image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc status=progress
32876 @end example
32877
32878 The @code{--list-image-types} command lists all the available image
32879 types.
32880
32881 @cindex creating virtual machine images
32882 When using the @code{qcow2} image type, the returned image is in qcow2
32883 format, which the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix
32884 in a VM}, for more information on how to run the image in a virtual
32885 machine. The @code{grub-bootloader} bootloader is always used
32886 independently of what is declared in the @code{operating-system} file
32887 passed as argument. This is to make it easier to work with QEMU, which
32888 uses the SeaBIOS BIOS by default, expecting a bootloader to be installed
32889 in the Master Boot Record (MBR).
32890
32891 @cindex docker-image, creating docker images
32892 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
32893 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
32894 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
32895 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
32896 Docker container using commands like the following:
32897
32898 @example
32899 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
32900 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
32901 docker start $container_id
32902 @end example
32903
32904 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
32905 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
32906 start any services you have defined in the operating system
32907 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
32908 using @command{docker exec}:
32909
32910 @example
32911 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
32912 @end example
32913
32914 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
32915 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
32916 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
32917 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
32918 @code{docker create}.
32919
32920 Last, the @option{--network} option applies to @command{guix system
32921 docker-image}: it produces an image where network is supposedly shared
32922 with the host, and thus without services like nscd or NetworkManager.
32923
32924 @item container
32925 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
32926 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
32927 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
32928 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
32929 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
32930 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
32931
32932 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
32933 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
32934 system.
32935
32936 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
32937 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
32938 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
32939
32940 @example
32941 guix system container my-config.scm \
32942 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
32943 @end example
32944
32945 @quotation Note
32946 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
32947 @end quotation
32948
32949 @end table
32950
32951 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
32952 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
32953 following:
32954
32955 @table @option
32956 @item --expression=@var{expr}
32957 @itemx -e @var{expr}
32958 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
32959 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
32960 operating system.
32961 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
32962 Installation Image}).
32963
32964 @item --system=@var{system}
32965 @itemx -s @var{system}
32966 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
32967 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
32968
32969 @item --derivation
32970 @itemx -d
32971 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
32972 building anything.
32973
32974 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
32975 @item --save-provenance
32976 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
32977 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
32978 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
32979 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
32980 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
32981 can run:
32982
32983 @example
32984 guix system image -t qcow2 --save-provenance config.scm
32985 @end example
32986
32987 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
32988 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
32989 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
32990 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
32991 of the image.
32992
32993 @item --image-type=@var{type}
32994 @itemx -t @var{type}
32995 For the @code{image} action, create an image with given @var{type}.
32996
32997 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses the
32998 @code{efi-raw} image type.
32999
33000 @cindex ISO-9660 format
33001 @cindex CD image format
33002 @cindex DVD image format
33003 @option{--image-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
33004 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
33005
33006 @item --image-size=@var{size}
33007 For the @code{image} action, create an image of the given @var{size}.
33008 @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
33009 suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU
33010 Coreutils}).
33011
33012 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
33013 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
33014 @var{file}.
33015
33016 @item --network
33017 @itemx -N
33018 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
33019 that is, do not create a network namespace.
33020
33021 @item --root=@var{file}
33022 @itemx -r @var{file}
33023 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
33024 collector root.
33025
33026 @item --skip-checks
33027 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
33028
33029 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
33030 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
33031 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
33032 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
33033 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
33034 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
33035
33036 @item --allow-downgrades
33037 Instruct @command{guix system reconfigure} to allow system downgrades.
33038
33039 By default, @command{reconfigure} prevents you from downgrading your
33040 system. It achieves that by comparing the provenance info of your
33041 system (shown by @command{guix system describe}) with that of your
33042 @command{guix} command (shown by @command{guix describe}). If the
33043 commits for @command{guix} are not descendants of those used for your
33044 system, @command{guix system reconfigure} errors out. Passing
33045 @option{--allow-downgrades} allows you to bypass these checks.
33046
33047 @quotation Note
33048 Make sure you understand its security implications before using
33049 @option{--allow-downgrades}.
33050 @end quotation
33051
33052 @cindex on-error
33053 @cindex on-error strategy
33054 @cindex error strategy
33055 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
33056 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
33057 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
33058
33059 @table @code
33060 @item nothing-special
33061 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
33062
33063 @item backtrace
33064 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
33065
33066 @item debug
33067 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
33068 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
33069 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
33070 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
33071 a list of available debugging commands.
33072 @end table
33073 @end table
33074
33075 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
33076 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
33077 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
33078 bootloader boot menu:
33079
33080 @table @code
33081
33082 @item describe
33083 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
33084 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
33085
33086 @item list-generations
33087 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
33088 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
33089 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
33090 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
33091
33092 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
33093 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
33094 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
33095 generations that are up to 10 days old:
33096
33097 @example
33098 $ guix system list-generations 10d
33099 @end example
33100
33101 @end table
33102
33103 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
33104 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
33105 each other:
33106
33107 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
33108 @table @code
33109
33110 @item extension-graph
33111 Emit to standard output the @dfn{service
33112 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
33113 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
33114 extensions). By default the output is in Dot/Graphviz format, but you
33115 can choose a different format with @option{--graph-backend}, as with
33116 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph, @option{--backend}}):
33117
33118 The command:
33119
33120 @example
33121 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | xdot -
33122 @end example
33123
33124 shows the extension relations among services.
33125
33126 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
33127 @item shepherd-graph
33128 Emit to standard output the @dfn{dependency
33129 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
33130 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
33131 example graph.
33132
33133 Again, the default output format is Dot/Graphviz, but you can pass
33134 @option{--graph-backend} to select a different one.
33135
33136 @end table
33137
33138 @node Invoking guix deploy
33139 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
33140
33141 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
33142 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
33143 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
33144 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
33145 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
33146 once as a logical ``deployment''.
33147
33148 @quotation Note
33149 The functionality described in this section is still under development
33150 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
33151 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
33152 @end quotation
33153
33154 @example
33155 guix deploy @var{file}
33156 @end example
33157
33158 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
33159 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
33160
33161 @lisp
33162 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
33163 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
33164 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
33165 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
33166 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
33167
33168 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
33169 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
33170
33171 (define %system
33172 (operating-system
33173 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
33174 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
33175 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
33176 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
33177 (target "/dev/vda")
33178 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
33179 (file-systems (cons (file-system
33180 (mount-point "/")
33181 (device "/dev/vda1")
33182 (type "ext4"))
33183 %base-file-systems))
33184 (services
33185 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
33186 (service openssh-service-type
33187 (openssh-configuration
33188 (permit-root-login #t)
33189 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
33190 %base-services))))
33191
33192 (list (machine
33193 (operating-system %system)
33194 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
33195 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
33196 (host-name "localhost")
33197 (system "x86_64-linux")
33198 (user "alice")
33199 (identity "./id_rsa")
33200 (port 2222)))))
33201 @end lisp
33202
33203 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
33204 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
33205 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @code{%system}.
33206 @code{environment} and @code{configuration} specify how the machine should be
33207 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
33208 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
33209 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
33210 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
33211 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
33212 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
33213 @var{environment} type would be used.
33214
33215 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
33216 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
33217 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), though this step is automatic on Guix
33218 System:
33219
33220 @example
33221 # guix archive --generate-key
33222 @end example
33223
33224 @noindent
33225 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
33226 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
33227
33228 @example
33229 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
33230 @end example
33231
33232 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
33233 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
33234 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
33235 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
33236 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
33237 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
33238 @code{user}. That is, the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
33239 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag. This can
33240 be accomplished with the following operating system configuration snippet:
33241
33242 @lisp
33243 (use-modules ...
33244 (gnu system)) ;for %sudoers-specification
33245
33246 (define %user "username")
33247
33248 (operating-system
33249 ...
33250 (sudoers-file
33251 (plain-file "sudoers"
33252 (string-append (plain-file-content %sudoers-specification)
33253 (format #f "~a ALL = NOPASSWD: ALL~%"
33254 %user)))))
33255
33256 @end lisp
33257
33258 For more information regarding the format of the @file{sudoers} file,
33259 consult @command{man sudoers}.
33260
33261 @deftp {Data Type} machine
33262 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
33263 deployment.
33264
33265 @table @asis
33266 @item @code{operating-system}
33267 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
33268
33269 @item @code{environment}
33270 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
33271
33272 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
33273 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
33274 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
33275 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
33276 however, an error will be thrown.
33277 @end table
33278 @end deftp
33279
33280 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
33281 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
33282 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
33283
33284 @table @asis
33285 @item @code{host-name}
33286 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
33287 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
33288 @item @code{system}
33289 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
33290 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
33291 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
33292 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
33293 keyring.
33294 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
33295 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
33296 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
33297 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
33298 remote host.
33299
33300 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
33301 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
33302
33303 @example
33304 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
33305 @end example
33306
33307 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
33308 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
33309 client does.
33310
33311 @item @code{allow-downgrades?} (default: @code{#f})
33312 Whether to allow potential downgrades.
33313
33314 Like @command{guix system reconfigure}, @command{guix deploy} compares
33315 the channel commits currently deployed on the remote host (as returned
33316 by @command{guix system describe}) to those currently in use (as
33317 returned by @command{guix describe}) to determine whether commits
33318 currently in use are descendants of those deployed. When this is not
33319 the case and @code{allow-downgrades?} is false, it raises an error.
33320 This ensures you do not accidentally downgrade remote machines.
33321 @end table
33322 @end deftp
33323
33324 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
33325 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
33326 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
33327
33328 @table @asis
33329 @item @code{ssh-key}
33330 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
33331 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
33332 @item @code{tags}
33333 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
33334 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
33335 @item @code{region}
33336 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
33337 @item @code{size}
33338 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
33339 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
33340 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
33341 @end table
33342 @end deftp
33343
33344 @node Running Guix in a VM
33345 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
33346
33347 @cindex virtual machine
33348 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
33349 distributed at
33350 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
33351 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
33352 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
33353 as QEMU (see below for details).
33354
33355 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
33356 commonly used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
33357 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
33358 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
33359 as @file{/run/current-system/configuration.scm} (@pxref{Using the
33360 Configuration System}).
33361
33362 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
33363 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
33364 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
33365 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
33366
33367 @cindex QEMU
33368 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
33369 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
33370 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
33371 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
33372 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
33373 image -t qcow2} on x86_64 hardware:
33374
33375 @example
33376 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
33377 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
33378 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
33379 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
33380 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
33381 @end example
33382
33383 Here is what each of these options means:
33384
33385 @table @code
33386 @item qemu-system-x86_64
33387 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
33388 host.
33389
33390 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
33391 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
33392 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
33393 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
33394 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
33395 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
33396 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
33397 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
33398
33399 @item -enable-kvm
33400 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
33401 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
33402 faster.
33403
33404 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
33405 @item -m 1024
33406 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
33407 which may be insufficient for some operations.
33408
33409 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
33410 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
33411 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
33412 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
33413 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
33414
33415 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
33416 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing
33417 store of the ``myhd'' drive.
33418 @end table
33419
33420 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
33421 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
33422 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
33423 to your system definition and start the VM using
33424 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
33425 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
33426 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
33427 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
33428
33429 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
33430
33431 @cindex SSH
33432 @cindex SSH server
33433 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
33434 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
33435 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
33436 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
33437
33438 @example
33439 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
33440 @end example
33441
33442 To connect to the VM you can run
33443
33444 @example
33445 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
33446 @end example
33447
33448 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
33449 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
33450 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
33451 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
33452 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
33453
33454 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
33455
33456 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
33457 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
33458 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
33459 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
33460
33461 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
33462 VM@. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
33463
33464 @example
33465 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
33466 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
33467 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
33468 name=com.redhat.spice.0
33469 @end example
33470
33471 You'll also need to add the @code{(spice-vdagent-service)} to your
33472 system definition (@pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}).
33473
33474 @node Defining Services
33475 @section Defining Services
33476
33477 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
33478 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
33479 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
33480
33481 @menu
33482 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
33483 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
33484 * Service Reference:: API reference.
33485 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
33486 @end menu
33487
33488 @node Service Composition
33489 @subsection Service Composition
33490
33491 @cindex services
33492 @cindex daemons
33493 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
33494 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
33495 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
33496 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
33497 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
33498 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
33499 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
33500 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
33501 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
33502 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
33503 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
33504 of the system.
33505
33506 @cindex service extensions
33507 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
33508 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
33509 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
33510 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
33511 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
33512 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
33513 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
33514 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
33515 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
33516 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
33517 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
33518
33519 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
33520 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
33521 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
33522
33523 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
33524
33525 @cindex system service
33526 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
33527 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
33528 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
33529 to learn about the other service types shown here.
33530 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
33531 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
33532 particular operating system definition.
33533
33534 @cindex service types
33535 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
33536 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
33537 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
33538 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
33539 different parameters.
33540
33541 The following section describes the programming interface for service
33542 types and services.
33543
33544 @node Service Types and Services
33545 @subsection Service Types and Services
33546
33547 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
33548 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
33549 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
33550
33551 @lisp
33552 (define guix-service-type
33553 (service-type
33554 (name 'guix)
33555 (extensions
33556 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
33557 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
33558 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
33559 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
33560 @end lisp
33561
33562 @noindent
33563 It defines three things:
33564
33565 @enumerate
33566 @item
33567 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
33568
33569 @item
33570 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
33571 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
33572 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
33573
33574 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
33575 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
33576
33577 @item
33578 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
33579 @end enumerate
33580
33581 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
33582
33583 @table @code
33584 @item shepherd-root-service-type
33585 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
33586 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
33587 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
33588 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
33589
33590 @item account-service-type
33591 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
33592 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
33593 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
33594 guix-daemon}).
33595
33596 @item activation-service-type
33597 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
33598 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
33599 booted.
33600 @end table
33601
33602 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
33603
33604 @lisp
33605 (service guix-service-type
33606 (guix-configuration
33607 (build-accounts 5)
33608 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
33609 @end lisp
33610
33611 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
33612 the parameters of this specific service instance.
33613 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
33614 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
33615 value is omitted, the default value specified by
33616 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
33617
33618 @lisp
33619 (service guix-service-type)
33620 @end lisp
33621
33622 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
33623 services but is not extensible itself.
33624
33625 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
33626
33627 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
33628
33629 @lisp
33630 (define udev-service-type
33631 (service-type (name 'udev)
33632 (extensions
33633 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
33634 udev-shepherd-service)))
33635
33636 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
33637 (extend (lambda (config rules)
33638 (match config
33639 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
33640 (udev-configuration
33641 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
33642 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
33643 @end lisp
33644
33645 This is the service type for the
33646 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
33647 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
33648 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
33649
33650 @table @code
33651 @item compose
33652 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
33653 services of this type.
33654
33655 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
33656 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
33657
33658 @item extend
33659 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
33660 the composition of the extensions.
33661
33662 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
33663 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
33664 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
33665 list of contributed rules.
33666
33667 @item description
33668 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
33669 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
33670 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
33671 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
33672 @end table
33673
33674 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
33675 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
33676 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
33677
33678 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
33679 interface for services.
33680
33681 @node Service Reference
33682 @subsection Service Reference
33683
33684 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
33685 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
33686 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
33687 @code{(gnu services)} module.
33688
33689 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
33690 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
33691 below). @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
33692 this particular service instance.
33693
33694 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
33695 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
33696 raised.
33697
33698 For instance, this:
33699
33700 @lisp
33701 (service openssh-service-type)
33702 @end lisp
33703
33704 @noindent
33705 is equivalent to this:
33706
33707 @lisp
33708 (service openssh-service-type
33709 (openssh-configuration))
33710 @end lisp
33711
33712 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
33713 with the default configuration.
33714 @end deffn
33715
33716 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
33717 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
33718 @end deffn
33719
33720 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
33721 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
33722 @end deffn
33723
33724 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
33725 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
33726 parameters.
33727 @end deffn
33728
33729 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
33730
33731 @lisp
33732 (define s
33733 (service nginx-service-type
33734 (nginx-configuration
33735 (nginx nginx)
33736 (log-directory log-directory)
33737 (run-directory run-directory)
33738 (file config-file))))
33739
33740 (service? s)
33741 @result{} #t
33742
33743 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
33744 @result{} #t
33745 @end lisp
33746
33747 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
33748 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
33749 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
33750 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
33751 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
33752 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
33753 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
33754 common pattern.
33755
33756 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
33757 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
33758
33759 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
33760 clauses. Each clause has the form:
33761
33762 @example
33763 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
33764 @end example
33765
33766 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
33767 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
33768 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
33769 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
33770 @var{type}.
33771
33772 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
33773 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
33774 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
33775 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
33776 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
33777 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
33778
33779 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
33780
33781 @end deffn
33782
33783 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
33784 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
33785 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
33786 @code{operating-system} declaration.
33787
33788 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
33789 @cindex service type
33790 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
33791 and Services}).
33792
33793 @table @asis
33794 @item @code{name}
33795 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
33796
33797 @item @code{extensions}
33798 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
33799
33800 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
33801 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
33802 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
33803 services.
33804
33805 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
33806 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
33807 extensions. It may return any single value.
33808
33809 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
33810 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
33811
33812 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
33813 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
33814 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
33815 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
33816 parameter value for the service instance.
33817
33818 @item @code{description}
33819 This is a string, possibly using Texinfo markup, describing in a couple
33820 of sentences what the service is about. This string allows users to
33821 find about the service through @command{guix system search}
33822 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
33823
33824 @item @code{default-value} (default: @code{&no-default-value})
33825 The default value associated for instances of this service type. This
33826 allows users to use the @code{service} form without its second argument:
33827
33828 @lisp
33829 (service @var{type})
33830 @end lisp
33831
33832 The returned service in this case has the default value specified by
33833 @var{type}.
33834 @end table
33835
33836 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
33837 @end deftp
33838
33839 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
33840 @var{compute}
33841 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
33842 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
33843 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
33844 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
33845 @end deffn
33846
33847 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
33848 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
33849 @end deffn
33850
33851 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
33852 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
33853 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
33854 provides a shorthand for this.
33855
33856 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
33857 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
33858 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
33859 service is an instance.
33860
33861 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
33862 an additional job:
33863
33864 @lisp
33865 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
33866 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
33867 @end lisp
33868 @end deffn
33869
33870 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
33871 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
33872 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
33873 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
33874 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
33875 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
33876 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
33877
33878 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
33879 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
33880 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
33881 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
33882 @end deffn
33883
33884 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
33885 service types, some of which are listed below.
33886
33887 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
33888 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
33889 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
33890 @end defvr
33891
33892 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
33893 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
33894 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
33895 @end defvr
33896
33897 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
33898 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
33899 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
33900 passing it name/file tuples such as:
33901
33902 @lisp
33903 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
33904 @end lisp
33905
33906 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
33907 pointing to the given file.
33908 @end defvr
33909
33910 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
33911 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
33912 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
33913 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
33914 @end defvr
33915
33916 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
33917 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
33918 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
33919 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
33920 @end defvr
33921
33922 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
33923 @anchor{provenance-service-type}
33924 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
33925 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
33926 in the system itself. It creates several files under
33927 @file{/run/current-system}:
33928
33929 @table @file
33930 @item channels.scm
33931 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
33932 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
33933 to build the system, if that information was available
33934 (@pxref{Channels}).
33935
33936 @item configuration.scm
33937 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
33938 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
33939 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
33940 received on the command line.
33941
33942 @item provenance
33943 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
33944 format that is more readily processable.
33945 @end table
33946
33947 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
33948 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
33949
33950 @quotation Caveats
33951 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
33952 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
33953 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
33954 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
33955 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
33956 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
33957
33958 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
33959 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
33960 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
33961 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
33962 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
33963 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
33964 comparison less trivial.
33965 @end quotation
33966
33967 This service is automatically added to your operating system
33968 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
33969 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
33970 @end defvr
33971
33972 @node Shepherd Services
33973 @subsection Shepherd Services
33974
33975 @cindex shepherd services
33976 @cindex PID 1
33977 @cindex init system
33978 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
33979 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
33980 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
33981 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
33982 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
33983
33984 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
33985 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
33986 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
33987 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
33988 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
33989
33990 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
33991
33992 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
33993 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
33994 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
33995
33996 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
33997 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
33998 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
33999
34000 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
34001 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
34002
34003 @table @asis
34004 @item @code{provision}
34005 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
34006
34007 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
34008 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
34009 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
34010 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
34011
34012 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
34013 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
34014
34015 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
34016 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
34017 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
34018 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
34019 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
34020
34021 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
34022 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
34023 underlying process dies.
34024
34025 @item @code{start}
34026 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
34027 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
34028 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
34029 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
34030 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
34031 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
34032
34033 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
34034 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
34035 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
34036 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
34037 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
34038 @command{herd} sub-commands:
34039
34040 @example
34041 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
34042 @end example
34043
34044 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
34045 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
34046 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
34047
34048 @item @code{documentation}
34049 A documentation string, as shown when running:
34050
34051 @example
34052 herd doc @var{service-name}
34053 @end example
34054
34055 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
34056 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
34057
34058 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
34059 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
34060 @code{stop} are evaluated.
34061
34062 @end table
34063 @end deftp
34064
34065 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
34066 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
34067 Shepherd service (see above).
34068
34069 @table @code
34070 @item name
34071 Symbol naming the action.
34072
34073 @item documentation
34074 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
34075
34076 @example
34077 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
34078 @end example
34079
34080 @item procedure
34081 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
34082 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
34083 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
34084 @end table
34085
34086 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
34087 greets the user:
34088
34089 @lisp
34090 (shepherd-action
34091 (name 'say-hello)
34092 (documentation "Say hi!")
34093 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
34094 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
34095 args)
34096 #t)))
34097 @end lisp
34098
34099 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
34100
34101 @example
34102 # herd say-hello example
34103 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
34104 # herd say-hello example a b c
34105 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
34106 @end example
34107
34108 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
34109 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
34110 info on actions.
34111 @end deftp
34112
34113 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
34114 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
34115
34116 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
34117 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
34118 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}. Its
34119 value must be a @code{shepherd-configuration}, as described below.
34120 @end defvr
34121
34122 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-configuration
34123 This data type represents the Shepherd's configuration.
34124
34125 @table @code
34126 @item shepherd (default: @code{shepherd})
34127 The Shepherd package to use.
34128
34129 @item services (default: @code{'()})
34130 A list of @code{<shepherd-service>} to start.
34131 You should probably use the service extension
34132 mechanism instead (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
34133 @end table
34134 @end deftp
34135
34136 The following example specifies the Shepherd package for the operating
34137 system:
34138
34139 @lisp
34140 (operating-system
34141 ;; ...
34142 (services (append (list openssh-service-type))
34143 ;; ...
34144 %desktop-services)
34145 ;; ...
34146 ;; Use own Shepherd package.
34147 (essential-services
34148 (modify-services (operating-system-default-essential-services
34149 this-operating-system)
34150 (shepherd-root-service-type config => (shepherd-configuration
34151 (inherit config)
34152 (shepherd my-shepherd))))))
34153 @end lisp
34154
34155 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
34156 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
34157 @end defvr
34158
34159
34160 @node Documentation
34161 @chapter Documentation
34162
34163 @cindex documentation, searching for
34164 @cindex searching for documentation
34165 @cindex Info, documentation format
34166 @cindex man pages
34167 @cindex manual pages
34168 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
34169 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
34170 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
34171 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
34172 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
34173 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
34174
34175 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
34176 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
34177 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
34178
34179 @example
34180 $ info -k TLS
34181 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
34182 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
34183 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
34184 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
34185 @dots{}
34186 @end example
34187
34188 @noindent
34189 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
34190
34191 @example
34192 $ man -k TLS
34193 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
34194 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
34195 @dots {}
34196 @end example
34197
34198 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
34199 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
34200 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
34201 respected.
34202
34203 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
34204 running, say:
34205
34206 @example
34207 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
34208 @end example
34209
34210 @noindent
34211 or:
34212
34213 @example
34214 $ man certtool
34215 @end example
34216
34217 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
34218 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
34219 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
34220 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
34221 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
34222 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
34223
34224 @node Installing Debugging Files
34225 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
34226
34227 @cindex debugging files
34228 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
34229 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
34230 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
34231 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
34232 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
34233
34234 This chapter explains how to use separate debug info when packages
34235 provide it, and how to rebuild packages with debug info when it's
34236 missing.
34237
34238 @menu
34239 * Separate Debug Info:: Installing 'debug' outputs.
34240 * Rebuilding Debug Info:: Building missing debug info.
34241 @end menu
34242
34243 @node Separate Debug Info
34244 @section Separate Debug Info
34245
34246 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
34247 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
34248 weighs in at more than 60 MiB@. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
34249 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
34250 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
34251 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
34252 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
34253
34254 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
34255 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
34256 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
34257 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
34258 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
34259 with GDB}).
34260
34261 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
34262 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
34263 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
34264 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
34265 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
34266 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
34267 Guile:
34268
34269 @example
34270 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
34271 @end example
34272
34273 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
34274 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
34275 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
34276 GDB}):
34277
34278 @example
34279 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
34280 @end example
34281
34282 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
34283 @file{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
34284
34285 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
34286 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
34287 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
34288 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
34289 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
34290 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
34291
34292 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
34293 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
34294 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
34295 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages with
34296 definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. To check
34297 whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use @command{guix package
34298 --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
34299
34300 Read on for how to deal with packages lacking a @code{debug} output.
34301
34302 @node Rebuilding Debug Info
34303 @section Rebuilding Debug Info
34304
34305 @cindex debugging info, rebuilding
34306 As we saw above, some packages, but not all, provide debugging info in a
34307 @code{debug} output. What can you do when debugging info is missing?
34308 The @option{--with-debug-info} option provides a solution to that: it
34309 allows you to rebuild the package(s) for which debugging info is
34310 missing---and only those---and to graft those onto the application
34311 you're debugging. Thus, while it's not as fast as installing a
34312 @code{debug} output, it is relatively inexpensive.
34313
34314 Let's illustrate that. Suppose you're experiencing a bug in Inkscape
34315 and would like to see what's going on in GLib, a library that's deep
34316 down in its dependency graph. As it turns out, GLib does not have a
34317 @code{debug} output and the backtrace GDB shows is all sadness:
34318
34319 @example
34320 (gdb) bt
34321 #0 0x00007ffff5f92190 in g_getenv ()
34322 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libglib-2.0.so.0
34323 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init_ctor ()
34324 from /gnu/store/@dots{}-glib-2.62.6/lib/libgobject-2.0.so.0
34325 #2 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=1, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffcfd8,
34326 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffcfe8) at dl-init.c:72
34327 #3 0x00007ffff7fe2866 in call_init (env=0x7fffffffcfe8, argv=0x7fffffffcfd8, argc=1, l=<optimized out>)
34328 at dl-init.c:118
34329 @end example
34330
34331 To address that, you install Inkscape linked against a variant GLib that
34332 contains debug info:
34333
34334 @example
34335 guix install inkscape --with-debug-info=glib
34336 @end example
34337
34338 This time, debugging will be a whole lot nicer:
34339
34340 @example
34341 $ gdb --args sh -c 'exec inkscape'
34342 @dots{}
34343 (gdb) b g_getenv
34344 Function "g_getenv" not defined.
34345 Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? (y or [n]) y
34346 Breakpoint 1 (g_getenv) pending.
34347 (gdb) r
34348 Starting program: /gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/sh -c exec\ inkscape
34349 @dots{}
34350 (gdb) bt
34351 #0 g_getenv (variable=variable@@entry=0x7ffff60c7a2e "GOBJECT_DEBUG") at ../glib-2.62.6/glib/genviron.c:252
34352 #1 0x00007ffff608a7d6 in gobject_init () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4380
34353 #2 gobject_init_ctor () at ../glib-2.62.6/gobject/gtype.c:4493
34354 #3 0x00007ffff7fe275a in call_init (l=<optimized out>, argc=argc@@entry=3, argv=argv@@entry=0x7fffffffd088,
34355 env=env@@entry=0x7fffffffd0a8) at dl-init.c:72
34356 @dots{}
34357 @end example
34358
34359 Much better!
34360
34361 Note that there can be packages for which @option{--with-debug-info}
34362 will not have the desired effect. @xref{Package Transformation Options,
34363 @option{--with-debug-info}}, for more information.
34364
34365 @node Security Updates
34366 @chapter Security Updates
34367
34368 @cindex security updates
34369 @cindex security vulnerabilities
34370 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
34371 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
34372 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
34373 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
34374 containing only security updates). The @command{guix lint} tool helps
34375 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
34376 distribution:
34377
34378 @smallexample
34379 $ guix lint -c cve
34380 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
34381 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
34382 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
34383 @dots{}
34384 @end smallexample
34385
34386 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
34387
34388 Guix follows a functional
34389 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
34390 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
34391 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
34392 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
34393 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
34394 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
34395 desired.
34396
34397 @cindex grafts
34398 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
34399 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
34400 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
34401 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
34402 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
34403 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
34404 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
34405
34406 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
34407 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
34408 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
34409 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
34410 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
34411 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
34412
34413 @lisp
34414 (define bash
34415 (package
34416 (name "bash")
34417 ;; @dots{}
34418 (replacement bash-fixed)))
34419 @end lisp
34420
34421 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
34422 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
34423 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
34424 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
34425 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
34426 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
34427 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
34428 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
34429
34430 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
34431 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
34432 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
34433 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
34434 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
34435 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
34436 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
34437
34438 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
34439 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
34440 Thus, the command:
34441
34442 @example
34443 guix build bash --no-grafts
34444 @end example
34445
34446 @noindent
34447 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
34448
34449 @example
34450 guix build bash
34451 @end example
34452
34453 @noindent
34454 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
34455 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
34456
34457 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
34458 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
34459
34460 @example
34461 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
34462 @end example
34463
34464 @noindent
34465 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
34466 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
34467
34468 @example
34469 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
34470 @end example
34471
34472 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
34473 @command{lsof} command:
34474
34475 @example
34476 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
34477 @end example
34478
34479
34480 @node Bootstrapping
34481 @chapter Bootstrapping
34482
34483 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
34484
34485 @cindex bootstrapping
34486
34487 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
34488 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
34489 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
34490 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
34491 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled?
34492
34493 It is tempting to think of this question as one that only die-hard
34494 hackers may care about. However, while the answer to that question is
34495 technical in nature, its implications are wide-ranging. How the
34496 distribution is bootstrapped defines the extent to which we, as
34497 individuals and as a collective of users and hackers, can trust the
34498 software we run. It is a central concern from the standpoint of
34499 @emph{security} and from a @emph{user freedom} viewpoint.
34500
34501 @cindex bootstrap binaries
34502 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
34503 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
34504 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
34505 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
34506 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
34507 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
34508 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
34509 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
34510 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
34511
34512 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
34513 re-create them if needed (@pxref{Preparing to Use the Bootstrap
34514 Binaries}).
34515
34516 @menu
34517 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
34518 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
34519 @end menu
34520
34521 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
34522 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
34523
34524 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
34525 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
34526 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
34527 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
34528 ``taken for granted.''
34529
34530 Taking the bootstrap binaries for granted means that we consider them to
34531 be a correct and trustworthy ``seed'' for building the complete system.
34532 Therein lies a problem: the combined size of these bootstrap binaries is
34533 about 250MB (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing
34534 or even inspecting these is next to impossible.
34535
34536 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a
34537 ``Reduced Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full
34538 Source Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would
34539 be hyperbole to use that term for what we do now.}.
34540
34541 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
34542 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
34543 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
34544 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
34545 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC).
34546
34547 Using these new binary seeds the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU
34548 C Library are built from source. From here on the more traditional
34549 bootstrap process resumes. This approach has reduced the bootstrap
34550 binaries in size to about 145MB in Guix v1.1.
34551
34552 The next step that Guix has taken is to replace the shell and all its
34553 utilities with implementations in Guile Scheme, the @emph{Scheme-only
34554 bootstrap}. Gash (@pxref{Gash,,, gash, The Gash manual}) is a
34555 POSIX-compatible shell that replaces Bash, and it comes with Gash Utils
34556 which has minimalist replacements for Awk, the GNU Core Utilities, Grep,
34557 Gzip, Sed, and Tar. The rest of the bootstrap binary seeds that were
34558 removed are now built from source.
34559
34560 Building the GNU System from source is currently only possible by adding
34561 some historical GNU packages as intermediate steps@footnote{Packages
34562 such as @code{gcc-2.95.3}, @code{binutils-2.14}, @code{glibc-2.2.5},
34563 @code{gzip-1.2.4}, @code{tar-1.22}, and some others. For details, see
34564 @file{gnu/packages/commencement.scm}.}. As Gash and Gash Utils mature,
34565 and GNU packages become more bootstrappable again (e.g., new releases of
34566 GNU Sed will also ship as gzipped tarballs again, as alternative to the
34567 hard to bootstrap @code{xz}-compression), this set of added packages can
34568 hopefully be reduced again.
34569
34570 The graph below shows the resulting dependency graph for
34571 @code{gcc-core-mesboot0}, the bootstrap compiler used for the
34572 traditional bootstrap of the rest of the Guix System.
34573
34574 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph -e '(@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-core-mesboot0)' | sed -re 's,((bootstrap-mescc-tools|bootstrap-mes|guile-bootstrap).*shape =) box,\1 ellipse,' > doc/images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph.dot
34575 @image{images/gcc-core-mesboot0-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of gcc-core-mesboot0}
34576
34577 The only significant binary bootstrap seeds that remain@footnote{
34578 Ignoring the 68KB @code{mescc-tools}; that will be removed later,
34579 together with @code{mes}.} are a Scheme intepreter and a Scheme
34580 compiler: GNU Mes and GNU Guile@footnote{Not shown in this graph are the
34581 static binaries for @file{bash}, @code{tar}, and @code{xz} that are used
34582 to get Guile running.}.
34583
34584 This further reduction has brought down the size of the binary seed to
34585 about 60MB for @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}.
34586
34587 Work is ongoing to remove all binary blobs from our free software
34588 bootstrap stack, working towards a Full Source Bootstrap. Also ongoing
34589 is work to bring these bootstraps to the @code{arm-linux} and
34590 @code{aarch64-linux} architectures and to the Hurd.
34591
34592 If you are interested, join us on @samp{#bootstrappable} on the Freenode
34593 IRC network or discuss on @email{bug-mes@@gnu.org} or
34594 @email{gash-devel@@nongnu.org}.
34595
34596 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
34597 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
34598
34599 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
34600 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
34601 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
34602
34603 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
34604 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
34605 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
34606 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
34607
34608 @example
34609 guix graph -t derivation \
34610 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
34611 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
34612 @end example
34613
34614 or, for the further Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
34615
34616 @example
34617 guix graph -t derivation \
34618 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
34619 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
34620 @end example
34621
34622 At this level of detail, things are
34623 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
34624 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
34625 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
34626 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
34627 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
34628 (@pxref{The Store}).
34629
34630 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
34631 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
34632 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
34633 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
34634 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
34635 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
34636 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
34637 tarball to be unpacked.
34638
34639 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
34640 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
34641 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
34642 is what the @file{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
34643 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
34644 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
34645 in the store, using the original layout. The
34646 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
34647 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
34648 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
34649 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
34650
34651 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
34652 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
34653 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
34654 point we have a working C tool chain.
34655
34656 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
34657
34658 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
34659 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
34660 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
34661 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
34662 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
34663 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
34664 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
34665
34666 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
34667 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
34668 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
34669 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
34670 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
34671 package from source. The command:
34672
34673 @example
34674 guix graph -t bag \
34675 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
34676 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | xdot -
34677 @end example
34678
34679 @noindent
34680 displays the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
34681 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
34682 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
34683 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
34684
34685 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
34686
34687 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
34688 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
34689 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
34690 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
34691 built.
34692
34693 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
34694 tools---i.e., with @option{--target} equal to @option{--host}. They are
34695 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
34696 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
34697
34698 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built. GCC
34699 uses @command{ld} from the final Binutils, and links programs against
34700 the just-built libc. This tool chain is used to build the other
34701 packages used by Guix and by the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash,
34702 Coreutils, etc.
34703
34704 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
34705 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
34706 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
34707 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
34708 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
34709
34710
34711 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
34712
34713 @cindex bootstrap binaries
34714 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
34715 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
34716 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
34717 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
34718
34719 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
34720 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
34721 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
34722 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
34723 command-line tools):
34724
34725 @example
34726 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
34727 @end example
34728
34729 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
34730 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
34731 this section.
34732
34733 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
34734 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
34735 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
34736 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
34737 know.
34738
34739 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
34740
34741 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
34742 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
34743 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
34744 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
34745 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
34746 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
34747
34748 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
34749 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
34750 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
34751 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
34752 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
34753
34754 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
34755 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
34756 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
34757 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
34758 a simple and auditable assembler.
34759
34760 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
34761 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
34762 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
34763 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
34764 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
34765 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
34766 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
34767 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
34768
34769 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
34770 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
34771
34772 @node Porting
34773 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
34774
34775 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
34776 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
34777 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
34778 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
34779 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
34780 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
34781 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
34782
34783 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
34784 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
34785 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
34786 one:
34787
34788 @example
34789 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
34790 @end example
34791
34792 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
34793 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
34794 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
34795 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
34796 taught about the new platform.
34797
34798 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
34799 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
34800 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
34801 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
34802 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
34803 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
34804 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
34805 as well.
34806
34807 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
34808 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
34809 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
34810 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @option{--with-abi}
34811 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
34812 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
34813 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
34814 reason.
34815
34816 @c *********************************************************************
34817 @include contributing.texi
34818
34819 @c *********************************************************************
34820 @node Acknowledgments
34821 @chapter Acknowledgments
34822
34823 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
34824 which was designed and
34825 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
34826 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix). Nix pioneered functional package
34827 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
34828 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
34829 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
34830
34831 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
34832 an inspiration for Guix.
34833
34834 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
34835 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
34836 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
34837 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
34838 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
34839
34840
34841 @c *********************************************************************
34842 @node GNU Free Documentation License
34843 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
34844 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
34845 @include fdl-1.3.texi
34846
34847 @c *********************************************************************
34848 @node Concept Index
34849 @unnumbered Concept Index
34850 @printindex cp
34851
34852 @node Programming Index
34853 @unnumbered Programming Index
34854 @syncodeindex tp fn
34855 @syncodeindex vr fn
34856 @printindex fn
34857
34858 @bye
34859
34860 @c Local Variables:
34861 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
34862 @c End: